9 Simatic s5 Catalog St50 en
9 Simatic s5 Catalog St50 en
9 Simatic s5 Catalog St50 en
SIMATIC is a family of pro grammable controllers (PLCs) consisting of many finely tuned components: Program mable controllers, program ming devices, intelligent in put/output modules, etc. And each product group encom passes in turn a whole range of individual components. Programmable controllers From the compact mini con troller to the highperfor mance PLC. There are SIMATIC controllers for every demand and every require ment, in all types and sizes. What they all have in common is high processing capability packed into the smallest pos sible space, ruggedness to cope with the harshest me chanical and climatic require ments, high speed and ex pandability.
There are HMI systems and systems for open communica tions to match SIMATIC. This graded performance capability is the strength of the SIMATIC family.
This catalog gives you in formation on our product ranges SIMATIC S5, SIMATIC 505, SIMATIC programming devices, SIMATIC PCs and SIMATIC S5 software.
Redundant systems Failsafety? High availability? No problem for SIMATIC S5/505! We offer the following PLCs based on our S595U, S5115U, S5155U and 505 standard systems S The S595F and the S5115F, two failsafe PLCs which can be used wherever there could be danger to person nel, material or the environ ment.
The S5115H, S5155H and TI505 systems, three fault tolerant systems which can be used wherever produc tion downtimes must be avoided at all costs.
Siemens AG 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998
Introduction
Intelligent I/O modules SIMATIC S5/TI505 PLCs don't just perform openloop control these days, they also handle the following: S Closedloop control S Positioning S Counting, proportioning S Valve control and much more. For this purpose, there are in telligent I/O modules: They are microprocessor con trolled and execute timecriti cal special tasks completely autonomously, and they have a direct connection to the pro cess via their own input/out put channels. This avoids additional loads for the CPU.
Distributed I/Os If it is necessary to bridge large distances between the process and the I/O modules, the wiring can become very complex and susceptible to faults. If a modular and flex ible automation system is re quired, we recommend use of distributed I/O systems: S Using the ET 100U elec tronic terminator, I/O mod ules can be located up to 3 km/1.8 miles from the pro cess.
With the ET 200 distributed I/O system, you can use dis tributed I/Os, minicontrol lers and a large number of field devices at distances of up to 23 km/14.3 miles from the programmable controller. The connected devices are networked over the PROFIBUSDP highspeed fieldbus, complying with EN 50 170.
The SIMATIC family offers you an attractive overall program ming devices, concept - from the lowcost handheld pro gramming devices to the es pecially powerful desktop programming devices. The rugged industrial PCs of the SIMATIC range are the ideal tools for acquiring, pro cessing and archiving ma chine data and process data
And to match these - our soft ware. Starting with the operat ing system: S WINDOWS 95 for the proven SIMATIC software and for all PC applications for operator control and visu alization of material flows and manufacturing sequences, as well as for process control tasks.
And our STEP 5/TISOFT soft ware allows you to program your controller simply and quickly. You generate, docu ment and test with one and the same software.
Industrial PC
The PCSR software for monitoring, openloop control and closedloop control is available specially for high speed configuring of lowend and mid range process con trol systems.
HMI
The more complex automated processes become, the more important it is to have man machine communications" suited to the process. The productivity of any manufacturing system de pends to a great extent on the flexibility of the control sys tems used. Decentralization means increased flexibility but also an increased need for devices to exchange data with each other and with a host computer. Services such as qualified consultation, dependable maintenance or training all help you to realize the full po tential of your SIMATIC.
Our range of SIMATIC HMI devices provides the right solution for every task.
Open communications
SIMATIC offers a choice of two solutions for this purpose: S Pointtopoint connection from CPU to CPU or over communications processors where only a few nodes are to be linked
Communications over the In dustrial Ethernet, PROFIBUS or SINEC L1 local area net works where larger numbers of programmable controllers are to be linked.
Services
Siemens ST 50 1998
1/3
Introduction
SIMATIC S5-90U
The mini PLC at a mini price. The cost effective alternative for more simple requirements.
SIMATIC S5-95U
The highspeed mini PLC with compact performance power in a small space.
SIMATIC S5-90U Main memory for program and data (1 statement = 2 bytes) Execution time for 1 K binary statements Flags Counters Timers Arithmetic functions Digital inputs/outputs, maximum/of which onboard Analog inputs/outputs, maximum/of which onboard HMI devices Communications: Pointtopoint connection Bustype LANs 4 KB RAM/EPROM/EEPROM 2 ms 1024, of which 512 retentive 32, of which 8 retentive 32 +, 176/16 16/0 J J SINEC L1 (slave) AS-Interface PROFIBUS (with CP 541) PROFIBUSDP slave (with CP 541)
SIMATIC S5-95U 16 KB plus 4 KB for data1) RAM/EPROM/EEPROM 2 ms 2048, of which 512 retentive 128, of which 8 retentive 32 +, -, x, : 480/32 41/9 J J (2nd serial interface optional) SINEC L1 (slave) PROFIBUS (optional) PROFIBUSDP slave (optional) PROFIBUSDP master (optional)
J = can be connected/available = cannot be connected/not available 1) Not with basic version, PROFIBUS master interface
1/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
Introduction
SIMATIC S5-100U
The modular mini PLC which saves space with extradis crete modular expandability.
SIMATIC S5-100U with CPU 100 2 KB RAM/EPROM/EEPROM 70 ms 1024, of which 512 retentive 16, of which 8 retentive 16 +, 256/0 8/0 J J
CPU 102 4 KB RAM/EPROM/EEPROM 7 ms 1024, of which 512 retentive 32, of which 8 retentive 32 +, -, x, : 448/0 16/0 J J SINEC L1 (slave) AS-Interface PROFIBUS (with CP 541) PROFIBUSDP slave (with CP 541)
CPU 103 20 KB RAM/EPROM/EEPROM 0.8 ms 2048, of which 512 retentive 128, of which 8 retentive 128 +, -, x, : 448/0 32/0 J J SINEC L1 (slave) AS-Interface PROFIBUS (with CP 541) PROFIBUSDP slave (with CP 541)
Siemens ST 50 1998
1/5
Introduction
SIMATIC S5-115U
The rugged programmable controller without fan for the entire midrange. It can be adapted in stages exactly to your requirements.
CPU 941 Main memory for program and data (1 statement = 2 bytes) Execution time for 1 K binary statements Flags/S flags Counters Timers Arithmetic functions Digital inputs/outputs, max. 18 KB RAM/EPROM/ EEPROM 1.6 ms 2048/01) 1281) 1281) +, -, x, :2) 4096/4096 of which max. 512 with process I/O image 256/256
CPU 942 42 KB RAM/EPROM/ EEPROM 1.6 ms 2048/01) 1281) 1281) +, -, x, :2) 4096/4096 of which 1024/1024 with process I/O image 256/256
CPU 943 48 KB RAM/EPROM/ EEPROM 0.8 ms 2048/01) 1281) 1281) +, -, x, :2) 4096/4096 of which 1024/1024 with process I/O image 256/256
CPU 944 96 KB RAM/EPROM/ EEPROM 0.8 ms 2048/01) 1281) 1281) +, -, x, :2) 4096/4096 of which 1024/1024 with process I/O image 256/256
J = can be connected/available 1) Of which all, half or none can be retentive = cannot be connected/not available 2) Fixed point
1/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
Introduction
S5-135U The compact controller with multiprocessor capacity for all tasks of the midrange. It saves a lot of space in the control cabinet with its com pact modules.
S5-155U The highperformance PLC which combines the highest performance levels with ex tremely short execution times - the memory giant with mul tiprocessor capability".
CPU 922 64 KB RAM/EPROM and 22 KB RAM for data blocks 20 ms 2048/0 128 128 +, -, x, :3)
CPU 928 64 KB RAM/EPROM and 46 KB RAM for data blocks 1.1 ms 2048/0 256 256 +, -, x, :3)
CPU 928B 64 KB RAM/EPROM and 46 KB RAM for data blocks 0.6 ms 2048/8192 256 256 +, -, x, :3)
max. 1024/1024 with process I/O image in addition 3072/3072 without process I/O image in addition 4096/4096 with direct memory access in addition 518152/518152 with page addressing max. 192/192 in addition 256/256 with direct memory access in addition 32130/32130 with page addressing J SINEC L1 PROFIBUS Ind. Ethernet AS-Interface 3) Fixed point/floating point 4) For S5155U only
Siemens ST 50 1998
1/7
Introduction
SIMATIC 505
The powerful programmable controllers providing the ideal combination of openloop control tasks, closedloop control tasks and complex mathematical functions.
CPU Main memory for program and data (1 state ment = 2 bytes) Execution time per 1 K of binary statements Flags/of which retentive Counters Timers Arithmetic func tions Digital inputs/ outputs, max. Analog inputs/ outputs, max. Distance to dis tributed mount ing racks SIMATIC moni toring systems Networking
0.9 ms
1.3 ms
1.3 ms1)
56320/ 4096 20480 20480 +, -, x, :, 8192 8192 1000/ 4000 m TIWAY/ Industrial Ethernet
56320/ 40961) 20480 20480 +, -, x, :, , trig. funct. 8192 8192 1000/ 4000 m TIWAY/ Industrial Ethernet 64 128 1023
J = can be connected/available
1/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
Fig. 2/1
The S590U and S595U pro grammable controllers are compact mini PLCs used for the economical solution of Programming, parameter assignment Programming is done with the STEP 5 programming lan guage in the STL (statement list), LAD (ladder diagram) or CSF (control system flow chart) methods of represen tation. The packages GRAPH Mini (for S595U only) and GRAPH 5 (S595U only, with restrictions) are available for programming sequential controls. STEP 5 is available in three versions: STEP 5 for mini PLCs, specially developed for pro gramming the S590U, S595U and S5100U mini PLCs, runs on ATcompatible PCs (can be supplied on diskette).
simple automation tasks. They can be employed for control tasks that are of a simple structure and where little STEP 5 basic package for PC, runs on commercial ATPCs under MSDOS, suitable for programming all SIMATIC programmable controllers. STEP 5 basic package, the most powerful of the STEP 5 packages, runs on all programming devices and can be used for all SIMATIC programmable controllers. Depending on the version, the scope of supply includes additional software for user friendly programming and configuring a well as the STEP 5 programming soft ware.
The performance characteris tics of the S590U, S595U and of the CPU 103 can be set via a parameter assign ment data block (DB1). For userfriendly parameter as signment, the COM DB1 pa rameter assignment software is available. The PG 720, PG 720C, PG 740 and PG 760 are available for programming, parameter assignment, function changes, tests and startup.
2/2
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Fig. 2/2
Mounting
Expansion
Expansion of the S5-90U and S5-95U The S590U can be expanded via the IM 90 interface with up to 6 I/O modules of the S5100U. Up to 32 I/O modules of the S5100U can be used direct in the S595U. The following I/O modules are available:
S S S
S590U
IM 90
max. 6 modules
Digital input and output modules Analog input and output modules Ex modules for connecting sensors and actuators in plants subject to explosion hazard Special modules for external timer functions, highspeed counters and analog limit value monitoring Signal preprocessing mo dules for closedloop control and positioning tasks as well as for cam controllers
S595U
max. 32 modules
Fig. 2/3 S
Expansion S
Intelligent modules for high speed preprocessing S Diagnostics modules for monitoring the I/O bus of the S590U/95U
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/3
Inputs PII 0
Read inputs
Execute program
Coun ter
Write outputs
Program memory 0
2/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Fig. 2/5
The S595F programmable controller is a failsafe mini PLC for the lower application range. Failsafe systems (Fsystems) are always required to protect personnel, environment and equipment. Fsystems prevent hazardous states by entering a safe state in the event of a fault, i.e. the fault components are switched off. They do not, however, increase the avail ability of a system or a ma chine. If, in addition to safety, availability of the system is also an important require ment, two S5-95F systems can be combined in a mas ter-slave system.
The S595F has been approved by the relevant technical authorities in Germany. The S595F can replace con ventional protective circuits. Implementation of the mini PLC is costeffective starting from as few as 10 to 14 safetyrelated relays. Typical fields of application of the S5-95F: S Burner and boiler controls S Presses such as eccentric presses, hydraulic presses, screw presses, stamping presses and bending presses
S S S
S S
Machine tools Industrial machines such as stamping machines, cutters Machineprotection devices such as protective screens, twohand controls, emer gency off pushbuttons, mut ing functions Passenger transport systems such as escalators, conveyors, lifting platforms, cableways, underground railways, lightrail transit systems Traffic signalling systems Chemical systems such as process furnaces, process controls, centrifuges, pollutant filters, overcharge blocks, reactors, batch pro cesses Signalling systems of the Federal Railways
Design
The S595F consists of two identical subunits which can be snapped onto a standard sectional rail and which are connected by means of a fiber optic link. Both units consist of a tough plastic case, into which a processor, As with the S595U, the program is generated with the STEP 5 programming language as STL (statement list), LAD (ladder diagram) or CSF (contol system flowchart) methods of representation. The Fspecific parameteriza tion, e.g. determining the
a power supply unit and the inputs and outputs are inte grated. If the number of onboard inputs and outputs is not sufficient, the S595F can be expanded by safetyrelated I/O modules. number of safetyrelated in puts, is performed menu driven with the aid of the COM 95F configuration soft ware. In RAM operation the user program is loaded into one of the two subunits and trans ferred to the other subunit au tomatically.
In safety operation, the user program is loaded from the EPROM. For nonsafetyrelated applications, some S5100U modules which are declared reactionfree can be used (see Configuring, Section 11). Users can choose from the PG 720P, 740 and 760 pro gramming devices on which the COM 95F configuration software can also be run.
Programming
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/5
2/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Press
B S1 F1 S2 F2 P1 P2 P1 P2 I II III IV V -
1 N N -
(N) + (N) N N + N
S: Degree of injury S1: Minor injury S2: Serious irreversible injury to one or more persons or the death of one person F: Frequency or duration of stay F1: Seldom to occasionally F2: Often to permanently P: Possibility of avoiding hazards P1: Possible under certain conditions P2: Hardly possible Fig. 2/6
I-V: Levels of calculated risk B, 1-4: Categories for safety related parts of controllers N: Normal categories for the risk level (N): Additional note for standard solutions for protection equip ment and electronic equipment +: Divergence to higher category -: Divergence to lower category
Example: Risk graph for calculating the category in accordance with EN 9541 for a press
DIN V 19250 DIN V 19250 is used in many areas of plant safety (chemi cals, petrochemicals, power stations). It distinguishes 8 quality levels which can be calculated for each plant us ing a risk graph (see Fig. 2/7). The S595F meets the require ments of quality level 6.
S1 A1 S2 A2 G1 G2 G1 G2 S3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 W2
1 2 3 4 5 6 W1 Burner control
S4
8 W3
Extent of damage S1: Minor injury to one person; minor environmental damage S2: Serious irreversible injury to one or more persons or the death of one person S3: Death of more than one person; permanent major environmental damage S4: Catastrophic effects, death of many persons
Duration of stay in hazardous areas A1: Seldom to occasionally A2: Often to permanently Danger prevention G1: Possible under certain conditions G2: Hardly possible Probability of occurrence of the unwanted event W1: Very low W2: Low W3: Relatively high
Fig. 2/7
Example: Risk graph for calculating the qualtiy level in accordance with DIN V 19250 for a burner control
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/7
Fig. 2/8
Expansion possibilities
Safetyrelated expansion of the S5-95F Safetyrelated expansion of the S595F is possible with up to 16 redundant I/O modules. Only special modules are licensed for use in safety related expansion: S Safetyrelated digital input module 6ES5 4318FA11 S Safetyrelated digital output module 6ES5 4508FA11
S max. 16 modules
Safetyrelated analog output module 6ES5 4648MG11 for acquir ing max. 16 failsafe values, depending on the require ment class and dynamic re sponse of the encoders
max. 16 modules
Fig. 2/9 S S
The modules are operated in twochannel configuration (one module per subunit). Nonsafetyrelated expansion possibilities of the S5-95F Nonsafetyrelated expansion of the S595F is possible with up to 32 I/O modules of the S5100U. The following modules can be connected: S Digital input/output modules; S Analog input/output modules
385B counter module IP 262 closedloop control module S CP 521 SI communications processor Nonsafetyrelated modules are operated in single channel configuration. The module can be plugged into either subunit.
Note: Only the components specifi cally listed in this section are licensed for use in expanding the S595F. The use of other components can nullify the prototype test of the S595F!
2/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
OF connecting cable
1 2 5 10
m m m m
Bus module
6ES5 700-8MA22
EPROM 8 Kbyte (CMOS) EPROM 16 Kbyte (CMOS) EPROM 32 Kbyte (CMOS) Failsafe DI 8 x DC 24V safetyrelated Failsafe DO 4 x DC 24V/2A safetyrelated
1)
IM316 F bus interface module1) Standard function block package for emergency off Standard function block package for firing systems Standard function block package for extended func tions
Order No. 6ES5 700-8MA11 6ES5 700-8MA22 6ES5 316-8MA12 6ES5 380-8MA11 6ES5 385-8MB11 6ES5 461-8MA11 6ES5 421-8MA12 6ES5 430-8MB11 6ES5 430-8MC11 6ES5 431-8MA11 6ES5 431-8MC11 6ES5 431-8MD11 6ES5 433-8MA11 6ES5 441-8MA11 6ES5 450-8MB11 6ES5 450-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MA11 6ES5 451-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MR12 6ES5 452-8MR11
Digital output 8 x 5 ... 24 V DC / 0.1 A Digital input/output with LED display Analog input 4 x "50 mV Analog input 4 x "1 V Analog input 4 x "10 V Analog input 4 x "20 mA Analog input 4 x "4 ... 20 mA Analog output 2 x "10 V Analog output 2 x "20 mA Analog output 2 x "4 ... 20 mA Analog output 2 x 1 ... 5 V IP 262 control module2) IP 263 positioning module IP 264 electronic cam controller module IP 266 positioning module2) IP 267 stepper motor control CP 521 SI communications processor CP 521 BASIC communications processor Master module for AS interface CP 2433 Simulation module (DI or DO)
6ES5 453-8MA11 6ES5 482-8MA13 6ES5 464-8MA21 6ES5 464-8MB11 6ES5 464-8MC11 6ES5 464-8MD11 6ES5 464-8ME11 6ES5 470-8MA12 6ES5 470-8MB12 6ES5 470-8MC12 6ES5 470-8MD12 6ES5 262-8MA12 6ES5 2628MB12 6ES5 263-8MA13 6ES5 264-8MA11 6ES5 266-8MA11 6ES5 267-8MA11 6ES5 521-8MA21 6ES5 521-8MB12 6GK1 2433SA00 6ES5 7888MA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/9
Sensors
Subunit B
Actuators
Comparing the inputs After reading in the input signals, both subunits compare the process images. If the results differ, they read in the input signals repeat edly, if necessary, until the discrep ancy time projected with the COM 95F has expired. If, at this time, the input signals still differ, there is an internal or external error. The pro grammable controller immediately initiates error handling. The user can determine the error response and the discrepancy time himself in consultation with the licensing body. Comparing the outputs At the end of a cycle, both subunits compare the process images again. If the results differ, there is an internal error. Both subunits switch off. Comparing other data In addition, the two subunits also compare S the current flags and count ers and, if required, S the signature of the SI NEC L1 link.
Interrupt processing Interrupts can be projected as software interrupt as well as hardware interrupt on the central controller. The interrupt response time is 3 ms in the case of the inter rupt inputs and 10 ms in the case of the digital inputs. Self-test The S595F programmable controller implements exten sive selftest functions. The following components are tested: Link between the central controllers S Processors S Memories S All redundant I/O devices
S
By means of some of these selftests, errors occurring simultaneously in both subunits can be detected. Selftest during startup During startup in safety operation (with EPROM), all self test functions are com pletely executed in each sub unit. Selftest during cyclic operation For cyclic operation, the ope rating system divides the self test functions into small test segments which it inserts in the program cycle.
2/10
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
online
offline
S5-95F
Standard function block packages which have already been prototype tested are available for various applica tions (see Section 7). COM 95F parameter assign ment software The COM 95F parameter as signment software supports the user during parameter as signment, startup, documen tation of redundancy charac teristics and error diagnostics:
S S
parameter assignment of F specific data in interactive mode Generation of the parame ter assignment data block from the parameter assign ment data System diagnostics via error data block and interrupt register Documentation of Fspecific data via a printer System operation, e.g. load block or read EPROM
Communications possibilities
Communications partners for the S595F can include: SIMATIC programmable controllers: S590U, S595U/F, S5100U, S5115U/H/F, S5135U, S5155U/H S Other Siemens systems, such as SICOMP PC (with interfaces), SICOMP M, TELEPERM M, MOBY I etc. S Thirdparty devices, printers, barcode readers
S
PG/PC
TD 390
There are three types of links: S Pointtopoint connection S SINEC L1 local area network S PROFIBUS local area network
PROFIBUS
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/11
HMI devices and printers en able userfriendly monitoring of the process: TD 390 (see Section 10) The TD 390 is connected to the programming device port and enables the following: S Display of messages S Modification of variables in a data block (in STOP only) and S Setting of the clock (in STOP only)
COROS HMI systems (see Section 10) Operator panels OP7, OP17, OP37, OP5, OP15, OP25, OP35 can be connected via the CP 521. This makes it possible to write operating parameters to a data block even in during safety opera tion.
2/12
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
The S5100U programmable controller is suitable for the solution of the most varied types of automation tasks. Design An S5100U programmable controller consists of the following: S A CPU S Bus units S Input/output modules plugged onto the bus units The CPU and bus units are snapped onto a 35 mm (1.36 in) DIN rail. The CPU contains a power supply for connection to 24 V DC. The relevant power supply module must be used for AC voltages of 115/230 V. The bus units which hold the I/O modules and connect them to the CPU are snapped onto the DIN rail to the right of the CPU.
The S5100U has a modular design (using bus units). Extradiscrete expansion capabilities and different mo The following I/O modules are available: S Digital input and output modules S Analog input and output modules S Ex modules for connecting sensors and actuators in areas subject to explosion hazard S Special modules for external timer functions, highspeed counters and analog limit value monitoring S Intelligent modules for high speed processing S Diagnostics modules for monitoring the I/O bus of the S5100U S Simulation modules for the program tests An S5100U can contain up to 32 I/O modules arranged in up to four tiers (see page 2/14).
dule types mean that it can be adapted optimally to the au tomation task to be solved.
Mechanical coding of I/O modules The bus units and modules have a keytype coding system to prevent the various module types from being con fused on replacement: The rear side of each module has a coding "key" which is set to a specific unchange able position for each module type. The bus unit has a rotable coding element. Before a module is swung down into position for the first time, the coding element must be turned into the correct position to allow insertion of the coding key. Thus, the bus unit can only take the module type intended for it.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/13
Horizontal configuration The modules can be installed side by side on a horizontal DIN rail (singletier configura tion). If a DIN rail is not long enough to take all modules re quired, up to four tiers can be installed in one configuration. The various tiers are inter connected using interface modules. The DIN rails must have a minimum spacing of Programming Programming is done with the STEP 5 programming lan guage in the STL (statement list), LAD (ladder diagram) or CSF (control system flow chart) methods of represen tation. The packages GRAPH Mini and GRAPH 5 (CPU 103 only) are available for pro gramming sequential controls. STEP 5 is available in three versions: STEP 5 for mini PLCs, specially developed for pro gramming the S590U, S595U and S5100U mini PLCs, runs on ATcompatible PCs (can be supplied on diskette).
21 cm (8.2 in) to achieve the necessary heat dissipation. The maximum distance between two tiers is 10 m (32.8 ft). Vertical configuration The DIN rail can also be arranged vertically with the modules being attached one under the other. Because of the resulting reduction in heat dissipation, the maximum STEP 5 basic package for PC, runs on commercial ATPCs under MSDOS, suitable for programming all SIMATIC programmable controllers. STEP 5 basic package, the most powerful of the STEP 5 packages, runs on all programming devices and can be used for all SIMATIC programmable controllers. Depending on the version, the scope of supply includes additional software for user friendly programming and configuring as well as the STEP 5 programming software.
ambient temperature is limited to 40 _C. If several tiers are used, the minimum and maxi mum clearances as for the horizontal arrangement apply. The installation guidelines apply not only for the S5100U modular PLC but also for the S590U and S595U compact PLCs expanded with I/O modules.
The PG 720P, PG 740 and PG 760 are available for pro gramming, function changes, tests and startup. Note The appropriate regulations must be observed when designing safetyrelated controls.
2/14
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Inputs PII 0
Read inputs
Execute program
Coun ter
Interrupt program
Write outputs
Program memory 0
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/15
Technical specifications
S590U General Range of functions Boolean logic, bracketed operations, result assignment, setting/resetting (latching/unlatching), counter and timer functions, load, transfer, comparison and jump operations, block calls, special functions, arithmetic STEP 5 STEP 5 STL, LAD, CSF STL, LAD, CSF, GRAPH Mini, GRAPH 5 (with restrictions) Linear or structured Linear or structured Analog value input, output, BCD/binary code conversion, multiplication and division for 16bit fixedpoint numbers, L2 SEND, L2 RECIVE (L2 interface only) Cyclic, alarmdriven program execution, Cyclic, alarmdriven program execution, manual and automatic restart manual and automatic restart, timecontrolled program execution, response in case of battery failure, retriggering the scan time, PID control algorithm approx. 2 ms 4 Kbyte 2 ms 16 Kbyte, can be allocated to program or data according to user requirements; additionally 4 Kbyte for data blocks1) 1 year 2048, 512 of which are retentive 128 0.01 to 9990 s 128; 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 480/32 41/9 4/4 66/2 Date/time/operating hours counter/clock prompt S595U
Programming language Methods of representation Program organization Integral function blocks (in the operating system)
Program memory S RAM (internal) or alternatively EPROM or EEPROM (in memory submodule) (2 byte = 1 statement) Backup time for RAM min. Bit memories S Number Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Number of inputs/outputs S Digital inputs/outputs maximum/onboard S Analog inputs/outputs maximum/onboard S Interrupt inputs maximum/onboard S Counter inputs maximum/onboard Hardware clock
1)
1 year 1024, 512 of which are retentive 32 0.01 to 9990 s 32; 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 176/16 16/ 1/1 13/1
2/16
Siemens ST 50 1998
CPUs/Compact PLCs
IEC 68227 12 shocks (semisinusoidal, 15 g, 11 ms) 145 x 135 x 146 (5.6 x 5.2 x 5.6) 1.5 kg (4 lb) 0.1 kg (0.27 lb)
Onboard power supply Supply voltage S Rated value S Permissible range Output voltage S V1 S V2 Output current max. S from V1 max. S from V2 Shortcircuit protection Backup battery S Backup period at 25 _C and uninterrupted backup of the CPU with memory submodule S Battery life approx. Protection class Galvanic isolation V1 Galvanic isolation V2 RI specification Cable crosssection for screw terminals - Flexible cables - Solid cables
1)
115 V/230 V AC 93 V to 127 V/187 to 253 V 24 V DC (for sensor) 5.2 V DC (for PGs) 100 mA 100 mA Electronic Lithium battery 1 year
24 V DC 20 V to 30 V 9 V DC (for external I/O) 5.2 V DC (for PGs) 1A 650 mA Electronic Lithium battery 1 year
5 years Class 1 to IEC 536 Yes No A in acc. with VDE 0871 2 x (0.5 to 1.5) mm2 (with connector sleeves) 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm2
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/17
1 x 106 0.5 x 106 1, can also be used as digital input Yes See onboard digital inputs typ. typ. min. max. 40 ms 180 ms 500 ms 50 m (164 ft) (unshielded) 1, can also be used as digital input Yes See onboard digital inputs typ. typ. max. min. max. 40 ms 180 ms 1 kHz 500 ms 50 m (164 ft) (unshielded)
Counter B: 2 kHz
2/18
Siemens ST 50 1998
CPUs/Compact PLCs
S595U 8; can also be used as digital inputs 0 to 10 V No 20 kW 12 bit 10 bit Instantaneous value coding (successive approximation) 40 ms 3.5 ms Yes 1.68 % 100 m (328 ft) 1 No 11 bit 10 bit 0 to 10 V 2.5 kW 20 ms (incl. setting time) Yes 30 mA 1% 100 m (328 ft) 0 to 20 mA 300 W 30 ms 11 % 100 m (328 ft)
max.
Based on rated value of measuring range (10 V or 20 mA) Order No. 6ES5 090-8MA01 Wall fastenings for direct mounting of the S590U on walls and supporting plates, 1 set, consisting of 4 fastenings IM 90 interface module for expansion of the S590U by up to 6 I/O modules Bus units, I/O modules Simulator for digital input signals STEP 5 package for mini controllers based on S5DOS/ST, runs under PG/PC, in Ger., Eng., Fr., It., Sp. Single licence Copy licence COM DB1 parameterization software Order No. 6ES5 981-8MB11
Ordering data
S5-90U programmable controller incl. backup battery for 115/230 V AC, without User's Guide 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbyte EEPROM 2 Kbyte EEPROM 4 Kbyte Backup battery (lithium battery) To be ordered as a separate item: S5-90U/-95U system manual with User's Guide for S590U/95U German English French Spanish Italian 35 mm DIN rail Length 483 mm (for 19 in cabinets) Length 530 mm (for 600 mm cabinets) Length 830 mm (for 900 mm cabinets) Length 2 m
6ES5 090-8ME11
6ES5 998-8MA12 6ES5 998-8MA22 6ES5 998-8MA32 6ES5 998-8MA42 6ES5 998-8MA52 6ES5 710-8MA11 6ES5 710-8MA21 6ES5 710-8MA31 6ES5 710-8MA41
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/19
Ordering data
Power supply module for 115/230 V AC ; 24 V DC/2 A for 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC/4 A for 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC/10 A 35 mm DIN rail Front connector1) 40pin for crimp terminals (increased EMC protection) S With crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts 40pin, for screw terminals S Standard S Increased EMC protection Sub D connector 9pin, male contacts 15pin, male contacts Extractor tool for crimp contacts
Order No.
6ES5 095-8MB02
6ES5 931-8MD11 6EW1 380-1AB 6EW1 380-4AB01 see S590U (see page 2/19)
6ES5 095-8MC01
6ES5 490-8MA13 6ES5 490-8MA03 6ES5 490-8MB11 6ES5 490-8FB11 6ES5 750-2AA11 6ES5 750-2AA21 6ES5 497-8MA11 6XX3 070 6XX3 071 see page 2/27
6ES5 095-8MD01
6ES5 095-8ME01
6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-0LC11 6ES5 375-0LC21 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41 6ES5 375-0LC61 6ES5 980-0MA11 6ES5 998-8MA J2
Crimp contacts, pack of 250 Crimping tool for crimp contacts Bus units, I/O modules STEP 5 package for mini PLCs Runs under PG/PC, in German, English, French, Spa nish, Italian Single license Copy license COM DB1 parameter assignment software for highspeed, userfriendly parameter assignment of S590U, S595U, S5100U, based on S5DOS/ST, runs under PG/PC Single license
6ES5 998-8MB J2
6ES5 998-8MC J1
6ES5 895-3MW J1
6ES5 998-8MD J1
1 2 3 4 5
6ES5 998-3ES J2
1 2 3 4 5
1) The left row of terminals on the front connector is marked with an "a", the right row with a "b". 2) Only for S595U with PROFIBUSDP master interface (6ES5 0958ME01)
2/20
Siemens ST 50 1998
CPUs/Compact PLCs
Technical specifications
S595F Function range Programming language Methods of representation Execution time for 1024 binary statements Const. loading of the PLC cycle by internal testing approx. Program memory S RAM (internal) or EPROM (in the memory submodule) 2 byte = 1 statement) Bit memories S Number Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Onboard I/Os S Digital inputs S Digital outputs Configurable failsafety, extensive selftesting and error diagnostics functions STEP 5 AWL/KOP/FUP 1.2 ms 20 to 30 ms 16 Kbyte
2048; 512 of which are retentive 128; not retentive 0.01 to 9990 s 128; 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 16; safetyrelated; 24 V DC, 10 mA; floating; interrupt with response time 10 ms 8; safetyrelated, floating; 24 V DC, 750 mA 8; (4 per subunit); not safetyrelated, floating 24 V DC, 500 mA; e.g. for shortcircuit test of external cabling 4; safetyrelated; 24 V DC, 10 mA; interrupt capability with response time 3 ms or 10 ms 2; safetyrelated, floating; 24 V DC, 10 mA, 900 Hz (can also be used for safetyrelated speed monitoring (alarm OB on overspeed)) 200 m (656 ft) 128; safetyrelated or 320; not safetyrelated 64; safetyrelated or 320; not safetyrelated 16; safetyrelated (depends on requirement class and dynamic response of encoders) or 32; not safetyrelated 16; not safetyrelated 24 V DC (20 to 30 V) 1 A at 24 V DC and maximum I/O configuration 32 modules S5100U I/O modules and/or safetyrelated digital input/output modules
S Interrupt counters S Hardware counters Cable length (unshielded) External I/Os (expansion) S Digital inputs S Digital outputs S Analog inputs S Analog outputs max. max. max. max. max.
PG, PC, SINEC L1 (slave), PROFIBUS (via CP 541), PROFIBUSDP (not safetyrelated, slave only, via CP 541) PG 720, PG 720C, PG 740, PG 760
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/21
Ordering data
S5-95F programmable controller Subunit, for 24 V DC Fiber optic connection cable for linking subunits 1 m (3.28 ft) 2 m (6.56 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbyte EPROM 16 Kbyte EPROM 32 Kbyte Backup battery (lithium battery) S5-95F system manual For further information see also Application Manual SIGUARD and SIMATIC S5-95F Safety German English COM 95F parameterization software withCOM 95F Operator Guide Single licence Copy licence German English French Italian
Ordering data
35 mm DIN rail Length g 483 mm (for 19 in cabinets) Length 530 mm (for 600 mm cabinets) Length 830 mm (for 900 mm cabinets) Length 2 m Front connector 1) 40pin for crimp terminals (increased EMC protection) S With crimp contacts t c p co tacts S Without crimp contacts 40pin 40 pin for screw terminals (increased EMC protection) Extraction tool for crimp contacts Crimp contacts, pack of 250
Order No.
6ES5 722-1BB00 6ES5 722-1BC00 6ES5 722-1BF00 6ES5 722-1CB00 6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 980-0MA11 6ES5 998-1MFJ3
6ES5 6 S5 490-8MA13 90 8 3 6ES5 490-8MA03 6ES5 490-8FB11 490 8FB11 6ES5 497-8MA11 6XX3 070 6XX3 071 750 2AA11 6ES5 750-2AA11
Crimping tool for crimp contacts connector 9pin, 9 pin male Sub D connector,
1) The left row of terminals on the front connector is marked with an "a", the right row with a "b".
2/22
Siemens ST 50 1998
CPUs/Compact PLCs
Fast detection of unsafe states by short-circuit moni toring in the I/Os and safe ty-related monitoring of pro gram processing S Direct link of additional nonsafety-related press func tions so that one controller can be used for the whole press S Comprehensive fault and diagnostics options if a fault occurs S Integration of additional cus tomized safety functions
S
The press safety controller SI MATIC S5-95F/P meets the safety and accident preven tion regulations and specifica tions that apply to presses in a user-friendly manner. It re places conventional contactor equipment that uses positiveaction contacts and also of fers the advantages of a mod ern freely programmable PLC in press safety. Design, principle of operation Programming See S595F (from page 2/5)
All functions are supplied as correctly programmed soft ware in the controller. Pressspecific functions such as two-hand engagement, oper ating mode selection, cam and limit switch scanning, etc., are supplied as software modules and make operation easier for the user.
These modules have been certified by the responsible German Trade Association. Safety on presses is guaran teed in conjunction with the accepted software packages. Only verification that safety requirements are fulfilled by the user program and the ex ternal feedback module is then necessary. Ordering data
Safety-related digital input Safety-related digital output Power supply modules, standard DIN rail Front connector 40-pin, with screw connection Parameterization software COM 95F Documentation Brief description
The S5-95F/P is programmed in the same way as the S5-95F (see Page 2/11)
Ordering data
Press safety controller SIMATICS5-95F/P with 2 S5-95F/P central control lers, fiber-optic cable (1 m), press-specific safety program, manual S Basic version for mechanical presses S Basic version for mechanical and hydraulic presses S Full version for mechanical presses 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbytes Backup battery (Lithium battery)
Order No.
Order No. 6ES5 431-8FA11 6ES5 450-8FA11 see S590U, S595U 6ES5 490-8FB11 see Section 7
6AT1 150-0AA03-0XA0 6AT1 150-0AA13-0XA0 6AT1 150-0AA23-0XA0 6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 980-0MA11
Description
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/23
Design
A control unit An internal power supply (24 V/9 V DC also for the internal power supply of the I/O modules) Internal program memory (RAM)
S
Receptacle for a memory submodule (EPROM, EEPROM) programming device port or connection for a LAN or op erator panel Connection for a power supply (115/230 V AC; 24 V DC)
S S
Connection for internal bus and bus units Compartment for a backup battery to save the contents of the RAM in the event of a power failure
Programming
The CPUs can be pro grammed in the statement list (STL), control system flow chart (CSF) or ladder diagram
(LAD) methods of representa tion. The method used de pends on the programming device. In addition, GRAPH 5 II
Technical specifications
CPU 1 C P U Programming language 1 Methods of representation 0 Program organisation 0 Supply voltage C S Nominal value P S Ripple Vpp max. U S Permissible range 1 Output voltage 0 Output current 2 S Nominal value S Permissible range Shortcircuit protection Backup battery S Backup time min. at 25 _C and continous backup of CPU with memory submodule S Service life of battery approx. Class of protection Galvanic isolation RI suppression specification Connecting cables for 24 V Range of functions CPU 100 CPU 102 CPU 103 Boolean logic, bracketed operations, result assignment, setting/resetting (latching/unlatching), counter and timer functions, load, transfer, comparison and jump operations, block calls, special functions, combine words, arithmetic STEP 5 STEP 5 AWL, FUP, KOP AWL, FUP, KOP, GRAPH 5/II Linear and structured 24 V DC 3.6 V 18 to 34 V (including ripple) 9 V DC (for the internal power supply of the I/O modules) 1A 0 to 1 A Electronic Lithium battery (3.4 V; 850 mAh) 1 year
5 years (at 25 _C) Class I in acc. with IEC 536 None A in acc. with VDE 0871 Stranded 2 x (0.5 to 1.5) mm2 (with end sleeves) Solid 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm2
2/24
Siemens ST 50 1998
CPUs/Compact PLCs
Analog value input/output BCD/binary code conversion Multiplication and division for 16bit fixedpoint numbers Cyclic, Time controlled, Interrupt driven 1 standard processor 1 standard processor 1 STEP 5coprocessor 0.8 0.8 0.2 0.8 0.8 1.9 0.85 to 3.35 150 150 to 170
Execution time (in s) S Boolean logic operations S Load and transfer operations I, Q, F, T, C Data word S Arithmetic operations S Jump and conversion operations S Timer and counter operations S Block calls S Substitution operations S DO operations (DO DW, DO FW)
40 to 80 55 to 70 55to 65 55 to 80 60 to 70 90 to 125 125 to 150 For further information, please refer to the list of operations
7 15 30 to 40 25 2 to 10 30 to 75 50
Scan cycle monitoring time approx. Program memory S Internal RAM or as alternative EPROM or EEPROM submodule (2 byte = 1 statement) Bit memories S Number Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Number of inputs/outputs S Digital inputs/outputs max. S Analog inputs/outputs max. Linkup S programming device interface
350 ms 2 Kbyte
350 ms 4 Kbyte
1024 512 of which are retentive 16 0.01 to 9990 s 16, 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 256 8 PG, PC1), OP
1024 512 of which are retentive 32 0.01 to 9990 s 32, 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 448 16
2048 512 of which are retentive 128 0.01 to 9990 s 128, 8 of which are retentive 0 to 999 448 32 PG, PC1), OP, SINEC L1 (slave), PROFIBUS (via CP 541), PROFIBUSDP (slave only, via CP 541)
Programming devices which can be used Hardware realtime clock Current consumption (at 24 V) Weight S Module S Memory submodule
1)
PG, PC1), OP, SINEC L1 (slave), PROFIBUS (via CP 541), PROFIBUSDP (slave only, via CP 541) PG 605, PG 720P, PG 740, PG 760, PC (ATcompatible)
1.0 A (with memory submodule) 0.65 kg (1.7 lb) 0.1 kg (0.27 lb)
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/25
Ordering data
CPU with integral power supply (24 V DC), receptacle for 375 memory submodule, compartment for backup battery and connection for programmer CPU 100 CPU 102 CPU 103 In addition, please state the Order No. for the S5-100U manual German English French Spanish Italian
Order No. 375 memory submodule EPROM, 8 Kbyte 16 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 2 Kbyte 4 Kbyte 8 Kbyte 16 Kbyte
Order No.
6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-0LC11 6ES5 375-0LC21 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41 6ES5 980-0MA11 see Section 7 6ES5 997-8MA J1 1 2 3 4 5
COM DB1 parameter assignment software S5-100U reference guide CPU 100, CPU 102, CPU 103 German English French Spanish Italian
6ES5 998-0UB13 6ES5 998-0UB23 6ES5 998-0UB33 6ES5 998-0UB43 6ES5 998-0UB53
2/26
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
Green LEDs beside the labelling fields for the indi vidual inputs indicate the signal status. The modules have mechani cal coding and are plugged onto the bus units. This also establishes the contact to the
terminal block for the signal cables. The latter need not be detached when replacing a module (fixed wiring). The fixed module slot coding does not require an address setter. No address displace ments occur if modules are
interchanged or gaps are left between modules. The digital input module 6ES5 422-8MA11 is addressed like an analog module and can only be plugged into the respective slots.
Technical specifications
Digital input module Number of inputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Input voltage S Nominal value S Frequency Input voltage S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current typ. S At "1 signal Delay S At "0" "1 typ. S At "1 "0 typ. Length of cable S Unshielded max. Quiescent current with 2wire BERO proximity switches max. Fault indication "No sensor voltage Insulation voltage (+ 9 V referred to ground) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at (+ 9 V referred to L+) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at Current consumption S Internal (from the CPU; 9V) max. Power loss typ. Weight approx.
1)
6ES5 420-8MA11 4 No 24 V DC 0 to 5 V 13 to 33 V 7 mA (at 24 V) 2.5 ms 5 ms 100 m (328 ft) 1.5 mA Red LED (L+ missing)
6ES5 421-8MA121) 8 No 24 V DC 0 to 5 V 13 to 33 V 7 mA (at 24 V) 2.3 ms 4.5 ms 100 m (328 ft) 1.5 mA Red LED (L+, M missing)
6ES5 422-8MA11 16 No 24 V DC 0 to 5 V 13 to 30 V 4.5 mA (at 24 V) 4 ms 3 ms 100 m (328 ft) 1.5 mA Red LED (L+, M missing)
6ES5 430-8MB111) 4 Yes (optocoupler) 4 24/60 V DC - 33 to + 8 V 13 to 72 V 4.5/7.5 mA (at 24/60 V) 3 ms 3 ms 100 m (328 ft) 1.5 mA Red LED (L+ missing)
6ES5 430-8MC111) 4 Yes (optocoupler) 4 115 V UC 47 to 63 Hz 0 to 40 V 85 to 135 V 14 mA (at 115 V AC) 6mA (at 115V DC) 10 ms 20 ms 100 m (328 ft) 5 mA No
12 V AC
12 V AC
12 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC 60 V AC 1250 V AC
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/27
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8 24 V DC 0 to 5 V
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8 5 V to 24 V DC 0 to 1.25 V (at 5 V) 0 to 6 V (at 24 V) 2.25 to 5 V (at 5 V) 10.8 to 24 V (at 24 V1)) 1.1 mA at 5 V 5.1 mA at 24 V
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8 24 V DC - 30 to + 5 V
170 to 264 V
13 to 33 V
85 to 135 V
195 to 253 V
13 to 30 V
typ.
8.7 mA (at 24 V)
9 mA (at 24 V)
typ. typ.
5.5 ms 4 ms
3 ms 3 ms
Length of cable S Unshielded max. Quiescent current with 2wire BERO proximity switches max. Fault indication "No sensor voltage Insulation voltage (+ 9 V to ground) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at (+ 9 V to L+) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at Current input S Internal (from CPU; 9V) max. Power loss typ. Weight approx.
12 V AC 500 V AC 30 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC 30 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC 30 V AC 500 V AC
1) 2) 3)
M or L+ settable (encoder switching to M or L+ potential) Can also be used for S595F For S595F only
Ordering data
Digital input module 4 inputs, nonfloating, 24V DC 8 inputs, nonfloating, 24V DC 16 inputs, nonfloating, 24V DC (front connector required) 4 inputs, floating, 24/60V DC 4 inputs, floating, 115V UC 4 inputs, floating, 230 V UC 8 inputs, floating, 24 V DC 8 inputs, floating, 115 V UC 8 inputs, floating, 230 V UC 8 inputs, floating, 5V to 24V DC
4)
Order No. Failsafe digital input module for S595F only, with 8 inputs, floating, 24 V DC Front connector4) for 6ES5 4228MA11 digital input module 40pin for crimp terminals (increased EMC protection) S With crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts 40pin for screw terminals S Standard S With increased EMC protection
6ES5 420 - 8MA11 6ES5 421 - 8MA12 6ES5 422 - 8MA11 6ES5 430 - 8MB11 6ES5 430 - 8MC11 6ES5 430 - 8MD11 6ES5 431 - 8MA11 6ES5 431 - 8MC11 6ES5 431 - 8MD11 6ES5 433 - 8MA11
6ES5 490 - 8MA13 6ES5 490 - 8MA03 6ES5 490 - 8MB11 6ES5 490 - 8FB11
The left row of terminals on the front connector is marked with an "a, the right row with a "b.
2/28
Siemens ST 50 1998
F .0 .4 .1 .5 .2 .6
1 L+ 2M 3 4 5 6 7 8
F .0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
1 L+ 2M 4 3 6 5 8 7 10 9
1 L1
1 L+
~~
.0 .4 .1 .5 .2 .6
2N 3 4 5 6 7 8
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
2M 4 3 6 5 8 7 10
.3 9 .7 10
.3 9 .7 10
9 1- L+ 2- M
4 DIGITAL INPUT
4 x 24V DC 6ES5 420-8MA11
4 DIGITAL INPUT
8 x 24V DC 6ES5 421-8MA12
2 DIGITAL INPUT
4 x 230V AC 6ES5 430-8MD11
4 DIGITAL INPUT
8 x 24V DC 6ES5 431-8MA11
1 23 45 6
12 3 45 6
123 4 5 6
123 4 5 6
6ES5 421-8MA12
1 L+ 2M
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
L+
3 6 5 8 7 10 9
NC NC
n
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
2 DIGITAL INPUT
8 x 115V AC 6ES5 431-8MC11
8 DIGITAL INPUT
8 x 5...24V DC 6ES5 433-8MA11
1 23 45 6
12 3 45 6
1 2 3
6ES5 433-8MA11
6ES5 422-8MA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/29
Design
The modules have mechani cal coding and are plugged onto the bus units. This also establishes contact with the terminal block for the signal cables. The latter need not be detached when replacing a module (fixed wiring).
The modules have fixed slot coding. Address assignments are thus not necessary and addresses are not shifted if modules are replaced or if the module configuration contains unassigned slots.
1 L+ F
1 L+ 2M 4 3 6 5 8 7 10 9 F
1 L1
1 L+ 2 N 4 3 6 5 8 7 10 9
.0 .4 .1 .5 .2 .6 .3 .7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
.0 .4 .1 .5 .2 .6 .3 .7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
FF 10A
FF 10A
5 DIGITAL OUTPUT
4 x 24V DC/0,5A 6ES5 4408MA11 1 2 3 4 5 6
5 DIGITAL OUTPUT
8 x 24V DC/0,5A 6ES5 4418MA11 1 2 3 4 5 6
3 DIGITAL OUTPUT
4 x 115/230V AC/1A 6ES5 4508MD11 1 2 3 4 5 6
3 DIGITAL OUTPUT
8 x 24V DC/1A 6ES5 4518MD11 1 2 3 4 5 6
6ES5 4418MA11
6ES5 4508MD11
6ES5 4518MD11
F
1
8 x 30V DC/230V AC
1
RELAY OUTPUT .0 .4 .4 .1 .5 .5 .2 .6 .3 .7
1L+ 2M 3
1 L+ 2M 4 3 3
P M L+ M 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6
4 5
.0
6 5
5 6
4 5
6 5
6 7
.1
8 7
9 11
6 7
8 7
8 9
13
15
.2
10
17 17
.6
8 .9
10 9
10
.3 5
M
19
19
.7
]24V
10
.7
M 8 P DIGITAL OUTPUT
4 x 24 V/2 A 6ES5 450-8FA11 1 2 3 4 5 6
17
17
7 DIGITAL OUTPUT
4 x 60V DC/230V AC 6ES5 4528MR11 1 2 3 4 5 6
DIGITAL OUTPUT
8 x 24V DC/1A 6ES5 4518MA11 1 2 3 4 5 6
19
19
DIGITAL OUTPUT
8 x 5...24V DC/0,1A 6ES5 4538MA11 1 2 3 4 5 6
7
123 6ES5 4518MR12
6ES5 4518MA11
6ES5 4518MR12
6ES5 4528MR11
6ES5 453-8MA11
6ES5 450-8FA11
2/30
Siemens ST 50 1998
max.
24 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 30 V 35 V 0.5 A 0.5 A 5 mA to 0.5 A 0.4 A 2A 5W Electronic Yes - 15 V 100 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 0.5 mA
24/60 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 72 V 0.5 A 0.5 A 5 mA to 0.5 A 0.4 A 2A 5 W/12 W Electronic Yes - 30 V 100 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 1 mA
115/230 V DC 85 to 264 V 47 to 63 Hz 1A 1A 0.05 A to 1 A Not permissible 4A 25 W/50 W Fuse No 100 Hz 2 HZ 100 % 3/5 mA
max.
Output current at "1 signal S Nominal value up to 60 _C S Nominal value up to 30 _C S Permissible range1) S In parallel operation max. (per output) S Total current Lamp load max. Shortcircuit protection Fault diagnosis possible Limitation of voltage induced on circuit interruption (internal) to Switching frequency S Resistive load max. S Inductive load max. Total load capability2) Residual current at "0 signal max. Signal level of outputs S At "1 signal min. Length of cable S Unshielded max. Fault indication "Shortcircuit, no L+/L1 Insulation voltage (+ 9 V to ground) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at (+ 9 V to L+) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at Current consumption S Internal (from the CPU or IM 318, 9V) max. S External (at 24 V, without load) max. Power loss typ. Weight approx.
1) 2) 3)
12 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC 60 V AC 500 V AC
One input of a digital input module is permitted as minimum load. Referred to the sum of all nominal currents of one module. Also for S595F
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/31
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8
8 Yes (optocoupler) 8
max.
Sply volt. L+/L1 (for the load) S Nominal value max. S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Value at t < 0.5 s max. S Frequency Output current at "1 signal S Nominal value up to 60 _C S Permissible range1) S In parallel operation (per output) max. S Total current Lamp load max. Shortcircuit protection Fault diagnosis possible Limitation of voltage induced on circuit interruption (internal) to Continuous current /th Switching capacity of contacts S Resistive load max. S Inductive load max.
5 to 24 V DC 2.4 V at 24 V 4.75 to 30 V 35 V 0.1 A 1 TTL input to 0.1 A 0.08 A 0.8 A No - 19 V (at 24 V DC)
24 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 30 V 35 V
24/60 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 72 V 35 V
No No
No No
3A 3 A (250 V DC) 1.5 A (30 V DC) 0.5 A (250 V AC) 0.5 A (30 V DC) 1x10 6 (AC11) 0.5x10 6 (DC11) 100 Hz 2 Hz 75 % 0.5 mA 10 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 3/5 mA 100 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 0.1 mA 10 Hz
5A 5 A (250 V DC) 2.5 A (30 V DC) 1.5 A (250 V AC) 0.5 A (30 V DC) 1.5x10 6 (AC11) 0.5x10 6 (DC11) 10 Hz 100 Hz 2 HZ 100 % 1 mA
Service life: switching operations (IEC 947-5-1) Switching frequency S Resistive load max. S Inductive load max. Total load capability2) Residual current at "0 signalmax . Signal level of outputs S At "1 signal min. Length of cable S Unshielded Fault indication
L+ - 0.6 V
L1 - 7 V
Open collector output 100 m (330 ft) No 100 m (330 ft) Red LED (L+/M missing) 100 m (330 ft) No
L+ - 0.6 V
max.
Insulation voltage (+ 9 V to ground) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at (+ 9 V to L+) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at Current consumption S Internal (from the CPU, 9V) max. S External (at 24 V, without load) max. Power loss typ. Weight approx.
12 V AC 500 V AC 24 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC
12 V AC 500 V AC 24 V AC 500 V AC
35 mA 50 mA 3W 0.23kg (0.62lb)
20 mA 8 mA 1W 0.22 kg (0.59lb)
1) One input of a digital input module is permitted as minimum load. 2) Referred to the sum of all nominal curents of the module. 3) Optionally as source or sink output module. 4) Every contact is bridged by a varistor (max. residual current 1 mA at 250 V AC/approx. 0 mA at 24 V DC). 5) 6ES5 4908MA13/6ES5 4908MB11, 6ES5 4908MB21 or 6ES5 4908MA03 front connector required. 6) For S595F only. 7) Also for S595F.
2/32
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 440-8MA12 6ES5 440-8MA22 6ES5 441-8MA11 6ES5 450-8MB11 6ES5 450-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MA11 6ES5 451-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MR12
6ES5 490-8MA13 6ES5 490-8MA03 6ES5 490-8MB11 6ES5 490-8FB11 6ES5 490-8MB21 6ES5 980-3BC41
1) The left row of terminals on the front connector is marked with an "a", the right row with a "b".
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/33
Design
Faults are indicated by three LEDs on the module. The digital input/output module is plugged into a bus unit but wired via a separate front connector. The 40pin front connector is screwed onto the front of the module.
It is available with crimp terminals and screw terminals and must be ordered separately. The module is addressed like an analog module and can be used in the relevant slots.
It has fixed slot coding. Address assignments are thus not necessary and addresses are not shifted if modules are replaced or if the module configuration contains unassigned slots. The module can also be used with the S595 F.
Technical specifications
Digital inputs Number of inputs Galvanic isolation Input voltage S Nominal value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Delay S At "0 "1 S At "1 "0 typ. typ. typ. 24 V DC 0 to + 5 V + 13 to + 30 V 4.5 mA 4 ms 3 ms 1.5 mA Red LED 16 No 8 16 No Digital outputs (continued) Lamp load max. Signal level of outputs at "1" signal Switching frequency S Resistive load S Inductive load Voltage induced on circuit interruption (internal) limited Parallel operation (possible in pairs) Permissible total current Total load capability2) Common data Permissible ambient temperature S Horizontal configuration S Vertical configuration Cable length (unshielded) Insulation measurement Nominal insulation voltage (+ 9 V to ground) Insulation group Current consumption S Internally from + 9 V (CPU, interface module) S Externally from L+ (without load) Power loss Weight typ. min. max. max. to max. 5W L+ (- 0.6 V) 100 Hz 2 Hz - 15 V 0.8 . IN 6A 75 %
Quiescent current with 2wire BERO proximity switches max. Fault indication "No L+/M Digital outputs Number of outputs Galvanic isolation In groups of Supply voltage Vpos (for the load) S Nominal value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Value at t < 0.5 s Output current /N at signal "1 S Nominal value S Permissible range1) Residual current at "0 signal max. Short-circuit protection (electronic) Fault indication "short circuit"
max.
24 V DC 3.5 V 20 to 30 V 35 V
max.
1)
2)
2/34
Siemens ST 50 1998
OUT DIGITAL
16 X DC 24 V n+1 n
IN F
n+1 n
L+
n+1
L+
n+1
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7 M L+
n
.0
.0
.1 .2 .3
0,5 A
.4 .5 .6
.7
.7 NC NC
n
.0 .1 .2 .3 .4 .5 .6 .7 M
1
.0
.0 .1 .2
0,5 A .7
.3 .4 .5 ST522179a .6 .7 M
3
6
2
6ES5 4828MA13
Ordering data
Digital input/output module with 16 inputs 24 V DC and 16 outputs 24 V DC; 0.5 A
Order No. 6ES5 482-8MA13 Front connector1) for digital input/output module 6ES5 4828MA13 40pin for crimp terminals (increased EMC protection) S With crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts 40pin for screw terminals S Standard S Increased EMC protection
Order No.
1) 2)
The left row of terminals on the front connector is marked with an "a", the right row with a "b". Also for S595F.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/35
Design
The following can be set by a coding switch on the front of the module: S 1, 2 or 4channel operation S Line frequency 50 or 60 Hz S Wirebreak alarm signal on/ off (not for current inputs) The modules have mechani cal coding and are plugged into the bus units. This also
establishes contact to the terminal block for the signal cables. The signal cables need not be disconnected to replace a module fixed wiring. The modules have fixed slot coding and do not require an address setter. No address displacements occur if mod ules are interchanged or gaps are left between modules.
The module with characteris tic linearization for thermo elements contains the char acteristic curves for S NiCr/NiAl (type K) in accordance with IEC 584 S Fe/CuNi (type J) in accordance with IEC 584 S Fe/CuNi (type L) in accordance with DIN 43 710 The characteristic curve for Pt 100 corresponds to DIN IEC 751.
2 +
4 +
6 +
8 + Cu Fe
10
2 +
4 +
6 +
8 +
10 U
10
8 +
10
KO
U Ch. 0
Ch. 2
Ch. 3
Ch. 1 Ch. 2
Ch. 2 Ch. 3
6ES5 4648MD11
4 + 4Dr. MU
10 + 4Dr. MU
10
2 +
10
10
+ + 4Dr. 4Dr. MU MU
U L+ M
2Dr. MU
2Dr. MU
Ch. 0 Ch. 1
Ch. 2
Ch. 3
Ch. 0
Ch. 1
Ch. 2
6ES5 4648ME11
2/36
+
Ch. 3
Ch. 0
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 464-8MA11 50 mV
6ES5 464-8MA212) 50 mV
6ES5 464-8MB112) 1V
6ES5 464-8Mc112) 10 V
1, 2 or 4 (optional) Yes (inputs to ground, not to one another) min. 10 MW Twowire connections 13 bit two's complement (2048 units = nominal value) Integrating Voltagetime conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 ms at 60 Hz 60 ms at 50 Hz 50 ms at 60 Hz At 50 Hz: 240 ms 120 ms 60 ms 1V 60 V AC/75 V DC 10 MW 10 MW 50 kW
At 60 Hz:
200 ms 100 ms 50 ms
24 V
24 V
24 V
50 V
At 200 % of nominal value (over 4095 units) Yes (centrally indicated by red LED)
No
86 dB 40 dB
100 mA 0.7 W
70 mA 0.7 W
70 mA 0.7 W
2)
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/37
max.
24 V
24 V
60 V No No
Noise suppression for f = n (50/60 Hz 1 %); n = 1,2 ... S Common mode rej. min. (Vp < 1 V) S Seriesmode rejection min. (peak value of noise < nominal range value) Basic error limits1) (at 20 _C) Operation limits1) (0 _C to 60 _C; for one year) Cable length (shielded) max. Supply voltage (for 2wire transducers) S Nominal value S Ripple S Permissible range Current consumption S Internal (at 9 V) S External (at 24 V) Power loss Weight
1) In accordance
86 dB 40 dB
1.5 4
1.5 4
4 6
max.
24 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 30 V
24 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 30 V
2)
3)
Ordering data
Analog input module with 4 inputs, floating for 50 mV for thermoelements ( 50 mV, with linearization) for 1 V for 10 V for 20 mA with 4 inputs, floating for 4 to + 20 mA
6ES5 464-8MA11 6ES5 464-8MA21 6ES5 464-8MB11 6ES5 464-8MC11 6ES5 464-8MD11 6ES5 464-8ME11
with 2 inputs, floating for 500 mV or Pt 100 for Pt 100 with linearization with 4 inputs, nonfloating for 0 to 10 V Failsafe analog input with 4 inputs, floating for 4 to + 20 mA
6ES5 464-8MG11
2/38
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The modules have mechani cal coding and are plugged into the bus units. This also establishes contact to the terminal block for the signal cables. The latter need not be detached when replacing a module (fixed wiring).
The modules have fixed slot coding and do not require an address setter. No address displacements take place if modules are interchanged or gaps are left between modules.
1
10
3 2 4
5 6
7 8
9 10
M L+ 24V DC
Ch. 0
Ch. 1
6ES5 470-8MA12 6ES5 470-8MD12 Fig. 2/20 Connection diagrams for analog output modules
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/39
2 2 Yes Yes Purely ohmic Purely ohmic 3.3 kW 300 W 2 or 4wire connection 2wire connection 12 bit two's complement (1024 units = nominal value) 0.15 ms 25 % Yes 30 mA 0.15 ms 25 % Yes 30 mA 15 V
2 2 Yes Yes Purely ohmic Purely ohmic 3.3 kW 300 W 2wire connection 2 or 4wire connection 12 bit two's complement (1024 units = nominal value) 0.15 ms 25 % Yes 15 V 0.15 ms 25 % Yes 30 mA
60 V AC/75 V DC 2.5 6
60 V AC/75 V DC 3 6
60 V AC/75 V DC 2 6
60 V AC/75 V DC 2 6
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range. 2) Also for S595F
Ordering data
Analog output module 2 outputs for 10 V, floating 2 outputs for 20 mA, floating 2 outputs for + 4 to 20mA, floating 2 outputs for + 1 to 5 V, floating
Order No.
2/40
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ex input/output modules
Barriers
2)
Jumpering panel Main cable Separation nonintrinsicallysafe/ intrinsicallysafe, incl. power supply
3)
Process
Zone 1 or 2
Fig. 2/21 Comparison of conventional technology and new technology using a centralized configuration example
The Ex modules are available as associated apparatus for the automation of chemical plants. They can be used for applications in instrumenta tion and control. Their primary task consists of isolating the intrinsicallysafe circuits of the Ex field from the non intrinsicallysafe internal circuits of the programmable controller.
Fields of application Chemical/petrochemical industry S Gas industry S Offshore technology S Transport (e.g. oil tankers, tank trucks)
S
Automotive industry (e.g. in paintshop) S Power supply, power distribution, etc. S Power stations S Specialized mechanical engineering (e. g. printing machines, industrial cleaning machines)
S
Design
Features Ex modules are of the same system technology as the other S5100U modules; they can thus be used together in one configuration S Galvanic isolation on the module S Coding of modules to prevent the wrong module from being used
S
The sensors and actuators are supplied by the module via a twowire circuit S Inputs and outputs of the modules can be connected directly, without additional isolation amplifiers or transmitter supply units S Rewiring per software possible
S
Modules capable of diagnosis S Reduced planning, installation and documen tation overhead S Low space requirements in switchrooms S Possibility of distributed configuration
S
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/41
Associated apparatus (S5100U Ex modules) V0 IK P Cext Lext Explanations: V0: Noload voltage IK: Shortcircuit current P: Power Ca: Maximum permissible external capacitance La: Maximum permissible external inductance
Braunschweig (Federal Republic of Germany) to be of "intrinsicallysafe" type of protection. Copies of this certification are included in the product manual. European constructional requirements S German regulations for installation S Types of protection
S
The modules also have certification from SEV (Swiss Electrotechnical Association) for Switzerland (Exception: 6ES5 467 8EA11, 6ES5 4678EF11) Possible applications of the S5100U Ex I/Os: centrally (S595U or S5100U) and in distributed configuration (ET 100U with SIMATIC or TELEPERM M; ET 200U with SIMATIC) S Planning and configuring documents S Examples of application
S
Part 2 provides the informa tion required for use of the Ex I/Os. The following topics are presented: S Construction of Ex systems S Installation in the Ex area
2/42
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ex input/output modules
Ex Module
No. of channels 4
Intrinsicallysafe equipment which can be connected Initiators to DIN 19 234 (NAMUR, see Cat. Section SA 2.3), switched contacts Solenoid valves, pilot lamps LED
Digital input
Digital output
Design
Status and fault indicators Digital input module S For each circuit, a green LED indicates "1 signal (contact closed for I > 2.1 mA for NAMUR sensors in accordance with DIN 19 234)
Digital ouput module For each circuit, a green LED indicates "1 signal (internal status; not affected by shortcircuit terminals)
A red LED, common for all circuits, signals shortcircuit S Group alarm as error diagnostics
S
F 3 .0 .1 .2 .3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 .0 .1 .2 .3
F 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ST542100c 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 ST542099c 13
DIGITAL INPUT
6ES5 4378EA12
(EEx ib) IIC PTB Nr. Ex88.B.2149x
+ S
DIGITAL OUTPUT
6ES5 4578EA12
(EEx ib) IIC PTB Nr. Ex88.B.2149x
+ S
10
10
Ex area
NAMUR Solenoid valve
6ES5 4578EA12
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/43
max. min./max.
max.
Sensor voltage supply Fault indication "shortcircuit" Type of protection / PTB No. Maximum values of input circuits S V0 S IK SP S Permissible external max. inductance Lext S Permissible external max. capacity Cext Permiss. ambient temperature max. Current consumption S Internal (from the CPU; 9 V) max. Power loss Weight approx.
Fault indication "shortcircuit" Type of protection / PTB No. Maximum values of output circuits S V0 S IK SP S Permissible external max. inductance Lext S Permissible external max. capacitance Cext Permiss. ambient temperature max. Current consumption S Internal (from the CPU; 9 V) max. Power loss Weight approx.
Red LED [EEx ib] IIC / Ex88.B.2149X (per circuit) 10.1 V 43 mA 97 mW 20 mH 3F 60 _C 55 mA 0.5 W 0.2 kg (0.44 lb)
Ordering data
Ex 437-8EA12 digital input module 4 inputs, floating, NAMUR Ex 457-8EA12 digital output module 4 outputs, floating, 7 V DC, 2 mA Ex bus unit for 2 Ex modules with terminal block for screw terminals
Order No. 6ES5 437-8EA12 Barrier for Ex modules Training and system manual Ex S5-100U peripherals German English French
6ES5 457-8EA12
6ES5 700-8EA11
2/44
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ex input/output modules
Ex module
Number of channels 4 2 2
Analog input module ( 50 mV) Analog input module ( 500 mV) Analog input module (4 to 20 mA)
operating mode 1 2 3 F 0 F 1 F F 3+ Ch 0 Ch 1 Ch 2 4 5+ 6 7+ 8 2 3
F 4 3 2 1
9+ Ch 3 10
7 Ch 1 8 4...20mA
operating mode 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 14
ANALOG INPUT
6ES5 4678EA11
(EEx ib) IIC PTB Nr. Ex94.C.2037
+ S + S
ANALOG INPUT
6ES5 4678EE11
(EEx ib) IIC PTB Nr. Ex91.C.2110x
+ S
ANALOG INPUT
6ES5 4678EF11
(EEx ib) IIC PTB Nr. Ex94.C.2036
4 Ch 0 6 4...20mA
8 Ch 1 10 4...20mA R>300?
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 14
ANALOG OUTPUT
6ES5 4778EC11
+ S
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/45
1 or 2 (optional) Yes, only to ground At least 31.5 M Twowire connection Fourwire connection (sensor supply via intrinsicallysafe power supply) 13 bit two's complement (2048 units = nominal value) Integrating Voltagetime conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 at 60 Hz 60/50 ms at 50/60 Hz 232/200 ms at 50/60 Hz 120/100 ms at 50/60 Hz 60/50 ms at 50/60 Hz 1V 60 V AC/75 V DC 82 mA 15 V Red LED At 200 % of nominal value (over 4095 units) Yes Yes For f = n (50/60 Hz + 1 %); n = 1,2 86 dB 40 dB
Digital representation of input signal Measuring principle Conversion principle Integration time (adjustable for optimum noise suppression) Encoding time (selectable) Cycle time for 4 inputs 2 inputs 1 input Permissible voltage S Between inputs S Inputs to ground (destruction limit) Permissible input current (destruction limit) Permissible input voltage (destruction limit) Fault indication Fault indication in the case of S Range exceeded S Sensor wire break S Sensor shortcircuit Interference voltage suppression S Commonmode interference S Seriesmode interference (peak value of interference < nominal range value) Basic error limits 1), at 20 _C min. min.
13 bit two's complement (2048 units = nominal value) Integrating Voltagetime conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 at 60 Hz 58/50 ms at 50/60 Hz 232/200 ms at 50/60 Hz 116/100 ms at 50/60 Hz 58/50 ms at 50/60 Hz max. max. max. max. 15 V 60 V AC/75 V DC 15 V Red LED Yes Yes For f = n (50/60 Hz + 1 %); n = 1,2 60 dB 40 dB
13 bit two's complement (2048 units = nominal value) Intergrating Voltagetime conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 at 60 Hz 58/50 ms at 50/60 Hz 116/100 ms at 50/60 Hz 58/50 ms at 50/60 Hz 15 V 60 V AC/75 V DC 15 V Red LED Yes For f = n (50/60 Hz + 1 %); n = 1,2 60 dB 40 dB
0.3 % 0.5 % [EEx ib] IIC / Ex94.C.2037 17.22 V 20 mA 86 mW 455 10 mH 240 nF 60 _C 200 m (660 ft)
0.15 % 0.4 % [EEx ib] IIC / Ex91.C.2109 (per channel) 18 V 82 mA 600 mW 354 4 mH 270 F 60 _C 100 m (330 ft)
0.3 %/ 0.5 % for standard/climate range 0.5 % [EEx ib] IIC / Ex94.C.2036 17.22 V 33 mA 142 mW 455 10 mH 240 nF 60 _C 200 m (660 ft)
Operational limits1) (0 _C to 60 _C, for 1 year) Type of protection / PTB No. Maximum values of input channels S V0 S IK SP S Ri S Perm. external inductance Lext max. S Perm. external capacitance Cext max. Permiss. ambient temperature max. Cable length (shielded) Supply voltage from module (for 2wire transducers) S Nominal value Current consumption S Internal (at 9 V) Power loss Weight
1)
max.
2/46
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ex input/output modules
6ES5 4778EC11 max. 100 m (328 ft) Red LED Yes Yes [EEx ib] IIC / Ex91.C.2109 18 V 82 mA 600 mW 354 4 mH 270 nF 60 _C 350 mA, incl. load 3.2 W 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
approx.
3 2
5 4 6
9 8 10
3 2
5 4 6
9 8 10
Ex area
comp. Ch.0 Ch.1 Ch.2 Ch.3
6ES5 457-8EA11
6ES5 457-8EF11
3 2
5 4 6
9 8 10
3 2
5 4 6
9 8 10
2-Dr. MU Ch.0
2-Dr. MU Ch.1
Ex area
ExSV
4-Dr. MU Ch.0
4-Dr. MU Ch.1
6ES5 457-8EA11
1 3 2 5 4 6 7 9 8 10
6ES5 467-8EE11
Ex area
Ch.0 Ch.1
6ES5 477-8EC11
Ordering data
Ex 467-8EA11 analog input module 2 or 4 inputs (can be switched over), floating, for 50 mV (thermoelement) Ex 467-8EE11 analog output module 1 or 2 inputs (can be switched over), floating, for 4 to 20 mA Ex 467-8EF11 analog input module 1 or 2 inputs (can be switched over), floating, Pt 100 ( 500 mV)
Order No. 6ES5 467-8EA11 Ex 477-8EC11 analog output module 2 outputs, floating, for 4 to 20 mA Ex bus unit for 2 Ex modules with terminal block for screw terminals Barrier for Ex modules Training and system manual Ex S5-100U peripherals German English French
Order No.
6ES5 467-8EE11
6ES5 497-8EA11
6ES5 467-8EF11
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/47
Overview
The following table shows the maximum number of intelli gent I/O modules which can be used with the S590U, S595U/F programmable
controllers, in the S5100U programmable controller and the slots available for them.
8 0-7 6 0-7
2/48
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The module contains several controller structures, mainly offtheshelf, such as single loop controllers, proportional and cascade controllers. The structures suitable for a given application can be selected from this list. The controller parameters for, e.g. the PID algorithm are freely settable depending on the application. The selfsetting function of the IP 262 closedloop control module simplifies this task. The IP 262 can be used as an I/O module with the S590U, S595U and S595F pro grammable controllers (6ES5 2628MB12 only), in the S5100U programmable controller.
The IP 262 control module is available in two variations: With 3 analog outputs for 3 continuous controllers with analog output signals (Kcontroller; not for S595F) S With 8 binary outputs for 4 continuous controllers with PDM signals or for stepper controllers (Scontroller)
S
Both variants have the following features in addition: 4 analog inputs for direct feed of setpoints and actual values S 4 binary inputs for changing operation modes
S
There is a sub D socket connector on the frontplate of the module for connecting sensors.
Principle of operation
If the supply voltage (24 V DC) and the setpoints are supplied, the module can also operate in standalone mode independent of the higherlevel CPU, i.e. it exe cutes the closedloop control completely autonomously. Connection to other pro Structures include: Basic settings Sensor types Assignment of analog inputs Functions of the binary inputs S Restart conditions S Response to CPU failure
S S S S
grammable controllers is possible over the SINEC L1 local area network (LAN). Backup characteristics enable the closedloop control to be continued even in the event of failure of the higher level CPU. Parameters include:
S S S
Functions
There are a large number of prepared functions and off theshelf controller structures available for designing control loops. In addition, there are 7 data blocks (DB 11 to DB 17) for parameterizing or structur ing the module.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/49
Additional input for reference temperature Digital representation of the input signal (including sign) Resolution (unipolar) Isolation
12 bit 11 bit Not galvanic (but electronic to central ground and to one another)
1.5 _C 4 _C 3 No 0 to 20 mA or 4 to 20 mA 4 No - 30 to + 4.5 V or open + 13 to + 30 V 8 1.5 V 14.2 to 30.2 V 100 mA, shortcircuit proof 100 to 200 ms
Permissible potential difference inputs to one another and to central ground Input signal ranges S Current S Voltage (for thermoelement) Measuring range for the thermoelement S Type J S Type K S Type L S Type S Absolute error S With type J, L and K S With type S Voltage with external switching
- 1 V to + 1 V 0 to 20 mA or 4 to 20 mA 0 to 50 mV or - 8.9 to 41.1 mV
0 to + 870 _C or - 210 to + 730 _C 0 to + 1230 _C or - 270 to + 990 _C 0 to + 850 _C or - 200 to + 720 _C 0 to + 1770 _C 1 _C 6 _C 0 to 10 V
Ordering data
IP 262 closed-loop control module S With 3 analog outputs for continuous controllers with analog output signals S With 8 binary outputs for continuous controllers with PDM signals or for stepper controllers1)
Order No. Configuring package for IP 2622) comprising standard function module (for description see Cata log Section 7) and manual German English French Italian Subminiature-D connector 25pin
Order No.
6ES5 262-8MA12
6ES5 262-8MB12
6ES5 262-5AA11 6ES5 262-5AA21 6ES5 262-5AA31 6ES5 262-5AA51 6ES5 750-2AA31
1) 2)
2/50
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The twochannel module can drive two independent axes. Four digital outputs are assigned to each channel. The outputs control the following functions: S Rapid traverse S Creep speed S Counterclockwise S Clockwise
Incremental or absolute position encoders can be used to capture actual path values. In addition to the digital out puts, the module has a digital input which captures the reduction cam (reference point switch) during reference point approach. In the "length measurement" function, the module calculates the path travelled as long as this input has signal "1". is loaded into the module memory. The IP 263 handles positioning of the axes auton omously after the target coor dinates have been specified. There are two speeds avail able for this (rapid traverse and creep speed).
The module requires two slots and up to four modules can be used per programmable controller (see table on page 2/48).
Principle of operation
The system changes between these two speeds at the changeover points. When the cutoff point has been reached, the module monitors the target approach and signals the CPU of the pro grammable controller when the target area is reached.
Technical specifications
Processor User memory S RAM S EPROM S EEPROM Encoders Position decoding Traverse range S Incremental position encoders max. S SSI absolute encoders max. Input voltage (nominal value) S Differential inputs S Asymmetrical inputs S Additional current and voltage data Supply voltage for encoders (shortcircuit proof, no overload) 80C32 (16 MHz) 32 Kbyte 64 Kbyte 1 Kbyte Incremental, absolute (SSI interface) 224 increments 8192 steps/revolution 2048 revolutions 5 V (RS 422) 24 V (incremental encoders only) see digital input (next page) 5 V/300 mA, 24 V/300 mA Input frequency/ cable length (shielded) S Symmetrical encoders (5 V signals) With 5 V encoder voltage max. With 24 V encoder voltage max. S Asymmetrical encoders max. (24 V signals) Data transmission frequency in the case of absolute position encoders selectable
200 kHz / 32 m (105 ft) 200 kHz / 100 m (328 ft) 100 kHz / 25 m (82 ft) 25 kHz / 100 m (328 ft)
125, 250, 500 kHz (shielded, at max. 160 m (525 ft) cable length), 1MHz (shielded, at max. 32 m (105 ft) cable length) 2 pulses displaced by 90_ and zero mark 1 pulse train Absolute value In acc. with RS 422/typ. 5 mA
Input signals S Incremental S 24 V initiator (BERO) S SSI Input currents at "1" signal S 5 V DC / 24 V DC
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/51
Logic voltage (generated from 24 V) Current consumption (24 V, without encoder power supply) typ. Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in.) Weight approx.
Ordering data
IP 263 positioning module IP 263 manual including example program German English 703 connecting cable for connecting S IP 263 $ Siemens incremental position encoders 6FX20012..., max. 32 m (105 ft) long 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 25 m (82 ft) 32 m (105 ft) S IP 263 $ Incremental position encoders for 5 V signals to RS 422, supply voltage 5 V, one end open, max. 32 m (105 ft) long 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 25 m (82 ft) 32 m (105 ft) Outgoing cable up down
Order No. 6ES5 263-8MA13 703 connecting cable for connecting S IP 263 $ Incremental position encoders for 5 V signals to RS 422, supply voltage 24 V, one end open, max. 100 m (328 ft) long 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (105 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 100 m (328 ft) S IP 263 $ Incremental position encoders for 24 V signals, supply voltage 24 V, one end open, max. 100 m (328 ft) long 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (105 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 100 m (328 ft) S IP 263 $ Absolute SSI position encoders, supply voltage 24 V, one end open, max. 160 m (525 ft) long 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (105 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 100 m (328 ft) 200 m (656 ft) Outgoing cable Sub D connector 15pin, male up down
Order No.
6ES5 703-1BF0 J 6ES5 703-1CB0 J 6ES5 703-1CC0 J 6ES5 703-1CC5 J 6ES5 703-1CD2 J
6ES5 703-3CB0 J 6ES5 703-3CC0 J 6ES5 703-3CD2 J 6ES5 703-3CF0 J 6ES5 703-3DB0 J
6ES5 703-2BF0 J 6ES5 703-2CB0 J 6ES5 703-2CC0 J 6ES5 703-2CC5 J 6ES5 703-2CD2 J 0 1
6ES5 703-4CB0 J 6ES5 703-4CC0 J 6ES5 703-4CD2 J 6ES5 703-4CF0 J 6ES5 703-4DB0 J
6ES5 703-5CC0 J 6ES5 703-5CD2 J 6ES5 703-5CF0 J 6ES5 703-5DB0 J 6ES5 703-5DC0 J 0 1 6ES5 750-2AA21
2/52
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The cam program encom passes 32 or 64 cam data sets depending on parame terization:
S
Max. 32 data sets with separate cam programs for forward and reverse, scan time (processing time) 57.6 s
Optionally max. 32/64 data sets, with a common cam program in each case for forward and reverse, scan time 57.6 s/115.2 s
All cams can be defined as pathpath cams or as path time cams. In addition, there is a counter and a brake cam.
Principle of operation
Each individual cam automati cally compensates for the dead time of the connected actuator by a speeddepen dent dynamic shift thus dispensing with the need for complicated matching in the STEP 5 program. This enables the highest switching accuracy to be achieved even in the case of fluctuating drive speeds.
In order to pass the short response time on to the process, the module has a digital output for each track. The machinery to be con trolled can usually be con nected direct and auxiliary contactors are only required for actuators with higher power consumption.
Synchronousserial absolute position encoders (SSI), incremental position encoders or 24 V signal sensors can be used. Sensor information can be channelled to further modules over a sensor output. After transferring the machine data and the cam data, the module operates autono mously and so offloads the CPU of the programmable controller.
Technical specifications
Processor User memory S RAM S EPROM S EEPROM Encoders Position encoders Traverse range S Incremental position encoders max. S SSI absolute encoders max. 80C32 (16 MHz) 32 Kbyte 64 Kbyte 1 Kbyte Incremental, absolute (SSI interface) 216 increments (generally quadruple evalution) 216 sensor steps 5 V (RS 422) 24 V (incremental encoders only) See digital inputs Supply voltage for encoders (shortcircuit, no overload) Input frequency/ cable length (shielded) S Symmetrical encoders (5 V signals) With 5 V encoder voltage max. With 24 V encoder voltage max. S Asymmetrical encoders max. (24 V signals) Data transmission frequency in the case of absolute positioning encoders selectable 5 V/300 mA, 24 V/300 mA
200 kHz / 32 m (105 ft) 200 kHz / 100 m (328 ft) 100 kHz / 25 m (82 ft) 25 kHz / 100 m (328 ft)
Input voltage (nominal value) S Differential inputs S Asymmetrical inputs S Additional current and voltage data
125, 250, 500 kHz (shielded, at max. 160 m (525 ft) cable length), 1 MHz (shielded, at max. 32 m (105 ft) cable length) 2 pulses displaced by 90_ and zero mark 1 pulse train Absolute value
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/53
Logic voltage (generated from 24 V) Current consumption (24 V, without encoder supply voltage) typ. Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in.) Weight approx.
Ordering data
IP 264 electronic cam controller module IP 264 manual incl. example program German English
2/54
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The heart of the IP 265 is an FPGA (field programmable gate array) which uses parallel processing to combine the previously incompatible features of free programmability and high speed reproducible response times. There are digital inputs and outputs integrated on the module for communication with the process I/O: S 8 x 24 V digital inputs 3 x 5 V differential inputs (RS 422) S 8 x 24 V digital outputs
S
In addition, an interface is available for connecting a fur ther IP 265. This can become necessary, for example, if ei ther the number of inputs and outputs or the program ca pacity of one IP 265 is insufficient. There is a submodule recep tacle on the module for a memory submodule con taining the user program.
Features Response times in the microsecond range S Exact reproducibility S Small dimensions S Autonomous processing of subprocesses, even when the CPU of the pro grammable controller goes to STOP S Direct I/O processing thanks to integral inputs/outputs S Output frequencies in the kHz range S Simple programming thanks to new function elements (e.g. edge bit memories, clock generator)
S
Principle of operation
When the user program is loaded, hardware structures are created in the IP 265 simi lar to the hardware circuits in hardwired controls. These structures enable highspeed parallel processing of process signals. In contrast to hard wired controls, the IP 265 is programmable and the hard ware connections can be de leted and reconfigured as often as desired. The process benefits directly from the short response times of the integral inputs and out puts. The plant sensors and actuators important to the subprocess are connected to the IP 265 via these inputs and outputs. The IP 265 con trols the subprocess autono mously.
&
<
& 1
programmed hardware structure
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/55
Programming
The COM 265 programming software is available for gen erating the user program and for startup. A programming device/PC is used for pro gramming. The IP user pro gram is generated in the con trol system flowchart method of representation using COM 265. The program does not have a block structure and is merely divided into individual segments. However, these segments are only editorial aids and since they are pro cessed in parallel, they have no influence on the order in which the program is pro cessed. The COM 265 programming software can be used to simu late offline control of the pro cess by the IP 265. Neither IP 265 nor programmable controller is required for this purpose.
The process environment can be integrated in the simu lation. This allows program errors to be detected and corrected quickly without connecting the process I/O or the IP 265. The program tested in this way is then transferred to the IP 265 either via memory submodule or direct over the backplane bus of the pro grammable controller. The following hardware is re quired to run COM 265 on a PG 720P, PG 740, PG 760 programming device or PC: S 80386 processor or higher S 4 MB RAM S Hard disk with 5 MB free storage capacity
S
The following software must also be installed: On the programming device's hard disk: S MSDOS from version 3.2 to version 6.22, or Windows. For standard applications, the standard function "counter" can be used. This is on EPROM with two cascadable 16bit counters, modulo function (restart of the counter after reaching the setpoint) and TOR function.
Technical specifications
Module Permissible ambient temperature S Horizontal installation S Vertical installation Current consumption from + 9 V (CPU) Operating status indicator Signal status indicator (for 24 V inputs and 24 V outputs) Weight Power losses of the module Memory submodule Extent of the program (based on comparison of STL statements) Digital inputs Number of inputs Galvanic isolation Input voltage L+ S Nominal value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Input circuit delay S Rising edge S Falling edge Cable length (shielded) Quiescent current with 2wire BERO connected typ. typ. typ. max. 9pin sub D socket 8 No 24 V DC 0 to 5 V 11 to 30 V (IEC 65 A) 6.5 mA (IEC 65 A) 15 s 10 s 100 m (328 ft) at max. 10 kHz 1.5 mA
0 to + 60 _C 0 to + 40 _C < 175 mA STOP (red LED) RUN (green LED) Green LED
approx. typ.
0.3 kg (10.5 oz) 23 W EEPROM 50 to 100 statements in the case of mixed functions up to approx. 170 statements in the case of purely binary functions Binary logic operations, timers, counters, comparison operations, SR flipflops, RS flipflops, edge bit memories, clock generator (1 Hz to 64 kHz), binary scalers
2/56
Siemens ST 50 1998
Residual current at "0 signal Voltage drop at "1 signal Cable length Permissible total current Expansion inputs/outputs Number of inputs/outputs
-15 V
Ordering data
IP 265 high-speed subcontrol module Configuring package for IP 265 comprising programming software COM 265 (for description see Cata log Section 7) and manual German English French Standard function counter on EPROM, with description, 3 languages German, English, French
Order No. 6ES5 265-8MA01 375 memory submodule for IP 265 user program EEPROM, 4 Kbyte Expansion cable 0.2 m (7.8 in) long for expansion interface Sub D connector, 9pin, male for digital outputs Sub D connector, 9pin, female for digital inputs
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/57
Design
Programming device
T M
PLC interface
Command interpreter
Setpoint axis
Controller DAC
Speed controller
Principle of operation
The module receives the tra versing job request either direct from the programming device or from the higherlevel pro grammable controller. From this, the IP 266 calculates a setpoint for the power section of the connected motor, taking the relevant machine data into account. At the same time, the IP 266 continuously calcu lates the actual position of the drive from the signals of the incremental position encoder.
The position controller gene rates the manipulated variable from the difference between the specified setpoint and the current actual position. The manipulated variable is output to the power section of the motor over the analog output module. The voltage value of the manipulated variable determines the positioning speed. The power section of the motor now controls the speed of the motor with the help of this voltage setpoint and the current motor speed signalled back by a tachogenerator as the actual value.
Operation with a program ming device In the test mode with the programming device the fol lowing comfortable functions are available: S The axis can be traversed for test purposes with fault indication on the screen S Machine data and traverse programs can be edited S Archiving onto diskette and fixed disk S Logging by printer
2/58
Siemens ST 50 1998
Functions
Operating modes Operator control: JOG mode, followup mode, reference point approach, incremental feed mode, automatic mode, teachin mode, zero offset, tool off set, drift compensation, in put machine data/ traversing program1), module identification1), drift compensation Monitoring: Read machine data 1), read traversing program1), read current actual value1), read module identification1), actual position, following error, distance to go
Machine data The machine data set includes various axisspecific specifications, such as S Different speeds S Accelerations and delays in both directions S Coordinates for the reference point, software limit switch S Offsets, correction values S Resolutions
Monitoring functions The IP 266 offers the following hardware and software monitoring functions: S Wire breakage and short circuit at the 5 V incremental position encoder S Failure of the 24 V voltage supply S Polarity reversal of the 24 V voltage supply S Switching off the power section S Fault in the startup of the IP 266 S Line interruption of the set point line (IP 266 power section) S Blocking of the drive S Wrong position control direction
Technical specifications
Incremental position decoding (pulse inputs) 5 V inputs (differential inputs to RS 422) 24 V inputs (asymmetrical inputs) Input voltage S Nominal value Input current at "1 Galvanic isolation Max. counting frequency, max. cable length (shielded) Binary inputs Galvanic isolation Input voltage range S Nominal value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Permissible opencircuit current at "0 signal Input current at 24 V typ. Binary outputs Galvanic isolation Output voltage range S Nominal value Max. output current at "1 signal Shortcircuit protection Cable length (shielded) Controller output (analog output) Output signal range Digital representation of the output signal Accuracy Shortcircuit protection No 30 V 24 V - 30 to + 5V 13 V to 30 V 1.5 mA 7.3 mA Cable length (shielded) max. max. No 20 V to 30 V 24 V 100 mA Shortcircuit proof output 100 m (328 ft)
2 pulses displaced by 90 _ and zero mark, and their inverse signals 2 pulses displaced by 90 _ and zero mark + 24 V 7.3 mA No +5V In acc. with RS 422 No
typ.
10 V 13 bit and sign 0.8 % with reference 10 V Shortcircuit proof output 32 m (105 ft)
100 kHz/25 m 500 kHz/30 m (82 ft) (98 ft) 25 kHz/100 m (328 ft)
1) Only with PG 720P, 740 or 760 programming devices and the COM 266 parameterization software. Siemens ST 50 1998
2/59
Ordering data
IP 266 positioning module1) Configuring package for IP 266 comprising parameterization soft ware COM 266 (for description see Catalog Section 7) and manual German English French 704 connecting cable for connecting S IP 266 5 V incremental encoder, one end open, max. 30 m (98 ft) long 2.5 m (8 ft) 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) S IP 266 24 V incremental encoder, one end open, max. 100 m (328 ft) long (up to 25 kHz), max. 25 m (82 ft) long (up to 100 kHz) 2.5 m (8 ft) 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164 ft)
1)
Order No. 6ES5 266-8MA11 705 connecting cable for connecting S IP 266 Siemens position encoder 6FX20012..., 3.2 m (10 ft) up to 32 m (105 ft) long 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (105 ft) S IP 266 Power unit of a servo motor analog interface ( 10 V), shielded cable, max. 32 m (105 ft) long 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) Sub D connector S 9pin, male, for connecting the motor power section S 15pin, male, for connecting the motor power section 6ES5 704-3BC50 6ES5 704-3BF00 6ES5 704-3CB00 6ES5 704-3CF00
Order No.
6ES5 750-2AA21
2/60
Siemens ST 50 1998
Principle of operation
The following data must be specified before the stepper motor can be controlled: S Configuration data for describing the technical characteristics of the drive system S Positioning data for defining the positioning path
The IP 267 generates a symmetrical traverse profile from all the data. The traverse profile consists of the acce leration range, the constant speed range and the delay range. The frequency in crease/decrease in the acce leration/deceleration range is linear.
The power section is con trolled via pulses. The number of pulses determines the length of the traverse path, the pulse frequency is a measure for the speed of the positioning process. The pulse output takes place inde pendently without burdening the CPU.
Functions
Digital inputs for calibration and limitation of the traversing ranges S Status display for different operating modes
S
Programmable pulse generator; Interface to commercial stepper motor components with 5 V differential inputs or
Technical specifications
Digital inputs Input voltage (nominal value) Input signal area S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Input voltage Number of inputs 24 V - 33 V to +5 V + 13 V to + 33 V 8.5 mA 5 (2 limit switches, emergency limit switches, reference point switch, external stop) 1 No + 22 V to 30 V Output stage Output voltages S Supply with + 5 V At "0 signal At "1 signal S Supply with Vp (Vp = 5 V to 30 V) At "0 signal At "1 signal Output current Output frequency Number of steps Permissible cable length
max. min.
0.4 V 4.5 V
typ.
Number of channels Isolation Supply voltage for 2wire BERO proximity switches
0.4 V Vp - 0.4 V 20 mA (shortcircuit proof) 204 kHz, independent of the output voltage 220 - 1 = 1 048 575 pulses per assignment 50 m (164 ft) at 50 kHz Twistedpair cable
Ordering data
IP 267 stepper motor controller1) IP 267 manual German English French Spanish Italian
Order No. 6ES5 267-8MA11 736 connecting cable for connecting S IP 267 Power section of a stepper, one end open 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 16 m (52 ft) Sub D connector 9pin, male
Order No.
6ES5 998-5SD11 6ES5 998-5SD21 6ES5 998-5SD31 6ES5 998-5SD41 6ES5 998-5SD51
1)
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/61
Design
385A counter module (not for S595F) The 385A counter module contains two down counters. The output values (1 to 999) are each set with a decade switch on the frontplate. The signal level of the counter pulses (5 V or 24 V) can be selected separately on the frontplate for both counters.
385B counter module The 385B counter module contains one counter which can be operated in two modes, as up counter or as up/down counter, settable on the frontplate. The signal level of the counter pulses (5 V differential voltage in accordance with RS 422 or 24 V) can also be selected on the frontplate. Position decoding The counter operates as an up/down counter ( 32,767). The momentary counter status can be scanned by the user program. The limit values are set in the user program. When a limit value is reached, the relevant output is set. Resetting and synchronization are performed via a reference input (24 V DC).
The module has an enable input (24 V). Pulse sensors or position encoders are connected to the frontplate with a connect ing cable and are supplied with voltage (24 V or 5 V) from the module.
Principle of operation
385A counter module (not for S595F) Each counter has an enable input which is set via the program. A positive edge at the enable input sets the counter to the desired output value (0 to 999). The counter pulses are captured. If the counter reaches status 0, the relevant output is set. The negative edge of the enable signal resets the output. 385A counter module (not for S595F) Counting The counter counts up from 0 to 65,535. When this setpoint is reached, the relevant output is set. A positive edge at the enable input resets the counter and outputs.
By setting duplication or quadruplication of the counter pulse evaluation, the accuracy of the acquired path is enhanced. Positioning tasks can also be solved in conjunction with an incremental position encoder. The table below shows how many 385B counter modules can be used in the S590U, S595U/F and S5100U pro grammable controllers and which slots are available for this purpose.
Quantity 4 8 8 4 8 8 Slots 0-5 0-7 0-7 0-7 0-7 0-7
PLC/ET S590U S595U S590F (only for 385B) S5100 with CPU 100 CPU 102 CPU 103
Technical specifications
Counter module Counters Galvanic isolation Counting range S Counting S Position decoding Counting frequency 6ES5 385-8MA11 2 Yes 999 to 0 (down) 500 Hz 6ES5 385-8MB11 1 No 0 to 65 535 (up) - 32 768 to + 32 767 (up/down) 25 kHz (24 V); 500 kHz (5V)
max.
2/62
Siemens ST 50 1998
Input voltage S Nominal value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Cable length S Unshielded S Shielded Outputs (limit value/setpoints reached) Output current at "1 signal S Permissible range Lamp load Shortcircuit protection Residual current at "0 signal Signal level S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Cable length (unshielded) typ. max. max.
5 to 500 mA 5W Electronic (display with red LED) 1 mA 3V L+ (- 2.2 V) 100 m (328 ft)
5 to 500 mA 5W Electronic (display with red LED) 0.5 mA 3V L+ (- 2,2 V) 100 m (328 ft)
Supply voltage L+ (for load) S Nominal value max. S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Supply of 2wire BERO Isolation voltage (inputs and outputs to each other and to ground, input to + 9 V) S Tested with Current input S Internal (from CPU; 9V) S External (at 24 V, without load) Power loss Weight
Ordering data
385A counter module Down counter, 2 counter levels counter frequency to 500 Hz 385 counter module1) Up/down counter, counter frequency to 25 kHz (24V)/500 kHz (5 V), also for position decoding 704 connecting cable for 385B counter module for 5 V signals (max. 50 m/164 ft) 2.5 m (8 ft) 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft)
1)
Order No. 6ES5 385 -8MA11 704 connecting cable for 24 V signals (max. 100 m/328 ft) 2.5 m (8 ft) 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 705 connecting cable for connecting the Siemens position encoders to the 385B counter module 5 m (16 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (105 ft)
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/63
Technical specifications
Number of timers Time range Setting Setting error Reproducibility max. 2 0.3 to 330 s By potentiometer 10 % 3% Temperature sensitivity Current consumption at + 9 V (CPU, IM 318) Weight max. max. approx. + 1 % per 10 _C of set time 10 mA 0.2 kg (0.44 Ib)
Ordering data
380 timer module1) with 2 timers, time range 0.3 s to 300 s
1)
2/64
Siemens ST 50 1998
Special modules
Technical specifications
Number of inputs Galvanic isolation Voltage range1)/ input resistance Current range input resistance
1)/
max.
Isolation voltage (+ 9 V to inputs and between inputs) S Tested at Current consumption at 9 V (CPU, IM 318) Weight max. approx.
Permissible overload capability Limit setting S Setting error S Hysteresis S Reproducibility max. max. max.
Ordering data
461 comparator module2) with 2 inputs, galvanic isolation, can be switched between voltage range of 0.5 to 10 V and current range of 0.5 to 20 mA 1) Can be switched over individually 2) Also for S595F
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/65
Design
Like the other I/O modules, it is simply plugged into the bus unit, but has no connection to the terminal block and is
A switch at the rear of the module selects whether the module simulates inputs or displays outputs.
Technical specifications
Inputs Outputs Galvanic isolation Current consumption at 9 V (CPU, IM 318) max. 8 switches 8 LEDs No 30 mA Power loss Weight typ. approx. 0.3 W 0.2 kg (0.54 Ib)
Ordering data
788 simulator module1) for simulating 8 inputs or 8 outputs (switches and LEDs)
1)
2/66
Siemens ST 50 1998
Functions
The user sets the desired mode when parameterizing the module. The CP 521 SI is parameterized via the appli cation program in the CPU or via a data block in the memory submodule on the communications processor. The module is equipped with a hardware clock which is powered by a backup battery in the event of a power failure.
2/68
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Data communication S In print mode S In communications mode Permissible cable length S With V.24 S With 20 mA (current loop) Additional software Power consumption Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in.) Weight approx.
Max. 255 massage frames of 80 characters each Variable frame length, max. 256 byte 15 m (49 ft) 1000 m (3300 ft) Not required 140 mA 45.5 x 135 x 85 (1.7 x 5.2 x 3.3) 0.5 kg (1.3 lb)
Ordering data
CP 521 SI communications processor1) To be ordered as a separate item: CP 521 SI manual German English French 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbyte EPROM 16 Kbyte EPROM 32 Kbyte EEPROM 8 Kbyte EEPROM 16 Kbyte
1) 2)
Order No. 6ES5 521-8MA22 SINEC L1 adapter for connecting the BT 777 to the CP 521 SI (optional) MODBUS operating system slave submodule2) with S5-95U, CPU 103 only (MODBUS RTU format) German, English, French; Spanish availabe soon Backup battery Sub D connector 25pin, male
6ES5 897-8QA01
6ES5 998-1UD11 6ES5 998-1UD21 6ES5 998-1UD31 6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41
Also for S595F With S5100U, CPU103 and S595U only; S595F available soon
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/69
The CP 521 SI can act as a MODBUS interface when using the MODBUS operating system submodule, which must be ordered separately. In this case, the CP is connected as a slave in a MODBUS network using the MODBUS RTU message frame format. A modem can also be connected since RTS/ CTS interface signals are supported by the operating system. The CP 521 BASIC can be used with the S590U and S595U programmable controllers as well as in the S5100U programmable controller. The COM 521 BASIC para meterization software is also required for startup of the CP 521 BASIC communi cations processor. This soft ware runs on all ATcompa tible PG 720, PG 720C, PG 740 and PG 760 programming devices.
Principle of operation
As well as program entry and program test, the COM 521 BASIC parameterization soft ware allows programs to be stored on an EPROM sub module, a diskette and a hard disk and also allows the reading in of programs generated with other program editors.
Functions
The BASIC interpreter and program editor support, for instance, the following functions: S Visualization; Entire screen forms can be stored in the RAM or EPROM of the CP 521 BASIC. They can be called up individually and output to a printer or monitor
S S
Temporary storage of data Math functions; The CP 521 BASIC provides arithmetic and logic functions of the BASIC programming language
The module has a hardware clock which has battery backup in the event of power failure.
2/70
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Software protocol
Permissible cable length S For RS 232 C (V.24) S For 20 mA (current loop) Additional software for startup and programming
COM 521 BASIC Power consumption typ. 140 mA 45.5 x 135 x 85 (1.7 x 5.2 x 3.3) 0.5 kg (1.3 Ib) Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in.) Weight approx.
1)
Current loop interface is passive as default; with connection of an external current supply (24 V DC) it can also be configured as an active interface.
Ordering data
CP 521 BASIC communications processor1) To be ordered as a separate item: Manual German English French COM 521 BASIC system program
Order No. 6ES5 521-8MB12 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbyte EPROM 16 Kbyte EPROM 32 Kbyte EEPROM 8 Kbyte EEPROM 16 Kbyte RAM 8 Kbyte RAM 16 Kbyte RAM 32 Kbyte MODBUS operating system slave submodule2) see 521 BASIC (MODBUS RTU format) German, English, French; Spanish available soon Backup battery Sub D connector 25pin, male
Order No.
6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41 6ES5 375-0LD11 6ES5 375-0LD21 6ES5 375-0LD31 6ES5 897-8QA01
1) 2)
Also for S5-95F With S5100U, CPU103 and S595U only; S595F available soon
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/71
Design
The CP 541 is snapped directly onto a DIN rail. For the connection to the pro grammable controller a connection cable is used, which is connected to the programming device inter face. The CP 541 must be supplied separately with 24 V DC. At startup, the PROFIBUS user address must be set on the module. Parameter assignment and evaluation of diagnostics data takes place with the S5 data block editor. The configuring data are stored on an integral EEPROM, requiring no maintenance.
S5115U/135U/155U with CP 5430, CP 5431 or IM 308; S7300, S7400 Thirdparty systems PROFIBUSDP
ET 200
S595U/DP
2/72
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
S
FDL for Multicast; For sending messages to several partners simul taneously (Multicast). It can be determined which part ners can receive the mes sage. This type of connec tion can be used safety related when connecting an S595F or S5115F
PROFIBUSDP; For the dataoriented connection between the CP541 as DP slave and a standard DP master. This connection cannot be used safetyrelated
Technical specifications
Compatible with S590U, S595U, S595F, S5100U, S5115U, S5115H, S5115F Internal EEPROM 1 for connection to PLC 1 for connection to PROFIBUS 9600 bit/s 93.75/187.5/500/1500 kbit/s 93.75/187.5/500/1500 kbit/s 93.75/187.5 kbit/s Types of connection via PROFIBUS Supply voltage Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in.) PLC/PLC connection Multicast via FDL PROFIBUSDP (slave) 24 V DC 45.5 x 135 x 85 (1.7 x 5.2 x 3.3)
Memory for configuration data Interface Transfer rate S CP 541 to PLC S CP 541 to PROFIBUS "DP/FMS" protocol "userdefined" protocol "DP" protocol or to IM 308B
Ordering data
CP 541 communications processor 735-8 connecting cable 1 m (3.28 ft) 2.5 m (8.2 ft)
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/73
SIMATIC S590U: slots 0+1 SIMATIC S595U: slots 0+1, 2+3, 4+5 or 6+7; max. 2 CPs SIMATIC S5100U: slots 0+1, 2+3, 4+5 or 6+7; max. 2 CPs (up to 3 CPs with CPU 103)
There is no need to configure the CP. Up to 31 AS interface slaves can be controlled ac cording to the AS interface specification. Up to 248 binary elements can be controlled when bi directional slaves are used. The supply voltage is moni tored on the AS interface shaped cable.
S
Design
S S S
Occupies two slots in the I/O area of the PLC. 16 bytes are used in the I/O address area. Status indicators for opera tional states.
Indication of the connected and activated slaves and their readiness. Integral analog section al lows direct connection of the AS interface cable.
Connection of the AS inter face shaped cable to the bus unit of the PLC. Easily replaceable because there is no cable connected to the CP itself.
Principle of operation
The module communicates in dependently with the AS inter face slaves. The program mable controller is thus fully relieved of slave scanning. Data transmission between the PLC and the AS interface slaves is transparent for the application with regard to data input and output.
The I/O data of the AS inter face slaves are handled like the standard I/O data of the PLC. The CP 2433 is pow erded via the backplane bus of the PLC. The slaves are powered via a separate AS in terface power supply unit. There are two modes: Standard mode In this mode, only the data bits of the slaves can be ad dressed in the I/O address area of the PLC.
Extended mode In addition to access to the data bits of the slaves in the I/O address area, a function block (FB 60) offers access to the master calls according to the AS interface specification (e.g. writing parameters). The extended mode can only be used with the S595U and S5100U (CPU 103).
Technical specifications
Bus cycle time Interfaces S Assignments I/O in programmable controller S AS interface port Supply voltage Current consumption S through backplane bus S through AS interface lines 5 ms for 31 slaves 16 bytes through S5 bus module; terminal 78; 910 DC +9 V through backplane typ. 200 mA at DC 9 V max. 100 mA Ambinet conditions S Operating temperature S Transport/storage temperature S Relative humidity Design S Board format S Dimensions (W H D) in mm S Weight S Pspace requirement 0 _C to +60 _C 40 _C to +70 _C 95% at +25 _C S5100U technology 90 134 85 360 g 2 slots
Ordering data
CP 2433 Communications processor for connection of SIMATIC S590U, S595U, ET200U, S5100U to AS interface
Order No. 6GK1 243-3SA00 Manual for AS interface contains CP 2413/CP 2430, CP 2433 description, introduction and fundamentals incl. software (FB60 + examples) S German S English S French S Italian
Order No.
2/74
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ordering data
DIN rail 483 mm (18.9 in) for 19 in cabinets 530 mm (20.8 in) for 600 mm (23.6 in) cabinets 830 mm (32.6 in) for 900 mm (35.4 in) cabinets 2 m (6.6 ft)
Bus units Application The internal bus of the S5100U and, if expanded, the S590U and S595U/F is assembled by the user from individual bus units. The bus units are snapped onto the DIN rail and inter connected by a flat ribbon cable.
Design
One bus unit can take two I/O modules. Each bus unit has a terminal block for connecting the signal cables. When replacing a bus unit it is only necessary to loosen the fixing
screws of the terminal block. The terminal blocks are supplied either with screw contacts or with crimp con tacts.
For alarm acquisition (only for S5100U with CPU 103) the bus unit with interrupt capa bility must be plugged in beside the CPU 103. The bus unit functions in other slots as a normal bus unit.
Technical specifications
Bus unit Bus unit with interrupt 6ES5 700 6ES5 700 -8MA11, -8FA111) -8MA221) -8MB11 SIGUT 2 -8MB21 Crimp snapin 2 Bus unit Bus unit with interrupt 6ES5 700 6ES5 700 -8MA11, -8FA111) -8MA221) -8MB11 -8MB21
Type of connection Number of plugin modules Number of bus units per programmable controller max. Connection between two bus units Number of terminals
16 (alarm acquisition only 1 beside CPU 103) Integrated cable connector 10 per module location Order No.
2x 0.5...1.5 mm2 (0.5 to 1.5) mm2 (with end sleeves) 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) mm2 91.5x162x41 91.5x135x41 (3.6x6.4x1.6) (3.6x5.3x1.6) 0.3 kg (10.6 oz) 0.2 kg (7.0 oz) Order No.
Ordering data
Bus unit S Screw terminals S Screw terminals (increased EMC protection)1) S Crimp terminals; with crimp contacts (increased EMC protection)1) Bus unit with interrupt S Screw terminals S Crimp terminals; with crimp contacts 1) Also for S595F Siemens ST 50 1998
Crimp contacts (package of 250) 6ES5 700-8MA11 6ES5 700-8FA11 6ES5 700-8MA22 Crimping tool for crimp contacts Extraction tool for crimp contacts Plug connection cover for bus unit (package of 10) 6ES5 700-8MB11 6ES5 700-8MB21
2/75
Technical specifications
Interface module Number of interface modules per CPU max. Permissible voltage between DIN rail and central grounding point max. Current consumption, internal (at 9 V) Weight max. approx. IM 315 1 pair IM 316 4 IM 316F 4
Ordering data
IM 315 interface module for 1 expansion rack; Two modules with 0.5 m (18.4 in) cable are supplied; Not for S595F IM 316 interface module for 1 to 3 expansion racks; One interface is required per rack; Not for S595F IM 316F interface module Similar to IM 316 but with increased EMC protection; Also for S595F
Order No. 6ES5 315 - 8MA11 712 connecting cable for connecting two IM 316/IM 316F Length 0.5 m (18.4 in) Length 2.5 m (8.2 ft) Length 5.0 m (16 ft) Length 10.0 m (32.8 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 712 - 8AF00 6ES5 712 - 8BC50 6ES5 712 - 8BF00 6ES5 712 - 8CB00
2/76
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
Technical specifications
Number of I/Os which can be connected Input voltage S Rated value S Permissible range S Permissible voltage dip Line frequency of the input voltage S Permissible range Current consumption from 230 V Current consumption from 115 V Inrush current at 115 V/230 V Output voltage S From V1 for encoder S From V2 for peripherals max. 6 115/230 V AC 93 to 127 V/87 to 253 V AC 20 ms Output voltage S From V1 S From V2 Floating S V1 S V2 RI suppression specification 50 to 63 Hz 95 mA 190 mA 2 A/1.2 A 24 V DC 9 V DC Power loss Shortcircuit protection Class of protection Connecting cables typ. 0.3 A 0.3 A Yes No Class A in acc. with VDE 0871 11 W Electronic Class 1 Stranded 2 x (0.5 to 1.5 mm2, with end sleeves) Solid 2 x (0.5 to 2.5 mm2) 58.5 x 135 x 120 (2.2 x 5.2 x 4.6) 0.82 kg (2.2 Ib)
Ordering data
IM 90 interface module for expansion of the S590U with up to 6 I/O modules
Siemens ST 50 1998
2/77
SIPAC 3804AB01 power supply module (for S595U and S5100U for powering CPU, PS 935 and load) S SIPAC 3804AB01 power supply module (for S595U, S5100U, for powering CPU, PS 935 and load) The power supply modules are snapped direct onto DIN rails (without bus unit) to the left of the S595U or S5100U S For further information regarding SIPAC/SITOP power supply modules see Catalog ST 71.
S
115/230 V AC (selectable) 92 to 132 V/ 187 to 264 V AC 0 ms 50/60 Hz 47 to 63 Hz 0.5/0.18 A 3/6 A 24 V DC 18 to 34 V 1A 0 to 1 A Fuse Class I Yes 1.5 kV AC Class A 7.5 W 2 x (0.5 to 1.5) 2 x (0.5 to 2.5) 45 (1.7) 1 kg (2.7 Ib)
Ordering data
PS 930 power supply module only for S5100U, for powering the CPU, however without load S For 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC, 1 A PS 931 power supply module for S595U/100U, for powering the CPU, PS 935, and the load S For 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC, 2 A
Order No. 6ES5 930-8MD11 SIPAC power supply modules for S595U/100U, for powering the CPU, PS 935, and the load. S For 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC; 4 A S For 115/230 V AC; 24 V DC; 10 A Fuse for PS 930 (Spare: 3 A F)
Order No.
6ES5 931-8MD11
2/78
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115U Application
Fig. 3/1
The S5115U programmable controller is suitable for au tomation tasks in the medium performance range. Its highly modular design featuring five different powerful CPUs has set a new standard. The S5115U is suitable for such areas as: S Machine control systems
S S
The rugged construction of this PLC makes it suitable for use under harsh operating and environmental conditions, e.g. in the vicinity of power equipment, in cranes, on oceangoing ships, or in offshore installations. The standardized hardware technology, the highly modu lar design of the PLC and the high performance capabilities of the programming devices give the system the following features: S Easy use due to simple assembly and connection S Simple replaceability with snapon blocktype modules S Adaptability through the use of different input and output voltages as well as the finely graduated modular expan sion capability of the inputs, outputs and memory S Operation without fans in all standard applications
Simple and vibrationresis tant mounting of modules, which are simply snapped onto the solid mounting rack and locked into position with screws Simple programming by means of structured pro gramming and the use of standardized program sections (function blocks) Offloading of the CPU and the program through the use of intelligent I/O modules (e.g. digital position de coder, valve control module) Simple communication with other programmable controllers and computers through the use of internal communications processors and LANs Easy system startup by means of programming de vices and service units with extensive programming and debugging aids
3/2
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115U (continued) Design An S5115U programmable controller (PLC) consists of a central controller (with CR 700) and as many expan sion units as required (with ER 701). The central controller always contains a power supply module and a CPU module. The expansion units can be configured with or without a power supply module, depen ding on the type. They are connected to the central controller using interface modules. Depending on the automation task, different input/output modules can be plugged into the PLC: Digital and analog I/O modules S Communications processors S Intelligent I/O modules S Modules for special functions
S
General
Adapter casings are available for modules which are not of blocktype construction. Possible configurations Central configuration In a central configuration the expansion units (EUs) are either in the same cabinet as the central controllers (CCs) or in a separate cabinet next to it. The maximum length for the cable connecting the CC to the furthest EU is 2.5 m (8.2 ft).
EU ER 701-0 ER 701-1
IM 305
EU ER 701-0 ER 701-1
IM 306
S5-115U/H
S5-115U/H/F
Fig. 3/2
Distributed configuration In a distributed configuration the EUs are installed at a distance of up to 3000 m (9840 ft) from the CC. Three additional EUs can be connected in a central configuration to each distributed EU. Note The expansion units of other SIMATIC S5 programmable controllers, distributed peripherals and field devices can also be connected.
IM 31.
CC CR 700-.
IM 30.
Fig. 3/3
Degree of protection
Mechanical loading
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/3
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115U (continued) Principle of operation The principle of operation of the S5115U programmable controller is largely governed by the function components "program memory" and "processor". In the versions of the S5115H and S5115F pro grammable controllers, the redundary functions are an additional factor. Program memory The program memory contains the user program. Processor The processor operates cyclically: At the beginning of each cycle, the processor reads the signal states of all inputs and stores them in a process input image (PII). The program is executed step by step. The processor stores the calculated signal states in a process output image (POI). At the end of a cycle, the pro cessor transfers the informa tion from the process output image to the outputs. The cycle can be stopped by interrupts (process and time interrupts). Programming
STEP 5 methods of representation U E 1.1 U E 1.2 = A 1.1 STL
Inputs 0 1 PII 0
Read inputs
Execute program
Coun ter
Interrupt program
Write outputs
Program memory 0
A1.1
S5-115U
GRAPH 5
Up to PG 760
Fig. 3/5
Programming language
The programming language for SIMATIC S5 pro grammable controllers is STEP 5 in one of the following representations: S CSF Control System Flowchart
Programs for sequence control systems can be entered clearly in the form of a flow diagram using the
GRAPH 5 software package. Programmable controllers with CPU 945 can also be pro grammed in the SCL high level language.
3/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115U (continued) Programming devices The following programming devices can be used for pro gramming the S5115U pro grammable controller:
S S S S
General
The programming devices have operator prompting to facilitate programming and numerous aids for debugging and system startup. A printer can be connected to the pro grammer for program docu menting.
Program input
There are two ways of entering the user program: S Direct program entry to the CPU in the central controller (online programming)
Programming the memory cards or memory sub modules (flash EPROM, EPROM and EEPROM) in the programming device without connecting it to the programmable controller. The memory card or memory submodule is then plugged into the CPU (offline programming) Time interrupt-controlled program execution OB 6: After a specified period of time, a time interrupt is initiated and this organization block is called. Subsequent execution depends on the program contents of OB6 defined by the user for this purpose. The higherpriority execution levels (organization blocks) can interrupt the lowerpriority execution levels after any STEP5 operation. The order of priority is as follows (from the highest to the lowest priority): time interrupt controlled, interrupt controlled, timecontrolled, cyclic.
Program execution
Cyclic program execution OB 1: The blocks of the user program are executed in the sequence specified in organi zation block OB 1.
Interrupt-driven program execution
OB 2 to OB 5: When certain input signal changes (process interrupts) occur, cyclic execution is interrupted at the next statement and an organi zation block assigned to this event is started. The user can formulate his response pro gram to this interrupt in this organization block. Cyclic program execution is then resumed at the point at which it was inerrupted.
Time-controlled program execution OB 10 to OB 13: The time when processing takes place depends on the call interval. This can be set between 1 ms and 1 min (CPU 945) or between 10 ms and 10 min (CPU 941 to CPU 944). It is therefore possible to process certain parts of the program independently of the scan time.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/5
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115U (continued) Communication Pointtopoint connection The communications pro cessors enable the pro grammable controller to communicate with other pro grammable controllers, computers, operator control and process monitoring systems and peripherals via pointtopoint connection. They have their own memory for data, texts and displays. The communications pro cessors handle data commu nications with the devices connected to them completely autonomously, thereby relieving the CPUs of time consuming communications tasks. For communication with computers, other pro grammable controllers and peripheral devices such as printers, either the CP523, CP524, CP544 and CP544B communications processors or the second interface of the CPU can be used (CPU943, CPU944, CPU945).
Printer Fig. 3/6 Connections between programmable controller and PC, operator control and process monitoring equipment and printer
Communication with the equipment of the SIMATIC HMI operator control and process monitoring The S590U, S595U/F, S5100U, S5115U/H/F, S5135U and S5155U/H programmable controllers can be connected. Features S Up to 31 nodes S Baud rate 9.6 kbit/s S Max. coverage 50 km (31 miles) S Transmission medium: twisted pair cable
SINEC L1 local area network SINEC L1 (Siemens Network Communication Low Range) makes it possible to configure a small, distributed auto mation system on the lower level of communications technology by simple means.
PROFIBUS local area network See Section 10. Industrial Ethernet local area network See Section 10.
3/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115U (continued) Quality assurance procedures To ensure correct operation of all SIMATIC S5 products and to prevent failures, extensive, costeffective quality assur ance procedures are carried out at every stage of the life of a product:
S S S S S S
General
During product planning During product development During production In product operation
Product planning The product planning phase covers all the activities from market research to type spe cification. Quality assurance in the product planning phase ensures that the SIMATIC S5 product conforms to the right standards of quality required on the market. Product development and production The following are some exam ples of routing quality assur ance precautions taken during development and production: S Use of highquality components
S S
Worstcase design of all circuits Systematic and computer controlled testing of all components supplied by subcontractors Burnin of all LSI circuits, e.g. processors and memo ries. Burning in is an aging process which helps to reduce the number of failures early in a product's life. The components are subjected to a high temper ature for several hours in a burnin cubicle Measures to prevent static charge from building up when handling MOS circuits Visual inspections at various stages of production Incircuit testing of all modules, i.e. computer aided testing of all compo nents and their interaction with other components in the complete circuit Continuous heatrun test at elevated ambient tempera ture over a period of several days
Careful computercontrolled final testing S Statistical evaluation of all failures to enable the im mediate initiation of suitable corrective measures
S
Product operation Even when the SIMATICS5 products are in operation on the customer's premises, they are still under constant supervision. Extensive quality control precautions are taken in the following areas: S Stockkeeping and despatch S Service S Field observation Established methods are used in all these areas, which operate precisely, punctually and conscientiously, whilst also remaining flexible for special customer require ments. Sometimes an even higher level of faulttolerance or safety is required than that normally offered by the SI MATIC S5 U range. Fault tolerant or failsafe pro grammable controllers, such as the S5115H or S5115F, are available for this purpose.
Availability
Availability is the probability of finding a system in a func Safety is defined by DIN31000 as "A state of lower risk than the permitted limit". The "permitted limit is the maximum acceptable
tional state at a specified point in time. degree of risk for a specific plant". The plantspecific degree of risk may be stipu lated by law, by the plant ope rator or by an independent body of experts, e.g. the German Technical Inspectorate (TV).
Safety
Installation guidelines SIMATIC programmable con trollers are designed for use in harsh industrial environ ments. To ensure correct operation of the equipment, it must be installed and connected in accordance with certain rules. Certain principles must also be observed as regards wiring, earthing and shielding. Timely planning of the neces sary measures for improving the electromagnetic compati bility (EMC) of the pro grammable controllers is advisable in order to avoid retrofitting. These rules are explained in the section entitled "Installation guidelines" in the relevant product manuals. For the installation of failsafe controls, the relevant regula tions must be observed.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/7
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115H Application In many fields of automation, increasingly high demands are being placed on the availability and fault tolerance of programmable controllers (PLCs). Particularly in fields where a plant shutdown would be extremely expensive. In such cases, only redundant systems can offer the standard of availability required. Faulttolerant systems will normally continue to operate even if one or more faults cause parts or the control system to fail. The S5115H programmable controller consists of two interlinked central controllers. It operates on the "master/ slave" principle. One subunit, the master, controls the process. If a fault occurs, the other subunit, the slave, immediately takes over control.
Fig. 3/7
This ensures a high degree of fault tolerance, which makes the S5115H especially suitable for applications in the following fields: Fields with predominantly continuous processes, e.g.: S Refineries S Chemicals S Power stations S Steelworks S Environmental protection (e.g. water treatment) S Pipelines S Offshore installations
Areas of production em ploying batch processes, e.g.: S The automotive industry S The pharmaceutical industry S The food industry S In plants with flexible manufacturing systems S In highbay warehouses The performance capability, user convenience and other technical features of the S5115H faulttolerant pro grammable controller corre spond to a large extent to the features of the S5115U.
Design
In the S5115H programmable controller the central functions are always implemented in a redundant configuration. The I/Os can, however, also be configured with redundancy. Three different levels of fault tolerance are possible, de pending on the arrangement of the I/O modules: S Normal fault tolerance (singlesided configuration) S Enhanced fault tolerance (switched configuration) S Maximum fault tolerance (fully redundant configu ration) Fig. 3/8 shows the configu rations for the three levels of fault tolerance. The different levels of fault tolerance can be combined as required.
I/O configuration
Singlechannel
Twochannel
Singlesided configuration
Switched configuration
Fig. 3/8
3/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115H (continued) Design (continued) Normal fault tolerance (singlesided configuration) In the singlesided configura tion (see Fig. 3/9) the I/Os are connected in single channel mode and only addressed by one of the two subunits. The I/Os in this configuration can be plugged into either S a central controller or, S if the number of slots is not sufficient, expansion units. Information read into the one subunit (e.g. from digital input modules) is automatically transmitted to the second subunit. It is immaterial whether one subunit is the master and the other the standby. What is important is whether or not the subunit which is connected to the I/Os is operational. In the event of a failure, the I/Os connected to the subunit concerned are also out of action. This configuration is used for sections of a plant which do not require enhanced availability. Enhanced fault tolerance (switched configuration) In the switched configuration (see Fig. 3/10) the I/Os are connected in singlechannel mode, but they can be addressed by both subunits. The I/Os in this configuration must always be plugged into an expansion unit with an ER 7013LH or EG 185U subrack. Up to eight expansion units can be connected in switched configuration, distributed between up to two I/O bus lines.
All 721 connecting cables EU
General
Subunit A
Subunit B
IM 304
EU
IM 314 IM 306
To further expansion units 1) Using either IM 306/IM 306 or IM 304/IM 314 Fig. 3/9 Singlesided configuration (normal fault tolerance)
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
IM 314R
To further expansion units Fig. 3/10 Switched configuration (enhanced fault tolerance)
Expansion units in switched configuration are connected via the IM 304 interface module in the central controller and the IM 314R interface module in the expansion unit. The expansion units can also be expanded in a centralized configuration via the IM 306 interface module.
Expansion units in switched configuration are connected to both subunits and are addressed by the one currently acting as master. This configuration is employed when failure of individual I/Os is not crucial.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/9
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115H (continued) Design (continued) Maximum fault tolerance (twochannel configuration) In the twochannel configura tion (see Fig. 3/11) identical I/Os are installed with the same addresses in both sub units. Inputs and outputs can be used in redundant configu ration in both the central controller and in additional expansion units. Both failure of central functions and failure of the I/Os on one channel can be tolerated. This configuration offers the maxi mum degree of availability. The I/O modules in the redun dant configuration must be made known to the operating system using the COM 115H parameterization software. The redundant I/O modules are addressed in the same way as singlechannel I/O modules in the user program. The operating system does the rest. The intelligent I/O modules and communications pro cessors can also be used in twochannel, redundant con figurations (see pages 3/53 and 3/56). Expansion units can be connected to each central controller in the same way as for the S5115U program mable controller, using the relevant interface modules (centralized and distributed configuration). The ET 200 distributed I/O system can also be connected to the S5115H programmable controller. For further information on the configuration of the S5115H faulttolerant programmable controller, please see Section 11 (Configuring).
Expansion unit IM 324R IM 304. IM 306 1) IM 324R IM 30. IM 306 1)
Subunit A
Subunit B
IM 314
IM 314
Subunit A
Subunit B
IM 314R
Mixed configuration The different levels of fault tolerance can be combined as required. A mixed configu ration (see Fig. 3/12), i.e. a combination of twochannel/ redundant, switched and singlesided configuration is frequently the most econo mical solution.
3/10
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115H (continued) Design (continued) Redundancy of IPs and CPs Intelligent I/O modules (IPs) and communications pro cessors (CPs) can also be used redundantly. Both switched and twochannel re dundant configurations are possible. Criteria Which configuration is the more suitable largely depends on the application. Advantages of the switched redundant configuration: S In the event of failure of one of the central controllers, the IPs/CPs retain their redundancy S In the event of failure of one of the IPs/CPs, the central controllers retain their redundancy S Shorter scan time Disadvantages of the switched redundant configuration: S At least two expansion units in switched configuration are required S For repair of an IP/CP the expansion unit concerned needs be switched off. All the other I/O modules in the same expansion unit are therefore out of action. Advantages of the two channel redundant configuration: S No expansion units in switched configuration are required S For repair of IPs/CPs it is usually only necessary to disconnect redundant components from the power supply. Disadvantages of the twochannel redundant configuration: S Longer scan time Switched redundant configuration At least two units are required for the switched redundant configuration. An IP or CP of the same type must be installed in each expansion unit. When data is received by one IP or CP, it is automati cally transmitted to the other subunit.
IP/CP
General
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
IP/CP
To remote node
Twochannel redundant configuration In the twochannel redundant configuration an IP or CP must be installed in each sub unit. Unlike I/O modules in re dundant configuration, the two IPs/CPs occupy different ad dresses or pages in the two subunits and operate inde pendently of one another. When data is received by one IP or CP, it is automatically transmitted to the other sub unit.
The redundancy function for the switched and twochannel redundant configurations must be programmed by the user. The user program defines which is the active IP or CP and must be able to detect a fault in one IP or CP in order to switch over to the other IP or CP if necessary. The operating system ensures that the data in the two sub units remains identical. The two IPs/CPs must be regarded as independent modules. For further details, please see Configuring (Section 11).
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/11
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115H (continued) Principle of operation The principle of operation of the S5115H faulttolerant programmable controller can be compared with an "OR" operation. The programmable controller is in an operational state when at least one of the two subunits is functioning correctly (see Fig. 3/14). Each of the central controllers contains a CPU 942H with a new firmware version com pared with that of the CPU 942. This firmware performs all the additional functions of the S5115H independently, e.g.: S Data interchange S Fault handling (switchover to standby) S Synchronization of the two subunits S Selftest S Fault locating The operating system of the S5115H supports redundant operation of: S Digital I/O modules S Analog I/O modules Data interchange and fault handling Masterslave operation The S5115H basically oper ates on the masterslave principle in hotstandby mode (see right). One subunit, the master, controls the process. If a fault occurs, the other subunit, the standby or slave, takes over the control functions. The faulty subunit can then be repaired without interrupting the process. The combined operation of the two subunits differs ac cording to the I/O configura tion: S Switched configuration. The master controls the process whilst the slave merely runs on standby. If a fault occurs, the standby immediately takes over control
Sensor
Subunit A
Data interchange: If a fault occurs, the operational subunit assumes control
Subunit B
Actuator
Twochannel I/O configura tion (fully redundant configu ration). Both subunits control the process in parallel. The standby also issues output signals and reads in input signals. For further details please refer to Section 11
Hotstandby Hotstandby is the ability to switch over to a standby device in the event of a fault automatically and without detremental effect. For operation in this mode it is absolutely essential that both subunits should be able to exchange data quickly and reliably. In the S5115H the two subunits are normally linked by the central controller interface via which they are both supplied with: S The same user program S The same data blocks S The same process I/O image contents S The same receive buffer contents, e.g. when using communications processors The standby unit is therefore always up to date and ready to take over control imme diately if a fault occurs.
Synchronization To avoid in switching over from master to standby, syn chronization of the subunits is essential. This includes inter change and comparison of data to ensure that both units have the same information at their disposal. The synchro nization procedure used for the S5115H is "eventdriven synchronization. Eventdriven synchronization is carried out every time an event occurs which could change the internal state of the subunits, e.g. S Commands with direct access to the I/Os S Block call commands S Time function commands When programming, the user does not need to think about synchronization because this is taken care of by the operat ing system.
3/12
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115H (continued) Principle of operation (continued) Self-test Extensive selftest functions are implemented in the S5115H programmable con troller. The following compo nents and functions are tested: S Internal S5 bus S Central controller link S Fault location system S CPUs S Memories Any faults detected during the selftest are reported. Programming, parameter assignment Programming Programming of the S5-115H is the same as for the S5-115U. All STEP 5 opera tions allowed in the S5-115U can be used. Both online and offline programming are possible. Online programming For online programming the programming device is con nected to the CPU of one of the subunits. The program is automatically relayed to the other subunit. Offline programming Offline programming is pos sible using an EPROM sub module in the programming device without connecting it to the programmable control ler. The submodule is then du plicated and plugged into the CPUs of both subunits. Parameter assignment The COM115H parameteri zation software supports the user in parameter assignment and error diagnostics:
COM 115H S5-115H Subunit B Programming device Memory submodule
General
Selftest on restart Each subunit runs through all the selftest functions on re start.
Selftest in cyclic operation For cyclic operation the oper ating system breaks down the selftest functions into short sections approximately 5 ms long. One or more of these are processed in a cycle. The number of sections per cycle is configured by the user.
Online programming
S5-115H Subunit A
Offline programming
Interactive parameter as signment of data specific to the H version S Generation of the parameter assignment data block from the parameter assignment data.
S
System diagnostics using the error data blocks and the interrupt register S Printout of data specific to the H version S General system handling, e.g. loading blocks
S
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/13
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115H (continued) Subracks for the S5-115H Subracks for central controllers:
S S S S
Subracks for distributed expansion: For singlesided or redundant configurations ER 7012, ER 7013 and ER 7013LH S For switched configurations ER 7013LH and EG 185U
S
ER 7010 ER 7011
for connecting expansion units in centralized and dis tributed configurations, for
Interface module required in Central controller Expansion unit
Singlesided or redun dant configuration Centralized expansion IM 305 IM 306 IM 304 IM 305, IM 306 in ER 7010/1 IM 314 in ER 7012/3/3 LH
Switched configuration
Distributed expansion
A CPU 942H is required in both subunits of the S5115H faulttolerant programmable controller. The following I/O modules can be used for the S5115H fault tolerant programmable controller: S I/O modules; all digital I/Os except for the 776 power output module; all analog I/Os Intelligent I/O modules; all intelligent I/Os except for the IP 241 digital position encoder S Communications processors
S
For further information on the I/O modules which can be used, see Section11.
3/14
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115F Application Safety is becoming more and more important in modern manufacturing processes. That is why systems which represent a danger to man, machine, production and the environment in the case of a fault must meet increasingly stringent safety requirements. Redundant systems meet these safety requirements. Failsafe systems deactivate the defective part immediately if a fault occurs. This does not, however, increase the availability. Failsafe operation of the S5115F programmable controller is achieved by comprehensive quality assurance measures and by: S The twochannel, i.e. redun dant structure with compari son of results via the central controller interface Requirement classes The safety requirements which must be met by a control system are set down in DIN V 19250. This standard divides the control systems into eight safety requirement classes. The requirement class for a certain application can be de termined by means of the risk graph in accordance with DIN V 19250 shown in Fig. 3/17. Requirement class 1 represents the lowest safety requirements. Class 8 requires the highest safety standard. The example illustrated in the risk graph shows how the requirement class fo a burner control is determined. From the four risk parameters (extent of damage, duration of stay in hazardous areas, danger prevention and proba bility of occurence) it is clear that the system must at least fulfill the conditions of require ment class 5. In accordance with DIN V 19250, the failsafe S5115F programmable controller corresponds to requirement class 6. The S5115F can therefore be used in the requirement classes 1 to 6.
General
S1 A1 S2 A2 G1 G2 G1 G2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 W1 Duration of stay in hazardous areas Seldom to occasionally Frequently to permanently Danger prevention Possible under certain conditions Hardly possible Burner control
S3 S4
8 W3
Extent of damage S1: Minor injury of one person; minor environmental damage S2: Major injury of one or several persons or death of one person S3: Death of several persons; permanent major environmental damage S4: Catastrophic effects, death of many persons
Probability of occurence of the unwanted event W1: Very low W2: Low W3: Relatively high
Fig. 3/17 Risk graph for the requirement classes in acc. with DIN V 19250 with examples of application
Applications for requirement class 6 include: S Burner controls, e.g. in coalfired power stations S Passenger transport systems, such as cable rail ways, underground railways and fairground carousels
Road traffic signal systems Telecontrol installations for gas and oil pipelines S Environmental protection systems, e.g. pollutant filters S Systems for the production of hazardous gases
S S
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/15
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115F (continued) Design The S5115F failsafe pro grammable controller consists of two interlinked central controllers. Only prototype tested components may be used (see Section 11). The central functions of the S5115F programmable con troller are always redundant. For the I/O modules, a distinc tion is made between "safety related" and "nonsafety related" areas. Safety-related areas In "safetyrelated" areas the I/O modules must always be in a twochannel, redundant configuration (see Fig. 3/18). This can be implemented in the central controllers or in expansion units. The operat ing system must be informed of which I/O modules are available in redundant config uration using the COM 115F parameter assignment soft ware. The redundant I/O mod ules are addressed as single channel I/O modules in the user program. The operating system does the rest.
I/O configuration
EU
EU
IM 306
Subunit A
Distributed configuration
Non-safety-related areas In "nonsafetyrelated" areas singlechannel configuration of the I/O modules is sufficient (see Fig. 3/19). The twochannel/redundant and singlechannel configura tions can be combined with one another. The I/Os in singlechannel configuration can be allocated to the two subunits as desired.
Central configuration
EU
IM 306
Subunit A
IM 324 IM 306
Subunit B
IM 304 IM 306
Distributed configuration
Fig. 3/19 Singlechannel I/O configuration (failsafe in central controller, nonfailsafe in expansion unit)
3/16
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115F (continued) Principle of operation The principle of operation of the failsafe S5115F pro grammable controller can be compared with an "AND" logic operation. It is in the op erating state only when both subunits operate properly. The two central controllers each contain a CPU 942F with firmware that is different from that of the S5115U. This firm ware executes all additional functions of the S5115F inde pendently as, for example: Data exchange and response to errors S Synchronization S Selftest
S
General
Output to sensor
Subunit A
Data exchange: In case of a fault, transition into a safe operating state
Readback input A
Readback input B
The failsafety of the I/O is ensured by the external inter connection of sensors and actuators (see Fig. 3/20 and Configuring in Section 11). Data exchange and response to errors Both subunits can exchange data rapidly and reliably via the central controller inter face, for the following purposes: S Comparison S Synchronization S Passivation (switching off of functions) Both subunits operate synchronously with the same user program. They carry out a cyclic comparison of: S Their input signals S Their output signals S Other data, such as the timers and counters Differences in the results of the two subunits indicate an error. A response to that error is then initiated. In the case of the failsafe S5115F pro grammable controller this response and other protective functions have to be deter mined in the COM 115F parameter assignment soft ware.
Actuator
The following error response options are available: S The entire unit is switched to STOP S Only the defective compo nents are deactivated S User program response Comparison of inputs After reading the input signal states, the two subunits compare their process images. If they detect any dif ferences between their pro cess images, they read the in put signals again - several times, if necessary - until the discrepancy time expires. If there are still any discrep ancies between the two pro cess images at that point, this indicates either an external or internal fault. The pro grammable controller immediately initiates the response to this error. The user can program the response and the dis crepancy time himself as agreed with the acceptance authorities.
Comparison of outputs At the end of one cycle, the two subunits compare their process images again. Different results indicate an internal fault. The selected error response is then initiated. Comparison of further data In addition, the two subunits compare S The current state of timers and counters S The current state of the logical program counter and, if necessary, S The data from the SINEC L1 link
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/17
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115F (continued) Principle of operation (continued) Synchronization Both subunits must be contin uously synchronized. That is why synchronization points are provided at the beginning and end of each program cycycle and at every 20 ms in the operating system. At these points, data are exchanged and compared with each other. During user program exe cution, the S5115F subunits are also synchronized with the following events: S Direct I/O accesses and clock scans; After such commands, the operating system automatically synchronizes both subunits
S
Process and time interrupts; Process and time interrupts are processed only after a synchronization. At the operating system level, the S5115F responds to an interrupt after a maximum of 20 ms. During user program execution the user himself must ensure synchronization by means of a standard function block.
Selftest
Extensive selftest functions are implemented in the S5115F failsafe pro grammable controller. The following components are tested: S Internal S5 bus S Central controller interface S Processors S Memory S All redundant I/Os
These selftests can even detect errors which have occured in both subunits simultaneously. Self-test during initialization During initialization in failsafe operation, the whole range of selttest functions is run through completely in each subunit.
Self-test in cyclic operation For cyclic operation, the oper ating system splits up the selftest functions into small test segments. Depending on the number of I/Os these are between 5 and 140 ms long. The number of test segments per cycle is determined by the user through the setting of the test cycle time.
Programming With the exception of certain restrictions, programming of the S5115F is identical to that of the S5115U. Program input can either be online or off line (see S5115H, page 3/14). For online programming the CPUs of both subunits must be provided with the same memory submodule. Frequently used functions, such as arithmetic and signalling functions, safety oriented interfacing or burn control are available in the package of prototypetested standard function blocks. These function blocks have already been tested by the German Technical Inspector ate (TV) and therefore facili tate the system acceptance procedure (see Section 7). Note In the failsafe mode, the control program must be stored on an EPROM or EEPROM submodule.
Online programming
programming device
S5-115F Subunit A
Memory submodule
Parameter assignment The COM 115F parameteri zation software supports the user in parameter assignment and error diagnostics: S Parameter assignment of safetyspecific data in inter active mode S Generation of the parame terization data block from the parameter assignment data
System diagnostics via error data block and interrupt register S Documentation of safety specific data via printer S General system handling, e.g. loading of block or reading of data S Failsafe communication via SINEC L1 LAN
S
3/18
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115F (continued) Communication Pointtopoint link A pointtopoint link with the S5115F programmable con troller is made possible using the CP 523 communications processor. It is primarily used for S Connection of printers, VDUs, keyboards, etc. S Data exchange with other SIMATICS5 units S Failsafe data exchange with the S5115F S Data exchange with any unit with a 20 mA (TTY) interface For further details of the CP 523 communications processor see Section 4.
General
S5-115F Subunit B
PC
S5-115F S5-115F Subunit A Use of: O+M Intelligent I/Os SIMATIC NET
Printer
Fig. 3/22 Pointtopoint link of the S5115F with a CP 523 or via a programming device interface
The moderately priced SINEC L1 local area notwork, which is designed for exten sive communications networks, enables up to 30 S5115F and S595F pro grammable controllers to communicate with each other. The PLCs are connected to the LAN via the CPU of one of the two subunits. Features S S5115U, S5135U or S5155U programmable controllers with CP 530 communications processors or other devices with SINEC L1 master capability (e.g. PCs) can be used as active nodes (masters) S The S5115F and S595F programmable controllers can be operated and interrogated from the master S SINEC L1 operation is reactionfree, i.e. faults of the individual nodes that might have occured are not transfered S Intelligent I/O modules and communications processors can be used in the master units
CP 530
Reactionfree transmission
Subunit B
Subunit B
S5-115F Subunit A
S5-95F Subunit A
The S5115F failsafe programmable controllers can use these modules via the SINEC L1 LAN
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/19
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
General
S5-115F (continued) Communication (continued) SINEC L1 local area network (continued) Possible configurations Singlechannel, nonsafety related link The nonsafetyrelated link is used for communication between programmable controllers of the U range (as master or slave) and failsafe S5115F or S595F pro grammable controllers (as slaves). Singlechannel, safety related link The safetyrelated link can be established only with a pro grammable controller of the U range as master. Safetyrelated links can only be established with S5115F or S595F programmable con trollers. The S5115F failsafe programmable controllers are connected to the LAN via one of the two subunits. Data exchange is carried out by means of special protocols which are in accordance with the safety requirements. The connection to the master is not safetyrelated but only reactionfree.
Subunit B Subunit B
S5-115F Subunit A
S5-95F Subunit A
Twochannel safety related link Data exchange is carried out in the same way as with the singlechannel, safety related link. The difference is that each subunit is connected to its own local area network. Both local area networks operate indepen dently; merely the contents of Like in the case of the SINEC L1, data transmission takes place reactionfree and the same types of link S Singlechannel, nonsafety related link S Singlechannel, safety related link and S Twochannel, safety related link can be realized. The S5115F programmable controller can be linked to de vices for operator control and process monitoring via the SI NEC L1 LAN. A direct connection of TDs/ OPs to the programming de vice interface of the S5115F is not possible.
the send and receive buffers of the two subunits are cycli cally compared with each other. Failure of one LAN (e.g. through line interruption) does not interrupt data exchange, as there remains a single channel, safetyrelated link via the other still functioning LAN.
With the CP 541 communi cations processor (see Section 2) the S5115F pro grammable controller can be connected to the PROFIBUS LAN. Thus, communication with the whole range of SIMATIC programmable controllers is possible.
For the S5115F pro grammable controller devices for operator control and pro cess monitoring can be used, if they are connected via the CP 523 communications pro cessor. It is also possible to connect the programming de vice terminal of the S5115F in series with another SIMATIC S5 programmable controller of the U range, e.g. via the second programming device terminal of a S5115U.
For further information on op erator control and process monitoring systems, see Section 10 and Catalogs ST 80.
3/20
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S5-115F (continued) Subracks for the S5-115F Subracks for central controllers: S CR 7000LB S CR 7002F The components to be used with the S5115F subracks partly differ from those of the S5115U subracks (see Section 11). Only prototype tested modules may be installed into the S5115F failsafe programmable controller. Subracks for centralized expansion: S ER 7011 S ER 7012 and ER 7013, each without power supply Subracks for distributed expansion: S ER 7012 S ER 7013 configurations and for linking the central controllers.
General
In the S5115F failsafe pro grammable controller, inter face modules are used for
Configuration for
IM 306 IM 304
A CPU 942F is required in both subunits of the S5115F failsafe programmable controller. The operating system of the S5115F supports the use of S Digital input modules 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 S Digital output modules 6ES5 4517LA12 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA111) 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4534UA12 S Digital input/output modules 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 Analog input modules 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 S Analog output modules 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12
S
The CP 523 communications processor can also be used for the S5115F. The CP 523 is used as: S Fault indication module S Safe communications module to further S5115F programmable controllers S Reactionfree communi cations module to other systems
Moreover, the communi cations processors and intelligent I/O modules in a programmable controller of the U range can exchange data with the S5115F pro grammable controller via the SINEC L1 or PROFIBUS LAN. Nevertheless, they cannot be plugged directly into the S5115F. Note When using other modules in the S5115F, the operating permission expires.
1) For new systems the use of the 6ES5 4534UA12 module is suggested. Siemens ST 50 1998
3/21
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Central processing units
CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943 and CPU 944 central processing units for the S5-115U Application The selection of the CPU to be used depends on the technical requirements of the automation task, especially with regard to processing times, memory capacities and functions. These criteria are the most important distinctive features of the CPUs. The CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943 and CPU 944 can be pro grammed in the STEP 5 pro gramming language. For pro gramming under GRAPH 5 the standard function block of the same name is required.
Design
The CPU 941 to CPU 944 cen tral processing units contain: S STEP 5 processor for pro cessing the user program S Internal program memory (RAM) S Integral hardware clock (in CPUs with 2 interfaces) S Receptacle for 375 memory submodule (RAM/EPROM/ EEPROM) S RUN/STOP switch with corresponding LEDs S Switch for setting retentive ness of bit memories, timers and counters S Switch for overall reset (resetting the entire user RAM of the CPU)
Builtin 20 mA (current loop) interface for connection of a programming device or op erator panel or for connection to the SINEC L1 LAN S CPU 943 and CPU 944 only: Optional 2nd interface for connection of a program ming device or operator panel or for connection to the SINEC L1 LAN
S
RAM submodules extend the internal RAM and are required for this purpose in the CPU 941 and CPU 942. When the RAM submodules are removed from their recep tacles in the CPU, the data is erased. The CPU 943 and CPU 944 are already equipped with the necessary amount of RAM. Programs and data can be stored on 375 memory submodules (EPROM or EEPROM) to protect them from power failures. The memory submodules are pro grammed on the program ming device using the recep tacle provided for this purpose and are then plugged into the CPU.
Not all programming device functions can be used at the 2nd interface. Transmission without protocol is possible with the ASCII driver. On the CPU 944, the 2nd interface can also be used for links em ploying the 3964 or 3964R communications protocol (special operating system, to be ordered separately). Interruptcontrolled (OB 2 to OB 5): Activation of four independent execution levels by process interrupts S Time interruptcontrolled (OB 6): This level is acti vated after expiry of a programmed time (times from 3 ms to 1 min)
S
Functions
The functions of the CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943 and CPU 944 are as follows: Program execution Cyclic (OB 1): Readin of input statuses, execution of the control program and out put of the output statuses S Timecontrolled (OB 10 to OB 13): Four independent levels for which the time of processing can be individ ually defined (times from 10 ms to 1 min).
S
Monitoring The CPUs monitor scan time, battery failure, or acknowl edgement delay, for example. Software protection for RAM operation The software protection feature prevents inadvertent overwriting or readout of programs by unauthorized persons. Scan time measurement The current, maximum and minimum scan times are measured.
Execution levels of higher priority can interrupt those of lower priority after any STEP5 operation (order of priority starting with the highest: time interruptcontrolled, interrupt controlled, timecontrolled, cyclic.
3/22
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943 and CPU 944 central processing units for the S5-115U (continued) Functions (continued) Clock The clock can be set and read. It can also be used for counting operating hours or for interrupt functions. Integral function blocks The operating system incor porates a number of function blocks programmed in machine language, which can execute at extremely high speed and do not occupy any space in the internal RAM. These integral function blocks are called in the same way as any other blocks in the user program and can only be interrupted by process interrupts. S Conversion blocks (BCD code converters) S Arithmetic blocks (multiplication, division) S Analog value processing Data handling blocks (these enable communications processors and intelligent I/O modules to be used and control the exchange of data with the CPU) S COMPR function block for compressing the contents of the internal RAM S DELETE function block (for deleting blocks)
S
Integral organization blocks Scan time triggering Variable time loop (range 160 s to 65 ms) S PID control algorithm S Scan cycleindependent readin of digital inputs and ouput of the process I/O image
S S
COM DB1 parameterization software The COMDB1 parameteriza tion software enables the user to assign parameters to the CPU quickly and easily and without errors. The software correctly applies all the rules for creating DB1. Any errors in DB1 or input errors are pointed out to the user. Further data blocks rendered necessary by the parameters of DB1 can also be created with COM DB1. COM DB1 cannot be used for assigning parameters to the second interface of CPU 943 and CPU 944. For technical specifications, see page 3/25.
Restart modes S Manual cold restart using mode selector or program ming device S Cold restart following power failure
Ordering data
CPU 941 CPU 942 CPU 943 With 1 serial interface With 2 serial interfaces CPU 944 With 1 serial interface With 2 serial interfaces To be ordered as a separate item: S5-115U manual (CPU 941 to CPU 944) with operating instructions for power supply modules, CPUs, digital and analog input/output modules, EU interface modules and programming instructions German English French Spanish Italian S5-115U quick reference guide for CPU 941 to CPU 944 German English French Spanish Italian 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) Not suitable for CPU 941 Not suitable for CPU 942 Not suitable for CPU 943 Not suitable for CPU 944 Not suitable for CPU 942F
Order No. 6ES5 941-7UB11 6ES5 942-7UB11 6ES5 943-7UB11 6ES5 943-7UB21 6ES5 944-7UB11 6ES5 944-7UB21 3964, 3964R communications protocol as an extension to the operating system for the CPU 944 375 memory submodules EPROM 8 8 Kbyte EPROM 16 Kbyte 1) b y t e EPROM 32 K EPROM 64 Kbyte y 1), 2), 5) 1) 2) 2), 3) 3), 5) EPROM 128 Kbyte1), EEPROM 8 Kbyte EEPROM 16 Kbyte RAM 8 Kbyte3), 4) RAM 16 Kbyte3), 4) RAM 32 Kbyte1), 3), 4) Standard function blocks GRAPH 5/II, S5115U closed loop control Programming software GRAPH 5/II g COM DB1 p parameter assignment software COM REG S5-115U parameter assignment software
6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-1LA61 6ES5 375-1LA71 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41 6ES5 375-0LD11 6ES5 375-0LD21 6ES5 375-0LD31 see Section 7
6ES5 998-0UF13 6ES5 998-0UF23 6ES5 998-0UF33 6ES5 998-0UF43 6ES5 998-0UF53
6ES5 997-7LA11 6ES5 997-7LA21 6ES5 997-7LA31 6ES5 997-7LA41 6ES5 997-7LA51
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/23
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Central processing units
CPU 945 central processing unit for the S5-115U Application The CPU 945 is a new addition at the high end of the spectrum (CPU 941 to CPU 944). It is particularly suitable for fast, highly complex and calculation intensive automation applica tions. Tasks are shared between several internal processors, enabling control tasks and communications tasks to be executed at the same time. Interrupt response times are extremely short. In addition to STEP 5, the highlevel lan guage SCL can also be used for programming the CPU 945 (see Section 7). Even lengthy, complicated programs can therefore be written and edited clearly and easily.
Design
In addition to the points listed under CPU 941 to CPU 944, the module contains: S STEP 5 processor with floatingpoint coprocessor S Bus controller for auto nomous handling of commu nications via the S5 internal backplane bus
Microcontroller for interface communications S Integral hardware clock S Receptacle for memory card S Slot for one of the following interface modules: programming device inter face module, V.24 module, 20 mA (current loop) mod ule, RS 422A/RS 485 mod ule, SINEC L1 module
S
Memory cards based on flash EPROMS (electrically erasable) are used in place of memory submodules. Instead of a fixed second in terface, a slot is provided for a replaceable interface module with a selection of different types.
Functions
The CPU 945 has the same basic function scope as the CPU 941 to CPU 944 with the following exceptions: Program execution The call interval for time controlled program execution can be set between 1 ms and 1 min. Monitoring A monitoring facility for collision of two timed interrupts is also installed.
Process I/O image transfer DELTA transfer (parameter selectable): When transferring the process output image, only the data which has changed since the last cycle is transferred S Parallel process I/O image transfer (parameter selectable): the process I/O image is updated parallel to cyclic program execution
S
programming device, either via the PROFIBUS, the Indus trial Ethernet or using Teleser vice. Integral function blocks There is an PID control algo rithm integrated in the operat ing system. Additional stan dard function blocks are available (see Section 7). The CPU 945 can also process function and data extension blocks (FX and DX). For technical specifications, see page 3/25.
Order No.
Changing the operating system The operating system of the CPU can be reloaded with the
Ordering data
CPU 945 With 256 Kbyte RAM With 384 Kbyte RAM
Order No. Interface modules 20 mA module V.24 module RS 422A/RS 485 module programming device module SINEC L1 module Programming adapter for memory cards (for pro grammers without integral adapter only) Parameter assignment software
6ES5 752-0LA12 6ES5 752-0LA22 6ES5 752-0LA42 6ES5 752-0LA52 6ES5 752-0LA62 6ES5 985-2MC11
S5-115U quick reference guide for CPU 945 German English French
see Section 7
Memory card for CPU 945 128 Kbyte flash EPROM 256 Kbyte flash EPROM 512 Kbyte flash EPROM
To be ordered as a separate item: Manual for the S5-115U with CPU 945 German English French Italian
3/24
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943, CPU 944 and CPU 945 central processing units for the S5-115U Technical specifications
CPU Memory capacity S Total S Internal RAM S Submodule/memory card RAM/EPROM/EEPROM Flash EPROM Memory extension with CP 516/CP 581 Programming language Types of blocks max. CPU 945 256/384 Kbyte 256/384 Kbyte 256/5121) Kbyte 8/120 Mbyte STEP, SCL CPU 944 96 Kbyte 96 Kbyte /1281)/16Kbyte 8/120 Mbyte STEP 5 CPU 943 48 Kbyte 48 Kbyte /641)/16 Kbyte 8/120 Mbyte STEP 5 CPU 942 42 Kbyte 10 Kbyte 32/32/16 Kbyte 8/120 Mbyte STEP 5 CPU 941 18 Kbyte 2 Kbyte 16/16/16 Kbyte 8/120 Mbyte STEP 5
max. max.
Organization blocks (OB), programming blocks (PB), function blocks (FB), sequence blocks (SB), data blocks (DB) FX, DX max. max. 256 per block type 50 32 32 32
Number of blocks Block nesting depth Program execution S Cyclic S Timecontrolled Call interval S Interruptcontrolled S Time interruptcontrolled Monitoring functions
32
Interruption possible after any STEP 5 operation Yes 4 execution levels OB 10 to OB 13 1 ms to 1 min 10 ms to 10 min 4 execution levels OB 2 to OB 5 1 execution level OB 6 Coll. 2 timed interr. Timeout, I/O error, acknowledgement delay, substitution error in FB/FX, transfer error in DB/DX, battery failure 0.1 s 0.2 s 0.1 s 0.1 s 0.5 s 0.1/1.0 s 0.1 s 0.35 s 0.4 s 0.75 s 1.35 s 50 s 0.8 s 1.5 s 1.8 s 0.8 s 3.6 s 0.8/3.6 s 0.8 s
2) 2)
Execution time for S Bit operations S Load and transfer (data) S Timer/counter operations S Data word comparison S Substitution operations S Block call operations Fixed point arithmetic S Addition, subtraction S Multiplication S Division Floatingpoint arithmetic S Addition, subtraction, multiplication S Division Interrupt response time Principle supplementary functions S Software protection, scan time measurement S Scan time monitoring S Realtime clock S PID control algorithm Flags/S flags Nesting levels Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Digital inputs/outputs S No. with process I/O image Analog inputs/outputs typ.
2) 2)
2) 2)
2) 2)
2) 2)
2 ms
2 ms
2 ms
2 ms
Optional3) Integral
Integral 2048/
Integral 2048/
2048/32768 2048/ 2048/ All, half or none of which retentive, as required 6 (for binary logic operations) 256 128 128 0.01 to 9990 s, all, 64 or none of which retentive, as required 256 128 128 0 to 999 (up/down), all, 64 or none of which retentive, as required 4096/4096 1024 each 256/256 4096/4096 1024 each 256/256 4096/4096 1024 each 256/256
128
128
1) Physical capacity, not all available for use 3) Version with second interface
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/25
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Central processing units
Technical specifications (continued)
CPU Interfaces 1st interface (builtin) 2nd interface, optional (CPU 945: replaceable interface module, CPU 943/CPU 944: with two interfaces) Current consumption (5 V; with memory submodule) S With 1 interface (serial) max. S With 2 interfaces (serial) max. Weight S Module S Memory submodule approx. approx. CPU 945 PG/OP/SINEC L1 PG/OP/3964/3964R, SINEC L1, ASCII driver CPU 944 PG/OP/SINEC L1 PG/OP/3964/3964R, SINEC L1, ASCII driver CPU 943 PG/OP/SINEC L1 PG/OP, SINEC L1 ASCII driver CPU 942 PG/OP/SINEC L1 CPU 941 PG/OP/SINEC L1
CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943, CPU 944 and CPU 945 central processing units for the S5-115U (continued)
0.55 A 0.64 to 1.25 A4) 0.8 kg (1.7 lb) 0.1 kg (0.2 lb)
0.16 A
0.16 A
3/26
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CPU 942H central processing unit for the S5-115H Application The CPU942H is required for the setup of a S5115H fault tolerant programmable con troller.
Principle of operation
The CPU942H central pro cessing unit contains a firm ware which is able to carry out all additional functions of the S5115H faulttolerant
programmable controller auto nomously. Part of that are the following functions: S Data interchange S Synchronization of both subunits
Technical specifications
Memory capacity S Internal RAM S Submodule RAM max. EPROM max. EEPROM max. 5 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 16 Kbyte (1 statement normally requires 2 byte in the program memory) 1.6 ms 15 ms (for 65 % binary and 35 % word operations) Counters S Number S Range Digital inputs Digital outputs Analog inputs Analog outputs Programming Organization blocks Program blocks Function blocks Sequence blocks Data blocks Nesting depth Program execution Nesting levels PID control algorithm S Processing time Closedloop control S Scan time S Individual controllers max. approx. 128 0 ... 999 (up, down) 1024 1024 64 64 Structured 256 256 256 (configurable) 256 254 32 Cyclic, interruptdriven, timecontrolled 6 (for binary logic operations) 1.7 ms 0.1 to 12.8 s 8 (for further details please see Section 7) 0.7 A 3.5 W 1.5 kg (3.3 lb) 0.1 kg (0.2 lb) Order No. 375 memory submodule (EPROM, max. 32 Kbyte) COM 115H parameterization software Manual German English French Spanish Italian
max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
Execution time for 1000 binary statements Execution time for 1000 statements
approx. approx.
Execution time for load and transfer operations to peripheral word Execution time for block call Basic cycle time (without user program) Interrupt detection time Interrupt response time Scan time monitoring Bit memories Timers S Number S Range typ. approx. max.
max.
Current consumption (at 5 V) (with memory submodule) max. Power loss Weight S Module S Memory submodule max. approx. approx.
Ordering data
CPU 942H for the S5-115H programmable controller, with receptacle for 375 memory submodule, connection for programmer or SINECL1 LAN and standard function blocks using communications processors
6ES5 998-0UH11 6ES5 998-0UH21 6ES5 998-0UH31 6ES5 998-0UH41 6ES5 998-0UH51
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/27
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Central processing units
CPU 942F central processing unit for the S5-115F Application The CPU 942F is designed for the setup of a S5115F failsafe programmable controller.
Principle of operation
The CPU 942F contains a firmware which is able to carry out all additional functions of the S5115F fail safe programmable controller autonomously.
S S
Part of that are functions like: Data interchange Synchronization of both subunits
S S
Technical specifications
Memory capacity S Internal RAM S Submodule RAM EPROM EEPROM 5 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 16 Kbyte (1 statement normally requires 2 byte in the program memory) 1.6 ms 15 ms (for 64% binary and 35 % word operations) Counters S Number S Range Digital inputs Digital outputs Analog inputs Analog outpus Programming Orangization blocks Program blocks Function blocks Sequence blocks Data blocks Nesting depth Program execution Nesting levels PID control algorithm S Processing time S5115U closed loop control S Scan time S Individual controller max. approx. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. 128 0 ... 999 (up, down) 1024 1008 64 64 Structured 6 256 256 (configurable) 256 254 16 Cyclic, interruptdriven, timecontrolled 6 (for binary logic operations) 1.7 ms 0.1 to 12.8 s 8 (for further details please see Section 7) 0.7 A 3.5 W 1.5 kg (3.3 lb) 0.1 kg (0.2 lb)
Execution time for 1000 binary statements Execution time for 1000 statements Execution time for load and transfer operations to peripheral word Execution time for block call Basic cycle time (without user program)
approx. approx.
60 to 140 ms (depending on the number of redundant I/O modules) approx. max. 2 ms 30 ms Configurable 2032 128 0.01 to 9990 s
Interrupt detection time Interrupt response time Scan time monitoring Bit memories Timers S Number S Range
max.
Current consumption (at 5 V) (with memory submodule) Power loss Weight S Module S Memory submodule
Ordering data
CPU 942F with receptacle for 375 memory submodule and connection for programming device or SINEC L1 LAN 375 memory submodule (EPROM, max. 32 Kbyte)
Order No. 6ES5 942-7UF15 COM 115F parameterization software S5-115F manual German English French Italian
3/28
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
24/48 V UC
3/30
24 V DC; 2 A
3/35
48/60 V UC 115 V UC
4327 4357LA 4357LB 435 7LC 4357LC 4367LA 4367LB 436 7LC 4367LC
3/30 3/30
24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 48/115 V AC, 1 A 115/230 V AC; 1 A 115/230 V AC; 1.5 A
230 V UC
3/30 /
Relay outputs 30 V UC; 0.5 A 250 V AC; 5 A 250 V AC; 5 A 24 V DC; 5 A Input/output modules Voltage values 24 V DC (inputs) 24 V DC; 0.5 A (outputs) 24 V DC (inputs) 24 V DC; 2.5 A (outputs) 24 V DC (inputs) 24 V DC; 1.5 A (outputs) Module ID 4827LA/7LF11 /7LF21 4827LF31 4857 Page 3/41 3/41 3/41
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/29
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital input modules Application
Design
Digital input modules are available with 8, 16 or 32 in puts and for a range of input voltages. The modules require 1/2 or 1 slot (depending on the subrack).
The modules comprise: Green LEDs for indicating signal status S Enable input F (4344 digital input module for NAMUR sensors only) for disabling input signals
S
Relay contact (MELD) and 24 V input (RESET) for interrupt processing The signal leads must be connected with front connectors. They can be labelled in the fields next to the LEDs.
S
Principle of operation
Enable input Digital input 4344 only: The input signals can be disabled by means of enable input F. This enable input can be deactivated by removing a jumper on the module. Interrupt processing Digital input 4347 only: A group signal generates an interrupt in the CPU when a particular input signal changes. The group signal drives a latching relay on the module (the relay contact MELD is accessible from the front panel), which can be reset via a 24 V input (RESET).
In the user program the user can specify for each input whether the interrupt is to be set by the positive or negativegoing edge. If interrupt processing is not essential, the 4347 module can be used in any type of subrack. Interrupt evaluation by the 4347 digital input module is only possible in a central controller. The module takes up two bytes for input addresses and two bytes for output addresses.
Interrupt evaluation is only possible in an expansion unit (ER 7013 subrack) which is connected using the IM 307 and IM 317 interface modules and if the 4324 digital input module (S5135/155U) is used in the expansion unit instead of the 4347 digital input module generating the interrupt. Note All digital input modules of the S5135U/155U pro grammable controllers (see Section 4) can be used in the S5115U with adapter casings. The 4344 digital input module requires an adapter casing (see page 3/98).
Technical specifications
Digital input module Number of inputs 6ES5 4207LA11 32 6ES5 4307LA12 32 6ES5 4317LA11 16 6ES5 4327LA11 16 6ES5 4347LA12 8 (with group signal) Yes (optocoupler) 1 24 V DC -30... +5 V +13...+30 V 8.5 mA 0.5... 1.5 ms 0.5... 1.5 ms 100 % 6ES5 4344UA12 see page 4/36 (S5135U, S5155U/H)
Galvanic isolation S In groups of Input voltage S Rated value S Frequency with AC S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current for "1 signal Delay S At "0 "1 S At "1 "0 Load factor1) at 55 C
Yes (optocoupler) 4 24/48 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0... 5 V 13... 60 V 8.5/10.5 mA 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 100 %
Yes (optocoupler) 4 48/60 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0... 10 V 30...72 V 9/10 mA 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 100 %
typ.
3/30
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
S Permissible load max. S Switching capacity max. Reset input Insulation voltage rating (external connections to housing, internal connections, other groups) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Current consumption S Internal (from power supply module; 5 V) max. Power loss (rated operation) typ. Front connector Weight approx.
30 V DC 500 V AC
60 V AC 500 V AC
60 V AC 500 V AC
30 V DC 500 V AC
Digital input module Number of inputs Galvanic isolation S in groups of Input voltage S Rated value S Frequency with AC S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal typ. Delay S At "0 "1 S At "1 "0 Load factor 1) S At 55 C S At 20 C Cable length S Unshielded max. S Shielded max. Insulation voltage rating (external connections to housing, internal connections, other groups) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Current consumption S Internal (from power supply module; 5 V) max. Power loss (rated operation) typ. Front connector Weight approx.
6ES5 4357LA11 16 Yes (optocoupler) 4 115 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0... 40 V 85...135 V 6 mA DC 15 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 75 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
6ES5 4357LB11 16 Yes (optocoupler) 2 115 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0... 40 V 85...135 V 6 mA DC 10 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 75 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
6ES5 4357LC11 8 Yes (optocoupler) 1 115 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0... 40 V 85...135 V 6 mA DC 10 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 75 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
6ES5 4367LA11 16 Yes (optocoupler) 4 230 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0...70 V 170...264 V 2.2 mA DC 15 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 35 ms 75 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
6ES5 4367LB11 16 Yes (optocoupler) 2 230 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0...70 V 170...264 V 2.2 mA DC 15 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 35 ms 75 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
6ES5 4367LC11 8 Yes (optocoupler) 1 230 V UC 47... 63 Hz 0...100 V 170...264 V 2.2 mA DC 16 mA AC 2... 13 ms 10... 25 ms 100 % 100 % 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 2700 V AC
250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 2700 V AC
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/31
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital input modules (continued) Ordering data
Nonfloating: 420-7 digital input module for S5115U/H 32 inputs, 24 V DC Floating: 430-7 digital input module for S5115U/H/F 32 inputs, 24 V DC, in groups of 8 431-7 digital input module for S5115U/H 16 inputs, 24/48 V UC, in groups of 4 432-7 digital input module for S5115U/H 16 inputs, 48/60 V UC, in groups of 4 434-4 digital input module for NAMUR1) sensor for S5115U/H 32 inputs, 5/15 V DC (TTL, CMOS, NAMUR) 434-7 digital input module for S5115U/H/F with interrupt group signal 8 inputs, 24 V DC, in groups of 1 435-7 digital input module for S5115U/H 16 inputs, 115 V UC, in groups of 4 in groups of 2 for S5115 U/H/F 8 inputs, 115 V UC, in groups of 1
6ES5 420-7LA11
6ES5 430-7LA12
6ES5 431-7LA11
6ES5 434-4UA12
6ES5 434-7LA12
6ES5 435-7LC11
1) NAMUR = Working group on standards in the measurement technique and control engineering
3/32
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
L1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25
L1
N(M) L1
N(M) L1
N(M)
N(M)
L1
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
L1
N(M) L1
N(M)
L1
6ES5 420-7LA11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 430-7LA12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 431-7LA11
01
N(M) L1
6ES5 432-7LA11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
N(M)
+ M + M MELD MELD + M + M
L1
02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 200 201 202 203 205
L1
N L1
N L1
N L1
N L1
L1 N L1 N
N L1
N L1
N L1
206 207 208 209 300 301 302 303 304 305 306 307 308 309 400 401 402 403 404 405 406 407
+ M + M RESET RESET M + M + M
L1 N L1 N
N L1
N L1
N L1
L1 N L1
N L1
6ES5 434-7LA12
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/33
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital input modules (continued) Connection diagrams (continued)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
F+ F1L+ 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 1LH+ 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 L1LH2LH2L+ 2.0 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2LH+ 3.0 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 24V + + 24V -
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
F+ F1L+ 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 1LH+ 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 L1LH2LH2L+ 2.0 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2LH+ 3.0 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7
+ + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + + -
+ 5...15V
5..15V +
3/34
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Design
Digital output modules are available with 8, 16 or 32 out puts and for a range of supply voltages (load) and rated load currents. The modules require one slot. Depending on the version, the modules comprise: S Green LEDs for indicating signal status S Shortcircuit detection
Group signalling output for shortcircuits (latching relay) with reset input S Red LEDs for indicating a shortcircuit
S
The module address (byte parameter when pro gramming) is slotdependent and need therefore not be set on the module.
The signal leads must be connected with front connectors. They can be labelled in the field next to the LEDs.
Principle of operation
The module converts the internal output signals of the programmable controller to the load voltage levels (DC or AC) used to control the process. The output voltage ranges are fixed. A selection of 2 or 3 ranges is available on some modules. Short-circuit protection The digital output modules are shortcircuitprotected (except for the relay outputs and the DA 4577 digital output module).
Protection is provided either electronically or by means of fuses. In the DA 4517 and 4537 modules, the short circuit signal is stored via a latching relay contact and indicated by a red LED for each group. In both modules a signal can be reset with a separate 24 V input (RES) or internally by a BASP signal. On the modules protected with fuses, red LEDs also indicate when a fuse has blown.
Parallel connection of outputs Parallel connection of the outputs is only possible with the relay output modules. Note All the digital output modules of the S5135U/155U pro grammable controllers (see Section 4) can be used in the S5115U with adapter casings.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/35
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital output modules (continued) Technical specifications
Digital output module Number of outputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Supply voltage Vpos (for load) S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (with ripple) Value at t<0.5 s Output current at "1 signal S Rated value S Permissible range Lamp load Shortcircuit protection Shortcircuit display max.
6ES5 441-7LA12 32 No
max.
24 V DC 3.6 V 20...30 V 35 V 0.5 A 5 mA...0.5 A 5W Electronic 1 LED/group with one common group signal Latching relay cont. 100 V DC ; 0.2 mA 20 W; 35 VA 24 V DC -15 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
24/48/60 V DC 3.6 V 20...75 V 87 V 0.5 A 5 mA...0.5 A 5W Electronic 1 LED/group with one common group signal Latching relay cont. 100 V DC ; 0.2 mA 20 W; 35 VA 24 V DC -30 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 100% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
max.
Shortcircuit group signal output S Permissible load S Switching capacity Reset input Inductive surge voltage on circuit interruption (internal) limited to Switching frequency S Resistive loads S Lamp loads S Inductive loads Load factor 1) S At 25 _C S At 55 _C Residual current at "0 signal max. Signal level of the outputs S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Cable length S Unshielded S Shielded max. min. max. max. max. max. max.
-15 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2 5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
-15 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
Insulation voltage rating (external connections to housing, internal connections, other groups) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V, no load) typ. typ.
10 mA 17 mA/group 20 W 46pin
3/36
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
max.
48/115 V AC 47...63 Hz 40...140V 2 A/group 40 mA...2 A 50/100 W/group Fuse (8 2.55 A FF) 1 LED/group
max.
-15 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.27 Hz 50% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -3 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
-23 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.27 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -3 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
10 Hz 10 Hz 10 Hz 100% 100% 1/3 mA +3 V Vpos -7 V 300 m (984 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
10 Hz 10 Hz 10 Hz 100% 100% 3/5 mA +3 V Vpos -7 V 300 m (984 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
10 Hz 10 Hz 10 Hz 100% 100% 3/5 mA +3 V Vpos -7 V 300 m (984 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
-10 V 10 Hz 8 Hz 2 Hz 100% 100% 100 A Open collector output 300 m (984 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/37
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital output modules (continued) Technical specifications
Digital output module Number of outputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Continuous current Ith Switching capacity of the contacts S Resistive loads max.
6ES5 458-7LB11 8 Yes (relay contacts)3) 1 5A 5 A at 250 V AC 2.5 A at 30 V DC 1.5 A at 250 V AC 0.5 A at 30 V DC 1.5 106 (to AC11) 0.5 106 (to DC11) None 10 Hz 10 Hz
6ES5 458-7LC11 16 Yes (relay outputs) 4 5A 5 A at 250 V AC 5 A at 30 V DC 0.4 A at 110 V DC 1.5 A at 250 V AC 1 A at 30 V DC 0.08 A at 110 V DC 1.5 106 (to AC11) 0.5 106 (to DC11) None 10 Hz 2 Hz
S Inductive loads
max.
Not permitted
Service life: Switching cycles (VDE 0660, Part 200) Shortcircuit protection Switching frequency S Resistive loads S Inductive loads max. max.
Insulation voltage rating (external connections to housing, internal connections, other groups) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Supply voltage Vpos S Rated value max. S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (with ripple) Value at t<0.5 s Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) Front connector Weight approx. typ. typ.
250 V AC 1500 V AC 24 V DC 3.6 V 20...30 V 35 V 50 mA 256 mA 6.5 W 46pin 0.8 kg (1.8 lb)
Ordering data
Nonfloating: 441-7 digital output module for S5115U/H; 32 outputs, 24V DC; 0.5 A Floating: 451-7 digital output module for S5115U/H/F; 32 outputs, 24V DC; 0.5 A 451-7 digital output module for S5115U/H; 32 outputs, 24V DC; 0.5 A with shortcircuit indication 453-7 digital output module for S5115U/H; 16 outp., 24/60 V DC; 0.5 A 453-4 digital output module for S5115U/H/F2);16 outputs, 24V DC; 2 A 454-7 digital output module for S5115U/H/F 16 outputs, 24 V DC; 2 A 8 outputs, 24 V DC; 2 A 455-7 digital output module for S5115U/H; 16 outp., 48/115 V DC; 1 A 456-7 digital output module
Order No. 457-7 digital output module for S5115U/H; 32 outputs, 5/24 V DC; 100 mA 458 7 digital output module 458-7 for S5115U/H/F 16 relay contact outputs 1) 30 V UC; 0.5 A 8 relay contact outputs, 250 V AC; 5A for S5115U/H 16 relay contact outputs 250 V AC; 5 A, 30 V DC; 5 A The operating instructions are included in the S5 115U manual S5115U (see page 3/23) 490 front connector For screw terminals S 24pin S 46pin For crimp terminals, 46pin S With 50 crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts For snapon clip terminals, 46pin
6ES5 441-7LA12
6ES5 458-7LC11
6ES5 490-7LB11 6ES5 490-7LB21 6ES5 490-7LA11 6ES5 490-7LA21 6ES5 490-7LC11
for S5115U/H
1) For new systems the use of the 6ES5 4534UA12 module is suggested 3) Each contact is jumpered with a varistor (residual current max. 1 mA at 250 V AC)
2) Adapter casing required 4) Reed relay for measuring circuits Siemens ST 50 1998
3/38
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
M MELD. MELD.
MELD. MELD.
M L1
M RESET RESET
RES.RES.+
6ES5 441-7LA12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 451-7LA12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 451-7LA21
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 453-7LA11
N
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
L1
L1 N
N L1
L1 N
L1 N
N L1
L1 N
L1 N
N L1
L1 N
L1 N
6ES5 454-7LA12
6ES5 454-7LB11
6ES5 455-7LA11
L1
6ES5 456-7LA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/39
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Digital output modules (continued) Connection diagrams (continued)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25
L1 N
L1
L1 N
L1
M
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
L1 N
L1
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
L1 N
L1
6ES5 456-7LB11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 457-7LA11
L1
L+ LF+ F-
6ES5 458-7LA11
6ES5 458-7LB11
1 2 3
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
N L+ L1
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
5 6
N LL1
8L+ 8L-
H+ H2L+ 9L+ 9L10L+ 10L11L+ +9Q1.0 -9Q1.0 +10Q1.1 -10Q1.1 +11Q1.2 -11Q1.2 +12Q1.3 -12Q1.3
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 0
N L+ L1
11L12L+ 12L-
34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
N L-
16L-
6ES5 458-7LC11
6ES5 453-4UA12
3/40
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Design
Digital input/output modules are available with 8 inputs and 8 outputs, 16 inputs and 16 outputs or 24 inputs and 16 outputs. The modules require 1/2 or 1 slot (depending on the subrack).
The signal leads must be connected with front connectors. They can be labelled in the field next to the LEDs.
The inputs and outputs can be addressed with the same addresses (e.g. E 4.0 to E 5.7 and A 4.0 to A 5.7). The input/ output connection (sink input/ source input or sink output/ source output) is fixed for the 4827 and 4857 modules, but parameterselectable for the 4827LF31 module. Note All the digital input/output modules of the S5135U/ 155U programmable con trollers (see Section 4) can be used in the S5115U with adapter casings.
Principle of operation
Interrupt processing 4857 digital input/output module only: The 4857 digital input/output module can be operated with or without interrupt pro cessing. Four of the total of 24 inputs can be used to gene
rate a group signal which triggers an interrupt when one of the input signals changes on the positivegoing edge. Interrupt evaluation is only possible in the central controller.
Technical specifications
Digital input/output module Number of inputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Interrupt inputs Suitable for safety signals Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Delay S At "0" ! "1" S At "1" ! "0" S For interrupt inputs Cable length S Unshielded S Shielded 1) Values for source input max. max. typ. 6ES5 482-7LA11 16, sink input Yes (optocoupler) 8 No 24 V DC -30...+5 V +13...+30 V 8.5 mA 2.2...4.6 ms 4.5...12 ms 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft) 6ES5 482-7LF11 16, source readback Yes (optocoupler) 8 Yes 24 V DC -10...+30 V1) -30...+5 V1) 0.8 mA 1.4...5 ms 1.4...5 ms 60 m (196.8 ft) 100 m (328 ft) 6ES5 482-7LF21 16, sink readback Yes (optocoupler) Yes 24 V DC -30...+5 V +13...+30 V 0.8 mA 1.4...5 ms 1.4...5 ms 60 m (196.8 ft) 100 m (328 ft) 6ES5 482-7LF31 8, source/sink readb. Yes (optocoupler) 8 Yes 24 V DC -30...+15 V (10...+30 V)1) +20...+30 V (-30...+5 V)1) 0.8 mA 1.4...5 ms 1.4...5 ms 60 m (196.8 ft) 100 m (328 ft) 6ES5 485-7LA11 24 No 4 No 24 V DC -30...+5 V +13...+30 V 7.2 mA 3 ms 3 ms 1.5 ms 60 m (196.8 ft) 100 m (328 ft)
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/41
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
max.
24 V DC 3.6 V 20...30 V 35 V 0.5 A 5 mA...0.5 A 5W 8.5 W Electronic Vpos -47 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
24 V DC 3.6 V 20...30 V 35 V 0.5 A 5 mA...0.5 A 5W 8.5 W Electronic Vpos -47 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA Vpos +2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
24 V DC 3.6 V 20...30 V 35 V 2.5 A 5 mA...2.5 A 40 W 60 W Electronic Vpos -47 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 100% 0.5 mA +3 V; Vpos2) Vpos -1 V; (+1 V) 2) 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
24 V DC 20...30 V 35 V 1.5 A 5 mA...1.5 A 5W Electronic (from 3.6 A) -15 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 50% 50% 1 mA
max.
max. max.
5W 8.5 W Electronic
Vpos -47 V 100 Hz 8 Hz 0.5 Hz 100% 50% 1 mA +3 V Vpos -2.5 V 600 m (1968 ft) 1000 m (3280 ft)
2) Values for sink output Order No. 485-7 digital input/output module for S5115U 24 inputs, 24 V DC and 16 outputs, 24 V DC 6ES5 485-7LA11
Ordering data
482-7 digital input/output module3) for S5115U/H/F 16 inputs, 24 V DC and 16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A, source input, source output sink input, source output source input, sink output 8 inputs, 24 V DC and 8 outputs, 24 V DC; 2.5 A either source input/ sink input or source output/ sink output
Order No.
490 front connector For screw terminals, 46pin For crimp terminals, 46pin S With 50 crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts For snapon clip terminals, 46pin
6ES5 482-7LF31
3) Operating instructions are included in the S5115U manual (see page 3/23).
3/42
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
+ 3)
P1)
+ 3)
2)
+ + + +
+ + + +
+ + + +
+ + + +
6ES5 482-7LA11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 482-7LF11
6ES5 482-7LF21
6ES5 482-7LF31
L1+ M L2+
6ES5 485-7LA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/43
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Analog input modules Application
Design
Modules with 4, 8 or 16 inputs are available. The modules each require one slot. The signal leads must be connected with front connectors. They can be labelled in the field on the front panel.
Measuring range modules required for signal con ditioning are plugged into the module. Each module sets the measuring range for a group of 4 channels (inputs). The 4607 and 4634 modules are reactionfree, the 4634 module is also suitable for failsafe operation. All modules indicate over range errors. The 4607 and 4657 can also detect wire breakage in the sensor line for the Pt 100 (userconfigurable). All modules have a high degree of noise suppression.
Functions such as wire break signalling, line frequency or measuring range are set us ing switches at the rear of the module.
Principle of operation
The analog input modules have different methods of op eration. The 4607, 4657 and 4634 modules work on an in tegrating measuring principle, whereas the 4663 analog input module uses instantaneous value encod ing. Analogdigital conversion is performed in the 4607 and 4657 modules by voltagetime conversion and in the 4634 by voltage frequency conversion. The 4663 module employs successive approximation and has the shortest encoding time.
Note All the analog input modules of the S5135U/155U pro grammable controllers (see Section 4) can be used in the S5115U with adapter casings. An adapter casing is required for the 4634 and 4663 analog input modules (page 3/98). The 4634 module must not be operated in the third cen trally connected ER 7013 subrack for S5115F.
Technical specifications
Analog input module Number of inputs 6ES5 460-7LA13 8 voltage/current inputs or 8 inputs for Pt 100 resistance thermometer Yes 6ES5 465-7LA13 16 voltage/current inputs or 8 inputs for Pt 100 resistance thermometer No 6ES5 463-4U.12 4 voltage/current inputs
Yes 0 ... 1 V, 0 ... 10 V, 0 ... 20 mA + 4 ... 20 mA for twowire and fourwire measuring transducers 1 V: y10 M; 10 V: 90 k; 20 mA: 50 4...20 mA: 62.5 Twowire connection 11 bit two's complement (1024 units = rated value)
50 mV; 500 mV; Pt 100; 1 V; 5 V; 10 V; 20 mA; + 4 ... 20 mA Input ranges can be selected for 4 channels at a time using measuring range modules 50 mV: y10 M 500 mV: y10 M Pt 100: y10 M 1 V: 90 k; 2 5 V: 50 k; 2 10 V: 50 k; 2 20 mA: 25 ; 1 4...20 mA: 31.2 ; 1
Input resistance in the individual ranges Types of connection of sensors Digital representation of the input signal
Twowire connection; fourwire connection for Pt 100 12 bit + sign or 13 bit two's complement (2048 units = rated value)
3/44
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Permissible voltage between the reference potential of a nonfloating sensor and the central earthing point max. Error indication for S Overranging S Wire breakage of the sensor line Noise suppression for f = n S (50/60 Hz 1%); n = 1,2... S Common mode noise min. (Vp < 1 V) S Series mode noise min. (peak noise value < rated value of the range) Basic error limits1)
75 V DC/60 V AC
1 V
At 200% of the nominal value (4095 units) It can be designed for the ranges 50 mV, 500 mV and Pt 100
120 dB 40 dB 50 mV: 2 500 mV: 1.5 Pt 100: 2 50 mV: 5 500 mV: 4.5 Pt 100: 5
86 dB 40 dB 1 V: 3.5 20 mA: 2.5 5 V: 3.5 4...20 mA: 2.5 10 V: 3.5 1 V: 7.7 20 mA: 6.7 5 V: 7.7 4...20 mA: 6.7 10 V: 7.7 200 m (650 ft); max. 50 m (164 ft) at 50 mV +24 V 3.6 V 20...30 V 36 V 0.15 A 46pin 0.4 kg (0.9 lb)
80 dB 40 dB
1.1
Operational error limits1) (0 _C to 60 _C) Cable length (shielded) Supply voltage S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t < 0.1 s Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) Front connector Weight approx. max.
3.7
typ. typ.
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range (5 V supply from power supply module).
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/45
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Analog input modules (continued) Technical specifications
Analog input module Number of inputs
6ES5 466-3LA11 8 differential inputs or 16 individual inputs (referred to ground) in 4 or 2 groups (selectable) Yes 0 ... 20 mA; 4 ... 20 mA; 20 mA 0 ... 1.25 V; 0 ... 2.5 V; 0 ... 5 V; 1 ... 5 V; 0 ... 10 V 1.25 V; 2.5 V; 5 V; 10 V Voltage measuring range: 10 M Current measuring range: 125 M Twowire connection 13 bit two's complement or 12 bit abs. value + sign or 12 bit binary Instantaneous value encoding Successive approximation max. max. max. 250 s 2 ms 4 ms
selector switch lets you select these values for 4 channels separately
Input resistance in the individual ranges Types of connection of signal sensors Digital representation of the input signal Measuring principle Conversion principle Encoding time per channel Cycle time for 8 inputs 16 inputs
Permissible voltage between inputs or between inputs and the central earthing point (destruction limit) max. Permissible voltage between the reference potential of a nonfloating sensor and the central earthing point max. Error indication for S Overranging S Wire breakage of the sensor line Noise suppression for f = n (50/60 Hz 1%); n = 1,2... S Common mode noise min. (Vp < 1 V) S Series mode noise min. (peak noise value < rated value of the range) Basic error limits1) (at 20 _C) Operational error limits1) (0 _C to 60 _C; for one year) Cable length (shielded) Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) Front connector Weight approx. max. typ. typ.
70 dB 40 dB
Voltage ranges (except 0...1.25 V; 1.25 V): Current ranges and 0...1.25 V; 1.25 V: Voltage ranges (except 0...1.5 V; 1.25 V): Current ranges and 0...1.25 V; 1.25 V: 200 m (650 ft) 0.7 A 43pin 0.4 kg (0.9 lb)
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range (5 V supply from power supply module).
3/46
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
6ES5 465-7LA13
6ES5 490 490-7LB21 7LB21 6ES5 490-7LA11 6ES5 490-7LA21 6ES5 490-7LC11
6ES5 498-1AA11 6ES5 498-1AA21 6ES5 498-1AA61 6ES5 498-1AA31 6ES5 498-1AA41 6ES5 498-1AA51 6ES5 498-1AA71
6ES5 497-4UA12 6ES5 497-4UB31 6XX3 068 6XX3 081 see page 3/98
Connection diagrams
Input 0 1 1
1 L+=24V 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 M2+ M2M3+ M3KOMP+ KOMPM4+ M4M5+ M525 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 M6+ M6M7+ M7L39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 M1M1+ MM+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
F+ FL+ Transducer 10V 1V/--mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA L-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
F+ FL+ Transducer 10V 1V/--mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA L-
+
Tr
+
Tr
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA
2 1 3
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27
Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA Transducer 10V 1V/..mA Common Range 10V 0...20mA 4...20mA
+
Tr
4 1 5
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
+
Tr
39 40 41 42
6 1 7 1
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
6ES5 460-7LA13
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/47
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Analog input modules (continued) Connection diagrams
1 L+=24V 2 1 M+ MM1+ M1M2+ M2M3+ M32 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 Mext. M12+ M12M13+ M13M14+ M14M15+ M15Mext. M4+ M4M5+ M5M6+ M6M7+ M7KOMP+ KOMP+ M8+ M8M9+ M9M10+ M10M11+ M11-
Channel
1 0 8 2
Channel
Input 0
1 2 3
1) 1)
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
1)
3 4 5 6
1 9
7 8 9 10 11 1
Mext.
1)
2 10
12 13 14 15 16 17 2
4 5 6 7
KOMP+ KOMP-
3 11
18 19 20 21 22 23 24
8 9 10 11
4 12
25 26 27 28
5 13
29 30 31 32 33 5
Mext.
1)
6 14
34 35 36 37 38 39 6
12 13 14 15
7 15
40 41 42 43
6ES5 465-7LA13
Input 0
1 2
Measuring voltage inputs Outputs for constant current
Mext.
1)
M4+ M4M5+ M5M6+ M6M7+ M7KOMP+ KOMP+ KOMPS+ SS1+ S1S2+ S2S3+ S3-
4 5 6 7
KOMP-
0 1 2 3
Mext.
1)
4 5 6 7
MANA = Common reference point of all current and voltage channels QVx = Voltage output CHANNELx QIx = Current output CHANNELx S+x = Sensor line+CHANNELx S-x = Common reference point of all current and voltage channels
3/48
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Design
Three analog output modules are available with 8 outputs each and a range of output voltages. The modules each require one slot.
The signal leads must be connected with front connec tors. They can be labelled in the fields on the front panel. The modules and front connectors can be inserted A voltagecurrent converter is also used to generate the corresponding output currents.The voltage and current output ranges for each module are fixed.
and removed under power. The module address (byte parameter when pro gramming) is slotdependent and need therefore not be set on the module. Note All the analog output modules of the S5135U/155U pro grammable controllers (see Section 4) can be used in the S5115U with adapter casings.
Principle of operation
The CPU of the central con troller transmits output values in digital form to the pro cessor of the analog output module. These are converted to analog voltages by a digitalanalog converter and a sampleandhold procedure.
Technical specifications
Analog output module Number of outputs (voltage and current outputs) Galvanic isolation Output ranges (rated values) S 6ES5 4707LA12 S 6ES5 4707LB12 S 6ES5 4707LC12 Load resistance S For voltage outputs S For current outputs Load connection Digital representation of the output signal Conversion time Permiss. overload capability approx. Shortcircuit protection Shortcircuit current (voltage output) approx. min. max. 6ES5 470-7L.13 8 Yes (not between the outputs) 10 V; 0...20 mA 10 V +1...5 V; +4...20 mA Only ohmic resistance 3.3 k 300 Load to the 0 V terminal 12 bit two's complement (1024 units = rated value) 1 ms 25% (up to 1280 units) Yes 25 mA Analog output module Opencircuit voltage (current output) approx. 6ES5 470-7L.13 18 V
Voltage between the reference potential of the load (0 V connection) and the housing max. Linearity in the rated range Operational limits (0 to +55_C) Cable length (shielded) max. Supply voltage S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t < 0.1 s Power consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) Front connector Weight approx. typ. typ.
60 V AC/75 V DC 2.5; 3 units 6 200 m (650 ft) + 24 V 3.6 V 20...30 V 36 V 0.25 A 0.3 A 46pin 0.4 kg (0.9 lb)
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/49
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Analog output modules (continued) Ordering data
470-7LA analog output module for S5115U/H/F 8 outputs; 10 V/0 ... 20 mA 470-7LB analog output module for S5115U/H/F 8 outputs; 10 V 470-LC analog output module for S5115U/H/F 8 outputs; +1 ... 5V; +4 ... 20 mA
6ES5 470-7LB13
6ES5 470-7LC13
Connection diagrams
L+24V QV 0 S+0 S-0 QI 0 QV 1 S+1 S-1 QI 1 1 2 3 QV 0 S+0 S-0 QV 1 S+1 S-1 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 MANA QV2 S+2 S-2 QI 2 QV 3 S+3 S-3 QI 3 13 14 15 QV2 S+2 S-2 QV 3 S+3 QI 3 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 QV 4 S+4 S-4 QI 4 QV 5 S+5 S-5 QI 5 27 QV 4 S+4 S-4 QV 5 S+5 S-5 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 MANA QV 6 S+6 S-6 QI 6 QV 7 S+7 S-7 QI 7 L - 0V 37 38 39 QV 6 S+6 S-6 QV 7 S+7 S-7 L - 0V 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 MANA MANA L+24V
Channel 0
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 2
Channel 3
Channel 3
Channel 4
Channel 4
Channel 5
Channel 5
Channel 6
Channel 6
Channel 7
Channel 7
3/50
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Intelligent I/O modules Overview Intelligent I/O modules are used for highspeed, high accuracy S Closedloop control S Positioning S Counting and proportioning S Processing of analog signals. The advantage of the intelli gent I/O modules lies in the fact that they execute these timecritical tasks completely autonomously (in most cases with their own processor). The CPU can then concentrate on its own control tasks more closely. These intelligent I/O modules are linked directly with the process via input and output channels. There is an entire range of intelligent I/O modules for the S5115U pro grammable controller, which can be used for the S5135U and S5155U/H. For further information, see Section 4.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/53
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Special modules
Overview Overview Special tasks
Memory CP 516 memory submodule Page 4/96 PC functions CP 581, the integral PC in the SIMATIC CP 581 with COROS LSB Page 4/97 4/101
Supplementary equipment
Communication TK 858 telecommunications unit Page 8/16 Simulation Simulation connectors Simulation panel Simulation modules 313 monitoring module Page 3/54 3/55 4/108 4/109
Simulation connectors Application For simulating binary input signals on the S5115U programmable controller.
Design
The simulation connectors must be plugged into digital input modules in the same way as front connectors and must be supplied with the signal voltage. They have switches which can be used as maintainedcontact switches (up position) or as momentarycontact switches (down position).
Order No.
2 versions are available: With 32 switches for 4207LA and 4307LA digital input modules S With 16 switches for 4317LA, 4327LA, 4357LA and 4367LA digital input modules
S
Ordering data
Simulation connectors With 32 switches With 16 switches
3/54
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Communications modules
Communications modules and bus systems Overview Communications processors are used for data interchange between the S5115U/H/F pro grammable controllers and the I/Os or other pro grammable controllers connected to them. Programmable controllers can be linked in two ways: Point-to-point connection Pointtopoint connection is used for connecting one or more I/Os or programmable controllers to a single S5115U/H/F programmable controller. The link can, for example, be made via the second interface of the CPU 943, CPU 944 and CPU 945. The CP 523, CP 524, CP 544 and CP 544B communications processors can also be used. These pri marily relieve the CPU of the responsibility for communica tions, thus enabling a large number of I/Os to be con nected. Bus systems LANs are used for interlinking a number of nodes. Possible nodes include: S S5115U/H/F programmable controllers S Thirdparty programmable controllers S Personal computers S Minicomputers or workstations S Field equipment There are three different LANs to choose from, depending on the area to be covered, the number and type of nodes and the transmission speed: S SINEC L1 S PROFIBUS S Industrial Ethernet A communications processor is available for each of these three bus systems. For further information, selection and ordering data, see Section 4.
3/56
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
CP 523 communications processor for the S5-115F Application The CP 523 communications processor makes linking to any desired devices with serial interfaces possible. The module is especially suitable for: S Direct safetyrelated link be tween two programmable controllers
S S
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Link with a personal computer as well as operator control and pro cess monitoring equipment
Devices with serial interfaces like, for example, printers, terminals, keyboards, barcode readers, CP 523, etc. can be connected.
Direct reactionfree link between a S5115F pro grammable controller and another SIMATIC program mable controller
Design
In the S5115F programmable controller it must be observed that the V.24 interface must only be used if the partner device ensures an electrical separation in accordance with VDE 0160. Interfacing The FB 252 integral function block in the S5115F pro grammable controller delivers blockwise data transfer to the CP 523. A safetyrelated link of further S5115F programmable con trollers is possible with stan dard function blocks (see Section 7).
Principle of operation
Message printout In the S5115F programmable controller the CP 523 can be used for the output of system fault signals. For that, it assigns the top 256 signals and in the event of system faults gives out one of these signals automatically. The signal texts for the system fault signals are contained in the diskette with the COM 115F parameterization software as an example.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/57
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-0LA subrack for S5-115U central controllers Application A small central controller with up to four I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7000LA subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required. Hardware interrupt evaluation is possible on all admissible slots for the corresponding modules.
Design
Up to three expansion units can be connected in series in centralized configuration (via IM 305 and IM 306 interface modules).
Type: Aluminium baseplate of extruded section with bus board for connecting the modules
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 941 to CPU 945 Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 305, IM 306 For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-0LA subrack
3/58
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CR 700-0LB subrack for S5-115U central controllers Application A small central controller with up to six I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7000LB subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required.
Subracks
Design
Two singlewidth modules in one adapter casing can be plugged into slots 0 and 3. Where two or more modules are installed in one casing, a fan subassembly is always required.
Hardware interrupt evaluation is possible on the admissible slots for the corresponding modules.
Connection of expansion units the same as for the CR 7002 subrack, but 2 interface modules can be used for distributed configuration in 1 adapter casing in slot 3. Type, dimensions and weight: see CR 7000LA subrack.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 941 to CPU 945 Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 304, IM 308, IM 308B IM 305, IM 306 IM 307 1) No interrupt processing possible in slot 3. 1) For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-0LB subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/59
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-1 subrack for S5-115U central controllers Application A central controller with up to seven I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7001 subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always re quired. Hardware interrupt evaluation is possible on the admissible slots for the corresponding modules.
Design
Type: Aluminium baseplate of extruded section with bus board for connecting the modules
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 941 to CPU 945 Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....), 776 power output Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 305, IM 306 1) Analog modules in slots 4, 5 and 6 only possible when using the IM 306 interface module. For slot assignment, see Section 11 11 Steckplatzbelegung siehe Katalogteil For slot assignment, see Section 11 11 Steckplatzbelegung siehe Katalogteil
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-1 subrack
3/60
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CR 700-2 subrack for S5-115U central controllers Application A central controller with up to seven I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7002 subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required. Hardware interrupt evaluation is possible on the admissible slots for the corresponding modules.
Subracks
Design
In centralized configuration up to 3 expansion units can be connected in series. In distributed configuration the following can be connected: S Up to 600 m, up to 2 times 4 expansion units (via IM 304)
S
For a distance of 50 to 500 m between 2 interface modules, max. 3 expansion units (via IM 307) Up to 23 km, max. 122 ET 200 distributed I/O modules (in two phases, via IM 308B)
In addition to that, up to 3 expansion units can be connected in centralized configuration to distributed expansion units. Type, dimensions and weight: see CR 7001 subrack.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 941 to CPU 945 Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output2), analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 304, IM 308, IM 308B IM 305, IM 306 IM 307 1) Analog modules in slots 4, 5 and 6 only possible when using the IM 306 interface module. 2) 4344 digital input module not in slot 6. 3) No interrupt processing possible in slot 6. 3) For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-2 subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/61
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-3 subrack for S5-115U central controllers Application A central controller with up to eleven I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7003 subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required.
Design
Two singlewidth modules in one adapter casing can be plugged into slots 0, 1, 2 and 6. Where two or more modules are installed in one casing, a fan subassembly is always required.
Hardware interrupt evaluation is possible in the admissible slots for the corresponding modules. Connection of expansion units the same as for the CR 7002 subrack, but 2 interface
modules can be used for distributed configuration in one adapter casing in slot 6. Type, dimensions and weight: see CR 7001 subrack.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 941 to CPU 945 Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output2), analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 304, IM 308, IM 308B IM 305, IM 306 IM 307 1) Analog modules in slots 4, 5 and 6 only possible when using the IM 306 interface module. 2) No interrupt processing possible in slot 6. 2) For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-3 subrack
3/62
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
ER 701-0 subrack for S5-115U expansion units Application An expansion unit containing up to six I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7010 subrack. Power supply by the central controller or an expan sion unit with the ER 7012 or ER 7013 subrack.
Subracks
Design
An expansion unit with the ER7010 subrack must always be connected in centralized configuration (IM 305 or IM 306 interface module).
Module locations
Slot No. Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1), block type only (6ES5 4..7....) IM 305, IM 306 0 1 2 3 4 5 IM
1) Except for 4347 digital input module; for analog modules the IM 306 interface module is required
Ordering data
ER 701-0 subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/63
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
ER 701-1 subrack for S5-115U expansion units Application An expansion unit containing up to nine I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7011 subrack. Power supply by the central controller or an expan sion unit with the ER 7012 or ER 7013 subrack.
Design
An expansion unit with the ER7011 subrack must always be connected in centralized configuration (IM 305 or IM 306 interface module).
Module locations
Slot No. Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1), block type only (6ES5 4..7....) IM 305, IM 306 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 IM
1) Except for 4347 digital input module; for analog modules the IM306 interface module is required.
Ordering data
ER 701-1 subrack
3/64
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
ER 701-2 subrack for S5-115U expansion units Application An expansion unit containing up to seven I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7012 subrack. A power supply module and the IM 306 interface module (for modules in block design) are always required.
Subracks
Design
An expansion unit with the ER7012 subrack must always be connected in distributed configuration (IM 314, IM 317 or IM 318 interface modules).
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....), Digital input and output, analog input and output modules1) (compact modules: 6ES5..4.-...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors IM 306 IM 314, IM 317, IM 318 313 monitoring module 1) The IM 306 interface module is necessary for modules in block design (for address setting). For slot assignment, see Section 11 PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM
Ordering data
ER 701-2 subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/65
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
ER 701-3 subrack for S5-115U expansion units Application An expansion unit containing up to seven I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7013 subrack. A power supply module and the IM 306 interface module (for modules in block design) are always required.
Design
An expansion unit with the ER7013 subrack must always be connected in distributed configuration (IM 314, IM 317 or IM 318 interface modules). When us ing IM 314 or IM 317 interface modules, also communica tions processors and intelligent I/O modules with page frame address can be plugged in.
In the ER 7013 expansion unit interrupt processing is only possible when using the IM 307/IM 317 fiber optic interface modules.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module Digital input and output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....), Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (compact mod.: 6ES5..4.-...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 306 (always required) IM 314 (also IM 310) or IM 318 IM 307, IM 317 313 monitoring module 1) Except for 4347 digital input module. 2) No interrupt processing possible in slot 7. 3) The IM 306 interface module is necessary for modules in block design (for address setting). 2) For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11 PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM
Ordering data
ER 701-3 subrack
3/66
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CR 700-0LB subrack for S5-115H central controllers Application A small central controller with up to four I/O modules can be configured with the CR 7000LB subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two central controllers.
Subracks
Design
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlesided configurations).
Up to two times four expan sion units (each with three additional EUs in centralized configuration) can be connected in distributed configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft).
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 942H Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 304 for linking central controllers or for distributed expansion IM 304, IM 306 IM 307 IM 324R for linking central controllers For slot assignment, see Sec. 11 For slot assignment, see Sec. 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-0LB subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/67
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-2 subrack for S5-115H central controllers Application A central controller with up to six I/O modules can be con figured with the CR 7002 subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two central controllers.
Design
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlesided configurations).
Expansion units in switched or distributed configurations cannot be used with this subrack.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 942H Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules1) (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors2) Intelligent I/O modules IM 304 for linking central controllers IM 305, IM 306 IM 324R for linking central controllers 1) 4344 digital input module not in slot 6 2) CP 526 and CP 527 basic boards only Order No. 6ES5 700-2LA12 For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-2 subrack
3/68
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CR 700-2F subrack for S5-115H central controllers Application A central controller with up to six I/O modules can be con figured with the CR 7002F subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two central controllers.
Subracks
Design
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlechannel I/O configurations).
Up to two times four expan sion units can be connected in distributed configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft).
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 942H Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors1) Intelligent I/O modules IM 304 for linking central controllers or for distributed expansion IM 305, IM 306 IM 307 IM 324R for linking central controllers 1) CP 526 and CP 527 as basic board only Order No. 6ES5 700-2LA22 For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-2F subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/69
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-3 subrack for S5-115H central controllers Application A central controller with up to nine I/O modules can be con figured with the CR 7003 subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two controllers.
Design
Two singlewidth modules in one adapter casing can be plugged into slots 0, 1, 2 and 6. Where two modules are installed in one casing, a fan subassembly is always required (see page 3/77).
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlechannel I/O configurations).
Up to two times four expan sion units can be connected in distributed configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft). Two interface modules in one adapter casing can be plugged into slot 6.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module CPU 942H Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 304 for linking central controllers or for distributed expansion IM 305, IM 306 IM 307 IM 324R for linking central controllers For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-3 subrack
3/70
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
ER 701-3LH subrack for I/O modules in switched configuration with S5-115H Application An expansion unit in switched configuration containing up to six I/O modules can be con figured with the ER 7013LH subrack. A power supply module and an IM 306 inter face module for address setting are always required.
Subracks
Design
A switched expansion unit with the ER 7013LH subrack is connected to the central controllers in distributed con figuration via two IM 314R interface modules.
Note on single-sided and two-channel configuration: The ER 7012 and ER 7013 subracks can also be used for singlesided and two channel configuration for the S5115H programmable controller.
The possible configurations are the same as those for the S5115U. For further details of these subracks please see pages 3/65 and 3/66.
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951 power supply module Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) Digital input and output, analog input and output modules (compact modules: 6ES5 4..4...., 6ES5 4663LA11) Communications processors Intelligent I/O modules IM 306 (always required) IM 314R 1) except 4347 digital input module Order No. 6ES5 701-3LH11 For slot assignment, see Section 11 Steckplatzbelegung siehe Katalogteil 11 Steckplatzbelegung siehe Katalogteil 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11 PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM
Ordering data
ER 701-3LH subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/71
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
CR 700-0LB subrack for S5-115F central controllers Application A central controller with up to four I/O modules can be con figured with the CR 700OLB subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two central controllers.
Design
Two communications pro cessors in one adapter casing can be plugged into slot 0, two interface modules in one adapter casing can be plugged into slot 3.
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlesided configurations).
Up to two times four expan sion units (each with three additional EUs in centralized configuration) can be connected in distributed configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft) (for redundant or singlechannel I/O configu rations).
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951F power supply module CPU 942F Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) 6ES5 4634U.12 analog input module, 6ES5 4534UA12 digital ouput module (compact modules) CP 523 communications processor IM 304 for linking central controllers or for distributed expansion IM 306 IM 324 for linking central controllers
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-0LB subrack
3/72
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
CR 700-2F subrack for S5-115F central controllers Application A central controller with up to six I/O modules can be con figured with the CR 7002F subrack. A power supply and CPU module are always required, as well as an IM 304 or IM 324R interface module for linking the two central controllers.
Subracks
Design
Up to three expansion units can be connected in centra lized configuration (for redundant or singlechannel I/O configurations).
Up to two times four expan sion units (each with three additional EUs in centralized configuration) can be connected in distributed
configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft) (for redundant or singlechannel I/O configura tions).
Module locations
Slot No. PS 951F power supply module CPU 942F Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) 6ES5 4634U.12 analog input module, 6ES5 4534UA12 digital output module (compact modules) CP 523 communications processor IM 304 for linking central controllers or for distributed expansion IM 306 IM 324 for linking central controllers
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM
Ordering data
CR 700-2F subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/73
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
ER 701-1 subracks for S5-115F expansion units Application A central controller with up to nine I/O modules can be con figured with the ER 7011 sub rack. Power supply by the central controller or an expan sion unit with the ER 7012 or ER 7013 subrack.
Design
An expansion unit with the ER 7011 subrack must always be connected in centralized configuration.
Module locations
Slot No. Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 IM
IM 306
Ordering data
ER 701-1 subrack
3/74
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
ER 701-2 subrack for S5-115F expansion units Application A central controller with up to seven I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7012 subrack. The IM 306 interface module is always required for address setting.
Subracks
Design
Expansion units with ER 7012 subracks can be connected to a central controller or an expansion unit with power supply with the IM 306 inter face module in centralized configuration or in distributed configuration with the IM 314 interface module to a central controller.
In centralized configuration, no power supply module must be plugged into the ER 7012 subrack. In distributed config uration, a power supply module is absolutely necessary.
This subrack makes two channel, redundant configura tion of I/O modules possible (see page 3/16). Interrupt evaluation is not possible in expansion units.
Module locations
Slot No. Power supply module Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules (block type 6ES5 4.. 7....) IM 306 IM 314 1) Only possible in this slot for centralized links (without power supply in the ER 7012 subrack). 1) PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM
Ordering data
ER 701-2 subrack
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/75
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Subracks
ER 701-3 subrack for S5-115F expansion units Application A central controller with up to eight I/O modules can be configured with the ER 7013 subrack. The IM 306 interface module is always required for address setting.
Design
Expansion units with ER 7013 subracks can be connected to a central controller or an expansion unit with power supply with the IM 306 inter face module in centralized configuration or in distributed configuration with the IM 314 interface module to a central controller.
In centralized configuration, no power supply module must be plugged into the ER 7013 subrack. In distributed config uration, a power supply module is absolutely necessary. In an expansion unit with this subrack also the 463 analog input module can be plugged in.
This subrack makes two channel, redundant configura tion of I/O modules possible (see page 3/16). Interrupt evaluation is not possible in expansion units.
Module locations
Slot No. Power supply module Digital input and output, digital input/output, analog input and output modules1) (block type: 6ES5 4..7....) 6ES5 4634U.12 analog input module3), 6ES5 4534UA12 digital output module (compact modules) CP 523 communications processor IM 306 IM 314 1) Except for 4347LA12 digital input module 2) Only possible in this slot for centralized configuration (without power supply in the ER 7013 subrack). 3) In centralized link with ER 7013 subracks the 463 analog input module must only be used in the central controller and in the first and second expansion unit. Only the 6ES5 7050AF00 cable (length 0.5 m) may be used for that. 2) 2) PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM
Ordering data
ER 701-3 subrack
3/76
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Fan subassembly Application A fan subassembly is required: S If the power supply module has an output load of more than 7 A S If several modules are installed in one adapter casing (except for IM 304/ IM 308 in one casing) S If certain modules are used (see Section 11 for further details)
Subracks
Design
The fan subassembly con tains two fans, a dust filter and fan monitors with floating contacts.
The fan subassembly and mounting accessories are available in two versions: S For long subracks (483 mm/19") S For short subracks (353 mm/14")
The fan subassembly should be installed under the PLC, using the relevant mounting accessories. A wiring duct is supplied along the mounting accessories. The field cables can be run off neatly to the sides in this duct.
Technical specifications
For long subracks Supply voltage Current consumption Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm (in) Weight S Cable duct with mounting brackets approx. S Fan subassembly approx. 115/230 V AC or 24 V DC 0.6/0.3 A or 0.8 A 480 x 172 x 264 (19 x 6.77 x 10.4) For short subracks 115/230 V AC or 24 V DC 0.6/0.3 A or 0.8 A 359 x 172 x 264 (14 x 6.77 x 10.4)
Ordering data
Fan subassembly S 115/230 V AC S 24 V DC Mounting accessories Dust filter (filter mat) For long subracks For short subracks
Order No. Replacement fan for above fan subassembly, comprising: 1 fan, plugin connector, replacement instructions
6ES5 981-0H J11 6ES5 981-0H J21 6ES5 981-0G J11 6ES5 981-0J J11 A B
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/77
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Power supply modules
PS 951 power supply modules for the S5-115U/H Application Power supply modules gener ate the voltages required by the programmable controller from the external power supply: +5 V as supply voltage for all modules; +5,2 V as supply voltage for the PG 605 programmer, the OP 393 and OP 396 operator panels and the BT 777 (observe max. current); +24 V for the 20 mA current loop interfaces.
Design
Power supply modules are available with one or two backup batteries, depending on the model. These can be replaced even when the power supply is switched off. In the case of the power
supply modules with only one backup battery, the backup voltage is supplied via sock ets during replacement. In those with two backup batter ies, the second battery be gins to supply the backup
voltage as soon as the first one fails. This also applies when it is removed for re placement. Five power supply modules are available for the S5115U/H programmable controller.
Technical specifications
Power supply module Supply voltage S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) S Frequency range Current consumption S Rated value IN S Inrush current S I2 t 6ES5 951-7LB21 230/120 V AC 187...264 V 94...132 V 47...63 Hz 0.4/0.6 A 0.8/1.4 A 15xIN 15xIN 0.2 A2s 1.8 A2s 20 ms +5 V 1.5% +5.2 V (1 A) +24 V (0.2 A) 6ES5 951-7LD21 230/120 V AC 187...264 V 94...132 V 47...63 Hz 0.4/0.6 A 0.8/1.4 A 15xIN 15xIN 0.2 A2s 1.8 A2s 20 ms +5 V 1.5% +5.2 V (2.5 A) +24 V (0.35 A) 6ES5 951-7NB21 24 V DC 3.6 V 19.2...30 V 1.5 A 15xIN 0.4 A2s 6ES5 951-7ND51 24 V DC 3.6 V 9.2...30 V 5A 15xIN 16 A2s 6ES5 951-7ND41 24 V DC 3.6 V 9.2...30 V 5.6 A 15xIN 4.5 A2s
max.
max.
Mains buffering Output voltage V1 Auxiliary voltages S V2 (e.g. for programmers) S V3 (e.g. for CP 525) Output current1) S Rated value for operation Without fan With fan S Permissible range Backup battery
3A 3A 0.3...3 A
7A 15 A 0.3...15 A
3A 3A 0.3...15 A
S Backup time S External backup voltage Shortcircuit protection Opencircuit protection Fuse (primary circuit) Class of protection Galvanic isolation Test voltage RI specification Weight
min.
2xlithium battery 1xlithium battery 1xlithium battery Size AA, Size C, Size C, (3.6 V/2x1.75 Ah) (3.6 V/5 Ah) (3.6 V/5 Ah) 1 year (at 0.3 mA, 25 _C and uninterrupted buffering) +3.4...+9 V Electronic Yes Integral Class 1 Yes 2.5 kV AC A in acc. with VDE 0871 Yes 2.5 kV AC A in acc. with VDE 0871 1.9 kg (4.1 lb) No A in acc. with VDE 0871 1.6 kg (3.5 lb)
approx.
3/78
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
PS 951 power supply modules for the S5-115U/H (continued) Ordering data
PS 951 power supply module for internal power supply of the S5115U/H (without backup battery) 230/120 V AC; 5 V, 3 A 230/120 V AC; 5 V, 7/15 A1) 24 V DC; 5 V, 3 A; nonfloating 24 V DC; 5 V, 7/15 A1); nonfloating DC 24 V; 5 V, 7/15 A1); floating Operating instructions included in the S5115U manual (see page 3/23). 1) Fan subassembly required in the subrack (see page 3/77) Order No. Backup battery, lithium battery Size C, 3.6 V/5 Ah Size AA, 3.6 V/1.75 Ah 6ES5 951-7LB21 6ES5 951-7LD21 6ES5 951-7NB21 6ES5 951-7ND51 6ES5 951-7ND41 Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/79
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Power supply modules
PS 951 power supply module for the S5-115F Application The PS 951 power supply module generates the internal operating voltage of 5 V DC required by the pro grammable controller from the external power supply 24 V DC. Only the PS 9517ND41 is approved for the S5115F failsafe programmable controller. Moreover, the module makes backup supply of the RAM modules of the CPU possible. Two backup batteries are installed for that in the PS 9517ND41. These can be replaced even when the power supply is switched off. The second battery begins to supply the backup voltage as soon as the first one fails or is removed for replacement.
Design
The PS 951 power supply module is potentialisolated and is suitable for applica tions
where the input circuit of the I/O modules is operated with out ground connection.
The lines with the supply voltage are connected to the bottom of the power supply module with the help of screw terminals.
Technical specifications
Supply voltage S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Current consumption S Rated value IN S Inrush current S I 2t Mains buffering Output voltage V1 Auxiliary voltage S V2 (e.g. for programming devices) S V3 (e.g. for CP 525) 24 V DC 3.6 V 19.2 ... 30 V Output current S Rated value for operation Without fan With fan S Permissible range Backup battery S Backup time S External backup voltage Shortcircuit protection Opencircuit protection Fuse (primary circuit) Class of protection Galvanic isolation Test voltage RI specification Weight approx. min.
max.
7A 15 A 0.3 ... 15 A 2 x lithium battery Size AA, (3.6 V/2 x 1.75 Ah) 1 year (at 0.3 mA, 25_C and uninterrupted buffering) + 3.4 ... +9 V Electronic Yes Integral Class 1 Yes 500 V AC A in acc. with VDE 0871 1.9 kg (4.1 lb)
max.
Ordering data
PS 951 power supply module for S5-115F for internal power supply (without backup battery) 24 V DC; 5 V, 7 A; nonfloating
Order No. 6ES5 951-7ND41 Backup battery (lithium battery) Size AA, 3.6 V/1.75 Ah
3/80
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules Overview The following table shows the interface modules and connecting cables required to link the various expansion units to the central controllers.
Interface modules
Expansion unit EU type for S5115U/H/F ER 7010 ER 7011 EU type for S5135U, S5155U/H Type of interface
Connecting cable Type Length Permanently connected 0.5 m (1.6 ft) or 1.5 m (5 ft) 7050 0.5 m (1.6 ft) ... 2.5 m (8.2 ft) 7210 0.5 m (1.6 ft) ... 200 m (656 ft) 7210 1 m (3.28 ft) ... 600 m (1968 ft) 7210 1 m (3.28 ft) ... 600 m (1968 ft) IM 317 7222 (fiber optic cable)
Centralized up to 2 m, asymmetric
S5115U S5115H1)
IM 305
IM 305
S5115U S5115H1) S5115F4) Distributed up to 200 m, symmetric Distributed up to 600 m symmetric S5115U S5115H1) S5115U S5115H1) S5115F S5115H3)
IM 306
IM 306
IM 304
IM 314R
Distributed 50 ... 1500 m (between every 2 modules), serial optical Distributed up to 3000 m, serial electrical
S5115U
IM 307
EG 183U EG 185U
S5115U
IM 308
S5115U S5115H1)
IM 308-B
ET 200U
1) S5115H with twochannel I/O modules (fully redundant configuration) or singlechannel/singlesided I/O configuration 2) An IM 306 interface module is required for setting the addresses of modules of block design 3) S5115H with singlesided I/O (switched) 4) The 463 analog input module can only be used in the 1st and 2nd EU and only with a 0.5 m (1.6 ft) cable.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/81
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
IM 305 and IM 306 interface modules; centralized configuration with S5-115U Application The IM 305 and IM 306 inter face modules enable expan sion units (EUs) to be connected in centralized configuration. The IM 305 interface module is used for connecting one expansion unit to the central controller. The IM 306 interface module can be used for connecting up to three expansion units to the central controller (CC) or to an expansion unit with a power supply module.
Design
IM 305 interface module The IM 305 interface module consists of two modules which are permanently connected by a cable (0.5 or 1.5 m (1.5 ft or 4.7 ft) long). It provides the expansion unit (in an ER 7010 or ER 7011 subrack) with the supply voltage and the signals from the internal bus. The expan sion unit must be positioned either above the central controller or (with a 1.5 m (4.7 ft) cable) adjacent to it. In this configuration, the addresses for the input and output modules are perma nently assigned to the slots. For example, slot 0 in the central controller is reserved for byte addresses 0 to 3 (binary signals 0.0 to 3.7, inputs or outputs) and slot 3 for byte addresses 12 to 15. IM 306 interface module One IM 306 interface module must be plugged into the cen tral controller and one into an expansion unit connected in centralized configuration (in an ER 7010 or ER 7011 sub rack). It is also used in expansion units connected in a distributed configuration (in an ER 7012 or ER 7013 sub rack) for setting the addresses of the I/O modules of block design. The IM 306 provides the expansion units with the supply voltage and the signals from the internal bus. The cable length from the central controller to the last expansion unit can be up to 2.5 m (8 ft). The minimum vertical clearance between two units is 100 mm (4").
Fig. 3/33 Connection of expansion units to the central controller in centralized configuration using IM 305 (left) and IM 306 (right) interface modules
EU IM 306 ER 701-1
EU IM 306 ER 701-1
CC IM 305 CR 700-.
CC CR 700-.
IM 306
In this configuration, the addresses for the input and output modules must be assigned to the slots using DIL switches on the IM 306 interface module. The fixed address assignments do not apply. Inputs and outputs can have the same address. The IM 306 interface module is also required for the ER 7012 and ER 7013 subracks if they contain I/O modules of block design (6ES5 4..7.).
Expansion units in the ER 7010 and ER 7011 sub racks can also be connected in a centralized configuration to the S5135U and S5155U programmable controllers (see Section 4) using the IM 306 interface module. An IM 3005LB interface module must be plugged into the cen tral controller for this purpose.
3/82
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 305 and IM 306 interface modules; centralized configuration with S5-115U (continued) Technical specifications
IM 305 interface module Current supplied to EU Current consumption (at 5V) Power loss Weight (total) max. approx. max. 1A 10 mA 0.05 W 0.6 kg (1.3 lb) IM 306 interface module Current supplied to EU Current consumption (at 5V) Power loss Weight max. approx. max. 2A 50 mA 0.25 W 0.3 kg (0.6 lb)
Interface modules
Ordering data
IM 305 interface module for S5115 U/H With 0.5 m (1.5 ft) cable With 1.5 m (4.7 ft) cable IM 306 interface module for S5115U/H/F Operating instructions included in the S5115U manual (see page 3/23).
Order No. 705 connecting cable for connecting IM 306 to IM 306 or IM 3005LB interface modules to IM 306 Length 0.5 m (1.6 ft) 1.25 m (4.1 ft) 1.5 m (4.9 ft) 2.5 m (8.2 ft)
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/83
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
IM 304 and IM 314 interface modules; distributed configuration up to 600 m with S5-115U Application The IM 304 and IM 314 inter face modules are used for distributed configuration of expansion units (EUs) with a central controller (CC). The expansion units can be up to 600 m (1969 ft) away from the central controller.
Design
The IM 304 interface module is plugged into the central controller (CR 700-0LB, CR 700-2 and CR 700-3 subracks) and the IM 314 interface module into the expansion unit (ER 701-2 and ER 701-3 subracks). Up to two times four expan sion units (with power supply module) can be connected in distributed configuration to one IM 304 interface module. The central controller and the distributed expansion units can be expanded with up to three additional expansion units (ER 701-0 and ER 701-1 subracks) connected in a centralized configuration. An IM 306 interface module must be plugged into each expansion unit to enable the addresses for the input and output modules to be assigned to the slots. This interface module is required even if no additional expan sion unit is connected. Up to four areas of 256 bytes each in the S5-115U pro grammable controller can be addressed with an IM 304 interface module. The areas can be set with a switch on the IM 314 interface module. A terminator must always be inserted in the last IM 314 interface module.
EU
ER 701-2 ER 701-3
IM 314 IM 306
Terminator
EU
ER 701-2 ER 701-3
IM 314 IM 306
Fig. 3/34 Connection of expansion units to the central controller in distributed configuration using IM 304 and IM 314 interface modules
Connection of other programmable controllers Expansion units in ER 7012 and ER 7013 subracks can also be connected to the S5135U and S5155U pro grammable controllers using the IM 304 and IM 314 inter face modules (see Section 4).
These two interface modules can also be used for connect ing the EU 183U and EU 185U expansion units to the S5115U programmable controller. Adapter casing required (page 3/98)
3/84
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 304 and IM 314 interface modules; distributed configuration up to 600 m (1968 ft) with S5-115U (continued) Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 max. S IM 314 max. Power loss S IM 304 S IM 314 max. max. Space requirements 1.5 A 1.0 A 7.5 W 5W Weight approx, 1/2 slot or 1 slot (see subracks, page 3/58f.) 0.3 kg (0.6 lb)
Interface modules
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for the central controller of an S5115U/H/F IM 314 interface module for the expansion unit of an S5115U/H/F Operating instructions included in the S5115U manual (see page 3/23).
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 Terminator for IM 314 interface module Adapter casing 6ES5 314-3UA11 721 connecting cable Standard lengths 1 m (3.2 ft) 1.6 m (5.2 ft) 2 m (6.5 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164.0 ft) Special lengths 2.5 m (8.2 ft) 3.2 m (10.5 ft) 8 m (26.2 ft) 12 m (39.3 ft) 16 m (52.5 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 25 m (82.0 ft) 32 m (105.0 ft) 40 m (131.2 ft) 63 m (206.6 ft) 80 m (262.4 ft) 100 m (328.0 ft) 500 m (1640.4 ft)
Order No. 6ES5 760-1AA11 see page 3/98 6ES5 721-0BB00 6ES5 721-0BB60 6ES5 721-0BC00 6ES5 721-0BF00 6ES5 721-0CB00 6ES5 721-0CF00 6ES5 721-0BC50 6ES5 721-0BD20 6ES5 721-0BJ 00 6ES5 721-0CB20 6ES5 721-0CB60 6ES5 721-0CC00 6ES5 721-0CC50 6ES5 721-0CD20 6ES5 721-0CE00 6ES5 721-0CG30 6ES5 721-0CJ 00 6ES5 721-0DB00 6ES5 721-0DF00
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/85
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 308 and IM 318 interface modules; distributed configuration up to 3000 m with S5-115U Application The IM 308 and IM 318 inter face modules are used for connecting I/O modules in the following expansion units (EUs) to a central controller (CC) in distributed configu ration:
S S S S
Interface modules
The ET 100U electronic termi nator (see Section 6) can also be connected. The expansion units and the ET 100U electronic terminator can be up to 3000 m (9900 ft) away from the central controller.
Design
The IM 308 interface module is plugged into the central controller and the IM 3183 interface module into the ex pansion unit or the IM 3188 interface module into the ET 100U electronic terminator. Two lines, each containing up to 32 expansion units (with IM 3183) or electronic termi nators (with IM 3188) in any order can be connected to one IM 308 interface module. A total of 63 expansion units and ET 100U electronic termi nators can operate via one IM 308 interface module. Digi tal and analog I/Os, intelligent I/O modules and communi cations processors with linear addressing can be used in the expansion units. The central controller and distributed expansion units (ER 7012 and ER 7013 sub racks) can be expanded with up to three additional expan sion units in centralized con figuration.
Type of cable Siemens control cable type A1) 6XV1 8300AH10 Siemens control cable type B V45551F21B5 (1.5 mm2, paired) 1) Available by the meter
A memory submodule with the address list for the IM 308 interface module is only required for connecting ET 100U electronic termi nators. In the S5115U programmable controller up to four areas of 256 bytes each can be ad dressed with an IM 308 inter face module. These areas can be set with a switch on the IM 318 interface module. The central controller and the expansion units or electronic terminators are isolated from one another. Cables The interface modules must be connected via twocore cables. They are supplied together with connectors for connecting the cables using screw terminals. The connec tors are provided with screw terminals for the incoming and the outgoing line.
A terminating resistor (120 ; supplied with the IM 308 inter face module) must be fitted to the connector of the last IM 318 in place of the out going line. An expansion unit can be switched off without affecting the operation of the other units. Selecting the cables: Shielded, twisted twocore cables are to be used. The resistance of a core must not exceed 50 , irrespective of the cable length. The surge impedance should be around 120 . The capacity per unit length must be as low as pos sible (<60 pF/m). The bottom table shows two types of cables that can be used. Adapter casing required (page 3/98)
3000 m/9840 ft
31 kbit/s
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/89
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
Design (continued)
additional EUs (centralized) CC
CR 700-0LB CR 700-2 CR 700-3
IM 308 and IM 318 interface modules; distributed configuration up to 3000 m with S5-115U (continued)
Terminator
EU
ER 701-2 ER 701-3
Terminator
Fig. 3/37 Connection of expansion units and ET 100U electronic terminators to the central controller in distributed configuration using IM 308 and IM 318 interface modules
Technical specifications
Transmission speed (selectable) Number of units that can be connected S Per connection S Total Addressing range for I/O modules Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 308 S IM 3183 31, 62, 187 or 375 kbit/s Power loss S IM 308 S IM 3183 Space requirements max. max. 2.5 W 1.5 W 1 slot or 1/2 slot (see subracks, starting page 3/58) approx. 0.4 kg (0.9 lb)
Weight
Ordering data
IM 308 interface module for the S5115U central controller 376 memory submodule (EPROM) for storing the address list for the ET 100U (not required for other expansion units); to be plugged into the IM 308 IM 318-3 interface module for the EG 183U, EG 185U, ER 7012 and ER 7013 expansion units
Order No. 6ES5 308-3UA12 6ES5 376-1AA11 IM 318-8 interface module for the ET 100U electronic terminator Adapter casing To be ordered as a separate item: IM 308/IM 318 manual German English French 6ES5 318-3UA11
3/90
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 308-C interface module; PROFIBUS-DP interface for the S5-115U/H (up to S5-155U/H) Application The IM 308C is a PROFIBUSDP master and/or slave module for SIMATIC S5115U/H up to S5155U/H. Up to 122 passive users like, for example, ET 200 distri buted I/O devices, the S595U/DP programmable controller or field devices with PROFIBUSDP interface can be connected to an IM 308C interface module.
Interface modules
Design
The IM 308C interface module must be plugged into the slot designed for it in the S5115U/H up to S5155U/H programmable controller.
The module needs a single width slot. The connection to the PROFIBUS LAN is made via
S S
a RS 485 bus interface plug or a RS 485 bus terminal Adapter casing required (page 3/98)
Principle of operation
As master module, the IM 308C interface module coordinates the bus access and the data transfer to the PROFIBUSDP. It can also operated as PROFIBUSDP slave and thus makes data exchange with other PROFIBUSDP masters possible.
The master and slave function can be used in combination, i.e. as a slave, an IM 308C interface module receives data from another program mable controller and simulta neously works as master of e.g. ET 200 I/O components.
S S
Global control: Sync, Freeze of I/O devices Address volume: 13 Kbyte data from the CPU can be addressed per IM 308C Shared inputs: the inputs of a slave can be read by several IM 308C interface modules
Configuring
Configuring takes place with the COM ET 200 Windows configuring package (see Section 9).
Technical specifications
Transfer rate Interfaces S Connection to PROFIBUS Supply voltage Current consumption Address volume Number of I/O devices which can be connected Data volume 9pin Sub D socket +5 V DC via backplane bus max. 0.6 A at +5 V DC 13 Kbyte for inputs, outputs and diagnostics max. 122 ET 200 U/B/C, S595U/DP and/or other field devices 244 byte inputs and outputs per slave 9.6 kbit/s up to 12 Mbit/s Permissible environmental conditions S Operating temperature S Transport/storage temperature S Relative humidity Mechanical design S S S S Module format Dimensions (W H) in mm Weight approx. Space requirements 0 _C to +60 _C 40 _C to +70 _C 5 to 95% Double eurocard 160 233.4 0.5 kg 1 slot
Ordering data
IM 308-C interface module for connecting the SIMATIC S5115U/H, S5135U, S5155U/H to PROFIBUSDP, with memory card (256 Kbyte)
Order No. 6ES5 308-3UC11 Memory card 256 Kbyte EPROM 1 Mbyte EPROM
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/91
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
IM 304 and IM 324R interface modules, for interfacing the S5-115H central controllers Application The IM 324R and IM 304 inter face modules are used for linking the two central controllers of an S5115H failsafe programmable controller.
Design
The IM 324R interface module is plugged into the first central controller (subunit A) and the IM 304 interface module into the second central controller (subunit B). The two interface modules are connected via a 721 connecting cable (up to 100 m (328 ft)). The IM 324R interface module has two memory areas where the necessary process data for data communications between the two central controllers is stored. Adapter casing required (page 3/98)
Subunit A
IM 324R
Subunit B
IM 304
Principle of operation
The IM 324R and IM 304 inter face modules handle all data communications between the
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 max. S IM 324R max. Power loss S IM 304 max. S IM 324R max. 1.5 A 1.0 A 7.5 W 5W Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot or 1/2 slot 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5115H programmable controller IM 324R interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5115H programmable controller
6ES5 324-3UR11
3/92
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 304 and IM 314R interface modules, for distributed configuration of I/O modules at S5-115H Application The IM 314R and IM 304 inter face modules are used for connection of I/O modules to the S5115H failsafe pro grammable controller in a singlechannel switched configuration.
Interface modules
Design
An IM 304 interface module is plugged into each of the two central controllers. Two IM 314R interface modules are plugged into each expan sion unit. The interface mod ules must be interconnected via 721 connecting cables (up to 600 m (1968 ft)). A termi nator must be plugged into the last interface module in each chain. A maximum of two chains, each with up to four expan sion units, can be connected to the central controllers, i.e. a total of eight expansion units. The IM 306 interface module can also be used for conn necting additional expansion units to each of the expansion units connected in switched configuration. Moreover, all other interface modules of the S5115U programmable controller can be used in the S5115H failsafe pro grammable controller. Adapter casing required (page 3/98)
EU ER 701-3LH EG 185U
IM 314R IM 306
Subunit A
IM 314R
Subunit B
IM 304
EU ER 701-3LH EG 185U
EU ER 701-3LH EG 185U
IM 306
IM 314R
Technical specifications
IM 304 Current consumption (at 5 V) max. Power loss max. 1.5 A 7.5 W IM 314R 1.0 A 5W Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot or 1/2 slot 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for the S5115H programmable controller IM 314R interface module for the expansion unit
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 Terminator for the IM 314R Adapter casing 6ES5 314-3UR11 721 connecting cable (up to 600 m (1968 ft))
Order No. 6ES5 760-0HA11 see page 3/98 see page 3/85
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/93
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
IM 304 and IM 324 interface modules; for interfacing the S5-115F central controllers Application The IM 324 and IM 304 inter face modules are used for linking the two central controllers of an S51115F failsafe programmable controller.
Design
Subunit A IM 324 Subunit B IM 304
The IM 324 interface module is plugged into the first cen tral controller (subunit A) and the IM 304 interface module into the second central controller (subunit B). The two interface modules are connected via a 721 connec ting cable (up to 10 m (33 ft)). The IM 324 interface module has two memory areas with a capacity of 2 K words each where the necessary process data for data communications between the two central controllers is stored.
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 S IM 324 max. max. 1.5 A 1.0 A Power loss S IM 304 S IM 324 Weight max. max. approx. 7.5 W 5W 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5115F programmable controller IM 324 interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5115F programmable controller Operating instructions included in the S5115F manual (see page 3/29)
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 Adapter casing 721 connecting cable 6ES5 324-3UA12
3/94
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
IM 306 interface module; for centralized configuration of I/O modules at S5-115F Application The IM 306 interface module is used for connecting up to three expansion units in a centralized configuration to a central controller or distrib uted expansion unit.
Interface modules
Design
Note When the 6ES5 4634U.12 analog input module is used, only cable 6ES5 7050AF00 (length 0.5 m (1.5 ft)) may be used for connecting the expansion units.
Principle of operation
The IM 306 interface modules handle all data communica tions between the connected central controller and expan sion units. The addresses to the input and output modules
must be allocated to the slots of the subrack using the DIP switches on the IM 306 inter face module. It is possible for inputs and outputs to have the same addresses.
Ordering data
IM 306 interface module Operating instructions included in the S5115F manual (see page 3/29).
Order No. 6ES5 306-7LA11 705 connecting cable between IM 306 and IM 306 Length 0.50 m (1.5 ft) 1.25 m (3.9 ft) 1.50 m (4.7 ft) 2.50 m (8.2 ft)
Order No.
The ER 7011, ER 7012 and ER 7013 subracks, without power supply modules, can be used for the expansion units. The IM 306 interface module must be plugged into the central expansion units and into the central controller or distributed expanison unit. The interface modules are connected via a 705 connecting cable..
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/95
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Interface modules
IM 304 and IM 314 interface modules for distributed configuration of I/O modules at S5-115F Application The IM 314 and IM 304 inter face modules are used for connection of expansion units to the S5115F failsafe pro grammable controller in a distributed configuration.
Design
The ER 7011 and ER 7013 subracks, without power supply modules, can be used for the expansion units. The IM 304 interface module is plugged into the central controller and the IM 314 interface module into the expansion unit. The interface modules must in inter connected via type 721 con necting cables (max. 600 m (1968 ft)). A terminator must be plugged into the last inter face module in each chain. Up to two chains with an expansion unit in direct con figuration each or 3 expansion units in centralized configu ration via an IM 306 3 inter face module each can be connec ted. A total of 8 expansion units can be connected.
721 connecting cable or terminator EU ER 701-2 ER 701-3 1st line: max. 4 EUs max. 600 m (1968 ft) IM 314 IM 306
CC CR 7000LB CR 7002F
IM 304 IM 306
705 connecting cable further EUs (in central configuration) 2nd line: max. 4 EUs max. 600 m (1968 ft)
IM 314 IM 306
Principle of operation
The IM 314 and IM 304 inter face modules handle all data communications between the central controller and the expansion unit and between the expansion units.
An IM 306 interface module must be plugged into each central controller and expan sion unit to enable addresses for the input and output modules to be allocated to the slots of the subracks.
This interface module is still required if no additional expansion units are to be connected. For technical data, see page 3/85.
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for the central controller IM 314 interface module for the expansion unit Operating instructions included in the S5115F manual (see page 3/28)
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 6ES5 314-3UA11 Terminator for IM 314 interface module Adapter casing 721 connecting cable
Order No.
3/96
Siemens ST 50 1998
Supplementary equipment
Front connector Application Front connectors are required for connecting signal leads to input and output modules. They simplify the installation and, if necessary, replace ment of modules. 490 front connectors are suitable for all modules of block design and 497 front connectors for compact modules used in the S5115U in adapter casings.
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Design
Modules can be connected by the following methods: S Screw terminals (end sleeves not required) S Crimp terminals S Snapon clip terminals (490 front connector only)
The front connectors are hooked onto the module at the bottom and screwed down at the top. Each front connector has a duct for the signal leads, thus enabling the 490 front connector to be comletely covered by the module frontplate.
Individual leads can be removed with the front connector in place. For the duplication of connections (e.g. incoming feeders) in 490 front connectors with screw terminals, the 763 bridge jumper is available.
Technical specifications
Front connector Connectors 6ES5 490-7LB11 Screw terminals 24pin 1 x (1.0 ... 2.5) mm2 or 2 x (0.5 ... 2.5) mm2 6ES5 490-7LB21 Screw terminals 46pin 1 x (0.5 ... 2.5) mm2 or 2 x (0.5 ... 1) mm2 or max. 1.5 mm2 with bridge jumper 6ES5 490-7LA.. Crimp terminals 46pin 1 x (1.0 ... 2.5) mm2 or 2 x (0.5 ... 0.75) mm2 6ES5 490-7LC11 Snapon clip terminals 46pin 1 x (0.25 ... 1.5) mm2 or max. 1.5 mm2 with conductors com bined in an end sleeve 6ES5 497- ... see Section 4
Duct: S Crosssection approx. S Number of leads max. 2.5 mm2 crosssection max. 1.5 mm2 crosssection max. 1.0 mm2 crosssection Weight approx.
Ordering data
490 front connector For screw terminals S 24pin S 46pin For crimp terminals, 24/46pin S With 50 crimp contacts S Without crimp contacts For snapon clip terminals, 46pin 763 bridge jumper for use with screw terminal 490 front connector; 1 package contains 10 jumpers 497 front connector for 4634 analog input module
Order No. K front connector for 4663LA11 analog input module For screw terminals singlewidth, 43pin For crimp terminals singlewidth, 43pin Crimp contacts 1 package contains 250 contacts Crimping tool for crimping the crimp contacts Extraction tool for crimp contacts (for S5115U modules) see Section 4 Labelling strips for the front cover; 1 sheet contains 6 strips
Order No.
6ES5 490-7LB11 6ES5 490-7LB21 6ES5 490-7LA11 6ES5 490-7LA21 6ES5 490-7LC11 6ES5 763-7LA 11
6XX3 081 6XX3 068 6XX3 070 6XX3 071 6ES5 497-8MA11
6ES5 497-7LA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/97
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
Adapter casings Application
Supplementary equipment
Compact modules (ES 902 design) can also be used in the S5115U/H/F pro grammable controller with adapter casings. The casings protect the modules against environ mental effects. They are mounted on the rack in block design as the other modules.
Technical specifications
Adapter casing Width Number of accomodated compact modules max. Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm Weight approx. For use in subracks 6ES5 491-0LB11 Singlewidth 2 43 x 303 x 187 0.45 kg CR 7000 CR 7001 CR 7002 CR 7003 ER 7012 ER 7013 6ES5 491-0LD11 Doublewidth 4 86 x 303 x 187 0.8 kg CR 7000LB CR 700 7002 CR 7003 ER 7013 6ES5 491-0LC11 Triplewidth 6 129 x 303 x 187 1.8 kg CR 7000LB CR 700 7002 CR 7003 ER 7013
Ordering data
Adapter casing with 1 protective cover S Singlewidth, for up to 2 compact modules S Doublewidth, for up to 4 compact modules S Triplewidth, for up to 6 compact modules
Order No.
3/98
Siemens ST 50 1998
Supplementary equipment
Text Display TD 390 Application The TD 390 text display is a compact text display unit for SIMATIC S5 systems. Its small dimensions enable it to be installed where space is limited. The TD 390 can be used with the S S590U, S595U/F, S5100U S S5115U and S S5135U, S5155U/H programmable controllers. Text can be displayed in stan dard mode (one line, 20 char acters) or extended mode (two lines, 40 characters). Design The TD 390 text display is connected to the programma ble controller direct via the programmer interface of the CPU. It can be installed di rectly in a cabinet door or control panel without a special mounting frame. For the time-of-day, prompter interval and operating hours counting the TD 390 accesses the relevant function in the CPU of the programmable controller direct. The TD 390 comprises: Two-line display panel (LCD) S Three membrane keys.
S
SIMATIC S5115U/H/F
The TD 390 provides the follo wing functions: S Display of up to 120 texts with or without variables S Display and setting of timeof-day and prompter inter val S Operating hours counter (display and reset) S Display and modification of 24 timer or counter values and 24 other process values as required.
A cable for connection to the CPU of the programmable controller (5 m/16 ft.) and a cable for the 24 V power sup ply (5 m/16 ft.) are also sup plied with the unit.
Application
Text, timers, counters and other process values are dis played and modified using data blocks in the CPU pre viously defined in the user program. Information is writ ten to and read out from va lues (data) stored in the data blocks is possible during ope ration. A display can be re quested in the user program by setting flags or on the TD 390 by calling and scrolling with the membrane keys.
The system texts are stored in the TD 390 in German, En glish, French, Spanish and Italian.
Technical specifications
Display Backlit LCD 2 lines 20 characters/line 5 mm average max. 24 V external 60 mA 120 mA 0 to 60 _C Transport and storage temperature Degree of protection Dimensions (W x H x D) in mm S Unit S Panel cutout Standard size (W x H) S Thickness of cabinet/ control panel Weight -40 to 70 _C IP 65 at the front 144 x 72 x 27 138 x 68 max. 4 0.25 kg
Ambient temperature
Ordering data
TD 390 text display incl. product manual (German, English, French, Spa nish, Italian)
Siemens ST 50 1998
3/99
Fig. 4/1
The SIMATIC S5135U and S5155U programmable con trollers are multiprocessor controllers intended for au tomation tasks in the medium and upper performance lev els. They provide a simple and economical solution for all automation tasks such as
S S S S S S
Openloop control Closedloop control and computation Communication Operator control and pro cess monitoring Signalling and logging Data processing
The controllers are therefore suitable for: S Machine control systems S Process automation S Process monitoring S Coordinating functions The standardized hardware technology, modular design of the PLCs and high perfor mance capabilities of the pro gramming device result in the following features: S5135U programmable controller The S5135U is a multipro cessor programmable control ler with special-purpose cen tral processors (CPUs) which are available in various com binations, each with its own program memory: S CPU 928B, optimized for fast bit and word processing as well as serial pointtopoint commu nication S CPU 928, optimized for open and closedloop control tasks
Easy use thanks to simple assembly of the modules and connection to I/O mod ules Simple adaptability of the various process signals be cause of different input/out put voltages of the I/O mod ules Analog process signals can also be adapted via I/O modules Extradiscrete modular as sembly using different I/O modules Simple programming by structuring the program and using standardized program sections (function blocks) Offloading of the central processors and user pro gram through the use of in telligent I/O modules (e.g. digital position decoder, valve control module)
Simple communication with other programmable con trollers and computers by means of internal commu nications processors and bus systems S Easy system startup by means of programming de vices and service units with extensive programming and debugging aids
S
The programming language used is STEP 5 with the fol lowing methods of representa tion: Control system flowchart CSF S Ladder diagram LAD S Statement list STL
S
CPU 922, optimized for arithmetic op erations, closedloop con trol, monitoring and report ing
dently of the others. This in creases the overall proces sing speed. Each processor can be started independently of the others.
Each CPU uses the same op erations set and is optimized for its particular tasks. By using a number of CPUs, the automation task can be broken down into manageable parts. Each processor exe cutes its program indepen
4/2
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
The S5155U programmable controller is therefore the most powerful PLC in the SIMATIC S5 system.
The S5155U programmable controller S has a high processing speed and S offers the largest memory expansion.
The S5155H consists of 2 ZG 135U/155U central con trollers (same hardware and software). Both central controllers work together in dynamic 1 out of 2 structure (hotstandby).
S S S
CPU 928, optimized for openloop and closedloop control tasks CPU 922, primarily for cal culation, closedloop con trol, monitoring and report ing Coordinator, required where more than one CPU is in use External memory: CP 516 memory submodule Communications processors for connecting human-ma chine interfaces and periph eral devices as well as for connection to local area net works
Modules for the input and output of binary and analog signals S CP 581 integrated PC S Intelligent I/O modules S Interface modules for con necting expansion units and distributed I/Os and field devices
S
Expansion units
If there are not enough slots available in the central con troller, or if certain modules are to be deliberately located elsewhere, expansion units can be connected to the cen tral controller. Centralized ex pansion units are located di rect at the central controller or in a cabinet next to it. Distributed expansion units can be located up to 3000 m (9840 ft) from the central con troller. Additional centralized expansion units can be con nected to the distributed ex pansion units.
An expansion unit can be equipped with the following modules depending on de sign and requirements:
S
Communications processors for connecting humanma chineinterfaces, personal computers (PCs) and pe ripheral devices as well as for connection to local area networks
Modules for the input and output of binary and analog signals S CP 581 integrated PC S Intelligent I/O modules S Interface modules for con nection to the central con troller or additional expan sion units
S
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/3
A coordinator assigns access to the internal S5 bus to the CPUs. The necessary in formation exchange between the CPUs is also handled by the coordinator.
Internal S5 bus
memory submodules, com munications processors, inter faces and input/output mod ules is conducted over this bus. the expansion units behave in exactly the same way for the user as modules in the central controller. The PROFIBUSDP field bus can be designed with a spe cial interface module.
If several CPUs are in use, a coordinator controls access to the internal S5 bus.
Interface modules
A feature of this LAN is fast cyclical communication and enables simple connection of distributed I/O stations and field devices to the automa tion system.
Communications processors
This offloads the CPU of time intensive communications tasks. The necessary data for texts and images can be stored in each communications pro cessor's own RAM or EPROM submodule.
In addition, communications processors can be used to configure the SINEC L1, PROFIBUS and Industrial Ethernet LANs and to connect programmable controllers to the LAN.
The input/output modules and the intelligent I/O modules constitute the link between the programmable controller and the process. They can be plugged into the central con troller and the expansion units.
4/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
IM 312-3
IM 312-5
EU 183U
EU 184U EU 187U
IM 300-3
IM 300-5
CC 135U/155U
UU 135U/155U
Fig. 4/2
Distributed configuration In a distributed configuration, the expansion units are in stalled at a distance of up to 3000 m (9840 ft) from the cen tral controller. Four additional expansion units can be con nected in a distributed config uration to each distributed ex pansion unit. Expansion units of the S5115U and the distributed I/O and field devices can also be connected.
IM 31.
EU 183U EU 185U
IM 30.
CC 135/155U
Fig. 4/3
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/5
Module slots
Wiring duct for signal cables Power supply chassis with fans (can be replaced without removing battery) Indicators and controls
Backup battery
Fig. 4/4
Mechanical features of the ZG 135U/155U central controller for the S5-135U and S5-155U programmable controllers
The central controllers and expansion units consist of a compact housing with Power supply chassis with 3 fans and a lithium backup battery as well as a storage battery (for the RAM) S 21 (or 20 or 11) module slots
S
Power supply chassis The power supply chassis with 3 fans is located in a tier in the bottom part of the hous ing. The input voltage is either 24 V DC or 230/120 V AC. An internal switch is provided for selecting either 230 V or 120 V AC. Output voltages for the inter nal power supply to the mod ules: 5 V DC (10 A, 18 A, 40 A; shortcircuit protected), with jacks for measuring current, 24 V DC (0.4 A, 0.5 A, 1 A, 2 A; fused), with jacks for measuring voltage 15 V DC Monitoring facilities (with LED indicators) are provided for: S Input voltage (no indication) S 5 V output voltage S 15 V, 24 V output voltage S 3.4 V backup battery volt age S Airflow for the fans S 24 V load voltage (external)
All screw terminals on the power supply chassis are in tended for conductors of up to 4 mm2 crosssection. Backup battery A lithium backup battery with storage battery as reserve is provided to supply power to all RAMs in the event of a power failure. Two jacks are provided for ex ternal input of the backup voltage. This allows the backup battery to be re placed without interrupting the backup voltage, even when the input voltage is switched off. The power sup ply chassis can be replaced without interrupting the backup supply.
The backup battery is not re quired in expansion units. Ex pansion units are also avail able without the power supply chassis or fans. Housing The housing consists of bolted sheetsteel sections with ventilation openings at the top and bottom. The slots have socket connectors and guides to accommodate the modules. A wiring duct for signal cables runs along the front, beneath the modules and above the power supply chas sis.
4/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Extraction handle
Fig. 4/6
Address label
LED
Fig. 4/7
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/7
Screw terminals
Fig. 4/8
Principle of operation
The principle of operation of the S5135U and S5155U programmable controllers is largely governed by the com ponents "program memory" and "processor". In the S5155H faulttolerant programmable controller, the redundancy functions are an additional factor (see page 4/18). Program memory The program contains the user program. Processor The processor operates cycli cally: At the beginning of the cycle, the processor reads the sig nal states of all inputs and stores them in a process input image (PII). The program is then executed step by step. The processor stores the cal culated signal states in a pro cess output image (POI). At the end of the cycle, the processor writes the signal states into the outputs. The cycle can be stopped by interrupts (process and time interrupts).
Inputs 0 1 PII 0
Read inputs
Execute program
Coun ter
Write outputs
Program memory 0
Fig. 4/9
4/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
LAD
E1.1 E1.2
The programming language for SIMATIC S5 program mable controllers is STEP 5 (see Section 7) in one of the following representations: Programming devices The following programming devices can be used for pro gramming the S5135U and the S5155U/H programmable controllers: S PG 720, PG 720P S PG 740
CSF Control System Flowchart S LAD Ladder Diagram S STL Statement List
S
Programs for sequence con trol systems can be entered clearly in the form of a flow diagram using GRAPH 5 (see Section 7). A printer can be connected to the programming device for program documenting.
S S
The programming devices have operator prompting to facilitate programming and aids for debugging and sys tem startup.
S
Program input
There are two ways of ente ring the program: S Direct program entry to the CPU in the central controller (online programming)
Programming the memory cards or memory submo dules (EPROM or EEPROM) in the programming device without connecting it to the PLC.
The memory card or me mory submodule is then plugged into the central controller (offline program ming).
Program execution
Cyclic program execution The blocks of the user pro gram are executed in the se quence specified in the orga nization block. Interruptdriven program execution When certain input signal changes occur, cyclic execu tion is interrupted at the next statement and an organization block assigned to this
event is started. The user can formulate his response pro gram to this interrupt in this organization block. Cyclic program execution is then re sumed at the point at which it was interrupted. Timecontrolled program execution An organization block is called after a preset time (time interrupt). Organization
blocks are available. Times between 10 ms and 20 min can be set for each organiza tion block. This makes it pos sible for certain parts of the program to be processed in dependently of the scan time.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/9
PC
S5-135U S5-155U/H
HMI
Printer
Fig. 4/11 Interfacing the programmable controller with PC, HMI devices and printer
SINEC L1 bus system The SINEC L1 bus system (Siemens Network Commu nication Low Range) provides a simple solution to the con figuring of small, distributed automation systems on the lower level of communications technology. The following PLCs can be connected to this bus system: S590U, S595U/F, S5100U, S5115U/H/F, S5135U and S5155U/H.
Features Up to 31 nodes Baud rate 9.6 kbit/s Max. coverage 50 km (31 miles) S Transmission medium: twisted pair cable
S S S
PROFIBUS bus system See Section 10. Industrial Ethernet bus system See Section 10.
4/10
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
During product planning During product development During production In product operation
Product planning The product planning phase covers all the activities from market research to type spe cification. Quality assurance in the product planning phase ensures that the SIMATIC S5 product conforms to the high standards of quality required on the market. Product development and production The following are some exam ples of routine quality assur ance precautions taken dur ing development and pro duction: S Use of highquality compo nents
S S
Worstcase design of all cir cuits Systematic and computer controlled testing of all com ponents supplied by sub contractors Burnin of all LSI circuits, e.g. processors and memo ries. Burning in is an aging process which helps to re duce the number of failures early in a product's life. The components are subjected to a high temperature for several hours in a burnin cubicle Measures to prevent static charge building up when handling MOS circuits Visual inspections at various stages of production Incircuit testing of all mod ules, i.e. computeraided testing of all components and their interaction with other components in the complete circuit Continuous heatrun test at elevated ambient tempera ture over a period of several days
Careful computercontrolled final testing S Statistical evaluation of all failures to enable the im mediate initiation of suitable corrective measures
S
Product operation Even when the SIMATIC S5 products are in operation on the customer's premises, they are still under constant super vision. Extensive quality con trol precautions are taken in the following areas: S Stockkeeping and dispatch S Service S Field observation Established methods are used in all these areas, which operate precisely, punctually and conscientiously, whilst also remaining flexible for special customer require ments. Sometimes an even higher level of faulttolerance or safety is required than that normally offered by the SIMATIC S5 U range. Fault tolerant or failsafe program mable controllers, such as the S5115H or the S5115F are available for this purpose.
Availability
Availability is the probability of finding a system in a func Safety is defined by DIN 31000 as "A state of lower risk than the permitted limit". The "permitted limit is the maximum acceptable
tional state at a specified point in time. degree of risk for a specific plant". The plantspecific de gree of risk may be stipu lated by law, by the plant operator or by an indepen dent body of experts, e.g. the German Technical Inspector ate (TV).
Safety
Installation guidelines SIMATIC programmable con trollers are designed for use in harsh industrial environ ments. To ensure correct op eration of the equipment, it must be installed and con nected in accordance with certain rules. Certain prin ciples must also be observed as regards wiring, earthing and shielding. Timely planning of the neces sary measures for improving the electromagnetic compati bility (EMC) of the program mable controllers is advisable in order to avoid retrofitting. These rules are explained in the section entitled "Installa tion guidelines" in the relevant product manuals. For the installation of failsafe controls, the relevant regula tions must be observed.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/11
In many fields of automation, increasingly high demands are being placed on the avail ability and faulttolerance of programmable controllers (PLCs). Particularly in fields where a plant shutdown would be extremely expensive. In such cases, only redundant systems can offer the stan dard of availability required. Faulttolerant systems con tinue to work in all likelihood when one or more parts of the control fail.
The S5155H/S5155H Lite programmable controller con sists of two interlinked central controllers. It operates on the "master/slave" principle. One subunit, the master, controls the process. If a fault occurs, the other subunit, the slave, takes over control. This ensures a high degree of faulttolerance, which makes the S5155H/S5155H Lite programmable controller es pecially suitable for applica tions in the following fields:
Fields with predominantly continuous processes, e.g.: S Refineries S Chemicals S Power stations S Steelworks S Environmental protection (e.g. water treatment) S Pipelines S Offshore installations Areas of production employ ing batch processes, e.g.: S The automotive industry S The pharmaceutical industry S The food industry S In plants with flexible manufacturing systems S In highbay warehouses
4/12
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Singlechannel
Threechannel inputs
Singlesided configuration
Switched configuration
Normal availability
Enhanced availability
High availability
Maximum availability
In the S5155H/S5155H Lite programmable controller the central functions are always implemented in a redundant configuration. S5-155H Configured with CPU 948R S5-155H Lite Configured with CPU 948RL The I/Os can, however, also be configured with redun dancy. The two subunits of the S5155H/S5155H Lite pro grammable controller are both equipped with the same hard ware and software and inter linked via the IM 304 and IM 324R interface modules (for linking central controllers) and the 721 connecting cable.
Three different levels of avail ability are possible, depend ing on the arrangement of the I/O modules: S Normal availability (single sided configuration) S Enhanced availability (switched configuration) S Maximum availability (fully redundant configuration) Full redundancy of the S5155H/S5155H Lite is im plemented with S Twochannel configuration of inputs and outputs S Threechannel input configu ration Fig. 4/13 shows the configu rations for the three levels of availability.
The different levels of avail ability can be combined as required. The performance capability, user convenience and other technical features of the S5115H/S5155H Lite fault tolerant programmable con troller correspond to a large extent to the features of the S5155U.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/13
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 30.
Subunit B
IM 304
Expansion unit
IM 31.
In the event of a failure, the I/Os connected to the subunit concerned are also out of ac tion.
This configuration is used for sections of a plant which do not require enhanced avail ability.
In the switched configuration (see Fig. 4/15) the I/Os are connected in singlechannel mode, but they can be ad dressed by both subunits. The I/Os in this configuration must always be plugged into an EG 185U expansion unit. Up to 16 expansion units can be connected in switched configuration, distributed be tween up to 8 I/O bus lines. Expansion units in switched configuration are connected via the IM 304 interface mod ule in the central controller and the IM 314R interface module in the expansion unit. The expansion units can also be expanded in a centralized configuration via the IM 300 interface module.
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
IM 314R
To further expansion units
Expansion units in switched configuration are connected to both subunits and are ad dressed by the one currently acting as master.
This configuration is employed when failure of indi vidual I/Os is not crucial.
4/14
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
IM 31.
IM 31.
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
Expansion unit
IM 314R
The following can be con nected to the central control ler: EG 184U EG 185U EG 187U ET 100U electronic terminator S ET 200 distributed I/O system
S S S S
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/15
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
Expansion unit
IM 314R
Intelligent I/O modules (IPs) and communications proces sors (CPs) can also have re dundant configuration. Switched redundant configuration The IPs and CPs can be plugged into expansion units of switched configuration. Twochannel redundant configuration The CPs can additionally be plugged into the two subunits. Selection criteria The type of configuration which is most favorable de pends on the type of applica tion.
Advantages of the switched redundant configuration: In the case of a central con troller failure, the IPs/CPs re main redundant S In the case of an IP/CP fail ure, the central controllers remain highly fault tolerant S Shorter scan time
S
Advantages of the twochan nel redundant configuration: No switched expansion units required S If the CPs are to be re paired, only redundant com ponents have to be discon nected from the power supply
S
Disadvantages of the switched redundant configu ration: S At least two switched expan sion units required S If the IPs/CPs are to be re paired, the corresponding expansion unit must be switched off. This means that all other I/O modules in this expansion unit are out of operation
Disadvantages of the two channel redundant configura tion: S Longer scan time
4/16
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Subunit A
IM 324R IM 304
Subunit B
IM 304
IM 314R
To partner
IM 314R
Subunit A
IM 324R
Subunit B
IM 304
IP/CP
IP/CP
To partner
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/17
Subunit A
Subunit B
Sensor
Actuator
Twochanel I/O configuration (fully redundant configura tion) Both subunits control the process in parallel. The standby also issues output signals and reads in input signals. For further details, please refer to Section 11 (Configuring) S Threechannel I/O configu ration (fully redundant con figuration). The combined operation of both subunits corresponds to the twochannel I/O con figuration
S
For operation in this mode it is absolutely essential that both subunits should be able to ex change data quickly and relia bly. In the S5155H/S5155H Lite the two subunits are nor mally linked by the central controller interface via which they are both supplied with: S The same user program S The same data blocks S The same process I/O image contents S The same receive buffer contents, e.g. when using communications processors The standby unit is therefore always up to date and ready to take over control immedi ately if a fault occurs.
Hotstandby Hotstandby is the ability to switch over to a standby de vice in the event of a fault au tomatically and without detri mental effect.
4/18
Siemens ST 50 1998
General
Selftest
Every fault recognized by selftest is reported. Selftest on restart Each subunit runs through all the selftest functions on re start.
Selftest in cyclic operation For cyclic operation the oper ating system breaks down the selftest functions into short sections approximately 5 ms long. One or more of these is processed in a cycle. The number of sections per cycle is configured by the user.
Operating modes
Fault detection with fault locating For uninterrupted operation, the operating system must be able not only to detect faults but also to locate them, in or der to deactivate the faulty module (by switching off the load voltage, in the case of outputs). This operating mode can be used for both digital input and output modules. Advantages of this operating mode: S In the event of a fault, the programmable controller S5155H/S5155H Lite con tinues to operate with the module which is functioning correctly S Faults can be corrected more quickly and easily
In the twochannel redundant I/O configuration, the operat ing system is responsible for the software side of fault lo cating. On the hardware side, locating inputs and outputs (LDls and LDOs) are re quired. In the threechannel redun dant input configuration, fault detection takes place by fault locating with a choice of two out of three. For further information regard ing the principle of operation of the faulttolerant S5155H/ S5155H Lite programmable controller, see Section 11 (Configuring).
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/19
On-line programming
Programming device
Subunit A
Memory card
Subunit B
Generation of the parameter assignment data block from the parameter assignment data S System diagnostics using the error data blocks and the interrupt register S Printout of data specific to the H version
S
4/20
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The module contains the follo wing: S Microprocessor (ASIC) for processing binary state ments and for highspeed processing of a number of selected word statements S Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing word statements and the operating program of the module S Microprocessor (8 bit) for processing the program ming device port S Memory (RAM) for bit me mories, timers, counters, process image, etc. S Internal memory: 64 Kbyte for the user pro gram and 46 Kbyte (RAM) for data of the user program (data blocks) S Receptacle for SIMATIC memory card (FLASH EPROM) for max. 64 Kbyte user program. STEP 5 V6.6 and higher is required for programming and erasing the memory card.
S S S
S S
Programming device port (15way Cannon socket) Shift register (246 x 8 bit) with high processing speed Operating program for cy clic, time and processcon trolled processing and error handling Software for multiprocessor communication Closedloop controller algo rithm (e.g. for pressure, tem perature or flow control) with the following features: Out put signal as manipulated variable or change in manip ulated variable, parameter ization via data block (fixed or variable values), limiting the output signal (high and low limits)
Depending on the job to be done, one to four CPUs 928 can be used in a central con troller of the S5135U or S5155U programmable con trollers, which are also suit able for multiprocessor opera tion with the following CPUs:
S
CPU 948, CPU 928B, CPU 928 in the central con troller of the S5135U/155U.
Both timecontrolled (clock: 10, 20, 100, 200, 500, 1000, 2000 and 5000 ms) and inter ruptdriven program execu tion are possible.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/23
The following startup is possible if block DX 0 is programmed accordingly: Automatic restart After voltage recovery the CPU returns automatically to the operating state. The other data is as listed under cold restart with reset, manual.
Technical specifications
Microprocessors Memory space S RAM internal (for data blocks only) S RAM internal or Memory card (flash EPROM); for program max. Execution time for S 1 K binary statements (AND, OR) S 1 K digital statements (load, transfer) S 8 control loops Number of control loops max. 8031 (8 bit) 80186 (16 bit), ASIC Outputs 46 Kbyte analog additional additional digital additional additional additional analog additional additional Program execution max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. 192 256 for direct memory access 1) 32,130 for page addressing 2) 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access1) 518,152 for page addressing 2) 192 256 for direct memory access 1) 32,130 for page addressing 2) S Cycle (OB1) S Interruptdriven S Timecontrolled in 9 clock pulses 0.6 A 0.2 A 3W 1 slot approx. approx. 0.5 kg (1.1 lb) 0.04 kg (0.088 lb)
64 Kbyte
1.1 ms 15 ms 20 ms 64 with standard function block "R64 controller structure (see Section 7) 2048 256 0.01 ... 9990 s 256 0 ... 999 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access 1) 518,152 for page addressing 2)
Current consumption (at 5 V) S CPU 928A max. S Memory card max. Power loss max. Space requirement Weight S CPU 928 S Memory submodule
1) Only with IM 304, IM307, IM 308 interface modules. 2) Only with IM 308 interface module (theoretical end value).
Ordering data
CPU 928 with receptacle for 1 memory submodule System manual, programming guide, manual
Order No. 6ES5 928-3UA21 Memory card with flash EPROMs 128 Kbyte (only 64 Kbyte usable)
4/24
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
S S
Programming device port (15way Cannon socket) Receptacle for interface module; the following can be installed: Second interface for pro gramming device and oper ator panel; V.24 interface; TTY interface; RS 422 A interface for point topoint connections; SINEC L1 interface Shift register (246 x 8 bit) with high processing speed Hardware clock Operating program for cy clic, time and processcon trolled processing and error handling
S S
Driver for 3964, 3964R, RK512, "open driver" Special functions for cycle statistics
Arithmetic unit, micropro grammed, with bit and word processor (16 bit), for high speed processing of binary and word statements Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the operating program of the module Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the builtin inter face and the second op tional serial interface Memory (RAM) for bit me mories, S bit memories, tim ers, counters, process image, etc. Internal memory: 64 Kbyte for the user pro gram and 46 Kbyte (RAM) for data of the user program (data blocks) Receptacle for SIMATIC memory card (FLASH EPROM) for max. 64 Kbyte user program. STEP 5 V6.6 and higher is required for programming and erasing the memory card.
Depending on the job to be done, one to four CPUs 928B can be used in a S5135U/ 155U central controller, which are also suitable for multipro cessor operation with the following CPUs:
S
S S S
CPU 922, CPU 928, CPU 948 in the central con troller of the S5135U/155U
Software for multiprocessor communication S Closedloop controller algo rithm (e.g. for pressure, tem perature or flow control) with the following features: Out put signal as manipulated variable or change in manip ulated variable, parameter ization via data block (fixed or variable values), limiting the output signal (high and low limits)
S
The CPU 928B functions on the same basis as, and is up wardscompatible with, the CPU 928. All STEP 5 com mands for the CPU 928 can execute without modification on the CPU 928B.
Restart modes Cold restart with reset, manual Warm restart, manual All bit memories, timers and counters are reset and the process image erased. Scanning of the user program starts at the beginning. The bit memories, timers, counters and the process image are retained during the downtime. Scanning of the user program continues at the point of interruption. Following power recovery, the CPU automatically enters the RUN mode. The other data is as listed under warm restart, manual. All memory areas are erased. The programmable controller enters the basic state. If a RAM is used, the user program must be loaded. If an EPROM is used, a cold restart with reset is possible. The overall reset function can be triggered by a switch on the processor or from the programming device.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/25
Technical specifications
Microprocessors Memory space S RAM internal (for data blocks only) S RAM internal or Memory card (flash EPROM); for program max. Execution time for S 1 K binary statements S 1 K word statements S 8 control loops Scan time monitoring Number of control loops max. 80186 (16 bit) 80188 (16 bit) Outputs 46 Kbyte analog additional additional digital additional additional additional analog additional additional Program execution max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. 192 256 for direct memory access 1) 32,130 for page addressing 2) 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access1) 518,152 for page addressing2) 192 256 for direct memory access1) 32,130 for page addressing 2) S Cycle (OB1) S Interruptdriven S Timecontrolled in 9 clock pulses S Clockcontrolled 0.6 A 0.2 A 0.1 A 0.1 ... 0.2 A 3W 1 slot approx. approx. 0.5 kg (1.1 lb) 0.04 kg (0.088 lb)
64 Kbyte 0.6 ms 1.5 ms 20 ms Programmable, default: 200 ms 64 with standard function block "R 64 controller structure" (see Section 7) 2048 8192 256 0.01 ... 9990 s 256 0 ... 999 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access1) 518,152 for page addressing 2)
Bit memories S bit memories Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Inputs
Current consumption (at 5 V) S CPU 928B typ. S Memory card max. S 377 memory submodule (RAM) max. S Interface modules S Power loss max. Space requirements Weight S CPU 928B S Memory submodule
1) Only with IM 304, IM 307, IM 308 interface modules. 2) Only with IM 308 interface module (theoretical end value). Order No. 6ES5 928-3UB21 Memory card with flash EPROMs 128 Kbyte (only 64 Kbyte usable) Interface module for 20 mA current loop (TTY) for V.24 (RS 232C) for RS 422A/RS 485 for SINEC L1 COM PP parameter assignment software Order No. 6ES5 374-2KG21
Ordering data
CPU 928 B with receptacle for 1 memory submodule and receptacle for 1 interface module System manual, programming guide, communications manual, instruction manual
6ES5 752-0AA12 6ES5 752-0AA23 6ES5 752-0AA43 6ES5 752-0AA53 6ES5 752-0AA62 see Section 7
4/26
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The module contains the follo wing: S STEP 5 processing unit (with 2 ASICs) for processing the user program S Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the operating system of the module S Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the builtin inter face and the second op tional serial interface S Memory (RAM) for bit me mories, S bit memories, tim ers, counters, process image, etc. S Internal memory (RAM) with 640 or 1664 Kbyte for the user program S Receptacle for SIMATIC memory card (flash EPROMs) S Hardware clock Program execution Cyclic program execution; Readin of input statuses, execution of the control pro gram and output of the out put statuses S Timecontrolled program execution; 9 independent timecontrolled program execution levels. The time of processing can be defined separately for each level. Times between 10 ms and 20 min can be set. A time controlled timed interrupt is also available S Interruptcontrolled program execution; via interrupts or process alarms; 4 interrupts via signal lines of the internal S5 backplane bus; 8 process alarms via input byte IB 0
S
Interfaces 1. Builtin serial interface (TTY) for programming device or operator panel 2. Slot for interface module for programming device; V.24 interface; TTY interface; RS 422 A interface for pointtopoint connections; SINEC L1 interface Depending on the job to be done, up to 4 CPUs 948 can be used in a central controller of the S5155U programmable controller; they are also suit able for multiprocessor op eration with CPU 948B, CPU 928 and CPU 922.
S
The user programs can be stored in the integral RAM (640 or 1664 Kbyte). If neces sary, the programming device can be used to store the user program on a flash EPROM to protect it from power failures. The CPU 948 is fully compa tible with the CPUs 946/947. It is not necessary to modify existing programs.
Functions
Time interruptcontrolled program processing; This execution level is acti vated after expiry of a pro grammed time (time resolu tion: 1 ms)
Including, for example, RAM test, BASP (output disable) test and clock test
Execution levels of higher priority can interrupt execu tion levels of lower priority af ter each STEP 5 operation. Monitoring S Scan time S Collision of two timed inter rupts S Addressing error S Acknowledgement delay Time
S S
Further functions S Easy access to the ex tended I/O area via function block FB 196 (contained in the "Basic functions" pro gram package, (see Section 7) S Programming device func tions via the internal S5 backplane bus, thus provid ing fast program loading via the Industrial Ethernet bus system S Password protection of the user program
Integral function blocks Including, for example S Disable or delay interrupts S Delete or generate blocks S Transfer process images S Copy data blocks
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/27
The following startup is possible if block DX 0 is programmed accordingly: Cold restart, automatic Following power recovery, the programmable controller automatically enters the RUN mode. The other data is as listed under cold restart with reset, manual. The bit memories, timers, counters and the process image are retained during the downtime. Scanning of the user program continues at the point of interruption. Following power recovery, the programmable controller automatically enters the RUN mode. The other data is as listed under cold restart with memory, manual.
Cold restart with memory, manual Cold restart with memory, automatic
Technical specifications
Microprocessors Total memory space S Internal memory S Memory submodule (flash EPROM) Programming language Block types 80186 (16 bit) 80188 (16 bit), 2 ASICs 640 Kbyte or 1664 Kbyte 640 Kbyte or 1164 Kbyte STEP 5, SCL Organization blocks (OB), Programming blocks (PB), Function blocks (FB, FX), Data blocks (DB, DX) max. 256 per block type 60 S S S S Cyclic (OB1) Interruptdriven Timecontrolled Operatorcontrolled stop Outputs digital additional additional additional analog additional additional Bit memories S bit memories Nesting levels Timers S Number S Range Counters S Number S Range Interfaces 1st interface (integral) 2nd interface (optional) Current consumption (at 5 V) S CPU 948 max. S Memory card max. S Interface module max. Power loss max. Space requirements Weight S CPU 928 S Memory submodule approx. approx. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access1) 518152 for page addressing 2) 192 256 for direct memory access 1) 32,130 for page addressing 2) 2048 32768 8 256 0.01 ... 9990 s 256 0 ... 999 programming device/operator paneldepending on interface module used 3.6 A 0.2 A 0.1 ... 0.2 A 20 W 2 slots 1 kg (2.2 lb) 0.06 kg (0.13 lb)
Execution times for S Bit operations S Word operations S Time/counter operations S Fixedpoint addition S Floatingpoint addition Scan time monitoring Inputs digital additional additional additional analog additional additional max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
0.18 ms 0.5 ms 0.18 ms 0.55 ms 3.3 ms Programmable, default: 200 ms 1024 with process image 3072 without process image 4096 for direct memory access 1) 518,152 for page addressing 2) 192 256 for direct memory access 1) 32,130 for page addressing 2)
1) Only with IM 304, IM 307, IM 308 interface modules. 2) Only with IM 308 interface module (theoretical end value).
4/28
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 752-0AA12 6ES5 752-0AA22 6ES5 752-0AA43 6ES5 752-0AA53 6ES5 752-0AA62 see Section 7
On account of the higher CPU speed, it is necessary to make adjustments to the stan dard function blocks in the case of the intelligent I/O mo dules.
Module
Please check that the version numbers of your standard function block comply with the required minimum version, by referring to the following table.
FB numbers concerned 167 to 173 156 to 158 178 to 182 183, 184 160, 161 162 164, 165 164, 165 100, 101 170 171 (no FB)
Standard FB can be used from V 2.2 A 04 A 02 A 03 A 02 A 03, B 03, C 04 A 02 A 02 V 3.0 A 02 Not implementable Implementable due to direct access
IP 240 IP 241 IP 242 A (...1AA3.) IP 242 B (...1AA41) IP 243 IP 244 IP 246 IP 247 IP 252 IP 260 IP 261 IP 281
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/29
Design
923A coordinator The module contains the fol lowing: S Memory (RAM) for 2048 in terprocessor communication bit memories S Clock generator and scaler for producing the time base on which access to the S5 bus is allocated among the CPUs 923C coordinator The module contains the fol lowing: S RAM for 2048 interprocessor communication bit memories and for data blocks
Clock generator and scaler for producing the time base on which the internal S5 backplane bus is allocated to the CPUs S Central programming device port with multiplexer: With the programming de vice connected to a 923C coordinator, the user can program up to eight proces sors without changing the front connectors
S
For programming a program mable controller via the Indus trial Ethernet, PROFIBUS and SINEC L1 local area network, the programming device ports of the 923C coordinator and the CP 143, CP 5430 or CP 530 communications proces sors need to be linked by means of the 725 connecting cable. The central programming de vice interface can only be op erated if the S5DOS operat ing system is loaded in the programming device.
Principle of operation
Each CPU communicates with the input and output modules via the internal S5 backplane bus. The coordinator allocates access rights to the S5 back
plane bus to each CPU in cy cles (timesharing). The allo cation sequence is fixed (CPU 1 CPU 2 CPU 3 CPU 4).
The CPUs can exchange in formation via interprocessor communication bit memories in the coordinator.
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S 923A coordinator max. S 923C coordinator max. Power loss S 923A coordinator S 923C coordinator max. max. 0.5 A 1.1 A 2.5 W 6W Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot 0.3 kg (0.7 lb)
Ordering data
923A coordinator The operating instructions are included in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155). 923C coordinator The operating instructions are included in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155).
Order No. 6ES5 923-3UA11 725 connecting cable for connecting 923C coordinator to the CP 143 or CP 530 commu nications processor 0.9 m (3 ft) 2.5 m (8 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 923-3UC11
4/30
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The CPU 948R/RL differs only in its firmware from the CPU 948 for the S5155U program mable controller. You must plug in a CPU 948R/RL into both subunits of the S5155H/ -155H Lite faulttolerant pro grammable controller. The module contains the fol lowing: S STEP 5 processing unit (with 2 ASICs) for processing the user program
Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the operating system of the module S Microprocessor (16 bit) for processing the builtin serial interface S Internal memory (RAM) with 128, 640 or 1664 Kbyte for the user program (355 memory submodule and RAM memory submodules are no longer required)
S
Memory (highspeed RAM) for bit memories, S bit me mories, timers, counters, process image, etc. S Receptacle for memory card (flash EPROMs, nonvolatile and electrically erasable) S Hardware clock S Builtin serial interface (TTY) for programming device or operator panel
S
The CPU 948R requires 2 slots. It can be plugged into the ZG 135U/155U central controller. Multiprocessor operation as with the CPU 948 is not pos sible with the CPU 948RL. The additional functions (selftest, synchronization, fault locat ing) increase the execution time by 5 to 15 %.
Principle of operation
Depending on the application, the central processing unit executes the user program ei ther cyclically, timecon trolled, interruptcontrolled or time interruptcontrolled. The firmware executes all addi tional functions of the fault tol erant programmable controller S5155H/-155H Lite automati cally. Eventdriven synchroniza tion S Transparent programming S Any combination of 1, 2 and 3channel I/O configu ration (3channel configura tion only for inputs) S Support of redundant analog inputs and outputs with fault detection and fault locating
S
These functions include the following: S Data exchange S Synchronization of the two subunits S Selftest S Fault handling (switchover to standby unit) S Fault locating
Functions
Comprehensive selftest functions S Comprehensive system diagnostics functions S Singlechannel and redun dant connection to the SINEC L1, PROFIBUS and Industrial Ethernet LANs S Singlechannel and redun dant connection to the PROFIBUSDP field bus
S
Programming device func tions via the Industrial Ether net LAN
For further information on functions, program execution and restart modes, refer to the description of the CPU 948 on page 4/27.
Programming
In addition to programming in STEP 5, the CPU 948R/RL can also be programmed with the SCL compiler in the SCL pro gramming language. The SCL highlevel language is a pro gramming language similar to PASCAL which has been opti mized for PLC applications.
SCL can be used for pro gramming complex tasks sim ply and easily in the SIMATIC S5. The SCL compi ler is integrated in the STEP 5 basic package S5DOS/MT, Version 6.
The user programs can be stored in the integral RAM (128, 640 or 1664 Kbyte). If necessary, the programming device can be used to store the user program on a flash EPROM to protect it from power failures. For this pur pose, a programming adapter is required.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/31
additional additional Outputs digital additional additional additional analog CPU 948RL additional additional Bit memories/S bit memories Timers S Number/Range Counters S Number/Range
max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
Execution times for S Bit operations S Word operations S Timer/counter operations S Fixedpoint addition S Floatingpoint addition Basic cycle time Scan time monitoring Inputs digital additional additional additional max. max. max. max. typ.
0.18 s 0.5 s 14/0.18 s 0.55 s 3.3 s 10 ms (CPU 948R) 20 ms (CPU 948RL) Programmable, default: 200 ms 1024 with process image (1, 2 or 3channel)2) 3072 without process image (1channel) 6144 for direct memory access (1channel) 518,152 for page addressing1)
Current consumption (at 5 V DC) S CPU 948R max. S Memory card Power loss Space requirements Weight max.
1) Only with IM 308 interface module (theoretical end value). 2) 3channel no possible with CPU 948RL.
Ordering data
CPU 948R For S5155H With 640 Kbyte user memory With 1664 Kbyte user memory CPU 948RL For S5155H Lite With 128 Kbyte user memory Memory card (flash EPROM) 256 Kbyte 1 Mbyte 2 Mbyte ZG 135U/155U subrack 230 V/115 V AC; 5 V, 18 A 230 V/115 V AC; 5 V, 40 A 24 V DC; 5 V, 18 A 24 V DC; 5 V, 40 A ZG 155H subrack 24 V DC; 5 V, 14 A COM 155H parameterization software for configuration and diagnostics of the S5155H faulttolerant PLC on 3 1/2" diskettes, Single license Copy license German English French
Order No. To be ordered as a separate item: S5-155H manual consisting of the S5155H operat ing instructions, the programming instructions and the CPU 948R/RL quick reference German English French S5-135U/155U system manual consisting of the descriptions of the central controllers (CC) and expansion units (EU), the inter face modules (IM), the power supply and the I/Os German English French
Order No.
6ES5 948-3UR51 6ES5 374-2KH21 6ES5 374-2KK21 6ES5 374-2KL21 6ES5 188-3UA12 6ES5 188-3UA22 6ES5 188-3UA32 6ES5 188-3UA52 6ES5 188-3UH31
4/32
Siemens ST 50 1998
24 V DC; 2 A 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 24/48/60 V AC, 2 A 115/230 V AC; 2 A Relay outputs 60 V DC; 0.5 A 250 V AC; 5A Input/output modules Voltage values/ current values 24 V DC (inputs), 24 V DC; 0.5 A (outputs)
Module ID 4824
Page 4/43
Digital input modules Application The digital input modules con vert the external binary sig nals from the process to the internal signal level of the pro grammable controllers.
Design
Digital input modules with 32, 16 and 8 inputs for a range of input voltages are available. The modules require either one or two slots. Enable input The input signals can be dis abled by means of the enable input F. This enable input can be deactivated by removing a jumper on the module.
Front connectors are used for terminating the signal cables. Both modules and front con nectors may be inserted and removed under power. Interrupt processing The 4324 digital input module generates an interrupt when an input signal changes:
S
Green LEDs indicate the sig nal status of the inputs. Adhesive labels are supplied to identify the modules and front connectors.
S
Principle of operation
In the central controller, an interrupt line is provided for each CPU. Modules must be plugged into the central controller
The CPU 948 has a mode of operation available which recognizes an interrupt by scanning the input byte 0. All modules (max. 8) used for interrupt generation must be accommodated in the same unit.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/33
- 3 ... + 7 V + 13 ... + 33 V 7 mA
- 33 ... + 8 V + 13 ... + 72 V 4.5 mA (at 24 V) 6.5 mA (at 48 V) 7.5 mA (at 60 V) 1.4 ... 5 ms 400 m (1312 ft)
- 33 .. +5 V + 13 ... + 33 V 8.5 mA
3 ms/1 ms/0.3 ms 600 m (1968 ft) (3 ms) 200 m (656 ft) (1 ms) 50 m (164 ft) (0.3 ms) 1000 m (3280 ft)
max.
Enable input F Input voltage S Rated value S Enable S Disable Input current of enable input typ. Cable length (unshielded) max. Insulation voltage (external connections to housing) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Supply voltage Vpos S Rated value S Ripple Vpp (referred to rated voltage) S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at <0.1 s Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) Power loss Space requirements Front connector Weight approx.
75 V DC 1250 V AC 24 V DC
75 V DC 1250 V AC
75 V DC 1250 V AC
max.
90 mA 2.2 ... 7.7 W (at 24 ... 60 V) 1 slot 42pin 0.4 kg (0.88 lb)
1) A shielded signal lead is required for use of the module. A filter (SIFI C, B84113CB30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module.
4/34
Siemens ST 50 1998
0 ... 15 V 20 ... 72 V
typ.
15 mA (at 48 V) 20 mA (at 60 V)
max.
Input voltage S Rated value S Enable S Disable Input current of enable input typ. Cable length (unshielded) max. Insulation voltage (External connections to housing) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Supply voltage Vpos S Rated value S Ripple Vpp (referred to rated voltage) S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t < 0.1 s Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V) S External (at 15 V) Power loss Space requirements Front connector Weight approx.
Jumper F+/F in the front connector 5/15/24 V DC + 4 ... + 33 V - 15 ... + 2 V 5 mA 100 m (328 ft) 75 V DC 1250 V AC 24 V DC (L+); 15 V DC (LH+) 250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 1500 V AC
250 V AC 1500 V AC
max.
15 % 20 ... 30 V; 5....15 V 36 V 80 mA 200 mA 300 mA 5.5 W 1 slot 42pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
100 mA
100 mA
80 mA
3.5 W (at 115 V) 17.0 W (at 230 V) 2 slots 20pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
2.0 W (at 115 V) 8.5 W (at 230 V) 2 slots 20pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
1) A filter (SIFI C, B84113CB30 or equivalent) is required in the 230 V AC load power supply for the module. Siemens ST 50 1998
4/35
6ES5 434-4UA12
4/36
Siemens ST 50 1998
L+
F+
L+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
F+ FL+
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
L-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
4L-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
F+ F-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ L1L+
F+ F-
0 1 2 3
1L2L+
4 5 6 7
2L-
3L+
0 1 2 3
3L4L+
4 5 6 7
4L-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6ES5 420-4UA14
L+ F+
6ES5 430-4UA14
F+ F-
6ES5 431-4UA12
F+ F-
6ES5 432-4UA12
F+ F-
L+
110.0 110.1
110.2 110.3 110.4 110.5 110.6 110.7
L-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1N
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1N
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 3 2 1 0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1N
1N
1N
1N
1L
110.0
1L
110.0
1L
110.0
110.1
110.1
2N
110.1
110.2
110.2
2L
110.2
111.3
111.3
3N
111.3
111.1
111.1
3L
111.1
111.3
111.3
4N
111.3
111.5
111.5
4L
111.5
111.7
111.7
2N
2N
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2N
2N
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5N
5N
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 7 6 5 4
2L
211.0
2L
211.0
5L
510.4
211.1
211.1
6N
6N
211.2
211.2
6L
610.5
211.3
211.3
7N
7N
211.4
211.4
7L
710.6
211,5
211,5
8N
8N
211.6
211.6
8L
810.7
211.7
211.7
6ES5 434-4UA12
6ES5 435-4UA12
6ES5 436-4UA12
6ES5 436-4UB12
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/37
Design
Digital output modules with 32, 16 and 8 outputs are available with a range of out put voltages and also with relay contact outputs. The modules require either one or two slots. Front connectors are used for terminating the signal cables. Modules and front connectors may be inserted and removed under power.
Green LEDs indicate the sig nal status of the outputs. In DC output modules, red LEDs indicate shortcircuits in the signal leads. The signal out put H is set to "1" if an over current or shortcircuit is de tected in an output. Up to 16 signal outputs can be con nected in parallel. In AC out put modules, red LEDs indi cate when a fuse has blown.
Principle of operation
4/38
Siemens ST 50 1998
5W Electronic Vpos - 47 V
5W Electronic Vpos - 47 V 100 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz (at 0.3 A) 0.5 Hz (at 0.5 A) 100 % 50 % 0.5 mA +3V Vpos -1.5 V 400 m (1312 ft)
10 W Electronic Vpos - 47 V 100 Hz 11 Hz 0.2 Hz (at 1 A) 0.5 Hz (at 2 A) 100 % 25 % 1 mA +3V Vpos -2.5 V 400 m (1312 ft)
10 W Electronic Vpos - 47 V 100 Hz 11 Hz 0.2 Hz (at 1 A) 0.5 Hz (at 2 A) 50 % 50 % 1 mA +3V Vpos - 2 V 400 m (1312 ft)
20 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz
75 % 50 % 5 mA 0.1 Vp Vpos - 1.5 V 300 m (984 ft) Junper F+/F- in the front connector
Enable input F Input voltage S Rated value S Enable S Disable Input current of enable input typ. Cable length(unshielded) max. Signalling output H Voltage if fault Current if fault (limited) Voltage if no fault min. max. max.
Insulation voltage (external connections to housing) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V, no load) Power loss Space requirements Front connector Weight approx. typ. typ. max.
1) Can also be used as L- switch. 2) 1 input of a digital input module is permissible as the minimum load. 3) Referred to the sum of the rated currents through an L+ input.
4) A shielded signal lead is required for use of the module. A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B-30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module. 5) Due to current load a double wide front connector is required.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/39
max.
Output current at "1 signal S Rated value S Permissible range S Making current per group for t <3/<20/<50 ms max. Lamp load Shortcircuit protection Switch. cap. of the contacts max. S Resistive load With arc suppr. module max. Without arc suppr. module max. S Inductive load With arc suppr. module max. Without arc suppr. module max. Switch. cycl. (VDE 0660, Part 200) Limitation of the voltage induced on circuit interruption (internal) to Switching frequency for S Resistive loads S Lamps S Inductive loads Total load rating 3) S With fan S Without fan Leakage current at "0" sign. Signal level of the outputs S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Cable length (unshielded) Enable input F Input voltage S Rated value S Enable S Disable Input current of enable input Cable length (unshielded) 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) max. max. max. max.
Vpos -75 V 20 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz 75 % 70 % 20 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 50 % 100 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz (at 0.5 A) 100 % 50 % (100 % at 35 _C) 1 mA +3V Vp -2.5 V 400 m (1312 ft) 100 Hz 11 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 100 % 10 Hz 5 Hz 2 Hz 100 % 100 %
5 mA 0.1 Vp Vp - 1.5 V 300 m (984 ft) Jumper F+/F- in the front connector
5 mA 0.1 Vp Vp - 1.5 V 300 m (984 ft) Jumper F+/F- in the front connector
24/48/60 V DC + 13 ... + 72 V - 72 ... + 8 V typ. max. 2.5 ... 6.5 mA 200 m ( 656 ft)
Can also be used as L-switch. For supply voltages higher than 72 V, the output voltage may exceed 13 V ("1" signal) in the nondrive state. Referred to the sum of the rated currents through an L+ input. Up to 500 mA possible with protective circuitry for the load (see operating instructions). A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B-30 or equivalent) is required in the 230 V AC load power supply for the module. A shielded signal lead is required for use of the module. A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B-30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module.
4/40
Siemens ST 50 1998
Insulation voltage (external connections to housing) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested with Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) typ. S External (at 24 V, no load) typ. Power loss max. Space requirements Front connector Weight approx.
250 V AC 1500 V AC 120 mA 250 mA 6.6 W 1 slot 42pin 0.7 kg (1.5 lb)
1) A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B30 or equivalent) is required in the 230 V AC load power supply for the module. 2) A shielded signal lead is required for use of the module. A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module.
Ordering data
Nonfloating 441-4 digital output module 32 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A Floating 451-4 digital output module 32 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A 453-4 digital output module 16 outputs, 24 V DC; 2 A (can also be used as L-switch) 454-4 digital output module 16 outputs, 24 V DC; 2 A 455-4 digital output module 16 outputs, 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 456-4UA digital output module 16 outputs, 115/230 V AC; 2 A 456-4UB digital output module 8 outputs, 115/230 V AC; 2 A 457-4 digital output module 16 outputs, 24/48/60 V DC; 0,5 A (can also be used as L- switch)
Order No. 458-4UA digital output module 16 relaycontact outputs, 60 V; 0.5 V g p module 458-4UC digital output 16 relaycontact outputs, 110 V DC; 250 V AC; 5 A 498 arc-suppression module for the 4584UA.. digital g output p module (RC elements for 4 outputs) The operating instructions are included in the S5-135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155). 6ES5 454-4UA14 497 front connector Crimp terminals, terminals singlewidth, 42pin Crimp terminals, p doublewidth, 42pin Crimp terminals, doublewidth, 20pin Screw terminals, single width, 42pin Screw terminals, double width, 42pin Screw terminals, terminals double width, 25pin (4544 only) Screw terminals, double width, 20pin
6ES5 441-4UA14
6ES5 458-4UC11
6ES5 451-4UA14
6ES5 498-1AB11
6ES5 453-4UA12
6ES5 455-4UA12
6ES5 497-4UA12 6ES5 497-4UA22 6ES5 497-4UA42 6ES5 497-4UB31 6ES5 497-4UB12 6ES5 497-4UB22 497 4UB22
6ES5 456-4UA12
6ES5 456-4UB12
6ES5 457-4UA12
6ES5 497-4UB42
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/41
F+
L+ L-
L-
H+
L+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
LH+
L+
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ L-
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 +1Q0.0 4 -1Q0.0 5 +2Q0.1 6 -2Q0.1 7 +3Q0.2 8 -3Q0.2 9 +4Q0.3 10 -4Q0.3 11 12 +5Q0.4 13 -5Q0.4 14 +6Q0.5 15 -6Q0.5 16 +7Q0.6 17 -7Q0.6 18 +8Q0.7 19 -8Q0.7 20 21 H+ 22 H23 2L+ 24 +9Q1.0 25 -9Q1.0 26 +10Q1.1 27 -10Q1.1 28 +11Q1.2 29 -11Q1.2 30 +12Q1.3 31 -12Q1.3 32 33 +13Q1.4 34 -13Q1.4 35 +14Q1.5 36 -14Q1.5 37 +15Q1.6 38 -15Q1.6 39 +16Q1.7 40 -16Q1.7 41 42
F-
F+
L+ LL+
F+ F1L+ 1Q0.0
0
1Q0.1
1
1Q0.2
2
1Q0.3
3
2Q0.4
4
2Q0.5
5
2Q0.6
6
2Q0.7
L+ L-
2L+
H+
L+
3L+ 3Q1.0
0
3Q1.1
1
3Q1.2
2
3Q1.3
3
4Q1.4
4 5
4Q1.5
4Q1.6
6
4Q1.7
L+
4L+
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
0 1 2 3
4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3
4 5 6 7
6ES5 441-4UA14
6ES5 451-4UA14
6ES5 454-4UA14
F+ F-
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1L
F+ F-
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 3 2 1 0
L+ LL+ 1L 1L 2L 2L 3L 3L 4L 4L
1L
1L
1L
1N
1Q0.0
1N
1Q0.0
1Q0.1
2L
2L
1Q0.2
2N
2Q0.1
3L
3L
2Q0.4
5L 5L 6L 6L 7L 7L 8L 8L L-
3N
3Q0.2
2Q0.5
4L
4L
2Q0.6
4N
4Q0.3
2Q0.7 2L+
2L
2L
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5L
5L
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 7 6 5 4
2N
2Q1.0
5N
5Q0.4
2Q1.1
6L
6L
2Q1.2
6N
6Q0.5
2Q1.3
7L
7L
2Q1.4
7N
7Q0.6
2Q1.5
8L
8L
2Q1.6
8N
8Q0.7
2Q1.7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ L-
F+ F-
1 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 23 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3
1L
1L
1N
1Q0.0
1Q0.1
1Q0.2 1Q0.3
4 5 6 7
L+ L1) 1)
2Q0.4
2Q0.5
2Q0.6
2Q0.7
0 1 2 3
2L
2)
2L
25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2N
2Q1.0
2Q1.1
2Q1.2
2Q1.3
4 5 6 7
2Q1.4
2Q1.5
2Q1.6
2Q1.7
6ES5 456-4UB12
6ES5 458-4UC11
Fig. 4/24 Connection diagrams of digital output modules 1) 24 V DC supply voltage for the relays 2) Voltage for the relay contacts
4/42
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The digital input/output mod ule provides 16 binary inputs and eight binary outputs. Another eight terminals can be used either as inputs or outputs.
Technical specifications
Number of inputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current S At "1 signal Delay S At "0"1 S At "1"0 Cable length S Unshielded Number of outputs Galvanic isolation S In groups of Output current at "1 signal S Rated value S Permissible range Lamp load max. Inductive load max. Shortcircuit protection Limitation of the voltage induced on circuit interruption (internal) to Switching frequency for S Resistive loads S Lamps S Inductive loads Total load rating S With fan S Without fan Leakage current at "0 signal Signal level of the outputs S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Cable length S Unshielded max. max. max. 16 or 24 Yes 16/24 24 V DC - 33 ... + 5 V + 13 ... + 33 V typ. typ. typ. max. 8.5 mA 0.3 ms 0.3 ms 50 m (164 ft) 8 or 16 Yes 8/16 0.5 A 5 mA ... 0.5 A 5W 12 W Electronic Enable input Synchronization input Synchronization output and shortcircuit signalling output S At "0 signal max. 1 signal S At "1 (shortcircuit) min. S Output max. p current . S u p p l y v o lVtpos age (for load) S Rated value S Ripple Vpp (referred to rated voltage) max S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t < 0.1 s Jumper F+/F- in the front connector As for other binary inputs
+3 V Vpos - 5 V 10 mA ( (currentlimited) )
24 V DC max. 15 % 20 ... 30 V 36 V
max.
Insulation voltage (external connections to housing, , other internal connections, groups) S In acc. with VDE 0160 S Tested at Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V, without load) Power loss Space requirements Front connector Weight approx. typ. typ. max.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/43
6ES5 497 - 4UA12 6ES5 497 - 4UA22 6ES5 497 - 4UB31 6ES5 497 - 4UB12
F+ FL+ 1L+ 1Q0.0 1Q0.1 1Q0.2 1Q0.3 1Q0.4 1Q0.5 1Q0.6 1Q0.7 SYN EIN
1I1.0 1Q1.0 1I1.1 1Q1.1 1I1.2 1Q1.2 1I1.3 1Q1.3 1I1.4 1Q1.4 1I1.5 1Q1.5 1I1.6 1Q1.6 1I1.7 1Q1.7
LH+
L-
L-
SYN AUS
1I3.0 1I3.1 1I3.2 1I3.4 1I3.4 1I3.5 1I3.6 1I3.7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6ES5 482-4UA11
Fig. 4/25 Connection diagrams for the 482 digital input/output module
4/44
Siemens ST 50 1998
4663
4/45
Analog input modules Application The analog input modules convert the analog signals from the process into digital values, which can be pro cessed by the programmable controller. Application of analog input modules: S Process monitoring S Measuring physical quanti ties, e.g. in mechanical en gineering, process engi neering, building services automation S Control engineering
Design
Analog input modules with 16, 8 and 4 inputs are available. The modules require one slot. Front connectors are used for terminating the signal cables. Modules and front connectors may be inserted and removed under power (except for the 466 input module). Adhesive labels are supplied to identify modules and front connectors.
460 input module: Eight floating channels Sequential measured value acquisition by means of op tovoltaic multiplexer S Measuring range selection by means of measuring range modules S Direct acquisition of thermo couple voltages S Direct fourwire connection of resistancetype sensors, e.g. Pt 100 S Power supply from L+, L S Use in large plants/ma chines with high common mode voltages S For closedloop control ap plications with time constant ranging from seconds to in finity
S S
463 input module: Four individually isolated channels S Simultaneous scanning of all channels within 162/3 or 20 ms (50 or 60 Hz) S Measuring range selection via jumpers in the front con nector S Acquisition of transducer signals S For fast, noiseimmune mea sured value acquisition even under unfavourable potential conditions S For closedloop control ap plications where speed is a critical factor (time constants >20 ms)
S
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/45
Common features of the 460, 463 and 465 input modules: S Integrating analogdigital conversion with a high de gree of noise suppression at 50 (60) Hz and suppression of harmonics S Enable input and input sig nals can be disabled S The 4604 input modules re quire two 498 measuring range modules S The 4654 input modules re quire two or four 498 mea suring range modules, de pending on whether up to 8 inputs or more than 8 inputs are used
466 input module: Eight differential or 16 indi vidual channels (floating) S Instantaneous value coding S Measuring range selection through fixed wiring at the front connector S For closedloop control ap plications where speed is a critical factor (time constant >4 ms)
S
Technical specifications
Analog input module Number of inputs 6ES5 460-4UA13 8 voltage/current inputs or 8 inputs for Pt 100 resistance thermometers 6ES5 465-4UA132) 16 voltage/current inputs or 8 inputs for Pt 100 resistance thermometers 6ES5 463-4U.12 4 voltage/current inputs
Yes No 12.5 mV (for 4604 only); 50 mV; 500 mV; Pt 100; 1 V; 5 V; 10 V; 20 mA; + 4 ... 20 mA Input range can be selected for 4 channels at a time, using measuring range modules 12.5 mV: y 10 M 50 mV: y 10 M 500 mV: y 10 M Pt 100: y 10 M 1 V: 90 k; 2 5 V: 50 k 2 10 V: 50 k; 2 20 mA: 25 k; 1 4 ... 20 mA: 31.25 ; 1
Yes 0 ... 1 V, 0 ... 10 V, 0 ... 20 mA + 4 ... 20 mA for twowire trans ducers and fourwire transducers 1V: y"10 M; 10 V: 90 k; 20 mA: 50 4 ... 20 ,A: 62.5 ; Twowire connection 12 bit two`s complement (1024 units = rated value) Integrating Voltagefrequency conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 ms at 60 Hz 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 ms at 60 Hz 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 ms at 60 Hz
Types of connection for signal sensors Digital representation of the input signal Measuring principle Conversion principle Integration time (selectable for optimum noise suppression) Encoding time per channel Cycle time for 4 inputs 8 inputs 16 inputs Permissible voltage between inputs or between inputs and the central grounding point (destruction limit) max. max.
Twowire connection; fourwire connections for Pt 100 12 bit plus sign or 13 bit two`s complement (2048 units = rated value) Integrating Voltagetime conversion 20 ms at 50 Hz 16 2/3 ms at 60 Hz 60 ms at 50 Hzbased on rated value 50 ms at 60 Hzbased on rated value 0.48 s at 50 Hz 0.48 s at 50 Hz 0.96 s at 50 Hz
Permissible voltage between the reference potential of a non floating sensor and the central grounding point max.
75 V DC/60 V AC
1V
75 V DC/60 V AC
4/46
Siemens ST 50 1998
At 200 % of rated value (4095 units) Can be designed for the range 50 mV, 500 mV and Pt 100
100 dB 40 dB
86 dB 40 dB
80 dB 40 dB
12.5 mV: 50 mV: 500 mV: 12.5 mV: 50 mV: 500 mV:
2 2 1.5 6 5 4.5
1.1
Pt 100: 5 10 V: 7.7 1 V: 7.7 20 mA: 6.7 5 V: 7.7 4 ... 20 mA: 6.7 200 m (656 ft); 50 m (164 ft) up to 50 mV + 24 V + 24 V 2.5 mA 0.15 A 0.15 A 1.5 W
3.7
200 m (656 ft); 50 m (164 ft) up to 50 mV + 24 V + 24 V 2.5 mA 0.13 A 0.15 A 3.5 W 1 slot 42pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib) 6ES5 466-3LA11
200 m (656 ft) + 24 V + 24 V 0.2 A 0.15 A 5.0 W 1 slot 42pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
8 differential inputs or 16 individual inputs (referred to ground) in 4 or 2 groups (selectable) Yes 0 ... 20 mA; 4 ... 20mA; 20 mA 0 ... 1.25 V; 0 ... 2.5 V; 0 ... 5 V; 1 ... 5 V; 0 ... 10V 1.25 V; 2.5 V; 5 V; 10 V; Voltage measuring range: 10 M Current measuring range: 125 Twowire connection 13 bit two`s complement or 12 bit abs. value + sign or 12 bit binary Instantaneous value encoding Successive approximation max. 250 s
}
Selector switch lets you select these values for 4 channels separately
Input resistance in the individual ranges Types of conn. for signal sensors Digital repres. of the input signal Measuring principle Conversion principle Encoding time per channel Cycle time for S 8 inputs S 16 inputs
max. max.
2 ms 4 ms
Permissible voltage between inputs or between inputs and central grounding point max. Permissible voltage between the reference potential of a nonfloa ting sensor and the central grounding point max.
75 V DC/60 V AC
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range (5 V supply from power supply chassis). 2) A filter (SIFI C, B84113-C-B30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module. Siemens ST 50 1998
4/47
70 dB 40 dB
Voltage ranges (except 0 ... 1.25 V; 1.25 V): Current ranges and 0 ... 1.25 V; 1.25 V: Voltage ranges (except 0 ... 1.25 V; 1.25 V): Current ranges and 0 ... 1.25 V; 1.25 V: 200 m (656 ft) 0.7 A 3.5 W 1 slot 43pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range (5 V supply from power supply chassis).
Ordering data
460-4 analog input module 8 inputs, signal range set via measuring range module (two 498 measuring range modules are required); floating 465-4 analog input module 16 inputs (8 with Pt 100), signal range set via measuring range module (two or four 498 measuring range modules are required); nonfloating 498 measuring range module for 4604 and 4654 analog input modules; four channels each 12.5 mV, 50 mV, 500 mV, Pt100 1V 5V 10 V 20 V + 4 ... 20 mA; for twowire transducer + 4 ... 20 mA; for fourwire transducer
Order No. 6ES5 460- 4UA13 463-4 analog input module 4 inputs, floating For 50 Hz power systems For 60 Hz power systems 466-3 analog input module 16 inputs, inputs floating The operating instructions are in cluded in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155). 497 front connector for 460, 463, 465 analog input modules Crimp terminals terminals, singlewidth, 42pin Crimp terminals, doublewidth, 42pin Screw terminals, singlewidth, 42pin Screw terminals, doublewidth, 42pin Front connector for 466 analog input module Crimp terminals, singlewidth, 43pin Screw terminals, singlewidth, 43pin
Order No.
6ES5 497-4UA12 497 4UA12 6ES5 497-4UA22 6ES5 497-4UB31 6ES5 497-4UB12
6ES5 498- 1AA11 6ES5 498- 1AA21 6ES5 498- 1AA61 6ES5 498- 1AA31 6ES5 498- 1AA41 6ES5 498- 1AA51 6ES5 498 - 1AA71
4/48
Siemens ST 50 1998
L+ LL+
F+ FL+
1)
LKomp. Komp.+ L+
2)
I+ I-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
F+ FL+
3
LKomp. Komp.+ L+
2)
7
I+ I-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
F+ FL+
1)
Komp. + Komp.-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
L+ LL+
F+ FL+
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Komp. + Komp. -
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
F+ FL+
L-
L-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
1) 1)
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
0 8
1)
Fig. 4/26 Connection diagrams for analog input modules 1) Connection to the central grounding point of the system (see under technical specifications) 2) Only for disconnecting the test current if wire breakage monitoring is not activated
Input
4..20mA 4..20mA
1 9
2 10
3 11
4 12
5 13
6 14
7 15
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/49
Design
Three analog output modules are available with eight out puts each and a range of out put voltages. The modules re quire one slot. Enaple input The enable input can be used to disable the output of new
Front connectors are used for terminating the signal cables. Modules and front connectors may be inserted and removed under power. values. The last output value is retained. The enable input can be deactivated by
Adhesive labels are supplied for identifying modules and front connectors.
Principle of operation
Technical specifications
Number of outputs Galvanic isolation Output ranges (rated values) S 6ES5 4704UA12 S 6ES5 4704UB12 S 6ES5 4704UC12 Load resistance S For voltage outputs min. S For current outputs max. Load connection Digital representation of the output signal Permissible overload capability approx. Conversion time Shortcircuit protection Shortcircuit current approx. Opencircuit voltage max. Voltage between the reference potential of the load (Manalog connection) and the casing max. Basic error limits1) (at 20 _C) Operational error limits (0 to 60 _C; for one year) Cable length (shielded) max. 8 voltage and current outputs Yes (not between the outputs) Enable input F Input voltage S Rated value S Enable S Disable Input current (for enable) Cable length (unshielded) Supply voltage Vp pos S Rated value S Ripple Vpp (referred to g ) rated voltage) S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t < 0.1 s Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) t S External (at 24 V) Space requirements 60 V AC/75 V DC 2 2 units 6 200 m (656 ft) Power loss Front connector Weight approx. max. max typ typ. . max.
10 V; 0 ... 20 mA 10 V + 1 ... 5 V; + 4 ... 20mA Purely ohmic 3.3 k 300 To the Manalog terminal 12 bit two`s complement (1024 units = rated value) 25 % (up to 1280 units) 1 ms Yes 25 mA (for a voltage output) 18 V (for a current output)
24 V DC + 13 ... 33 V - 33 ... + 5 V 5 mA 200 m (656 ft) 24 V DC 15 % 20 ... 30 V max max. . yp. typ typ. typ 36 V 0.25 0 25 A 0.3 0 3A 1 slot 90W 9.0 42pin 0.4 kg (0.88 Ib)
1) In accordance with DIN 43 745; referred to nominal measuring range (5 V supply from power supply chassis) 2) A filter (SIFI C, B84113CB30 or equivalent) is required in the 24 V DC load power supply for the module.
4/50
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 470-4UB13
6ES5 470-4UC13
L+ LL+
F+ F-
Ch.0
Ch.1
Ch.2
Ch.3
L-
Ch.4
Ch.5
C6.6
Ch.7
M An a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
F+ F-
Ch.0 0 Ch.1 1
Ch.2 2 Ch.3 3
L-
Ch.4 4 Ch.5 5
C6.6 6 Ch.7 7 M An a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
L+ LL+
F+ F-
Ch.4 4 Ch.5 5
C6.6 6 Ch.7 7 M An a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/51
fact that they execute these timecritical tasks completely autonomously. The CPU can then concentrate on its own control tasks more closely. There is an entire range of in telligent I/O modules for the S5135U and S5155U/H
programmable controllers, which can be used for various applications. The following overview shows which modules can be used for which applications.
The advantage of the intelli gent I/O modules lies in the Signal preprocessing
Closedloop control Page S IP 244 temperature 4/61 Positioning Openloop control Page
Positioning Page Closedloop control S IP 246I and 4/65 IP 246A positioning module for servo drives S WF 721, 4/89 WF 723A, WF 723B and WF 723C positioning modules
Counting/ proportioning
Page
S IP 252 4/71 closedloop control module for drives S IP 260 4/74 closedloop control module for highspeed individual controllers
S IP 240 4/53 counter/position decod er/positioning module S IP 241 4/55 digital position decoder S IP 247 4/69 positioning module for stepper motors S WF 705 4/81 position encoder module S WF 706C 4/83 positioning module S WF 707 cam controller 4/86
S IP 240 4/53 counter/position decod er/positioning module S IP 242A, IP 242B counter modules 4/57
S Page 4/84: Comparison of IP 240 and IP 288 with WF 706 S Page 4/87: Comparison of IP 241 and IP 288 with WF 707 S Page 4/90: Comparison of IP 246 with WF 721 and WF 723A
4/52
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The module contains two channels that can be used in dependently of each other in four modes: S Counting (signals from pulse encoders at frequencies of up to 70 kHz) S Position decoding (in con junction with incremental position encoders) S Positioning via cutoff points S Speed measurement for the IP 252 closedloop control module (in conjunction with Counting The positivegoing edge of the enable input sets the counter to the initial value set in the user program (max. 9999). The counter counts the input pulses down to zero. When 0 is reached, the counter generates a process interrupt or sets its output (programselectable). The pulses continue to be counted (down to max. 9999) if the enable input remains "1". Position decoding The counter counts up and down to " 99,999. The counting pulse frequency can be doubled or quadrupled via user program. The channel is synchronized via the refer ence input. Eight tracks (cams; travel sections or counting ranges; with allowance for a zero off set) can be specified via soft ware. Positioning via cutoff points In this mode, defined points within the traverse range (" 9,999,999) of the axis can be approached.
incremental speed enco ders) Besides the inputs for pulse sensing (inputs for 5 V and 24 V available), each channel of the module is provided with: S 1 enable input (5 V/24 V) for "counting" mode S 1 reference input (prelimi nary contact, 5 V/24 V) for position decoding and posi tioning S 2 outputs (5 V/24 V; 0.5 A) for control of actuators
The cables to the sensors can be connected S either with 15pin sub D connectors (upper sockets, shielded cables) or with S screwtype connectors (lower sockets, cables up to 1.5 mm2, up to approx. 10 kHz) The module requires one slot.
Principle of operation
-9999
+9999
Track 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
Rapid traverse
Creep speed
Binary output 1
1 0 1 0
Binary output 2
4/53
The following errors are de tected: S Wire breakage with 5V sym metrical position encoders S Shortcircuit in signal cables S Zero mark errors The necessary program for the CPU is available in the form of standard function blocks (see Section 7).
The positioning tolerance va ries between "0.002 mm at 0.06 m/min and " 2 mm at 60 m/min.
Technical specifications
Pulse inputs Galvanic isolation Position decoding, positioning S Differential inputs (5 V, symmetr.) for sensor interfaces to RS 422A or similar Input frequency Cable length (shielded) S 5V/24V inputs (asymmetrical) Input frequency Cable length (shielded) Counting 5V/24V inputs Input frequency Cable length (shielded) Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Binary inputs Galvanic isolation Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current at "1 signal Cable length (shielded) max. max. No 5 V DC 0 ... 0.8 V + 2.4 ... 5 V 0.14 mA 100 m (328 ft) No 24 V DC - 30 ... + 5 V + 13 ... 30 V 6.5 mA 100 m (328 ft) typ. max. max. No 2 pulses displaced by 90_ and zero mark and inverse signals (e.g. Siemens 6FX2 0012... positioning encoder) 500 kHz 30 m (98.4 ft) (w/ 5 V sensor sply) 2 pulses displaced by 90_ and zero mark (e.g. Siemens 6FX2 0014... posn. encoder) 50 kHz 25 kHz 25 m (82 ft) Pulses 70 kHz 25 m (82 ft) 5 V DC 0 ... 0.8 V + 2.4 ... 5 V 0.14 mA 100 m (328 ft) Binary outputs Number per channel Galvanic isolation Supply voltage Vpos (for load) S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Output current at "1 signal S Rated value Switching frequency with S Resistive load (24 V, 50 mA) S Inductive load (8.5 W) S Lamp load (5 W) Residual load at "0 signal Output voltage S At "1 signal Cable length S Shielded Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) Supply current for sensors S At 5 V S At 24 V (external supply) Addresses used Space requirements Weight approx. 2 with position decoding and positioning, 1 with counting Yes
max.
24 V DC 3V 20 ... 30 V 500 mA
max. max.
max. max.
200 Hz 2 Hz 8 Hz 1 mA Vpos - 3 V 1000 m (3280 ft) 0.8 A (excluding sensor supply) 0.8 A total 0.6 A total 16 byte 1 slot 0.45 kg (0.99 lb)
Ordering data
IP 240 counter, position decoder and positioning module To be ordered as a separate item: Configuring package for IP 240 comprising manual and standard FB1) for counting, position acquisition and positioning German English French Italian 1) For description see Page 7/109
Order No. 705-3 connecting cables for Siemens positioning encoder 6FX 20012 with Vpos = 5 V 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) Sub D connector 15pin
Order No.
6ES5 240-1AA21
6ES5 705-3 BF01 6ES5 705-3 CB01 6ES5 705-3 CC01 6ES5 705-3 CD21 6ES5 750-2AA21
4/54
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The IP 242A and IP 242B counter modules contain a to tal of seven independent 16bit or 32bit counter chan nels. Five of these channels can be used for counting up and down. The inputs and outputs are galvanically iso lated. The IP 242A can be up graded to an IP 242B with an EPROM and operated when the standard function blocks have been replaced. The counting and gate pulses of the individual counter chan nels can be derived from an external pulse encoder or from an internal quartz crys tal. The counter outputs can be configured as either pulse outputs or level switch out puts.
The modules each require one slot. Features Counting frequency up to 500 kHz; S Scaler chain (programmable and assigned randomly to counters 1 to 5), 4 x part factor 10 or 16 (BCD) and 1 x 4 bit S Counters 1 to 5 cascadable S Group interrupt output for user program An interrupt can be issued when a predefined interrupt value or the synchronization point is reached. The re sponse times can be reduced considerably by instruction lists (short user programs) on the counter modules.
19 modes of operation for counters 1 to 5 S 1/3 modes of operation for counters 6 and 7 S Input signal level 5 V or 24 V, with 16bit counters, adaption for each individual input by jumpers or resistors S Output signal (24 V level) with up to 40 kHz pulse or varied pulse and pulse pause
S
Principle of operation
If the counting range of one counter is not sufficient, sev eral counters can be cas caded together. The necessary software for the CPU is available in the form of standard function blocks (see Section 7).
Technical specifications
Counter module Number of counters S With 16 bit (cascadable) (counters 1 to 5) S With 24 bit (counters 6 and 7) S With 32 bit (counters 6 and 7) Number of modes (softwareselectable) Number of counters with compar ison facility for random counts Clock frequency (internal) S Counters 1 to 5 S Counters 6 and 7 Counter frequency conditioning Counting frequency S 24 V signals/ 5 V signals max. S 5 V (RS 422) max. Measured value preprocessing Measured value memory IP 242A 5 (up/down programmable) 2 up and down for direct connection of incremental encoders with two pulse trains displaced by 90 (5 V, RS 422) IP 242B
19 (counters 1 to 5) 1 (counters 6 and 7) 7 (one interrupt value can be specified for each counter) 1 MHz with 16bit scaler as well as programmable scaler chain Yes, for counters 1 to 5
2 up and down for direct connection of incremental encoders with two pulse trains displaced by 90 (5 V, RS 422) 19 (counters 1 to 5) 3 (counters 6 and 7) 7 (one interrupt value can be specified for each counter) 1 MHz with 16bit scaler as well as programmable scaler chain 10 MHz (direct, without scaler) Yes, for counters 1 to 5
480 kHz (counters 1 to 5) 500 kHz (counters 6 and 7) Yes, by means of arithmetic functions Yes, freely assignable up to 100 measured values (100 x 2 data words)
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/57
75 V DC 500 V AC 1.1 A 50 mA 1 Kbyte with S5155U, page addressing optional, 1 page frame 1 slot 0.4 kg (0.9 Ib)
approx.
Ordering data
IP 242A counter module2) Upgrade kit from IP 242A and IP 242B IP 242B counter module To be ordered as a separate item: Configuring package for IP 242A/B comprising manual and standard FB1) German English French Italian 1) For description see Page 7/121 2) Cannot be used with CPU 945
Order No. 6ES5 242-1AA32 on request 6ES5 242-1AA41 Connector (4 pcs.) Converter for 24 V asymmetrical incremen tal encoder up to 5 V (RS 422) symmetrical incremental encoder 705 connecting cable for connection of Siemens position encoder 6FX2 001-2... 6ES5 242-5AB11 6ES5 242-5AB21 6ES5 242-5AB31 6ES5 242-5AB51 Length 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft)
4/58
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
S S S
1 analog/digital converter (-10 to + 10V, 12 bits, 35 s) with 8 inputs 2 digital/analog converters (-10 to +10V, 12 bit, 5 s) 1 digital/analog converter (0 to + 10V, 8 bit, 10 s) 4 analog value matching functions (zero offsets and amplifier settings) 2 difference amplifiers (P controllers) with settable gain
2 analog value comparators, the results are read in via a following logical circuit and then further processed as alarms (depending on the type of programmable con troller used via alarm cables or via a digital input module with alarm generation) S 1 digital output (8 outputs, 24 V; 0.4 A) S 1 digital input (8 inputs, 24 V)
S
The gains and zero points can be set on the front panel via trimpots. 6 measuring sockets are available for checking the settings. The module requires 1 slot.
Principle of operation
Depending on the given task, the components can be con nected to each other or to the inputs and outputs (routing). The analog values of an input selected via the multiplexer are converted to digital values via the A/D converter so that they can then be processed directly in the central control ler.
At the same time they can be compared with other values in the IP 243-3. Individual ana log values can be adapted for this. Set values for direct comparison can be sent from the central controller to the IP 243-3 through the D/A con verter.
The program required for the central controller is available as standard function modules (see Catalog Section 7).
Technical specifications
A/D converter, 12 bit Number of inputs Input voltage range (set with jumpers) Input resistance approx. Digital representation of signal 1 8 -5 to +5 V, -10 to +10 V, 0 to 10 V 1 M 11 bit + sign; input voltage range = 2047 units successive approximation 35 s D/A converter, 12 bit Output voltage Load impedance min. Digital representation of signal 2 -10 to +10 V 2 k 11 bit + sign; output voltage range = 2047 units yes approx. 25 mA 5 s " 0.6 " 0.9 (0 to 55 _C)
Short-circuit protection Short-circuit current Settling time to 99% of final value for 20 m line length Basic error limits Operational error limits
Conversion method Conversion time max. (without command processing times) Basic error limits Operational error limits
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/59
max. min.
Short-circuit protection Short-circuit current Settling time to 99% of final value for 20 m line length Basic error limits Operational error limits Analog value matching Input voltage range Input resistance Gain range Setting range for zero offset Difference amplifier Input voltage range Input resistance Gain range Output voltage range Load impedance Short-circuit protection Short-circuit current Comparator Number of inputs Input voltage range Input resistance Binary inputs Input voltage range S nominal value S for signal "0" S for signal "1" Input current for signal "1" Delay time Input filter time constant approx. Input filter time constant approx. Input filter time constant approx.
250
24 V DC 3.6 V 20 to 30 V 35 V 600 mA 270 mA No 20 m 400 m 1000 m 0Vconnection (low resistance connected to housing)
Ordering data
IP 243-3 analog module To be ordered as a separate item: IP 243-3 manual German English French 1) For description see Page 7/119
Order No. 6ES5 243-1AA13 Front connector K S 43pin, for crimp connection S 43pin, for screw connection Standard-function blocks for IP 2431)
Order No.
4/60
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The IP 244 contains a micro processor which implements the control functions in multi plex mode. User setting is also possible. The module requires one slot. Inputs 1 binary input for switching the controller on and off (heating switch); operates only on controllers for which it was configured S 13 analog inputs for con necting floating (grounding required) or nonfloating thermocouples, twowire connection, linearization by firmware, 0 ... 50 mV: FeCuNi, NiCrNi, Pt 10%RhPt, Pt 13%RhPt in accordance with DIN 43710 for temperatures up to 1600 C
S
1 compensation input for connecting a Pt 100 resist ance thermometer for refer ence junction temperature compensation (threewire connection) S 2 monitoring inputs (0 ... 20 V) for connecting transmitters. These signals are not processed by the controller but only monitored for limits
S
or S 8 analog inputs for connect ing Pt 100 resistance ther mometers (0 ... 500 mV, four wire connection) or S 16 analog inputs for con necting voltage sensors, such as pyrosensors (0 ... 500 mV; twowire connec tion). The analog inputs are de signed, with respect to earth ing and shielding, with en hanced resistance to interference which allows op eration of the module in the proximity of electrical drives. Cascade controllers with one master controller and up to twelve secondary fol lowup controllers optional S Separate parameter sets for heating and cooling
S
Outputs 17 outputs for twoposition controller (HEATOFF) or threeposition controller (HEATOFFCOOL); can be selected from 13 two position to 8 threeposition and 1 twoposition control lers. The "on" duration of an out put (manipulated variable for cooling or heating) dur ing one sampling interval corresponds to the value of the manipulated variable calculated by the controller. Manual operation is pos sible.
Principle of operation
Controller characteristics 13 controllers can be pro grammed with P, I and D components The treshold value can be selected to avoid pumping of an output The sampling time can be selected between 800 ms and 32 s
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/61
15 Channel No.
Analog/digital converter
11 bit
Actualvalue processing Linearization of characteristics Ambient temperature compensation Limit monitoring Extreme value memory Averaging
Parameters
The selfoptimization can be activated for each channel by means of a start/stop bit.
Setpoints Parameters
P I D
Parameters
Control signal (manipulated variable) processing Limit monitoring for response threshold Clock control for markspace ratio Selection of 2point or 3point response
LOutput No. 1 17
L-
Parameter monitoring
PID controller
Controlled process
Self optimization
4/62
Siemens ST 50 1998
A second setpoint can be entered (e.g. for reduced temperature at night); either the first or the second set point can be selected with a control bit (set by the user program) S Limit monitoring of the set points entered
S
Note The IP 244 temperature con trol module must be inserted in the central controller when using the IM 307/IM 317 inter face modules. Operation of the IP 244 tem perature control module is permissible only in slots with battery backup. The necessary software for the CPU is available in the form of standard function blocks (including an example for easy startup) (see Section 7).
Setpoint processing S Step changes in the set points can be converted into ramp functions with variable slope coefficients Technical specifications
Analog inputs either Inputs for thermoelements Input voltage range Input resistance Permissible thermoelements (for max. temperature) 13 (twowire connection) 0 ... 50 mV 10 M FeCuNi (700 C), type L, type J NiCrNi (1200 C); type K Pt10%RhPt (1600 C); type S Pt13%RhPt (1600 C); type R 2 0 ... 20 V; can be changed to 0 ... 50 V 50 k (20 V); 10 k (50 mV) 1 for Pt 100 (threewire connection) 8 (fourwire connection)
Analog output The CPU can read the manip ulated variables of all con trollers of the IP 244 in one scanning cycle and therefore transfer the manipulated vari ables to analog output mod ules. Heating current monitoring The module can also be pro grammed for the "closedloop control with heating current monitoring" mode (thermo elements only). Failure of the individual heat ing elements can be detected by monitoring the heating cur rents. The program evaluates any drop below the permissi ble heating current range.
Integrating time (adjustable for optimum noise suppression) S At 50 Hz S At 60 Hz Conversion time max. (1 measured value) S At 50 Hz S At 60 Hz Permissible voltage between S Inputs or between inputs and central grounding point max. S Reference potential of a sensor and the central grounding point max. Test voltage S Analog input to analog input S Analog input to S5 bus Fault message for S Range exceeded S Wirebreakage S Limit exceeded (programmable limit) S Shortcircuit Noise suppression for f = n (50/60 Hz " 1 %); n = 1, 2, 3 ... S Common mode noise S Series mode noise (peak value of the noise voltage < rated value of the range) min.
20 ms 16 2/3 ms
60 ms 50 ms
Inputs for instrument transformers Input ranges (rated values) Input resistance Themperature compensation inputs or Inputs for Pt 100 (resistance thermometers, max. temperature 830 C) Input voltage range or Inputs for voltage sensors Input voltage range Digital representation of input signals (internal) Galvanic isolation Measuring principle min.
0 ... 500 mV
16 (twowire connection) 0 ... 500 mV 11 bit + sign (2048 units = nominal value) Yes Integrating
100 dB
min.
40 dB
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/63
50 m (164 ft) shielded Galvanic isolation 24 V DC - 2 ... + 4.5 V + 13 ... + 35 V Power supply voltage Vpos S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) Output current at "1 signal S Rated value S Permissible range Shortcircuit protection Limiting of the voltage induced on circuit interruption to
D@
max.
120 mA 0.2 ... 120 mA Yes -1V 2.4 W 100 % max. max. min. max. max. 2 A +3V Vpos - 2.5 V 400 m (1312 ft) 1000 m (3300 ft)
xdt ) T
dx ) dt
Lamp load Load factor at 55 C Residual current at "0 signal Signal level of the outputs S At "0 signal S At "1 signal Cable length S Unshielded S Shielded General specifications Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V, without load) Assigned binary addresses Space requirements Weight
max.
0 or 1 0.01 ... 256 (1 ... 512) @ TA or TN = R (0.5 ... 512) @ TA or TD = 0 0 ... 1600 C (11 bit) 0 ... 65536 K/h Setpoint " 255 K 0 ... 50 % (of setpoint) 0 ... 50 % (of setpoint)
typ. typ.
approx.
Ordering data
IP 244 temperature control module To be ordered as a separate item: Configuring package for IP 244 comprising manual and standard FB1) German English French Italian
Order No. 721 connecting cables shielded; For binary signals (max. 500 m (1640 ft)) 2.5 m (8.2 ft) 3.2 m (10.5 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) For analog signals (max. 50 m (164 ft)) 2.5 m (8.2 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) 50 m (164 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 244-3AB31
6ES5 721-4 BC50 6ES5 721-4 BD20 6ES5 721-4 BF00 6ES5 721-4 CB00 6ES5 721-4 CD20
6ES5 721-5 BC50 6ES5 721-5 BF00 6ES5 721-5 CB00 6ES5 721-5 CD20 6ES5 721-5 CF00
4/64
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
Two versions of the IP 246 po sitioning module are availa ble: S IP 246I for incremental posi tion encoders Machine data and programs required for positioning are stored in the RAM of the IP 246 positioning module. For this, the COM 246 para meterization software (see Section 7) must be loaded into the programming device used. The user can program target positions and traversing speeds: S In the program memory of the CPU S In the program memory of the IP 246 positioning mod ule (with the COM 246 para meterization software) The current position of the two axes is determined from the signals of the position en coder. From the difference to the current set position, a position controller (Pcontrol ler) calculates the current speed setpoint, which is out put as an analog signal (" 10 V) and is available to the speed controller of the current converter of the ap propriate axis.
Principle of operation
The module can be serviced via two interfaces, either from the programmable controller or from a programming de vice. Both axes can be used inde pendent of each other either as a rotary or linear axis. Operation with a programming device In the diagnostics mode, both axes can be controlled from a programming device. Set points, actual values, follow ing error and a number of other values are displayed on the screen. Error messages are displayed in detailed plain text. For operation with a programmer (and for programming), the COM 246 parameteriza tion software is required (see Section 7).
Operation with a programmable controller For communication between the positioning module and the CPU, the appropriate standard function block (FB 164 and FB 165; see Sec tion 7) must be loaded into the CPU. The possible calls are put together in a list (see page 4/66). The PLC and programming device interfaces can be op erated simultaneously. Using the PLC, simple pointtopoint linkage of the two axes is possible. Machine data The machine record includes axisspecific parameters such as S Various speeds S Accelerations and decelera tions in both directions S Coordinates for reference point, software position switch S Offsets, tool compensations S Resolution S Type of axis: Rotary or linear axis
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/65
Loops, including infinite loops Onthefly changeovers Dwell times Offsets, tool compensations Metric and imperial mea sures
Each traversing program can be carried out by both axes (even simultaneously).
Setpoint axis 1
Controller DAC
Speed controller
T Axis 1
Communications processor
PLC interface
Command interpreter
Setpoint axis 2
Controller DAC
Speed controller
T Axis 2
CPUs
Functions
IP 246I
IP 246A
Positioning and position control of two independent axes with variablespeed drives Incremental S 5 V differential signal S 24 V signal Linear axis Rotary axis Jogging mode Followup mode Reference point approach and/or set reference point Incremental travel Automatic mode Teachin mode Zero shift Tool offset Entry of machine data and traversing program Module identifier Drift compensation Read machine data Read traversing program Read current actual values Read module identifier Path actual value Following error Distance to go "Axis ready for operation"; "Position reached" External start/stop RAM/EPROM CPU Absolute (digital) S 24 V signal S Switching to P potential S Switching to M potential
S Monitoring
Binary outputs signal the following: Selectable via binary inputs User program referencing the IP246 Can be stored in Machine data and traversing programs can be modified via CPU Module replacement possible without reloading program
Yes Yes
4/66
Siemens ST 50 1998
24 V inputs Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current (at "1 signal) max. Galvanic isolation Counting frequency S For 5 V inputs S For 24 V inputs Cable length (shielded) Position detection, absolute max. Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current (at "1 signal) max. Galvanic isolation Cable length (shielded) Binary inputs/outputs Galvanic isolation Input voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Input current Output voltage S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal Output current S Output current at "1 Permissible range S Residual current at "0 max.
20 bit (parallel, Gray code) 24 V DC - 33 ... + 3 V + 10.5 ... 33 V 7 mA No 32 m (105 ft) 4/2 per axis No 24 V DC 33 ... + 3.6 V + 13 ... 33 V
max.
typ.
9.5 mA (at 24 V) 24 V DC +3V Vpos24 - 1.5 V 120 mA (shortcircuit proof) 5 ... 120 mA 0.5 mA
approx.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/67
6ES5 706-3BF00 6ES5 706-3CB00 6ES5 706-3CC00 6ES5 706-3CD20 6ES5 706-6BF00 6ES5 706-6CB00 6ES5 706-6CC00 6ES5 706-6CD20 6ES5 706-4BF00 6ES5 706-4CB00 6ES5 706-4CC00 6ES5 706-5BB00 6ES5 706-5BF00 6ES5 706-5CB00 6ES5 706-5CC00
6ES5 246-5AA11 6ES5 246-5AA21 6ES5 246-5AA31 6ES5 750-2AB21 6ES5 750-2AA21 6ES5 750-2AA11
4/68
Siemens ST 50 1998
Principle of operation
Machine data and traversing programs required for posi tioning are stored in the RAM of the IP 247 positioning mod ule. For this, the COM 247 pa rameter assignment software (see Section 7) must be loaded into the programming device used. The user can program target positions and traversing speeds S In the program memory of the CPU or S In the program memory of the IP 247 (with the COM 247 parameter assign ment software). The module calculates the an gular increment to be carried out by the motor from the ac tual and target positions. The actual position of an axis is not fed back from outside but determined by the module it self. From the mechanical charac teristics of the drive unit (transmission ratio) and the machine data stored on the module (e.g. max. accelera tion) the module determines the required pulse sequence (and direction) and transfers this to the power section of the stepper motor. Accelera tion and deceleration are cal culated using an exponential function: With exponential ac celeration a greater path is covered over a given length of time than with linear accel eration.
Stepper motors with two, four or five phases can be con trolled with step frequencies of 0.5 Hz to 100 kHz. Operation with a program ming device AIl three axes can be con trolled from a programming device. Actual values, resid ual path and a number of other values are displayed on the screen. Error messages are displayed in detailed plain text. For operation with a program ming device (and for pro gramming) the COM 247 pa rameter assignment software is required. Operation with a programmable controller For communication between the positioning module and the CPU, the appropriate standard function blocks (FB 164 and FB 165; see Section 7) must be loaded into the CPU. Machine data The machine record includes axisspecific parameters such as: S Various speeds S Accelerations (frequency changes) S Coordinates for reference point, software position switch
Offsets, tool compensations The number of angular in crements of the motor per revolution S Transmission gear ratio of the drive S Type of axis: rotary or linear axis
S S
Traversing programs The program memory takes 7000 characters. The rest same as for IP 246. Operating modes The following groups of modes are possible: S Set reference point proce dure and reference point by software S Modes for manual traversing S Automatic modes S Input and deletion of com pensations and shifts S Teachin mode
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/69
Setpoint axis 1
Pulse generator
Power section
M Axis 1
Communications processor
Setpoint axis 2
Pulse generator
Power section
M Axis 2
Setpoint axis 3
Pulse generator
Power section
M Axis 3
CPUs
PLC interface
Command interpreter
Technical specifications
Signal to the power section Positioning outputs Pulse, Pulse Direction, Direction Reset, Reset 5 V/20 mA, 24 V/20 mA jumperselectable; 5 V to 24 V/20 mA with additional voltage 5V 24 V DC - 33 ... + 3 V + 10.5 ... 33 V 7 mA Machine data Traversing range Number of angular increments per revolution Transmission ratio of the drive Pulse frequency Frequency gain Backlash compensation Tool length compensation Supply voltages Vpos24 S Rated value S Ripple S Permissible range (including ripple ) Current consumption S Internal (at 5 V) S External (at 24 V, without load) Supply voltage for 2wire BERO Battery backup Cable length 24 V DC - 33 ... + 3.6 V + 13 ... V 9.5 mA Space requirements Weight approx. max. max. max. To be preselected with COM 247 100.000 mm 12 ... 1000
pulses rev.
S Differential inputs Ready signal input S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal S Input current (at 24 V) Binary inputs/outputs Signal output "Position reached" S Rated value S For "0 signal max. S For "1 signal min. S Output current at "1 max. Permissible range S Residual current at "0 max. Inputs for position switch (2), reference point switch, external Start/Stop S Rated value S For "0 signal S For "1 signal S Input current (at 24 V) typ.
64.999 mm
100,000 mm
20 bit (parallel, Gray code) 24 V DC 3.6 V 20 ... 30 V typ. typ. 0.8 A 0.05 A 22 ... 33 V PLC battery 100 m (328 ft) 1 slot 0.4 kg (0.9 lb)
typ.
max.
Ordering data
IP 247 positioning module without manual To be ordered as a separate item: Configuring package for IP 247 comprising manual, standard FB1) and parameter assignment software COM 2472) German English French Sub D connector 9pin (plug) 25pin (plug) 1) For description see Page 7/123 2) For description see Page 7/21
Order No. 704 connecting cable (open cable end) S For power section 1.6 m (5.2 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 50 m (164 ft) S For binary inputs and outputs 2 m (6.56 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 50 m (164 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 247-4UA31
6ES5 704-4BB60 6ES5 704-4B F00 6ES5 704-4CB00 6ES5 704-4CC00 6ES5 704-4CF00 6ES5 704-5BC00 6ES5 704-5BF00 6ES5 704-5CB00 6ES5 704-5CC00 6ES5 704-5CF00
6ES5 247-5AA11 6ES5 247-5AA21 6ES5 247-5AA31 6ES5 750-2AA11 6ES5 750-2AA31
4/70
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The IP 281 basic board has one counter channel for direct connection of incremental en coders or pulse encoders. A second channel can be connected using an optional plugin submodule. The two 16 or 32bit counters can op erate either independently or in conjunction with one another. The channel(s) can be used for counting both up and down. The counter function and the bus interface of the IP 281 counter module are imple mented in an ASIC. This en sures very fast data inter change with the CPU of the programmable controller. It is therefore particularly suitable for measured value acquisi tion, interrupt processing and highspeed closedloop con trol.
The incremental encoders are connected via Sub D connec tors; the digital inputs and outputs are connected via screw terminals (included in the scope of delivery). The module requires one slot. Features S One channel for counting up and down (16 or 32 bit), up gradable to two channels (16 or 32 bit) with a plugin submodule, for connection of incremental encoders S Five operating modes for in dependent operation of the two counters S Four operating modes for operation of the two count ers in conjunction with one another S Individual setting of count ing width, counting range and counting mode for each counter interrupt value. For fast re sponse, the counter outputs can be used and/or an inter rupt can be sent to the CPU. The counter outputs can be configured with a selectable minimum pulse or with level switching.
S S S S
Counting pulses are ac quired from three different evaluations of the signal lev els at the encoder inputs (single, double and quadru ple evaluation) Transfer of values from counter 1 to counter 2 in the form of interrupt or load val ues Direct start of counter 2, when counter 1 has reached an interrupt value Enabling/disabling in the form of levels, pulses (at the digital input of the counter) or by software control Gate start, gate stop and setting via digital inputs Counters loaded with de fined initial values Cormparison with one inter rupt value for each counter Synchronous setting of start, stop and readout
Principle of operation
The IP 281 counter module captures the pulses from in cremental encoders depend ing on direct connectable gate signals. The module evaluates the direction and compares the actual value per counter with a definable
The user program does not require standard function blocks for data exchange with the CPU. Highspeed access is achieved via load and transfer operations.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/79
Number of modes (softwareselectable) Number of counters with comparison facility for random counts Counting frequency when driven with S 24 V signals S 5 V RS 422 signals Galvanic isolation S For inputs and outputs S Between two inputs S Between input and S5 bus Power supply voltage Vpos S Rated value S Ripple Vpp S Permissible range (including ripple) S Value at t > 5 s
max. max.
250 KHz 250 KHz Yes Yes (between encoder and digital inputs) Yes 24 V DC 3.6 V 20 ... 30 V 35 V
75 V DC 500 V AC 0.6 A 2.5 A 8 byte with linear addressing 1 slot 0.4 kg (0.88 lb)
max.
max.
Ordering data
IP 281 counter module with 24 V encoder power supply 24 V and 5.2 V encoder power supply Plug-in submodule for upgrading with 2nd channel To be ordered as a separate item: IP 281 manual German English French Italian 703 connecting cable Between IP 281 and S Siemens incremental position encoder 6FX2 0012 ... 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 25 m (82.0 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) S Incremental position encoder for 5 V signals, to RS 422, power supply voltage 5 V, with one end open 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 25 m (82.0 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) Cable opening bottom top
Order No. 703 connecting cable Between IP 281 and S Incremental position encoder for 5 V signals, to RS 422, power supply voltage 24 V, with one end open 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) 50 m (164.0 ft) 100 m (328.0 ft) S Incremental position encoder for 24 V signals, power supply voltage 24 V, with one end open 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft) 32 m (104.9 ft) 50 m (164.0 ft) 100 m (328.0 ft) Cable opening bottom top
Order No.
6ES5 703-3CB0J 6ES5 703-3CC0J 6ES5 703-3CD2J 6ES5 703-3CF0 J 6ES5 703-3DB0J
6ES5 703-1BF0 J 6ES5 703-1CB0J 6ES5 703-1CC0J 6ES5 703-1CC5J 6ES5 703-1CD2J
6ES5 703-4CB0J 6ES5 703-4CC0J 6ES5 703-4CD2J 6ES5 703-4CF0 J 6ES5 703-4DB0J 0 1 6ES5 750-2AA21
Sub D connector 15pin (plug) 6ES5 703-2BF0 J 6ES5 703-2CB0J 6ES5 703-2CC0J 6ES5 703-2CC5J 6ES5 703-2CD2J 0 1
4/80
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
WegerfassungsbaugruppeWF 705 Anwendungsbereich Die Wegerfassungs baugruppe WF 705 dient dem Erfassen und Verarbeiten der Signale von bis zu 12 syn chronseriellen Absolutwert gebern (SSI).
Aufbau
An die Wegerfassungsbau gruppe WF 705 lassen sich anschlieen: S 4 Absolutwertgeber, direkt anschliebar
Erweiterung ber Istwertver teiler, der die Werte von je 3 Achsen erfat; bis zu 4 Istwertverteiler sind an eine Wegerfassungsbau gruppe anschliebar. Der Mischbetrieb (Direktanschlu und Istwertverteiler) ist mg lich
Arbeitsweise
Bild 4/41 zeigt den prinzipiel len Ablauf des Datenverkehrs zwischen den Wegmegebern und der Zentralbaugruppe des Automatisierungsgertes. Fr den Datenaustausch mit der Zentralbaugruppe sind StandardFunktionsbausteine fr das Anwenderprogramm lieferbar (siehe Katalogteil 7).
Achse 1
. . .
OB
. . .
. . .
Achse 12 DB Istwerte
Technische Daten
Anschliebare Geber Wegerfassung absolut Verfahrbereich bertragungs geschwindigkeit Stromaufnahme (bei 5 V) Versorgungsspannung fr Wegmegeber max. synchronserielle Absolut wertgeber (SSI) 25 Bit Datenlnge (SSI, Gray oder BinrCode) 8192 Winkelschritte je Umdre hung, 4096 Umdrehungen 1 Mbit/s 0,5 A (ohne Geberversorgung) DC 24 V (extern) Versorgungsstrom fr Wegmegeber bei 24 V Leitungslnge (geschirmt) zum Geber S bei 125 kbit/s S bei 1 Mbit/s zum Istwertverteiler berwachungen Belegte Adressen Platzbedarf Gewicht etwa max. 0,3 A je Geber
max.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/81
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
Preis Steckleitung 790/590 mit offenem Leitungsende, zwischen WF 705 und S SSIWegmegeber Standardlngen 2m 5m 10 m 18 m Sonderlngen1), max. 25 m bei 1 Mbit/s max. 120 m bei 125 Kbit/s S Istwertverteiler Standardlngen 6ZB5 440-0AA01-0BA5 6ZB5 440-0AA02-0BA5 2m 5m Sonderlngen1), max. 10 m BestellNr. Preis
S zwischen Istwertverteiler und SSIWegmegeber 2m Standardlngen 5m 10 m 18 m 25 m 35 m 50 m 60 m Sonderlngen1), max. 25 m bei 1 Mbit/s max. 120 m bei 125 Kbit/s 1) Lnge im Klartext angeben
6FM1 590-2EA00 6FM1 590-2EB00 6FM1 590-2EC00 6FM1 590-2ED00 6FM1 590-2EE00 6FM1 590-2E F00 6FM1 590-2EG00 6FM1 590-2EH00 6FM1 590-2EZ00
4/82
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
WegerfassungsbaugruppeWF 706 C Anwendungsbereich Die Positionierungsbau gruppe WF 706 C dient dem Positionieren von Achsen ber Abschaltpunkte mit polum schaltbaren Motoren oder (in Verbindung mit einem optio nellen Analogmodul) zur Posi tionierung von Achsen mit Frequenzumrichtern, Servoan trieben oder Proportionalven tilSteuerungen. Auerdem ei gnet sich die WF 706 C ausgezeichnet zur Wegerfas sung und zum Zhlen.
Aufbau
Die WF 706 C ist in zwei Aus fhrungen lieferbar: S Mit 3 Kanlen S Mit 6 Kanlen Zur Positionierung mit Frequenzumrichtern ist die WF 706 C modular mit 1 oder 2 Analogmodulen erweiterbar (3 bzw. 6Kanalversion).
An die Baugruppe lassen sich folgende Geber anschlieen: S Inkrementalgeber S Absolutwertgeber mit seriel ler Datenbertragung(SSI Geber) S Einfache 24VSignalgeber (BERO)
Durch die geringe Schnittstel lenbreite von 8 Byte im Peri pheriebereich knnen bis zu 16 Baugruppen in einem Au tomatisierungsgert betrieben werden. Die Baugruppe bentigt 1 Ein bauplatz bei 3 Kanlen und 2 Einbaupltze bei 6 Kanlen. Spezielle Funktionen unter sttzen den Zhlvorgang. So kann z.B. mit der TorFunktion ein Zhlvorgang durch ein ex ternes Signal auf einen schnellen Digitaleingang oder alternativ durch einen internen Zeittakt gesteuert werden. Ein Analogmodul enthlt 4 Analogausgnge, von denen drei direkt Kanlen zugeord net sind. Sie knnen zur Posi tionierung von Antrieben (wahlweise "10 VSchnitt stelle oder 0 ... 10 VSchnitt stelle mit Richtungsbit) wer den.
Arbeitsweise
Je nach Variante knnen mit der WF 706 C drei oder sechs Achsen betrieben werden. Durch die einfache und offene Struktur stehen viele Funktio nen zur Verfgung, z. B. S Positionieren ber Abschalt punkte S Wegerfassung mit schneller Schaltpunktausgabe S Zhler mit schneller Vergleichswertausgabe S Dosierzhler In Verbindung mit Analogmo dulen zustzlich: S Positionieren von Achsen mit Frequenzumrichtern oder Servoantrieben
externe Gebersignale
Mit Hilfe der 4 Digitalaus gnge mit einer Schaltleistung von 0,5 A bei 24 V lassen sich alle notwendigen Schtze di rekt ansteuern. Durch die ausschlieliche Ver wendung von HardwareLogik und den Einsatz eines spe ziell fr diese Aufgabe entwik kelten integrierten Bausteins schalten die Ausgnge in we niger als 50 ms. Dadurch ist die WF 706 auch als Universalzhler mit maxi mal 6 Kanlen einsetzbar.
internes Zhlregister Nullpunktverschiebung
Referenzpunktwert
Modulowert
Vergleichswert 1 (VGL 1) Auswertung der Vergleichsergebnisse 4 Digitalausgnge Steilheit Beschleunigungs-Rampe Steilheit Bremsrampe Analogmodul Analogausgang Rampenerzeugung
Vergleichswert 2 (VGL 2)
Frequenzumrichter
4/83
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
Gesteuerte Positonierung mit IP 240 oder WF 706 C
IP 240 Anzahl der Achsen Anschliebare Wegmeger max. 2 S inkremental 5 V S inkremental 24 V WF 706 3/6 S inkremental 5 V S SSIAbsolut Wertgeber 500 kHz 1 Mbit/s 16 777 215 Inkremente Referenznocken (Vorkontakt)
Geberfrequenz bei 5 V inkremental bei 24 V inkremental bertragungsrate (SSI) Verfahrbereich Binreingnge je Achse
Binrausgnge je Achse,
2 fr S Eilgang S Schleichgang oder S rechts S links 254 je Achse typ. 2 ms 16 Byte S Lngenmessung S externe Synchronisation S Zhlfunktionen S Rundachse S selbstndige Berechnung der Schaltpunkte
4 fr S Eilgang S Schleichgang oder S rechts S links 2 je Achse < 50 ms 8 Byte S Lngenmessung S externe Synchronisation S Zhlfunktionen S schneller Datenaustausch mit der CPU S kurze Reaktions zeiten S Analogmodul fr Frequenzumrichter (optional)
Besondere Merkmale
Technische Daten
Anschliebare Geber inkrementale Geber synchr.serielle Absolutwert geber (SSI) 24VSignalgeber (BERO) symmetrische Signale A, A; B, B; Z, Z. Vierfachauswertung erfolgt immer max. max. max. 16 777 215 Inkremente nein 500 kHz 35 m 13 Bit, 21 Bit und 25 Bit Daten lnge (SSI, Gray oder BinrCode) 24 Bit werden ausgewertet Verfahrbereich max. 8192 Winkelschritte je Umdrehung 2048 Umdrehungen nein 62,5 kbit/s bis 1 Mbit/s max. max. 120 m 25 m siehe Binreingnge 200 kHz 16 777 215 2 je Kanal 24 V 5 mA (bei 24 V) 4 je Kanal 24 V 0,5 A (kurzschlufest)
Potentialtrennung bertragungsrate Leitungslnge (geschirmt) bei 125 kbit/s bei 1 Mbit/s Zhlen 24VEingnge Zhlfrequenz Zhlbereich Binreingnge Eingangsspannung Eingangsstrom Binrausgnge Ausgangsspannung Ausgangsstrom
Wegerfassung inkremental 5VEingnge (nach RS 422) Verfahrbereich Potentialtrennung Zhlfrequenz Leitungslnge(geschirmt) Wegerfassung absolut
max. max.
max.
4/84
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
WegerfassungsbaugruppeWF 706 C (Fortsetzung) Technische Daten (Fortsetzung)
Analogausgnge (optional) S pro Modul angesteuert durch - WF 706 C - SIMATIC S5 S Ausgangsspannung Ausgangsstrom Reaktionszeit berwachungen Versorgungsspannungen S Nennwert S Welligkeit Uss S zulssiger Bereich (Welligkeit eingeschlossen) Stromaufnahme (bei 5 V) S 3KanalAusfhrung S 6KanalAusfhrung Versorgungsstrom fr Weg megeber bei 5 V und bei 24 V Belegte Adressen Platzbedarf S 3KanalAusfhrung S 6KanalAusfhrung Gewicht S 3KanalAusfhrung S 6KanalAusfhrung etwa etwa 0,75 A (ohne Geberversorgung) 1,5 A (ohne Geberversorgung)
4 3 1 DC - 10 V ... +10 V - 5 mA ... + 5 mV < 50 ms bei ohmscher Last auf Kabelbruch und Kurzschlu DC 24 V 3V 20 ... 30 V
max.
0,3 A je Geber 8 Byte 1 Einbauplatz 1 x 11/3 SEP 2 x 11/3 SEP 0,4 kg 0,45 kg
Bestelldaten
Positionierbaugruppe WF 706 C mit 3 Kanlen mit 6 Kanlen Analogmodul zustzlich zu bestellen ist Beschreibung WF 706 mit BeispielprogrammDiskette
BestellNr.
Preis Steckleitung 790 zwischen WF 706 und S HeidenhainWegmegeber ROD 320 Standardlngen 5m 10 m 18 m Sonderlngen1): max. 35 m S SiemensWegmegeber 6FC9 320 oder 6FX2 0012 Standardlngen 2m 5m 10 m 18 m Sonderlngen1): max. 35 m S SSIWegmegeber mit offenem Leitungsende Standardlngen
BestellNr.
Preis
6FM1 790-1CA00 6FM1 790-1CB00 6FM1 790-1CC00 6FM1 790-1CD00 6FM1 790-1 CZ00
2m 5m 10 m 18 m
6FM1 790-1FA00 6FM1 790-1FB00 6FM1 790-1FC00 6FM1 790-1FD00 6FM1 790-1 FZ00
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/85
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
Das Nockensteuerwerk WF 707 dient der Ausgabe von wegabhngigen Schalt funktionen bei Antrieben mit Linear und Rundachsen. Das Einsatzgebiet liegt hauptsch lich bei kleinen und schnellau fenden Maschinen.
Aufbau
Die Baugruppe verfgt ber 16 Nockenbahnen, auf denen insgesamt 32 Nocken verteilt werden knnen.
An die Baugruppe lassen sich folgende Geber anschlieen: S Inkrementalgeber S Absolutwertgeber mit seriel ler Datenbertragung (SSIGeber) S Einfache 24VSignalgeber (BERO) Zustzlich stehen zur Verf gung: S Ein Zhlnocken S Ein Bremsnocken. Durch die geschwindigkeits abhngige, dynamische Ver schiebung gleicht jeder Nok ken automatisch die Totzeit des angeschlossenen Stell gliedes aus. Jeder Nockendatensatz ist whrend des Betriebes ber das Automatisierungsgert vernderbar , so da auch an der laufenden Maschine opti miert werden kann. Ein Rck lesen der Istwerte bzw. der aktuellen Nockendaten ist mglich. Fr jede Nockenbahn steht ein Digitalausgang 24 V/0,5 A auf der Baugruppe direkt zur Verfgung. Damit lassen sich die zu steuernden Aggregate direkt oder ber Hilfsschtze ansteuern. Nicht bentigte Digitalausgnge knnen vom Automatisierungsgert ange steuert werden.
Durch die geringe Schnittstel lenbreite von 8 Byte im Peri pheriebereich knnen bis zu 16 Baugruppen in einem Au tomatisierungsgert betrieben werden. Die Baugruppe bentigt 1 Ein bauplatz. Die berwachung der S Gebersignale, S Synchronisation, S Digitalausgnge erhht die Betriebssicherheit bzw. fhrt im Fehlerfall zu de finierten Betriebszustnden und Meldungen. Der Digitalausgang OKMel dung signalisiert den fehler freien Betrieb. Die Synchronisation des Ist wertzhlers mit dem inkre mentalen Geber ist mglich durch S GeberNullmarke, S externes Synchronisations signal, S externes Synchronisations signal und GeberNullmarke (UNDVerknpfung) und S Synchronisationsbit vom Automatisierungsgert.
Arbeitsweise
32 Nocken, die beliebig auf 16 Nockenbahnen verteilt werden knnen, schalten ge nauer als 1 Grad bei 2400 Takten pro Minute. Das ent spricht einer Reaktionszeit kleiner als 60 ms. Bei Verln gerung der Reaktionszeit auf ca. 120 ms stehen sogar 64 Nocken zur Verfgung. Soll mit linearen Bewegungen gearbeitet werden, knnen je weils 32 Nocken beliebig auf geteilt werden fr ein Nocken programm Vorwrts und ein Nockenprogramm Rck wrts. Die Umschaltung zwi schen den beiden Program men erfolgt entweder mit Hilfe der automatischen Richtungs erkennung oder gesteuert durch das Automatisierungs gert. Alle Nocken knnen wahl weise definiert werden als S WegWegNocken oder S WegZeitNocken.
4/86
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
NockensteuerwerkWF 707 (Fortsetzung) Gesteuerte Positonierung mit IP 241 und WF 707
IP 241 Anzahl der Kanle Weggebereingnge 2 mit Geberan pamodul: Geber mit 3ExcessGrayCode, BCDCode, DualCode; Analogwertgeber 50 kHz fr digitale Werte; 200 kHz fr absolute, serielle Me werteingabe pro Kanal 16 Spuren mit je 1 Nocke ja WF 707 1 5VInkremental geber (RS 422) 24VInkremental geber SSIAbsolutwertgeber
maximale Zhlfrequenz
Technische Daten
Fr rotatorische Achse Nocken pro Nockenprogramm Nocken wirksam Zykluszeit pro Nockenprogramm Nocken pro Nockenprogramm Nocken wirksam Zykluszeit pro Nockenprogramm Fr lineare Achse Nocken pro S Vorwrtsprogramm S Rckwrtsprogramm Zykluszeit pro Nockenprogramm Nocken Nockenarten 32 32 57,6 ms 32 vorwrts/rckwrts 57,6 ms 64 vorwrts/rckwrts 115,2 ms erforderlicher Eingangsstrom der Gebersignale Nutzung des Gebersignals fr weitere Baugruppen Wegerfassung, inkrementell 5 VEingnge (nach RS 422) Verfahrbereich Potentialtrennung Zhlfrequenz S S S S max. max. WegWegNocken WegZeitNocken ZhlNocken BremsNocken max. max. symmetrische Signale A, A; B,B; z, Zt. immer Vierfachauswertung 65 536 Inkremente nein 500 kHz max. Programmierung WegWegNocken WegZeitNocken anschliebare Geber Start/Endposition in Inkrementen Startposition in Inkrementen, Zeit als Faktor zur Zykluszeit Inkrementalgeber Synchr.serieller Absolutwert geber (SSIAbsolutwertgeber) 24VSignalgeber (BERO) 10 mA 5
Nockenbahnen Taktzahl/min
16 2400
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/87
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
Verfahrbereich Potentialtrennung bertragungsrate Digitaleingnge Eingangsspannung Eingangsstrom Potentialtrennung Eingangsfrequenz Digitalausgnge Ausgangsspannung Ausgangsstrom Potentialtrennung
S GeberLeitungsbruch S Geberfehler S Kurzschlu/berlastung der Digitalausgnge S Synchronisation S Istwert S Nockenbahnstatus S Bewegungsrichtung DC 24 V 3V 20 bis 30 V DC 5 V 0,25 A 0,3 A 1 Einbauplatz
Versorgungsspannungen Up S Nennwert S Welligkeit Uss S zulssiger Bereich (Welligkeit eingeschlossen) Versorgungsspannung Stromaufnahme bei DC 5 V ohne Geber Versorgungsstrom fr Weggeber bei DC 5 V und DC 24 V max. Platzbedarf Gewicht etwa
0,4 kg
Bestelldaten
Nockensteuerwerk WF 707 Steckleitung 790 zwischen WF 707 und S WF 707 zum Durchschleifen der Wegistwerte 0,5 m Lngen 2,0 m S HeidenhainWegmegeber ROD 320 S SiemensWegmegeber 6FC9 320 oder 6FX2 0012 S SSIWegmegeber mit offenem Leitungsende
Preis Wegmegeber S fr Anbau 1000 Pulse/Umdrehung 2000 Pulse/Umdrehung 2500 Pulse/Umdrehung S fr Einbau in Motoren der Baureihe 1 FT S weitere Wegmegeber zustzlich zu bestellen ist die Beschreibung WF 707 mit Beispielprogramm Diskette und EMVRichtlinien
BestellNr.
Preis
6FX2 001-2CB00 6FX2 001-2CC00 6FX2 001-2CC50 siehe Katalog SD 12 siehe Katalog ST 71 6ZB5 440-0ST01-0BA3
6FM1 790-1JS00 6FM1 790-1JA00 siehe WF 706C (siehe Seite 4/85) siehe WF 706C (siehe Seite 4/85) siehe WF 706C (siehe Seite 4/85)
4/88
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C Anwendungsbereich Die Baugruppen WF 721, WF 723 A, WF 723 B und WF 723 C bilden die Positio nierfamilie WF 721/WF 723. Diese Baugruppen decken das Positionierspektrum ab bezglich geregeltem Positio nieren von drehzahlgeregelten Antrieben fr sowohl Einachs als auch Mehrachsanwendun gen. Durch sie lassen sich die elektrischen und hydrauli schen Achsen von Maschinen
und Anlagen einfach und wirtschaftlich automatisieren, z. B.: S Transferstraen S Frdereinrichtungen S Montagelinien S Beschickungseinrichtungen S Pressen S Holzbearbeitungsmaschinen S Verpackungsmaschinen S Handhabungsgerte, Portale S Sondermaschinen S Rundtaktmaschinen
WF 721/WF 723 A
Die Positionierbaugruppe WF 721 ist fr typische Ein achsAnwendungen geeignet, whrend die WF 723 A auch fr die Anwendung von meh reren unabhngigen Achsen ausgelegt ist. Die Positionier baugruppen WF 721/WF723 A Die Positionierbaugruppe WF 723 B setzt auf der Funk tionalitt der WF 721/ WF 723 A auf und ergnzt das Positionierspektrum in der SIMATIC S5 hinsichtlich NCFunktionalitt. Die Positio Neben Einachs und NCAn wendungen gibt es weitere Positionieraufgaben, wobei mehrere Achsen in einem Ver fahrprogramm koordiniert und damit verkettet zu verfahren
sind bezglich der Funktiona litt und der Datenformate der WFParameter identisch. Das heit, ein Maschinendatensatz einer WF 723 AAchse kann auch von einer WF 721Achse interpretiert werden und um gekehrt. Die WF 721 besitzt nierbaugruppe WF 723 B beinhaltet Bearbeitungsfunk tionen wie Linear und Zirku larinterpolation, Spindelfunk tionen, Parameterrechnung und StandardBohrzyklen. Die Baugruppe WF 723 B lt sind. Die Positionierbau gruppe WF 723 C vervollstn digt mit dieser Funktionalitt die Positionierfamilie WF 721/ WF 723. Weitere wichtige An forderungen knnen mit der
darber hinaus im Vergleich zu einer WF 723 A einen dop pelt so schnellen Mekreis takt. Sie ist deshalb beson ders fr dynamische EinachsPositionieraufgaben geeignet.
WF 723 B
sich fr drei Vorschubachsen, zwei Vorschubachsen und eine Spindel oder fr drei Vor schubachsen und eine ex terne Spindel verwenden.
WF 723 C
WF 723 C erfllt werden, z.B. schnelles und exaktes Positio nieren von Walzenvorschben und Gleichlauf von maximal 3 Achsen.
Aufbau
Maschinensteuertafel
WF 470
GRACIS-S5
PG-Anschaltung
Durch die Standardisierung der Nahtstellen lassen sich Peripherie, Hardware und SoftwareModule baugrup penbergreifend einsetzen. Dies spart Kosten bei der Projektierung, der Inbetrieb nahme und dem Service. An die Baugruppen lassen sich folgende Geber anschlie en: S Inkrementalgeber S Absolutwertgeber mit seriel ler Datenbertragung (SSI) Durch die geringe Schnittstel lenbreite von 32 Byte im Peri pheriebereich lassen sich bis zu 28 Baugruppen, d. h. 84 Achsen in einem Automatisie rungsgert betreiben. Die Baugruppen bentigen je weils 1 Einbauplatz. Ein Be trieb ohne Lfter ist mglich.
Software Standard A
WF 721
WF 723A
WF 723B
WF 723C SIMATIC S5
M T
M T
M T
M T
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/89
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C (Fortsetzung) Arbeitsweise Die Baugruppen ermglichen schnelles und genaues Posi tionieren beim Einrichten,
Betriebsarten Einrichten Referenzpunktfahren Handbetrieb (MDI) Steuern Automatik AutomatikEinzelschritt AutomatikEinzelsatz Nachfhrbetrieb Slave
Mit Maschinendaten wird die Positionierbaugruppe an die spezielle Bearbeitungstech nologie angepat.
Grundauflsung Geberfrequenz S absolut S bei 5 V inkremental S bei 24 V inkremental Verfahrbereich Verfahrgeschw. Beschleunigung max.
max. max.
Programmspeicher
zeit oder quittungsgesteuert vor, whrend oder nach Verfahrsatz, istwertbezogen 4msZeitraster 4msZeitraster
ja 6/6 Binreingnge fr S externen Satzwechsel S Start von extern S externen Satzwechsel mit fliegendem IstwertSetzen S fliegendes Messen ja ja ja fr COM 723, PCSteuern zentral ber SIMATIC S5-PGSchnittstelle COM 723 und Standard B470, StandardBOP25 Standard BGRACIS Standard A und Standard B470, StandardBOP25 Standard BGRACIS PCSteuern
S Simulation S SatzVorlauf/Rcklauf S Satz Ausblenden PGAnschlu Software fr S Erstellen von Maschinendaten und Verfahrprogramm S Untersttzung bei Test und Inbetriebnahme
ja
4/90
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C (Fortsetzung) Programmierung Der modulare Aufbau der StandardSoftware erleichtert das Erstellen maschinenspe zifischer STEP 5Programme. Der Speicher der
Speicherkapazitt Anzahl Programme Anzahl/ Stze/Programme max. Gesamt anzahl Stze
SIMATIC S5 wird dabei nicht belastet. Die Programme las sen sich auch im Simulations betrieb testen, ohne die Ma schine in Betrieb zu nehmen.
WF 721 200 100 250 WF 723 A 200/Achse 100 750
Die Kommunikation zwischen der SIMATIC S5 und den Posi tionierbaugruppen bernimmt die Software Standard A.
Bedienung ber COM 723 PCSteuern Standard B470 Standard BGRACIS Standard BOP25
WF 721 x x x x x
WF 723 A x x x x x
WF 723 B x x x in Vorbereitung
WF 723 C x x in Vorbereitung
COM 723
Komfortabel bei Programmie rung und Projektierung und untersttzend bei Inbetrieb nahme und Service. Das Soft warePaket COM 723 in Ver bindung mit SYSDOK 723 hilft. Einfach und schnell las sen sich mit COM 723 Daten stze erstellen und archivie ren, die damit im Inbetriebnahme und Service fall schnell und unabhngig verfgbar sind.
COM 723 bietet: S Einfache Handhabung durch bedienergefhrte Window Technik auf Basis Windows 3.1 S Einfache, kurze und flexible Projektierung und Inbetrieb nahme durch Plausibilitts kontrollen und OfflinePro jektierung im Bro S Kurze Projektierungszeiten durch das Duplizieren von Anlagendateien und das ge meinsame Datenformat mit Standard BGRACIS SYSDOK 723 basiert auf dem StandardHilfesystem von MSWindows und luft in ei nem eigenen Fenster neben COM 723. Es bietet neben der kontextbezogenen Hilfe folgende Funktionen:
Einfacher und schneller Baugruppentausch durch Einstellung und Parametrie rung der Baugruppe mittels Joblisten S Servicefreundlichkeit durch das schnelle Vergleichen von Dateninhalten S Gut lesbare Datenstze durch mgliche anwender spezifische Erluterungen S Schneller Zugriff auf unter sttzende Informationen durch die systemintegrierte, papierlose Dokumentation SYSDOK 723
S S S S S S S
SYSDOK 723
Die Systemintegrierte Doku mentation SYSDOK 723 bein haltet die papierlose Form der jeweiligen Funktionsbeschrei bung bzw. Programmieranlei tung.
Einblendung und Sprnge zu verwandten Themen Blttern schrittweises Zurckverfol gen des Informationspfades elektronische Lesezeichen elektronische Notizzettel Suchen mit zweistufigem Index
PCSteuern
Mit PCSteuern steht zu Inbe triebnahme und Testzwecken ein hilfreiches Werkzeug zur Verfgung. Erste Verfahr ergebnisse der Achsen sind ohne die spter hinzukom mende Maschinensteuertafel mglich.
Im Servicefall kann der An wender zum Lokalisieren ei nes Fehlers die Achsen direkt verfahren oder mit Statusan zeige einen Achsfehler im Klartext auslesen.
Vor unbefugten Eingriffen lt sich das SoftwarePaket PC Steuern durch die Funktion Schlsselschalter schtzen. Die Bedienung von PCSteu ern erfolgt unter Windows ab Version 3.1.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/91
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C (Fortsetzung) Programmierung (Forsetzung) Standard Bedienoberflache Zur Bedienung und Diagnose der Positionierbaugruppe WF 721/723A stehen Stan dardMasken fr das Bild schirmsystem WF 470 und das Operator Panel OP 25 zur Verfgung. Die Kopplung zwischen SIMATIC S5 und dem Visualisierungsgert erfolgt mit den SoftwarePaketen Standard B470 bzw. Standard BOP 25. Diese bie ten standardisierte Masken und ermglichen zusammen mit der Mentechnik eine komfortable Bedienung. Von der Eingabe der Maschinen daten bei der Inbetriebnahme Standard BGRACIS bietet: Einfache Handhabung durch bedienergefhrte Mentech nik und Hinweise in der Sta tuszeile S Zeit und Kostenersparnis in Verbindung mit der SIMATIC S5CPU durch Standard BGRACISLsung auf Basis GRAPI (Gracis Applikations Interface) S Schnelle, kurze Fehlerlokali sierung und Inbetriebnahme durch eindeutige Schnittstel len und Meldungen im Klar text S Bedienerfreundliche Bedie nung durch einmalige Zu ordnung der Einheit in der Projektierungsphase S Einfaches ndern/Editieren von Datenstzen durch Plausibilittskontrollen S Standardbilder, die sich um spezielle Anlagenbilder er weitern lassen
S
ber die Programmierung der Verfahrbewegung bis zur Feh lerdiagnose wird der Anwen der mit Masken gefhrt. Auerdem besteht die Mg lichkeit, die Maschine an den jeweiligen Proze durch frei projektierbare Masken anzu passen.
Standard BGRACIS
Mit der Bedienoberflche Standard BGRACIS knnen die Bedienung und Diagnose sowie die Datenverwaltung und Datenversorgung der Po sitionierbaugruppen WF 721/ 723A und WF 723 B realisiert werden. Standard BGRACIS ist sowohl unter GRACIS ULB (unterer Leistungsbereich) als auch unter GRACIS OLB (oberer Leistungsbereich) ab lauffhig. Neben StandardMasken bie tet das Visualisierungssystem GRACIS die Mglichkeit, die Maschine an den jeweiligen Proze durch frei projektier bare Masken anzupassen. Die einfache Bedienerfhrung erfolgt ber Mentechnik und SoftkeyLeiste.
Bei Standard BGRACIS OLB stehen fr die Verwaltung, Versorgung und Projektierung eigene Menzweige zur Verf gung. Dadurch kann man komfortabel Datenstze ko pieren und verliert bei kom plexen Anlagen nie den ber blick. Standard BGRACIS OLB bie tet zustzlich: S Hohe Verfgbarkeit im Falle eines Baugruppendefekts durch zentrale Datenarchi vierung S Kurze Projektierungszeiten durch das Duplizieren der Anlagendateien und das ge meinsame Datenformat mit COM 723 S Sowohl lokalen als auch ver netzten Einsatz (PROFIBUS oder Industrial Ethernet) S Effektive Projektierung durch offene Struktur mit Import ExportFunktionen S Gut lesbare Datenstze durch mgliche anwender spezifische Erluterungen
Technische Daten
WF 721 Mesysteme Anzahl Kanle inkrementelle Geber SSIAbsolutwertgeber 1 WF 723 A inkrementelle Geber SSIAbsolutwertgeber 3 unabhngige Achsen WF 723 B inkrementelle Geber SSIAbsolutwertgeber 3 Vorschubachsen oder 2 Vorschubachsen/ 1 Spindel oder 3 Vorschubachsen/ 1 externe Spindel WF 723 C inkrementelle Geber SSIAbsolutwertgeber bis zu 3 unabhngig kombinierbare Achsen 2 Walzenvorschub/ 1 Achse 1 Walzenvorschub 2 Achsen 0,01 500 000 1 99 999 1 (in Vorbereitung) 999 999 (in Vorbereitung) 999.999 999
Verfahrgeschwindigkeit S von mm/min S bis mm/min Beschleunigung S von mm/s2 S bis mm/s2 Ruckbegrenzung S von mm/s2 S bis mm/s2 Verfahrbereich in m max. Spindeldrehzahl (1/min)
4/92
Siemens ST 50 1998
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C (Fortsetzung) Technische Daten (Fortsetzung)
WF 721 Kenngren S 1 Referenzpunkt je Achse S 2 SoftwareEndschalter S Rundachse rangierbar S UmkehrloseKompensation S TEACH IN S Istwertbewertungsfaktor zur Anpassung von Getriebeberset zungen S 6 Nullpunktverschiebungen S Linear/Zirkularinterpolation S Schraubenlinien/FWort Interpolation S StandardBohrzyklen/ Parameter S orientierter Spindelhalt S Gleichlauf von 3 Achsen S Verfahrprogramme DIN 66025 Walzenvorschub Technologische Korrekturen S Vorschub/Beschleunigung (Override) S Driftkompensation S Werkzeugkorrektur Eingnge fr Prozesignale S fliegendes Messen/Istwertsetzen S Start UND/ODER verknpft S externer Satzwechsel S Referenzpunktverfahren ohne BERO/setzen S Istwert sperren/ Einlesefreigabe extern Ausgnge fr Prozesignale S nderung von MFunktionen S Position erreicht und Halt S Achse fhrt vorwrts/rckwrts S Startfreigabe S Konstantfahrt/Beschleunigen, Verzgern Schaltfunktionen (MFunktionen, BCDAusgabe +2 Dekaden) S quittungs/zeitgesteuert S wegabhngig berwachungen S Systemprogrammspeicher S Busnahtstelle S Ein/Ausgabe der Daten S Schleppabstand S Spannungswerte 5 V, 15 V, 24 V S Mekreis S Gleichlauftoleranz Versorgungsspannungen S Baugruppe (von SIMATIC S5Bus) Spannung/Stromaufnahme S Geber Spannung intern/extern Stromaufnahme bei DC 5 V/ DC 24 V je Geber S Eingnge (pro Kanal) Spannung/Stromaufnahme S Ausgnge (pro Kanal) Spannung/Strom max. SignalspannungsSollwert S Spannung/Strom bei 10 V x x x x x x / / / x x/x x Lnge, Verschlei x/x x x x/x / x x x x / WF 723 A x x x x x x / / / x x/x x Lnge, Verschlei x/x x x x/x / x x x x / WF 723 B x x x x x x x 3D/2D x/x x/x x x x/ x Lnge, Radius, Verschlei x/ x x/ / x x x x / WF 723 C x x x x x x x 2D/ / / x x x1) x/x x Lnge, Verschlei x/x x x x/x x/x x x x x x/x
x/x x x x x x x x
x/x x x x x x x x
x/x x x x x x x
x/x x x x x x x
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/93
Signalvorverarbeitende Baugruppen
PositionierbaugruppenWF 721/WF 723 A/WF 723 B/WF 723 C (Fortsetzung) Technische Daten (Fortsetzung)
WF 721 Ein und Ausgnge S parametrierbare Aus/Eingnge S Reglerfreigabe/Reglerrckmeldung SIMATIC S5115U, 135U, 155U S Platzbedarf S belegter Adreraum S Anzahl Baugruppen, max. S Betrieb ohne Lfter Gewicht etwa 6/6 1/1 1 x 11/3 SEP 32 Byte 28 mglich 0,6 kg WF 723 A 6/6 3/3 1 x 11/3 SEP 32 Byte 28 mglich 0,7 kg WF 723 B 6/6 3/3 1 x 11/3 SEP 32 Byte 28 mglich 0,7 kg WF 723 C 6/6 3/3 1 x 11/3 SEP 32 Byte 28 mglich 0,7 kg
1) Funktionen Walzenvorschub: Konstantfahrt, Ruck am Beschleunigungsanfang, Beschleunigungsknickpunkte, Istwertnullen bei Start oder externer Einlesefreigabe, berspeichern des Geschwindigkeitswertes, Druckmarkensteuerung
Bestelldaten
Positionierbaugruppe WF 721 Positionierbaugruppe WF723A Firmware-Hochrstsatz WF 721 Firmware-Hochrstsatz WF 723 A Positionierbaugruppe WF 723 B Firmware-Hochrstsatz WF 723 B Positionierbaugruppe WF 723 C Wegmegeber, inkrementell S fr Anbau 1000 Pulse/Umdrehung 2000 Pulse/Umdrehung 2500 Pulse/Umdrehung weitere S fr Einbau in Motoren der Baureihe 1FT Standard A Kopplung SIMATIC S5 mit WFTechnologiebaugruppen Standard B-470 STEP 5Bausteine fr SIMATIC S5 und Bildmasken fr WF 470 Kopplung Standard A mit WF 470 Software fr Datenverkehr Standard-B-GRACIS ULB Bildmasken und Textlisten fr GRACIS ULB Kopplung Standard A mit GRACIS GrundSoftware Standard B-GRACIS OLB Applikationen und Bildmasken fr GRACIS OLB Kopplung Standard A mit GRACIS GrundSoftware Standard-B-OP 25 STEP 5Bausteine fr SIMATIC S5 und Bildmasken fr OP 25 Kopplung Standard A Software-Pakete fr Programmiergerte PG 710+/ 720/730/740/750/760/770 oder IBM kompatiblen StandardPC (Dis kette 3,5" MSDOS) Software COM 723 einschlielich SYSDOK 723 und Beschreibung COM 723 PC-Steuern
BestellNr. 6FM1 721-3AA20 6FM1 723-3AA10 6FM1 721-4AA00 6FM1 723-4AA00 6FM1 723-3BA00 6FM1 723-4BA00 6FM1 723-3CA00
Preis Dokumentation Kurzbeschreibung WF 721/ WF 723A deutsch Handbuch WF 721/ 723A komplett S deutsch S englisch SYSDOK 723A S deutsch S englisch Kurzbeschreibung WF 723B deutsch Beschreibung WF 723B deutsch Handbuch WF 723B komplett S deutsch S englisch SYSDOK 723B S deutsch S englisch Kurzbeschreibung WF 723C S deutsch S englisch Beschreibung WF 721/WF 723 S deutsch S englisch
BestellNr.
Preis
6ZB5 440-0PW01-0BA5
6ZB5 440-0VK01-0BA2 6ZB5 440-0VK02-0BA2 6ZB5 440-0RS01-2AA6 6ZB5 440-0RS02-2AA5 6ZB5 440-0SB01-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0SC01-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0VM01-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0VM02-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0SJ01-2AA2 6ZB5 440-0SJ02-2AA2 6ZB5 440-0VS01-0BA0 6ZB5 440-0VS02-0BA0 6ZB5 440-0VP01-0BA2 6ZB5 440-0VP02-0BA2 6ZB5 440-0VY01-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0VY02-0BA1 6ZB5 440-0WA01-2AA2
6FX2 001-2CB00 6FX2 001-2CC00 6FX2 001-2CC50 siehe Katalog ST 71 siehe Katalog SD 114 6FM1 700-7UA31-1AA0
6FM1 723-8AA31-1AA0
6FM1 723-8UD31-1MA0
Handbuch WF 723C komplett S deutsch S englisch SYSDOK 723C deutsch Steckleitung 790 zwischen S WF 721 und Stromrichter Standardlngen
6FM1 723-8UC31-1AA0
6FM1 025-8AA30-1MA0
6FM1 723-6UA31-1AA0
Sonderlngen, max. 30 m1) S WF 723 und Stromrichter Standardlngen 2m 5m 10 m Sonderlngen, max. 30 m1) zwischen WFBaugruppe und S Heidenhain ROD 320 S SiemensWegmegeber 6FC9 320 S SSIWegmegeber, 1 Leitungsende offen
1)
2m 5m 10 m
6FM1 790-2BA00 6FM1 790-2BB01 6FM1 790-2BC00 6FM1 790-2BZ00 6FM1 790-2CA00 6FM1 790-2CB00 6FM1 790-2CC00 6FM1 790-2CD00 siehe WF 706C siehe WF 706C siehe WF 706C
6FM1 723-6UB30-1MA0
4/94
Siemens ST 50 1998
Special modules
Supplementary devices
Simulation Simulation modules 313 monitoring module Page 4/104 4/105
CP 516 memory submodule Application The CP 516 memory submo dule is used for storing large amounts of data which are not constantly required in the user memory of the CPU, e.g. recipes and message texts. The module can also be used as a backup medium for pro duction data acquisition.
Design
Two memory cards can be in serted in the CP 516 memory submodule. Memory cards with flash EPROM are useful for storing data for reading only. For greater data protec tion when using RAM memory Data storage is controlled by the CPU using a standard function block. The data
cards, a lithium battery can be fitted in the CP 516 memory submodule, to en sure that the data is retained when the CP 516 is not plugged in.
The module has a special connection for data inter change with a programming device.
Principle of operation
Technical specifications
Number of memory locations Memory capacity Current consumption (at 5 V) max. max. 2 8 Mbyte 0.8 A Power loss Space requirements Weight max. 5W 1 slot 0.6 kg (1.32 lb)
Ordering data
CP 516 memory submodule Standard function blocks including CP 516 manual To be ordered as a separate item: CP 516 manual German English French
Order No. 6ES5 516-3UA11 see Section 7 Memory card RAM, 256 Kbytes RAM, 512 Kbytes RAM, 1 Mbytes Flash EPROM, 256 Kbytes Flash EPROM, 1 Mbytes Flash EPROM, 2 Mbytes Flash EPROM, 4 Mbytes Lithium backup battery for CP 516
Order No.
6ES5 374-2AH21 6ES5 374-2AJ21 6ES5 374-2AK21 6ES5 374-2FH21 6ES5 374-2FK21 6ES5 374-2FL21 6ES5 374-2FM21 6ES5 980-0AE11
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/95
Design
The CP 581 has a modular design. It consists of a basic board and optionally a mass storage module and up to 2 slot modules. CP 581 basis board The basic board contains the following: S 80486 DX4 microprocessor (100 MHz) S VGA graphics interface (can be disabled) S User memory, modular with 4 to 32 Mbyte S Receptacle for a memory card with 1 Mbyte, 2 Mbyte, 4 Mbyte, 8 Mbyte or 16 Mbyte capacity S Optional 4 Mbyte onboard silicon disk can be ac cessed as drive and imple mented with flash EPROMS S 1 V.24/TTY interface (COM 1) for printer S 1 V.24/RS 485 interface (COM 2) for mouse S 1 free V.24/RS 485 interface (COM 3) S 1 VIDEO interface for multi frequency monitor (3 Coax midi sockets) for distances up to 250 m (820 ft) S 1 interface for standard key board, for distances up to 250 m (820 ft) with remote terminal interface (RTI)
Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN""STOP" switch: The tasks executed for the different switch settings can be specified in the user pro gram (e.g. application start in the case of "RUN"). S "RESET" pushbutton S LEDs: "RUN" (green) for operation "STOP" (red) for interrupts S LEDs: "Fault" (red) for module faults, "SD" (green) for indicating memory card access Mass storage module Every basic board can be ex panded by a mass storage module. A mass storage module con sists of the following: S Hard disk drive with at least 800 Mbyte capacity S 31/2" diskette drive S 1 Centronics interface for e.g. dongle, printer S 1 free V.24/TTY interface (COM 4) Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "HD" LED (green) indicates access to the hard disk
Slot module A basic board can be ex panded by up to 2 slot mod ules. A short AT module can be plugged into a slot module. The short AT module for the CP 581 can be up to 10 mm wide, 120 mm high and 165 mm deep. The CP 581 receives its power supply and battery backup from the program mable controller. The CP 581 integral personal computer requires 1 to 4 slots depending on configuration. CP 581 system software The CP 581 system software contains communications software for data exchange with the CPU of the program mable controller (see Fig. 4/44) and the CP_Link soft ware. CP_Link enables startup of the basic board without mass memory module using a pro gramming device or PC via the interface (COM 1) of the CP 581. Using CP_Link, the operating system and the user program can be loaded into the basic board without mass storage module.
4/96
Siemens ST 50 1998
Special modules
The German version of the MSDOS V 6.22 operating system is included in the scope of delivery of the basic board.
Language upgrades for Eng lish and French are to be or dered separately.
Principle of operation
CP 581
Applications
MSDOS
Hard disk
S5 driver
CPU
S5 user programs
S5 data
Functions
Process data acquisition This function can be used to capture data from different S5 data areas, such as data blocks and bit memories, in the CP 581. This data can be read globally or selectively from the data area within a defined timebase and col lected in one or more files in the CP 581. The CP 581 can record the collected and con verted process data and then manage and process this data with a suitable MSDOS user program (e.g. dBASE),
and all independently of the programmable controller. S5 drive emulation Thanks to the S5 drive emu lation, S5 data can easily be incorporated into CP 581 pro grams. S S5 data blocks can be con verted automatically in order to incorporate them e.g. into standard programs such as Excel or Lotus 123 without any intermediate steps. S S5 data blocks can be ac cessed via almost all MSDOS commands.
After starting the drive emu lation (S5 Remote), the CP 581 provides a new (virtual) drive. This is a logical and not a physical drive. There are 4 catalogs on this drive, one each for the CPUs 1 to 4. The CP 581 stores the data blocks of the CPUs in the catalogs in the form of MSDOS files. It is operated online with data of the S5CPU.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/97
mands on the CP 581 from the CPU. If the CP 581 is oper ated without keyboard and monitor (e.g. mass memory functions), the command in terpreter can be used, if nec essary, to copy data on the CP 581 or to execute other necessary MSDOS functions. Programming Programming is used to solve all those tasks resulting from communication between the CPU and the CP 581 which cannot be handled by the system programs supplied.
These include, e.g., data ex change with higherlevel com puters or operator inputs for a CPU. Additional functions Interrupts are possible from the CP 581 integral PC to the CPU of the programmable controller and vice versa. Direct network connection is possible via a slot module. The booting sequence can be selected freely by the user.
Ambient temperature S Operating S Transport/storage S Relative humidity Supply voltage Current consumption S At + 5 V S At + 24 V Power loss Dualport RAM Space requirements Weight Mass storage module Diskette drive Hard disk drive (memory capacity) min.
typ. typ.
Shock (measured on hard disk drive) S Form max. S Duration max. S Operating max. S Transport max.
1/ 2
Weight
4/98
Siemens ST 50 1998
Special modules
6ES7 478-1AM00-0AA0 6ES7 478-1AN00-0AA0 6ES7 478-1AP00-0AA0 6ES7 478-1AQ00-0AA0 6ES7 478-1BM10-0AA0
6ES5 736-2BD20 6ES5 736-2BF00 6ES5 736-2CB00 6ES5 581-3LA11 6ES5 581-0RA12
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/99
Design
788-7LA simulation module For 16 binary input signals and 16 binary output signals. The module is for use with the 482 digital input/output mod ule. The module contains the fol lowing: S 16 switches for the input of binary signals; can be used as latching pushbutton (to the left) or as momentary contact pushbutton (to the right) S 16 LEDs for indicating binary output signals S 2 sockets for feeding in the signal voltages S 1 connection for the 7687LA cable (0.3 m (1 ft); to be or dered separately) to the 482 digital input/output module
788-7LB simulation module For 1 analog input signal and 1 analog output signal. The module is for use with the 460 analog input module and the 4707LB analog output mod ule. The module contains the following: S 1 rotary switch for selecting the input range S 1 tenturn potentiometer for setting the input value (scale 0 to 100 %) S 1 measuring instrument for indicating the input value (scale 0 to 100 %) S 1 rotary switch for selecting the output range S 1 measuring instrument for indicating the output value (scale 0 to 100 %) S 1 connection for the 7687LB cable (0.3 m (1 ft); to be or dered separately) to the 460 analog input module and to the 4707LB analog output module
788-7LC simulation module For input and indication of digital values (e.g. timer or counter values). The module is for use with the 482 digital input/output module. It con tains the following: S 1 4digit key code switch for specifying digital values S 1 4digit numerical display for indicating digital values S 1 connection for the 7687LA cable (0.3 m (1 ft); to be or dered separately) to the 482 digital input/output module The simulation modules can be used in the central control ler ZG 135U/155U, ZG 135U and in the expansion unit EG 185U. The modules each require 2 slots.
Ordering data
788-7LA simulation module for binary signals 788-7LB simulation module for analog signals 788-7LC simulation module for digital values
Order No. 6ES5 788-7LA11 6ES5 788-7LB11 6ES5 788-7LC11 To be ordered as a separate item: Manual German English Connecting cables for simulation modules in S5135U/155U
Order No.
4/104
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC VIDEOMAT picture evaluation system Application The main application for SIMATIC VIDEOMAT is in S assembly technology in the automotive industry and au tomotive suppliers, the elec trical industry, the plastics industry and in S packaging technology in the pharmaceutical, cosmetic, foodstuffs and beverage in dustries. The module allows:
S
SIMATIC VIDEOMAT is a com plete picture evaluation sys tem for implementation in the S5115U, S5135U/155U or S5155H programmable con trollers. With SIMATIC VIDEO MAT, pictures from both monochrome and color cam eras can be evaluated. The automation of visual inspec tion using picture evaluation systems results in uniform product quality and is there fore both reliable and eco nomical.
S S S
Contactless visual inspec tion for quality assurance (dimensions, contours, shape, existence, assembly, location, quantity) Monitoring of highspeed processes Inspection of products with high throughput Identification of components on the basis of shape, di mensions, pattern, color, codes or characters Assignment of components to classes and categories
Features SIMATIC VIDEOMAT has the following special features: S Up to six cameras can be connected S Fast moving objects can be captured from different view points S Picture preprocessing in realtime S Recorded picture data is ac cessed while the picture is still being acquired S Processing rates of up to 30 items per second S Remote diagnostics and service is possible via mo dem and telephone lines S Perfect optimization of the production process due to knowledge from online log ging S Wide range of applications by configuration of the most varied inspection tasks S Low configuration effort due to easy operation and tried and tested function blocks S Space saving integration into SIMATIC automation systems
4/106
Siemens ST 50 1998
CCD cameras
Interfaces: S SVGA video output with si multaneous display of pic ture and graphic S PCMCIA interface for connecting a modem for digital picture and data transmission via the tele phone lines S 1 serial (RS232 or TTY) inter face and 1 centronics inter face S Keyboard interface, mouse interface S 8 x 24 V digital inputs S 8 x 24 V digital outputs Principle of operation SIMATIC VIDEOMAT is a tar get system and programming system in one. The request for evaluation and output of the results takes place automati cally via communication with the SIMATIC CPU.
Software: MSDOS 6.2 operating sys tem S System software for interac tive generation of applica tions from monochrome pic tures including parameterizable sequencing control and an interface to the process
S S
Test programs, data and also camera pictures can be ar chived onboard. In order to program the sys tem, simply connect a moni tor and keyboard. On the monitor, up to three pictures, data and graphics can be dis played in windows.
Due to userfriendly operator prompting, the picture evalua tion system SIMATIC VIDEO MAT is easily adapted to the specific task, and no pro gramming knowledge is nec essary.
Technical specifications
Picture processor Picture memory Format 80486 DX4, 133 MHz 8 Mbyte From 256 x 256 x 8 bit to 1024 x 1024 x 8 bit, freely configurable MSDOS 6.2 RGB video output PCMCIA interface for connecting a modem 1 serial (RS232 or TTY) 1 centronics interface Monitor connection Keyboard connection Mouse connection 24 V digital inputs 24 V digital outputs Current consumption Space requirements 1 SVGA 1 1 8 8 4 A at 5 V 2 slots
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/107
Ordering data
SIMATIC VIDEOMAT for monochrome picture evaluation for monochrome cameras, 50 Hz or 60 Hz picture frequency, simul taneous storage of up to 3 camera pictures, system software, runtime license, several lan guages S 6 camera ports S 6 camera ports, with hardware realtime picture processing SIMATIC VIDEOMAT for color picture evaluation for RGB, FBAS, SVHS, YC color cameras, 50 Hz or 60 Hz picture frequency, HSI hardware or YUV color coding, system software, runtime license S 2 camera ports SIMATIC VIDEOMAT manual German English
Order No. CCD camera with C mount 756 x 581 square pixels, 625 lines, 50 halfpictures / s, exposure time adjustable from 1/10,000 to 1/50 s, with restart and reset, voltage rating 12 V DC, 210 mA 6GF2 005-0BC01 6GF2 005-0BE01 Single-chip-RGB color camera 756 x 581 square pixels, 625 lines, 50 halfpictures / s, exposure time adjustable from 1/10,000 to 1/50 s, voltage rating 12 V DC, 500 mA Lenses for above cameras depending on the application Lighting equipment depending on the application 6GF2 005-0CC01 6GF7 002-1CA01 6GF7 002-1CA02 14 color monitor max. resolution 1024 x 768 pixels Keyboard Mouse Connecting cables for VIDEOMAT S Adapter cable for connecting monochrome cameras S Connecting cable for one RGB color camera, Length 10 m (32.8 ft) Length 20 m (approx. 66 ft)
6GF9 002-1BA
4/108
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Personal computers Minicomputers or worksta tions S Field equipment S Printers
S S
second interface of the CPU. The CP 523, CP 524, CP 544 and CP 544B communications processors can also be used. These primarily relieve the CPU of the responsibility for communications thus enab ling a large number of I/Os to be connected. Bus interfacing Bus interfacing is used for in terlinking a number of nodes. Possible nodes include: S S5135U and S5155U/H programmable controllers S Thirdparty programmable controllers
There are four different busses to choose from, de pending on the area to be covered, the number of nodes and the transmission rate: S SINEC L1 S AS interface S PROFIBUS S Industrial Ethernet A communications processor is available for each of these four bus systems.
Communication
Page 4/110 Bus interfacing S CP 530 communications processor SINEC L1 for small and mediumsized communications applications Transmission rate 9.6 kbit/s AS interface for digital sensors and actua tors for the lowest field level PROFIBUS to PROFIBUS standard DIN 19245, Part 1 Transmission rate 9.6 to 1500 kbit/s selectable Industrial Ethernet CSMA/CD (IEEE 802.3) Transmission rate 10 Mbit/s Page 4/118
4/112 S CP 2430 FMS/DP commu nications processor 4/114 S CP 5431 FMS/DP commu nications processor
4/122
4/118
4/114
4/124
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/109
Design
The module contains the follo wing: S Microprocessor (8 bit) and interface chips (USART) S RAM as user memory for temporary storage of mes sages S Receptacle for 375 memory submodule (EPROM, EEPROM with max. 32 Kbyte) for a maximum of 4095 messages S Hardware clock S Interface for connection of devices with V.24 or 20 mA currentloop signals (sub D connector, 25pin) Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S 2 LEDs (green) for indicating the interface status
Devices with serial interfaces can be connected, e.g.: S Printers S Terminals S Keyboards S Barcode readers S Programming devices and AT compatible PCs (e.g. in connection with the PRO DAVE DOS 64R driver soft ware) S Programmable controllers via CPU 943, CPU 944, CPU 928B or the CP 521, CP 523, CP 544 communica tions processors (CP 524 and CP 5252 only in con junction with special drivers)
Interface The interface is suitable for the transmission of S 20 mA currentloop signals (TTY) and S V.24 signals. The transmission rate of the interface is 200 bit/s up to 9600 bit/s and is selectable in fixed steps. The module requires one slot.
Principle of operation
The CP 523 communications processor can be used for the following functions: S Interfacing programmable controllers and thirdparty devices and S Message printout The CP 523 handles data communication with the de vice connected to it com pletely autonomously, as well as preprocessing and tempo rary storage of data. The CP 523 occupies 8 byte in the analog I/O area.
All information between the communications processor and the CPU is exchanged via this area. Interfacing With the CP 523, interfacing to any desired unit with serial interface, e.g. interfacing with a personal computer for operator control and process monitoring, is possible.
Data transfer is possible ei ther with a 10bit or 11bit character frame: 10bit character frame either: S 1 start bit, 7 data bit, 2 stop bit S 1 start bit, 7 data bit, 1 parity bit, 1 stop bit S 1 start bit, 8 data bit, 1 stop bit
4/110
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
In the communications mode, two open listings and one standardized listing are avail able on the module: S In the transparent commu nications mode, data trans mission is without receive side end identifier sequence (message frames with fixed lengths or evaluation of the character delay time deter mine the end of the mes sage) Programming Programming of the module is not necessary. Only the type of interface (V.24, TTY), the additional interface parame ters (transmission rate, hand shake, ...) and the operating
Order No. 6ES5 523-3UA11
In the interpretive mode, data transmission com mences with receiveside end identifier sequence and control character. The characters RUB OUT = 7Fh, Backspace = 08h, XON/XOFF (assign nothing or 01 h to 7Eh), 1 or 2 end characters (se lectable from 01 h to FFh) are evaluated S In the 3964(R)K commu nications mode, data trans mission is via the 3964 or 3964R protocol
S
Message printout With the CP 523 communica tions processor it is possible to output up to 4095 mes sages on a peripheral device with serial interface (printer, visual display unit, etc.). The message texts are stored on the module's memory sub module. Each message can have a maximum of three vari ables. Permissible variables include the following: Date, time of day, token characters for fur ther message texts, printer control parameters.
mode (event recorder, inter facing) can be parameterized with the user submodule or via an initialization message from the programmable con troller.
Ordering data
CP 523 communications processor 375 memory submodule EPROM 8 Kbyte EPROM 16 Kbyte EPROM 32 Kbyte EEPROM 8 Kbyt e EEPROM16Kbyte Program examples for data link
Order No. Manual German English French Spanish Italian Connecting cables
6ES5 375-1LA15 6ES5 375-1LA21 6ES5 375-1LA41 6ES5 375-0LC31 6ES5 375-0LC41 6ES5 897-2UE11
6ES5 998-0DD11 6ES5 998-0DD21 6ES5 998-0DD31 6ES5 998-0DD41 6ES5 998-0DD51 see Page 4/116
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/111
Design
The module contains the follo wing: S Microprocessor (8 bit) and interface chips S RAM for variable data S 2 dualport RAM S Receptacle for 373 memory submodule (EPROM) for up to 128 Kbyte of user pro gram (interprocessor com munication functions or message texts) S Receptacle for interface module for connecting de vices with V.24/V.28, 20 mA (TTY) or RS 422A/RS 485 signals; software clock Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN""STOP" switch "RUN" for normal operation, "STOP" for interrupting normal operation S 2 LEDs (red) for indicating the interface status Devices with a serial interface can be connected, e.g.: S Printers, e.g. DR 210, DR 211, DR 230, DR 231, PT 88 and PT 89 (with ECMA character set) S Programmable controllers, through CPU 928B or com munications processors CP 524, CP 5252, CP 544, CP 544B
S S
S S
Programmable controllers via CPU 944 or communica tions processors CP 523, CP 521SI in conjunction with special drivers SICOMP M minicomputers AS 215, AS 235K, AS 235 and AS 235H automation systems of the TELEPERM M process control system (see Catalogs PLT 110 and PLT 111) Programming devices and AT compatible PCs (e.g. in connection with the PRO DAVE DOS 64R driver soft ware, see Section 7) Other automation systems Thirdparty computers
Interfaces Three different interface mod ules are available for the inter face of the CP 524 for trans mitting: S 20 mA currentloop signals (TTY) S V24/V.28 signals S RS 422A/RS 485 signals The transmission rate of the interface is S 110 bit/s to 19,200 bit/s (9600 bit/s with TTY) and is S selectable in fixed steps us ing the programming de vice. The V.24/V.28 module pro vides a number of auxiliary signals conforming to the RS 232C or CCITT V.24 stan dard when using the relevant special driver software (see Section 7). RS 422A or RS 485 signals (voltage difference) ensure a higher degree of immunity to noise from external sources than V.24 or TTY signals. The following links can be estab lished in accordance with the EIA standard: S Pointtopoint connections with RS 422A in fullduplex mode S Multipoint connections with RS 485 in halfduplex mode (with special driver soft ware) See page 4/115 for technical specifications.
4/112
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Programming
The CP 524 can be pro grammed offline using the 373 memory submodule. For this purpose, the COM 525 parameter assignment soft ware
Order No. 6ES5 524-3UA15
Ordering data
CP 524 communications processor 752 interface submodule for CP 524 only for 20 mA current loop (TTY) for V.24/V.28 (RS 232C) for RS 422A/RS 485 373 memory submodule EPROM 32 Kbyte EPROM 64 Kbyte EPROM 128 Kbyte COM 525 parameter assignment software
Order No. Special drivers (customized transmission protocols) To be ordered as a separate item: Manual for CP 524 (S5DOS version) German English French Connecting cables see Section 7
6ES5 752-0AA12 6ES5 752-0AA22 6ES5 752-0AA43 6ES5 373-1AA41 6ES5 373-1AA61 6ES5 373-1AA81 see Section 7
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/113
Design
The modules contain the follo wing: S 80186 microprocessor (16 MHz) S RAM for variable data S Two dualport RAM S Receptacle for memory card (flash EEPROM) for up to 256 Kbyte (optional) S 2 receptacles for interface submodules for the connec tion of devices with V.24/V.28, 20 mA TTY or RS 422A/RS 485 signals S Hardware clock Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN""STOP" switch, RUN for normal operation, STOP for interrupting normal operation S Four LEDs (red/green) for in dicating the interface status S Two LEDs for indicating the status of the module (RUN, STOP)
The following can be connec ted to the module: S DR 210, DR 211, DR 230, DR 231, PT 88, PT 89 print ers S SIMATIC S5 programmable controllers via CP 524, CP 544, CPU 928B, CPU 944 and CPU 945; connec tion is also possible via CP 521 SI and CP 523 (see pages 2/67 and 4/110) S SICOMP M minicomputers S Automation systems AS 215, AS 235K, AS 235 and AS 235H from the TELEPERM M process con trol system (see Catalogs PLT 110 and PLT 111) S Programming devices and AT compatible PCs (e.g. in connection with the PRO DAVE DOS 64R driver soft ware) S Other automation systems S Thirdparty computers
Interfaces Three different interface sub modules are available for the interfaces of the CP 544 and CP 544B for transmitting: S 20 mA currentloop signals (TTY), S V.24/V.28 signals (RS 232C) S RS 422A/RS 485 signals The transmission rate of the interfaces is 300 bit/s to 76800 bit/s (9600 bit/s for TTY, 19200 bit/s V.24 and is selectable in fixed steps us ing the programming device. The sum of the two transmis sion rates must not exceed 76800 bit/s when both inter faces are assigned. RS 422A or RS 485 signals (voltage difference) ensure a higher degree of immunity to noise from external sources than V.24 or TTY signals. Moreover, higher transmission rates can be reached. Point topoint connection with RS 422A in fullduplex mode can be established in accor dance with the EIA standard.
4/114
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Communications jobs for the programmable controller or the computer can be stored in a data block in the CPU, the internal RAM of the CP 544 and CP 544B or on the addi tional memory card (flash EEPROM).
A safe endtoend link be tween the CPUs of both communications partners can be achieved with the RK 512 standard computer link
The CP 544 and CP 544B communications processors handle data communications with the devices connected to it completely autonomously. PG 730, PG 750 and PG 770 programming device. For pa rameter assignment, the COM PP parameterization software must be loaded into the pro gramming device.
Programming
COM PP permits simple, op eratorpromptedprogramming and supports both startup and debugging.
Transmission rate S 20 mA (TTY; current loop) S V.24/V.28 (RS 232 C) S RS 422A/RS 485 S Sum of both interfaces Transmission protocols
9600 bit/s 9600 bit/s 3964 (R) ASCII, interpretive ASCII, transparent
Even, odd, mark, space, none 7 or 8 bit 10 or 11 bit 4065 messages 3 variables per message Message text stored on memory submodule of CP
Even, odd, none 58 bit 712 bit 1000 messages 1 variable per message Message text stored on memory submodule of CP Production and shopfloor data 99 lines long, 40 variables per line 68 bit 812 bit
max.
Parameterization
Offline on EPROM/ EEPROM or in user program Screw connection Sub D socket, 25pin
with COM 525 offline in EPROM Sliding locking devices Sub D socket, 25pin Sub D socket, 15pin
with COM PP online or offline Sliding locking device Sub D socket, 25pin Sub D socket, 15pin
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/115
Ordering data
CP 544 communications processor CP 544B communications processor 752 interface submodule for 20 mA current loop (TTY) for V.24/V.28 (RS 232C) for RS 422A/RS 485 Memory card with flash EPROM, 256 Kbyte with RAM, 256 Kbyte COM PP parameterization software The instruction manual for COM PP is contained in the CP 544 manual. CP 544 adapter cable to programming device connec ting cable Special driver for CP 544B (customerspecific protocols) To be ordered as a separate item: CP 544/CP 544B manual German English French
Order No. 6ES5 544-3UA11 6ES5 544-3UB11 725, 726, 734 connecting cables to other SIMATIC S5 devices via CP 524, CP 5252, CP 544, CP 544B S 20 mA current loop (TTY) 3.2 m (10.4 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 200 m (656 ft) S V.24 (max. 16 m (52 ft)) 2 m (6.56 ft) 3.2 m (10.4 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 16 m (52.4 ft) S RS 422A/RS 485 (for CP 524 and CP 544) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 200 m (656 ft) to SICOMP R minicomputers via PROMEA EA 01G with DUST 3964R S 20 mA current loop 3.2 m (10.4 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 50 m (164 ft) 200 m (656 ft) S V.24 (max. 16 m (52 ft)) 2 m (6.56 ft) 3.2 m (10.4 ft) 5 m (16.4 ft) 10 m (32.8 ft) 20 m (65.6 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 752-0AA12 6ES5 752-0AA22 6ES5 752-0AA43 6ES5 374-2KH21 6ES5 374-2AH21 see Section 7
6ES5 726-1BD20 6ES5 726-1B F00 6ES5 726-1CB00 6ES5 726-1CF00 6ES5 726-1DC00 6ES5 726-8BC00 6ES5 726-8BD20 6ES5 726-8BF00 6ES5 726-8CB00 6ES5 726-8CB60
6ES5 726-3BD20 6ES5 726-3B F00 6ES5 726-3CB00 6ES5 726-3CF00 6ES5 726-3DC00 6ES5 726-4BC00 6ES5 726-4BD20 6ES5 726-4BF00 6ES5 726-4CB00 6ES5 726-4CC00
4/116
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
6ES5 725-8BD20 6ES5 725-8B F00 6ES5 725-8CB00 6ES5 725-8C F00 6ES5 725-8DC00 6ES5 726-7BC00 6ES5 726-7BD20 6ES5 726-7B F00 6ES5 726-7CB00 6ES5 726-7CB60
6ES5 726-5BD20 6ES5 726-5B F00 6ES5 726-5CB00 6ES5 726-5C F00 6ES5 726-5DC00
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/117
SIMATIC S5-135/-155U: If used for I/O mode only, can be used in the I/O slots in the central unit and ex pansion unit; in paging mode the CP can be used in CP slots in the central con troller and expansion unit
Depending on the configura tion of the PLC up to four CP 2430 can be used in the PLC. Configuration of the CP is not necessary. Control of up to 2 x 31 AS-Interface slaves in accor dance with the ASi specifica tion is implemented. Up to 496 binary elements can be controlled if bi-direc tional slaves are used. The supply voltage is moni tored on the AS-Interface pro file line. A pushbutton for each mas ter part for switching the op erating state and accepting the existing configuration S Coding plug for setting ad dresses and variants
S
Design
Two ASInterface masters on one module S Occupies one slot in the SIMATIC S5 S In I/O mode, 32 bytes are used in the I/O address space
S
Display of the connected and activated slaves and their ready-for-operation signals S Connection of both ASInter face lines via connectors with terminal blocks (solder less connection with screw locking)
S S
Principle of operation
Both ASInterface masters control a separate ASInterface segment with up to 31 ASInterface slaves completely independently of one another Three variants are available: I/O mode: Only accesses to slave data in the I/O address space, no master calls
Two operating variants: Standard mode: Data bits of the slaves can be addressed in the I/O ad dress space of the PLC. Master calls are not pos sible. I/O and paging operation: Accesses to slave data in the I/O address space and master calls via paging ac cess
Expanded mode: Access to master calls in ac cordance with the ASI specifi cation (e.g. writing parame ters) is possible
User interface
Paging mode: Access to slave data and master calls via paging ac cess
4/120
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Connection method
Number of nodes
Interfaces S Assignment of I/O address area in PLC S ASInterface connection Permissible ambient conditions S Operating temperature S Transport/storage temperature Space required Weight
Error detection
Ordering data
CP 2430 Communications processor for connection of SIMATIC S5115U, S5135U, S5155U to ASInterface, including connector
Order No. 6GK1 243-0SA10 Manual for AS-Interface contains CP 2413/CP 2430/ CP 2433 description, introduction and basics incl. software (FB60 + examples) S German S English S French S Italian
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/121
Design
The module contains the follo wing: S One microprocessor with memory S One receptacle for 376, 377 memory submodule S One programming device in terface S One interface for PROFIBUS twowire line S One interface for plastic fi ber optic cable (PROFIBUS) The CP 5431 FMS/DP commu nications processor handles data communications via the PROFIBUS network or via the PROFIBUS protocol (PROFIBUS FMS). The func tions of a DP master (class 1) in accordance with EN 50 170 can also be used (combi master functions). The communications proces sor relieves the program mable controller of a consid erable proportion of communications tasks. It is programmed using the COM 5431 FMS/DP parame terization software with opera tor prompting (see Section 7).
Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN" "STOP" switch S LEDs for Stop, Run and CP fault
Principle of operation
The transmission rate can be set via the software (9.6, 19.2, 93.75, 187.5, 500 kbit/s or 1.5 Mbit/s). The preferred transmission rate of 187.5 kbit/s is preset. Standard function blocks for the user program are avail able for data communications with the CPU (see Section 7). Functions of the CP 5431 FMS/DP in accor dance with EN 50 170:
S
S S S
FDL interface: Direct access to layer 2 ser vices (PROFIBUS layer 2); PLCPLC connections
Global I/O interface: Auto matic transmission of I/O areas with global I/O Distributed I/O interface: Automatic transmission of I/O areas to PROFIBUS DP slaves Programming device inter face for local and remote programming via the net work Clock functions: Network wide clock synchronization FMS user interface (PROFIBUS FMS) Cyclic I/O interface: Auto matic transmission of I/O areas with cyclic interface
4/122
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
PROFIBUS electrical Connection of nodes via Topology Transmission medium Max. distance between 2 nodes RS 485 bus terminal Row/tree structure Twisted pair cable 9.6 km at 9.6 kbit/s Connection to S PROFIBUS (RS 485) S PROFIBUS (plastic) S Programming device/diagnostics interface Optical Link Modules Line, ring or star structure Glass fiber optic 62.5/125 mm Plastic fiber optic 980/1000 mm Permissible ambient conditions S Operating temperature S Transport/storage temperature Space requirements Weight S Module S Memory submodule
Ordering data
CP 5431 FMS/DP communications processor SINEC L2 interface module for S5115U/H, S535U, S5155U/H COM 5431 FMS/DP parameter asgmt software CP 5431 FMS/DP manual German English French 376 memory submodule (EPROM) 16 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 64 Kbyte 377 memory submodule (RAM) 16 Kbyte 32 Kbyte 64 Kbyte RS 485 bus terminal for PROFIBUS with connecting cable 1.5 m (4.92 ft) 3.0 m (9.84 ft) Bus cables for PROFIBUS Bus cable2)3) 2-wire, shielded Bus cable, halogenfree 2wire, shielded 1) Up to 187.5 kbit/s
Order No. Bus cable for PROFIBUS (ctd.) 6GK1 543-1AA01 Bus cable with PE coatingl2)3) 2wire, shielded Bus cable (buried) 2)3) 2wire, i shielded hi ld d Trailing cable 2)3) 2wire, shielded Bus cable for festoon mounting 2)3) 2wire, shielded us cable cab e for o PROFIBUS-PA O US Bus S blue, for applications in hazard ous areas S black, for applications in non harzardous areas FIBER OPTIC CABLE 2) standard cable, splittable without connector, sold by the meter, max. 400 m (1312 ft) FLEXIBLE FIBER 2) OPTIC CABLE trailing cable, splittable without connector, sold by the meter, max. 200 m (656 ft) BFOC connector; single f FIBER OPTIC CABLE t for CABLE, stan dard cable and trailing cable Additional fiber optic cables, PROFIBUS fiber optic network components and PC modules
see Section 7
see Section 10
6GK1 901-0DA00-0AA0
see Catalog IK 10
2) Sold by the meter, max. 1000 m (3280 ft), minimum order 20 m (65.6 ft)
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/123
Design
CP 1430 TF/1430 TCP communications processor Two versions of the CP 1430 TF communications processor are available: S CP 1430 TF Basic for using the SEND/RECEIVE interface or few TF connec tions; up to 64 ISO transport connections (for SEND/RE CEIVE) or up to 16 TF con nections.
S
CP 1430 TF Extended for highend applications, many TF connections and high realtime accuracy (1 ms), up to 100 TF con nections or up to 100 ISO transport connections (for SEND/RECEIVE).
The CP 1430 TF and CP 1430 TCP communications proces sor have the following inter faces: S 15pin sub D socket (pushlocking) for connec tion to Industrial Ethernet; switchable to AUI or Indus trial Twisted Pair S 15pin sub D socket (screwlocking) for connec tion to programming de vices. Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN" - "STOP" switch S LEDs for indicating the "STOP", "RUN", "FAULT" and "15 V" states The module requires one slot. The CP 1473 MAP is pro grammed using the COM 1473 parameterization soft ware with operator prompting. The CP 1430 TF and the CP 1430 TCP is programmed us ing the COM 1430 TF or COM 1430 TCP parameterization software. Standard function blocks for the user program are available for data inter change with the CPU (see Section 7). can be programmed remotely. Using the programming de vice multiplexer (see Section 8), several modules can be programmed via one inter face.
CP 1473 MAP communications processor The communications proces sor has two interfaces: S 25pin sub D socket for con nection of the PG 720, PG 720 C, PG 740 and PG 760 programming de vices S 15pin sub D socket for con nection to Industrial Ethernet Operator controls and indica tors on the front panel: S "RUN" - "STOP" switch S "RESET" pushbutton S LEDs for indicating the "STOP" and "RUN" states The module requires two slots.
Principle of operation
The CP 1430 TF, the CP 1430 TCP and CP 1473 MAP han dle data communications with the entire network completely autonomously. All layers of the ISO 7layer reference model are implemented. The communications processors therefore relieve the program mable controller of a large proportion of communications tasks.
Programming
The PG 720, PG 720 C, PG 740 and PG 760 program ming devices can be con nected directly to the Indus trial Ethernet. In this way, all programmable controllers
See Section 10 as well as Catalog IK 10 for further de tails of the Industrial Ethernet LAN as well as of PC modu les.
4/124
Siemens ST 50 1998
Communications modules
Max. number of nodes Allocation method Industrial Ethernet fiber optic Topology Transmission medium Transmission rate Transmission mode Max. distance between 2 random terminals Max. number of nodes Allocation method CP 1430 TF/CP 1430 TCP/ CP 1473 MAP communications processors Current consumption S CP 1430 TF/CP 1430 TCP with out transceiver at 5 V max. S CP 1430 TF/CP 1430 TCP with transceiver at 5 V max. at 24 V max. S CP 1473 with 15 V module at 5 V max. Space requirements S CP 1430 TF with transceiver S CP 1473 MAP Weight S CP 1430 TF/ CP 1430 TCP S CP 1473 MAP
1.7 A
approx. approx.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/125
6GK1 100-0AB00
6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA0 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA1 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA2 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA4 2XV9 450-1AU00 see Section 7
6XV1 800-6FE60
6ES5 727-1BD20 6ES5 727-1CB00 6ES5 727-1CB50 6ES5 727-1CC00 6ES5 727-1CD20 6ES5 727-1CF00 6ES5 727-0AA11
4/126
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The 135U/155U central con troller comprises: S 21 free slots S 1 power supply chassis with builtin fan S5-135U, S5-155U Depending on the extent of the automation task, the cen tral controller can be equipped with the following CPUs: S CPU 948 (max. 4) S CPU 928B (max. 4) S CPU 928 (max. 4) S CPU 922 (max. 4)
All CPUs can also operate jointly in multiprocessor mode. When more than one of these central modules is used a 923A/923C coordinator is required (see page 4/30). S5-155H One CPU 948R can be used per central controller.
Power supply chassis Redundant twooutofthree fan concept; Should one fan cease oper ating the speed of the other fans is increased thus enab ling the programmable con troller to continue operation. The defective fan can be re placed while the controller is in operation S Redundant oneoutoftwo battery concept; In the case of a failure of the main battery (Li battery) the accu battery switches on automatically for a period of three weeks S Mains buffering to NAMUR: 20 ms S Enhanced electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
S
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/127
For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
1) Jumper selection on the IM 307 must be observed. Interrupt transfer is only possible on slots 107 to 131. 2) In the case of 135U with Order No. 6ES5 1353UA42 only slot 163. 3) Note the functions given in the lower half of the table.
4/128
Siemens ST 50 1998
Ordering data
135U/155U central controller without CPU, without backup battery, with power supply S 230/120 V AC, 5 V/18 A, 15V/0.5 A, 24 V/1 A1) S 230/120 V AC; 5 V/40 A, 15 V/2 A, 24 V/2.8 A S 24 V DC; 5 V/18 A, 15 V/0.5 A, 24 V/1 A S 24 V DC; 5 V/40 A, 15 V/2 A, 24 V/2.8 A1) 135U central controller without CPU, without backup battery S 24 V DC; 5 V/10 A 1) Also for S5155H
Order No.
6ES5 188-3UA12
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/129
Design
The central controller 155H is a module subrack divided into two halves. It has S 10 slots (left half) S 11 slots (right half) Of these slots two each are used for the power supply, two for the CPU and one for the IM 324R/IM 304.
Five (left half) or six (right half) free slots are therefore available. The 155H is supplied with two 24V DC; 5V,14A power sup plies and a fan subassembly.
One or two backup batteries per power supply can also be ordered to back up the CPU (redundant backup).
Ordering data
155H central controller without CPU; without backup bat tery, with two power supplies 24 V DC; 5 V/14 A Backup battery
Order No. 6ES5 188-3UH31 To be ordered as a separate item: S5-155H manual (with description of the 155H) Other manuals Accessories, parts
Order No.
6ES7 971-0BA00
4/130
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The 183U expansion unit comprises: S 21 free slots S 1 builtin power supply chassis with fans The 183U can be centrally connected to the central
controller or to other expan sion units with the IM 312 in terface module. In addition the 183U can be connected distributed to central control lers with the IM 310, IM 314, IM 317 and IM 318 in terface modules.
A hardware interrupt is not possible in the 183U expan sion unit. No battery backup is provided for the RAM.
Possible configurations
Note the respective slot requirements of the modules! Slot No. IM 300 interface module IM 310, IM 314, IM 317 or IM 318 interface modules IM 3123 interface module Digital input modules, digital output modules Analog input modules, analog output modules Intelligent I/O modules 313 monitoring module For slot assignment, see Section 11 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107 115 123 131 139 147 155 163
Ordering data
183U expansion unit with power supply S 230/120 V AC; 5 V/18 A, 15 V/0.5 A, 24 V/1 A S 24 V DC; 5 V/18 A, 15 V/0.5 A, 24 V/1 A
Order No. To be ordered as a separate item: S5-135U/155U system manual 6ES5 183-3UA13 6ES5 183-3UA22 Additional manuals Accessories, spare parts
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/131
Design
The 184U expansion unit comprises: S 21 free slots S 1 fan subassembly The 184U can be centrally connected to the central con troller or to other expansion units by using the IM 312 in terface module.
A power supply chassis is not required because the expan sion unit is supplied via the connecting cable for the IM 3125 interface module.
A hardware interrupt is not possible in the expansion unit. Modules with RAM bak kup cannot be implemented because there is no battery backup for the supply vol tage.
Possible configurations
Note the respective slot requirements of the modules! Slot No. IM 3125 interface module Digital input modules, digital output modules Analog input modules, analog output modules Intelligent I/O modules 313 monitoring module For slot assignment, see Section 11 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107 115 123 131 139 147 155 163
Ordering data
184U expansion unit without power supply S With 230/120 V AC fan S With 24 V DC fan
Order No. To be ordered as a separate item: S5-135U/155U system manual 6ES5 184-3UA11 6ES5 184-3UA21 Additional manuals Accessories, spare parts
Order No.
4/132
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The EG 185U expansion unit comprises: S 21 free slots S 1 builtin power supply chassis with fans The EG 185U can be con nected distributed to central controllers or other expansion
units with the IM 314, IM 317 and IM 318 interface mod ules. All intelligent I/O modules (IP) and communications proces sors (CP) can be connected in the EG 185U.
Up to 8 communications pro cessors can be programmed via an interface if a 923C coordinator is used. A hardware interrupt is not possible in the EG 185U ex pansion unit. A backup bat tery is provided for the RAM.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/133
For slot assignment, see Section 11 For slot assignment, see Section 11
Ordering data
185U expansion unit with power supply, without backup battery S 230/120V AC; 5V/18A, 15V/0.5A, 24V/1A S 230/120V AC; 5V/40A, 15V/2A, 24V/2.8A S 24V DC; 5V/18A, 15V/0.5A, 24V/1A S 24V DC; 5V/40A, 15V/2A, 24V/2.8A Backup battery (lithium battery)
Order No. To be ordered as a separate item: S5-135U/155U system manual 6ES5 185-3UA13 6ES5 185-3UA33 6ES5 185-3UA23 6ES5 185-3UA43 6EW1 000-7AA Additional manuals Accessories, spare parts
Order No.
4/134
Siemens ST 50 1998
Design
The 187U expansion unit comprises: S 11 free slots A power supply chassis, fan and wiring duct are not avail able.
The 187U expansion unit can be centrally connected to central controllers or other ex pansion units with the IM 312 interface module. The power supply is delivered by the connecting cable of the IM 3125 interface module.
A hardware alarm is not pos sible in the 187U expansion unit. No battery backup is provided for the RAM.
Possible configurations
Note the respective slot requirements of the modules! Slot No. IM 3125 interface module Digital input modules, digital output modules Analog input modules, analog output modules 313 monitoring module 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107 115 123 131 139 147 155 163
Ordering data
187U expansion unit To be ordered as a separate item: S5-135U/155U system manual
Order No. 6ES5 187-5UA11 see page 4/155 Additional manuals Accessories, spare parts
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/135
Input voltage S Rated value S Permissible range (including ripple) Line frequency S Rated value S Permissible range Input current S Rated value S Inrush current max. I2 . t value of inrush current Stored energy time in the event of power failure Message via separate floating contacts Number of outputs Output voltage (A1/A2/A3) S Rated value S Tolerance
24 V DC 18 to 33 V
24 V DC 20 to 30 V
DC 24 V 18 to 33 V
50 Hz 47 to 63 Hz 1.5 A (230 V)/ 2.5 A (120 V) 26 A for 100 ms 4 A2 s 20 ms 2.6 A (230 V)/ 4.5 A (120 V) 25 A for 2 ms 5.2 A2s 20 ms 9.5 A 100 A for 100 ms 2,7 A2s 20 ms 20 A 200 A for 1 ms 18 A2s 20 ms 4.8 A 100 A 20 A2s 5 ms Fan failure, Battery failure 2 5.1 V DC/24 V DC 0.5 % (+ 25 %, - 24 %) 18 A/1 A/0.5 A 0.5 to 18 A 40 A/2.8 A/2 A 1.6 to 40 A 10 A/0.4 A 0 to 10 A No Li battery (3.6 V; 5 Ah) No 14 A 100 A 2.7 A2s 5/20 ms (settable) Fan failure, Battery failure 2 5.1V DC/24V DC - 0.5 %, + 2% (+ 25%, -12.5%)
Fan failure (1 fan), Fan failure (2 or 3 fans), Battery failure 3 (outputs A1/A2/A3) 5.1 V DC/24V DC/15 V DC 0.5 %/(+ 25 %, -12.5 %)/ 5 %
Output current (A1/A2/A3) S Rated value S Permissible range Galvanic isolation Main buffering Reserve buffering Input for monitoring the load voltage 24 V Auxiliary voltage S 15 V 0.5 % S 24 V + 25 %/- 12.5 % Power loss Number of integrated fans Weight 15 V submodule Can be installed in Input voltage Input current Output voltage S Rated value S Tolerance Output current Weight
14 A/0,1 A 0.2 to 14 A Yes Li battery (3.6 V; 1.9 Ah) Li battery (3.6 V; 1.9 Ah) No
max.
0.5 A 2A 0.5 A 2A 1A 2.8 A 1A 2.8 A 80 W 147 W 90 W 153 W 3 (2outof3 fan concept; fans can be exchanged during operation) 5.8 kg (12.7 lb) 6ES5 956-0AA12 (for power supply only 6ES5 955-3NA12) Power supply chassis 24 V auxiliary voltage of the power supply chassis Equal to output current + 15 V 0.5 % 0.5 A 0.2 kg (0.4 lb)
approx.
approx.
max. approx.
Note: The power supply units can be switched from 230 V to 120 V supply voltage. 5 V and 15 V ouput voltages are stabilized, the 24 V output voltage is roughly stabilized.
4/136
Siemens ST 50 1998
The SITOP power basic line (24 V/2 A to 40 A) has been specially developed and opti mized for industrial use. The units are used as load power supplies and for supplying electronic modules with a nar row input voltage range. It has excellent control characteris tics, without the need for op tional extras at additional The SITOP power special line (24 V/5 A to 10 A) is, like the basic line, specially designed for industrial use. The units are particularly suitable for use with distributed I/O (5A, 10 A) and for supplying the ASI bus (2.4 A). The spe cial feature of these units is the extremely narrow and rigid metal case. The units of the SITOP power universal line (24 V / 2.5 A to 4 A) have been developed for applications with demanding technical requirements. Inter ference suppression to class B guarantees minimal emitted interference. This means that in addition to industrial opera tion, the units are also suit able for domestic use, i.e. in building services automation.
cost. With no more than the essential functions, these units represent the optimum solution for industrial custom ers in terms of price and technology.
It allows installation in ap plications requiring a low mounting depth, i.e. in ma chines, tight spaces, Upro files and switchboxes at the machine.
For the basic technical speci fications, see the following page.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/137
50/60 Hz 47 to 63 Hz 24 V DC 3%; 1% < 150 mV 83 % to 89 % 50 Hz 47 to 63 Hz 2 to 40 A 0 to 40 A Electronic Class I Yes Class A IP 20 and IP 00 0 to + 60 _C 0.5 to 7 kg
2.5 to 4 A 0 to 4 A (up to 50 _C) Electronic Class I Yes Class B (VDE 0871) IP 20 0 to + 60 _C 0.5 kg
Ordering data
Power supply SITOP power basic line Singlephase, 24 V/2 A Singlephase, 24 V/5 A Singlephase, 24 V/10 A 3phase, 24 V/20 A 3phase, 24 V/40 A Power supply SITOP power special line Singlephase, 24 V/5 A Singlephase, 24 V/10 A DC/DC, 30 V/2.4 A
Order No. Power supply SITOP power universal line Singlephase, 24 V/2.5 A Singlephase, 24 V/4 A Singlephase, 24 V/20 A 3phase (500 V), 24 V/20 A
Order No.
6EP1 331-1SL11 6EP1 333-1SL11 6EP1 334-1SL11 6EP1 436-1SL11 6EP1 437-1SL11
Further information can be found in the catalog for systems engineering KT 10.
4/138
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
Expansion unit EU type for S5135U, S5155U/H EU 183U ER type for S5115U/H/F Interface module type
Connecting cable Type Length 0.5 m2) 0.95 m2) 0.5 m2) 1.5 m2) 7050/ 0.5 ... 2.5 m 0.5 m2) 0.95 m2) 0.5 m2) 1.5 m2) 0.5 m2) 0.5 m2) 7050/ 1 ... 100 m 0.5 m2) 1.5 m2) 7210/ 1 ... 500 m 7210/ 1 ... 500 m Shielded, twisted 2wire cable
IM 300-3
IM 312-3
IM 300-5 (5CA11) IM 300-5 (5LB1) IM 301-3 IM 301-5 Centralized and distributed up to 100 m (328 ft), symmetrical S5135U S5155U S5155H1), IM 301-3
ER 7011
IM 301-3 IM 301-5 Distributed up to 500 m (1640 ft), symmetrical S5135U S5155U S5155H1), S5155H3) Distributed up to 3000 m (9840 ft), serial electrical S5135U S5155U S5155H1), IM 308 IM 304
ER 7012 ER 7013
IM 310 IM 312-5
IM 314
IM 314R IM 318-3
IM 318-8 ER 7012 ER 7013 IM 317 IM 307 (IM 307 not in ER 7012) 7222 (fiber optic cable)
Distributed 50 ... 1500 m (164 ... 4920 ft) (each between 2 interface modules), serial optical
IM 307
EU 183U EU 185U
1) S5155H with twochannel I/O modules (fully redundant configuration) or singlechannel/singlesided I/O configuration. 2) At its one end, the cable is permanently connected to IM 312, at the other end it is provided with a plug connector for connection to IM 300, or IM 301. 3) S5155H with singlechannel I/Os (switched).
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/139
These expansion units can also be connected in central ized configuration with the EG 183U and EG 185U ex pansion units.
Design
The IM 300 interface module must be plugged into the slot provided in the central con troller. The IM 312 interface module is plugged into the expansion unit. Up to four IM 300 interface modules can be used in the central control ler, however, not more than two IM 3005 in the ZG 135U/155U. One IM 300 interface module can be plugged into each EG 183U or EG 185U expan sion unit. The IM 300 interface module allows two areas of 256 byte to be configured (P and Q areas).
Connecting the EG 184U and EG 187U expansion units (Expansion units without power supply chassis) The IM 3005C interface mod ule is to be used in the central controller and the IM 3125 in terface module in the expan sion unit (see Fig. 4/49). Power (5 V, internal) is sup plied to the EG 184U and EG 187U expansion units by way of the interface modules. Connection of the EG 183U expansion unit (Expansion unit with power supply chassis) The IM 3003 interfacemodule is to be used
in the central controller and the IM 3123 interface module in the expansion unit (see Fig. 4/47). The IM 3123 and IM 3125 interface modules can not be used simultaneously in one chain. Connecting additional expansion units In addition to the aforemen tioned expansion units, an ex pansion unit in the ER 7011 expansion rack of the S5115U programmable con troller can also be connected (see Fig. 4/48). The expansion unit is supplied with power (5 V) by way of the interface module.
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 300 max. S IM 312 max. Power loss S IM 300 S IM 312 max. max. 0.6 A 0.2 A 3W 1W Order No. IM 312 interface module for the expansion units EG 184U or EG 187U; S Expansion unit arranged above the central controller, 0.5 m (1.6 ft) cable S Location of expansion unit arbitrary, 1.5 m (4.9 ft) cable EG 183U; S Expansion unit arranged above the central controller, 0.5 m (1.6 ft) cable S Expansion unit arranged below the central controller, 0.95 m (3.1 ft) cable Terminator for the IM 312-3 interface module The operating instructions are in cluded in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155). Order No. Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot 0.35 kg (0.77 lb)
Ordering data
IM 300 interface module for the central controller S For connecting the EG 184U or EG 187U S For connecting the EG 183U S For connecting the ER 7010 or ER 7011 IM 306 interface module for the expansion units ER 7010, ER 7011 705 connecting cable for connecting the IM 3005LB interface module to the IM 306 Length 0.5 m (1.64 ft) 1.2 m (3.93 ft) 1.5 m (4.92 ft) 2.5 m (8.2 ft)
6ES5 312-5CA12
6ES5 312-5CA22
6ES5 312-3AB12
6ES5 312-3AB32
6ES5 760-0AB11
4/140
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
EU ER 701-1 IM 306 interface module 705 connecting cable IM 306 interface module
EU 183U
With this configuration, both cabinets must be electrically connected to each other
EU EU 183U
EU ER 701-1 IM 306 interface module 705 connecting cable IM 306 interface module
ER 701-1
EU ER 701-1
EU 183U
EU ER 701-1
EU ER 701-1
EU 183U
CC 135U/155U
Fig. 4/47 Connection of expansion units with power supply chassis to the central controller in centralized configuration using the IM 3123 and IM 3003 interface modules
Fig. 4/48 Connection of expansion units without power supply chassis to the central controller in centralized configuration using the IM 306 and IM 3005LB interface modules.
With this configuration, both cabinets must be electrically connected to each other.
EU 184U EU 187U
EU 184U Eu 187U
EU 184U EU 187U
EU 184U EU 187U
EU 184U EU 187U
max. 5A
CC 135U/155U
EU 184U EU 187U
Fig. 4/49 Connection of expansion units without power supply chassis to the central controller in centralized configuration using the IM 3125 and IM 3005 interface modules.
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/141
Design
The IM 301 interface module is plugged into the central controller and the IM 310 in terface module into the ex pansion unit. Additional ex pansion units can be con nected in centralized configu ration to the distributed EG 183U expansion units. Up to four IM 301 interface modules can be plugged into the cen tral controller.
The IM 3015 interface mod ule is used if additional EG 184U or EG 187U expan sion units are to be connected in a centralized configuration to the central controller. The IM 3013 interface mod ule is used if additional EG 183U expansion units are to be connected in a central ized configuration to the cen tral controller.
Terminators must always be inserted into the last IM 310 and into the unused central connectors of the IM 3013 and the unused distributed connectors of the IM 3013 and IM 3015. The IM 301 interface module allows two areas of 256 byte to be configured (CP and Q areas).
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 301 max. S IM 310 max. Power loss S IM 301 S IM 310 max. max. 0.8 A 0.7 A 4W 3.5 W Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 301 interface module for the central controller S For the connection of the EG 184U or EG 187U S For the connection of the EG 183U Terminator for the IM 301 S For free distributed connection of IM 3013 and IM 3015 (bottom) S For free centralized connection of IM 3013 (top) IM 310 interface module for the expansion unit Terminator for the IM 310 The operating instructions are included in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155).
Order No. 721 connecting cable 1.00 m (3.28 ft) 1.60 m (5.20 ft) 2.00 m (6.56 ft) 2.50 m (8.20 ft) 3.20 m (10.4 ft) 5.00 m (16.4 ft) 8.00 m (26.2 ft) 10.00 m (32.8 ft) 12.00 m (39.3 ft) 16.00 m (52.4 ft) 20.00 m (65.6 ft) 25.00 m (82.0 ft) 32.00 m (104.9 ft) 40.00 m (131.2 ft) 50.00 m (164.0 ft) 63.00 m (206.6 ft) 80.00 m (262.4 ft) 100.00 m (328.0 ft) 500.00 m (1640 ft)
Order No.
6ES5 721-0 BB00 6ES5 721-0 BB60 6ES5 721-0 BC00 6ES5 721-0 BC50 6ES5 721-0 BD20 6ES5 721-0 BF00 6ES5 721-0 BJ00 6ES5 721-0 CB00 6ES5 721-0 CB20 6ES5 721-0 CB60 6ES5 721-0 CC00 6ES5 721-0 CC50 6ES5 721-0 CD20 6ES5 721-0 CE00 6ES5 721-0 CF00 6ES5 721-0CG30 6ES5 721-0 CJ00 6ES5 721-0 DB00 6ES5 721-0 DF00
6ES5 760-0AA11
4/142
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
EU 183U
EU 183U
EU 184U EU 187U
760-0AB11 terminator
CC 135U/155U
EU 183U
EU 183U
760-0AB11 terminator
760-0AA11 terminator
Fig. 4/50 Distributed connection of EG 183U expansion units to the central controller via the IM 310 and IM 3013 interface modules
EU 184U EU 187U
EU 183U
EU 184U EU 187U
760-0AB11 terminator
CC 135U/155U
EU 183U
EU 183U
760-0AA11 terminator
760-0AA11 terminator
Fig. 4/51 Distributed connection of EG 184U/187U expansion units to the central controller via the IM 310 and IM 3015 interface modules
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/143
EG 183U EG 185U
The expansion unit can be up to 600 m (1969 ft) away from the central controller.
Design
The IM 304 interface module is plugged into the central controller and the IM 314 in terface module into the ex pansion unit. Additional ex pansion units can be con nected in a centralized confi guration to the distributed ex pansion units. Up to four IM 304 interface modules can be plugged into the central con troller.
Terminators must always be inserted into the last IM 314 interface module.
The IM 314 interface module allows four areas of 256 byte to be configured (P, Q, IM 3 and IM 4 areas). The IM 3 and IM 4 areas can only be acces sed via absolute addresses.
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 max. S IM 314 max. Power loss S IM 304 S IM 314 max. max. 1.2 A 1.0 A 6W 5W Number of units connectable to one IM 304 Space requirements Weight approx. 4 1 slot 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for the central controller IM 314 interface module for the expansion unit Terminator for the IM 314 The operating instructions are included in the S5135U/155U system manual (see page 4/155).
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 6ES5 314-3UA11 6ES5 760-1AA11 721 connecting cable
4/144
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
EU 183U
EU 183U
EU 184U EU 187U
EU 183U EU 185U
EU 183U EU 185U
EU 183U
EU 183U
EU 184U EU 187U
CC 135U/155U
EU 183U EU 185U
EU 183U EU 185U
Fig. 4/52 Connection of expansion units to the central controller in a distributed configuration using the IM 314 and IM 304 interface modules
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/145
Design
The IM 308 interface module is plugged into the central controller and the IM 3183 in terface module into the ex pansion unit, or the IM 3188 interface module into the ET 100U electronic terminator. Up to four IM 308 interface modules can be plugged into the central controller. Two lines, each containing up to 32 expansion units or ET 100U electronic termina tors in any order can be con nected to an IM 308 interface module. A total of 63 expan sion units and ET 100U elec tronic terminators can operate via one IM 308 interface mod ule. Digital and analog I/Os can be used in the expansion units and electronic termina tors, but not intelligent I/Os or communications processors.
A memory submodule con taining the address list is only required for the IM 308 if ET 100U electronic termina tors are connected to it. The central controller and the expansion units or electronic terminators are floating with respect to each other. The IM 308 interface module allows four areas of 256 byte to be configured (P, Q, IM 3 and IM 4 areas). The IM 3 and IM 4 areas can only be ac cessed via absolute ad dresses. Cables The interface modules are to be connected via twocore cables. The modules are sup plied together with connectors for connecting the cables us ing screw terminals. The con nectors are provided with and distance to the last unit of a line:
Transmission rate 500 m (1640 ft) 375 kbit/s 187 kbit/s
screw terminals for the incom ing and the outgoing line. A terminating resistor (120 ; supplied with the IM 308) is to be mounted to the connector of the last IM 318. An expan sion unit or an ET 100U elec tronic terminator can be switched off without affecting operation of the other units. Selecting the cables: Shielded, twisted twocore cables are to be used. The re sistance of a core must not exceed 50 , irrespective of the cable length. The surge impedance should be around 120 . The capacitance per unit length must be as low as possible (< 60 pF/m). The bottom table shows two types of cable that can be used.
Technical specifications
Transmission rate (selectable) Number of units that can be connected S Per connection max. S Total max. Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 308 max. S IM 318 max. 31, 62, 187 or 375 kbit/s Power loss S IM 308 S IM 318 Space requirements Weight max. max. approx. 2.5 W 1.5 W 1 slot 0.4 kg (0.88 lb)
32 63 0.5 A 0.3 A
4/148
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
6ES5 318-8MA12
EU 183U EU 185U
ET 100U
CC 135U/155U
max. 63 stations
max. 32 stations
Terminating resistor
ET 100U
EU 183U EU 185U
Fig. 4/55 Connection of expansion units and ET 100U to the central controller in a distributed configuration using the IM 318 and IM 308 interface modules
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/149
Design
The IM 308C interface mod ule must be plugged into the slot designed for it in the S5115U/H up to S5155U/H programmable controller. As master module, the IM 308C interface module coordinates the bus access and the data transfer to the PROFIBUSDP. It can also operate as PROFIBUSDP slave and thus makes data exchange with other PROFIBUSDP masters possible.
The module requires a single width slot. The connection to the PROFIBUS LAN is made via The master and slave function can be used in combination, i.e. as a slave, an IM 308C interface module receives data from another program mable controller and simulta neously works as master of e.g. ET 200 I/O components.
S S
Principle of operation
S S
Global Control: Sync, Freeze of I/O devices Address volume: 13 Kbyte data from the CPU can be addressed per IM 308C Shared Inputs: the inputs of a slave can be read by several IM 308C in terface modules
Configuration
Configure this module with the configuration package COM PROFIBUS (see Section 7).
Technical specifications
Transfer rate Interfaces at PROFIBUS Supply voltage (via backplane bus) Current consumption at 5 V DC Address volume for inputs, outputs and diagnostics Number of I/O devices which can be connected max. 9.6 kbit/s up to 12 Mbit/s 9pin sub D socket +5 V DC Data volume Permissible environmental conditions S Operating temperature S Transport/storage temperature S Relative humidity Mechanical design S S S S Module format Dimensions (W H) in mm Weight approx. Space requirements 244 byte inputs and outputs per slave 0 _C to +60 _C 40 _C to +70 _C 5 to 95% Double eurocard 160 233.4 0.5 kg 1 slot
0.6 A 13 Kbyte max. 122 ET 200 U/B/C, S595U/DP and/or other field devices
Ordering data
IM 308-C interface module for connecting the SIMATIC S5115U/H, S5135U, S5155U/H to PROFIBUSDP, with memory card (256 kByte)
Order No. 6ES5 308-3UC11 Memory card 256 Kbyte EPROM 1 Mbyte EPROM
Order No.
4/150
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
Design
The IM324R interface module is plugged into the first cen tral controller (subunit A) and the IM304 interface module into the second central con troller (subunit B). The two in terface modules are connec ted via a 721 connecting cable (max. 100 m (328 ft)).
Subunit A
IM 324R
Subunit B
IM 304
Principle of operation
The two IM324R and IM304 interface modules handle all data communications
between the two central con trollers of the failsafe pro grammable controller.
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 max. S IM 324R max. Power loss S IM 304 S IM 324R max. max. 1.5 A 1.0 A 7.5 W 5W Space requirements Weight 1 slot 0.3 kg (0.66 lb)
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5155H IM 324R interface module for linking the central controllers of the S5155H
6ES5 324-3UR11
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/151
Design
An IM 304 interface module is plugged into each of the two central controllers. Two IM 314R interface modules are plugged into each expan sion unit. The interface mod ules must be interconnected via 721 connecting cables (max. 600 m (1968 ft)). A ter minating resistor must be plugged into the last interface module in each chain. The expansion units (EG 185U) can be situated up to 600 m (1968 ft) away from the central controllers. A max imum of eight lines, each with up to four expansion units, can be connected to the cen tral controllers. The maximum number of expansion units which can be connected is 16. The following can also be connected to each EG 185U expansion unit: S Expansion units EG 183U, EG 184U and EG 187U in a centralized configuration us ing IM 300 interface mod ules S Expansion unit EG 183U and the ET 100U electronic ter minator in distributed config uration using IM 308 inter face modules S The ET 200 distributed I/O system using the IM 308C interface module (see Section 6)
IM 314R
Subunit A CC 135U/155U
Additional lines
Subunit B CC 135U/155U
IM 304
IM 304
IM 304
IM 314R 2nd EU EU 185U/ ER 701-3LH IM 314R 3rd EU EU 185U/ ER 701-3LH Additional EUs Additional EUs max. 4 EUs max. 600 m (1968 ft)
IM 314R Terminator
4/152
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface modules
Technical specifications
Current consumption (at 5 V) S IM 304 max. S IM 314R max. Power loss S IM 304 S IM 314R max. max. 1.5 A 1.0 A 7.5 W 5W Space requirements Weight approx. 1 slot 0.3 kg
Ordering data
IM 304 interface module for the central controller IM 314R interface module for the EG 185U expansion unit Terminator for IM 314R
Order No. 6ES5 304-3UB11 6ES5 314-3UR11 6ES5 760-0HA11 721 connecting cable
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/153
Design
The front connectors are hooked into the module at the bottom, swung towards the module and bolted at the top. The width of the front connec tors corresponds to one of the following: S 1 slot (singlewidth) or S 2 slots (doublewidth).
Doublewidth front connectors should always be used for doublewidth modules or if the slot adjacent to the module at the right is unused (always in the EG 187U expansion unit; without fan).
Stranded conductors should be used for easy movement of the front connectors. Further types of connection with modified front connec tors, prepared cables and ter minals for sensors and actua tors can be found in the Catalog KT 10 (SITOP power).
Technical specifications
Front connector Connection Conductor crosssection S Crimp terminals S Screw terminals 6ES5 497-... Crimp terminals or screw terminals 0.5 ... 1.5 0.5 ... 2.5 mm2 mm2 Space in the front connector S Crosssection approx. S Number of cables max. with 2.5 mm2 max. with 1.5 mm2 max. with 0.5 mm2 Weight approx. 470 mm2 24 36 48 0.2 kg (0.44 lb)
Ordering data
497-4UA front connector for crimp terminals (without crimp contacts) S Width = 1 slot, 42pin for the following modules (with fan) 6ES5420.., 430.., 431.., 432.., 434.., 441.., 451.., 458.., 460.., 463.., 465.., 470.., 482.. S Width = 2 slots, 42pin for the modules 6ES5453.., 454.., 457.., 482..; for the following modules (without fan) 6ES5420.., 430.., 431.., 432.., 434.., 441.., 451, 458.., 460.., 463.., 465.., 470.. S Width = 2 slots, 20pin for the following modules 6ES5435.., 436.., 455.., 456.., 951..
Order No. 497-4UB front connector for screw terminals 6ES5 497-4UA12 S Width = 1 slot, 42-pin for the following modules (with fan) 6ES5420.., 430.., 431.., 432.., 434.., 441.., 451.., 458.., 460.., 463.., 465.., 470.., 482.. S Width = 2 slots, 42pin for the modules 6ES5453.., 454.., 457.., 482..; for the following modules (without fan) 6ES5420.., 430.., 431.., 432.., 434.., 441.., 451.., 458.., 460.., 463.., 465.., 470.. S Width = 2 slots, 25pin for the module 6ES5454.. S Width = 2 slots, 20pin for the following modules 6ES5435.., 436.., 455.., 456.., 951..
Order No.
6ES5 497-4UB31
6ES5 497-4UB12
6ES5 497-4UA22
6ES5 497-4UA42
4/154
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 497-4UC11
1 2 3 4 5
6ES5 998-0ULJ3
6ES5 955-3LC41
6ES5 998-1ULJ4
6ES5 955-3LF41
6ES5 998-2ULJ4
6ES5 955-3NC41
6ES5 955-3NF41
6ES5 998-1UMJ2
6ES5 955-3NA12
1 2 3 4 5
Siemens ST 50 1998
4/155
6ES5 988-3NB11
6ES5 981-0DA11
6ES5 981-0FA41
6ES5 981-0FA11
4/156
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC 505
General
Application
Fig. 5/1
The SIMATIC 505 program mable controllers provide a special combination of open loop control tasks, closed Design Compactness The SIMATIC 505 program mable controllers have an ex tremely compact design cor responding to the stateoftheart of integrated circuits (ASICs). The latest design technology ensures low space requirements with high performance. System costs and space requirements decrease at the same time as system reliability increases.
loop control tasks and com plex mathematical functions for a large variety of applica tions in process engineering. Intelligent I/O modules The SIMATIC 505 program mable controllers have differ ent digital, analog and intelli gent I/O modules as well as communications processors available. There are digital module versions with 8, 16, 32 inputs/outputs, and relay module versions with 8, 16, 32 outputs. Analog input/out put modules acquire signals from thermocouples and RTD inputs. In addition, there are ATcompatible PC modules and different communications processors (for example, with RS 232 interfaces) available. Distributed control The SIMATIC 505 program mable controllers let you take a truly distribued approach to your plant control. First of all they are designed to meet the latest IEC safety and reliability standards to withstand the toughest industrial environ ments so that they can be placed wherever they are needed. Secondly, a powerful, remote I/O capability enables I/O modules and subracks to be placed as far as 1000 m/3280 ft from the controller itself, thus eliminating the need for long, multiple cable runs to remote sensors and actuators.
5/2
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC 505
General
Design (continued)
Redundant systems For critical process applica tions, the SIMATIC 560T/TI565T systems can be combined with the TI505 Hot backup with singlechan nel I/O design The hot backup system con sists of a redundant configu ration of the CPUs. The active PLC and the standby PLC are each equipped with a hot backup card. A fiberoptic connection be tween the active and the standby PLC executes self monitoring and synchroniza tion of the programs up to four times per cycle. The active PLC updates the standby PLC automatically and hands over control as soon as a serious fault oc curs. The hot backup system re quires no additional program ming by the user.
I/O modules to form a redun dant system. The redundant design reduces any possible down time to a minimum.
TRISPLITTER box
Fig. 5/2
It guarantees the integrity of both PLCs even during online program edits.
Hot backup with twochannel I/O design The TI505 I/O system can also operate redundantly. For this purpose, a special power supply module and the RBC (remote base controller) are installed redundantly (double) in a special redun dantly designed mounting rack. The RFRBC is an intelli gent interface between the RCC (remote channel control ler) and the redundant mounting rack. The redundant mounting rack, equipped with 11 slots, con tains two power supply mod ules (110/220 V AC or 24 V DC) and two RBCs. In addi tion, each redundant mount ing rack has two cables so that if one line fails an auto matic switch can be made to the other.
505-6511
Fig. 5/3
In normal mode, one of the re dundant RCBs is active and the other is in standby. If an fatal fault occurs in the active RCB, communications are au tomatically switched to the
redundant standby RCB. This takes place within one PLC cycle.
Siemens ST 50 1998
5/3
SIMATIC 505
Programming
Insulation group
Temperature range
Order No. CPUs (continued) Firmware upgrade kit for TI5451101 Version 2.1.1 for TI5451102 Version 3.1 TI555 8192 digital/8192 analog inputs/ outputs, memory 384 KB, memory 1920 KB TI560T (with power supply) for twistedpair cable S 110 V AC, RS 485, RCC S 24 V DC, RS 485, RCC for coaxial cable connection S 110 V AC, RCC S 24 V DC, RCC TI565T (with power supply) for twistedpair cable S 110 V AC, RS 485, RCC S 24 V DC, RS 485, RCC for coaxial cable connection S 110 V AC, RCC S 24 V DC, RCC
Order No.
PPX:2601099-8005 PPX:2601099-8006
PPX:555-1101 PPX:555-1102
PPX:535-1212
PPX:545-1102
PPX:545-1103
5/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC 505
Ordering data
Order No. Controllers Controllers for expansion units S I/O channel controller (IOCC) for TI5352) S Distributed base controller (DBC) for TI5353) S Remote channel controller (RCC), coaxial S Remote channel controller (RCC), RS 485 interface S Remote base controller (RBC), coaxial FM mode4) S Remote base controller (RBC), RS 485 interface4) S Remote base controller (RBC) for TI560T/565T, max. 4 km, coaxial S Remote base controller (RBC), for TI560T/565T, max. 1 km, RS 485 S 505/6MT controller S 505/7MT controller Manuals S 7 MT interface adapter S 6 MT interface adapter Communications modules Peerlink module, Pointtopoint link between 2 to 16 modules, mixed link between TI500 and TI505, with manual S for TI505, 2 redundant channels S for TI500, 1 channel S for TI500, 2 redundant channels TIWAY communications processor NIM with manual S 2 redundant interfaces (local line) for TI505 S 2 redundant interfaces (RS232) for TI505 S 2 redundant interfaces (local line) for TI500 S 2 redundant interfaces (RS232) for TI500 UNLINK host adapter with manual and PIM S 115 V AC, local line/local line TI WAY interfaces, computer inter faces RS232C/423 S 115 V AC, RS232C/RS232C TI WAY interfaces, computer inter faces RS232C/423 S 220 V AC, local line/local line TI WAY interfaces, computer inter faces RS232C/423 S 220 V AC, RS232C/RS232C TI WAY interfaces, computer inter faces RS232C/423
Order No.
PPX:500-5114-A
PPX:505-7111
PPX:505-7112
PPX:505-7113
PPX:505-7114
3) TI535: DBC as interface in each expansion rack. 4) RBC as interface between CPU and RCC in expansion racks for 560T/565T.
Siemens ST 50 1998
5/5
SIMATIC 505
Ordering data
Order No. I/O modules (continued) Digital input modules (cont.) S 48/24 V DC, 16 inputs S 24 V AC, 8 inputs S 24 V AC, 16 inputs S 24 V AC, 32 inputs S 110 V AC, 8 inputs S 110 V AC, 16 inputs S 110 V AC, 32 inputs S 220 V AC, 8 inputs S 220 V AC, 16 inputs S 220 V AC, 32 inputs S 24 V DC isolated, 16/8 interrupt inputs S 48 V DC, isolated interrupts, 16 inputs/outputs S 125 V DC, isolated interrupts, 16 inputs/outputs S Simulation modules, 32 inputs Digital output modules S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 8 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 8 sinkonly out puts S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 16 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 16 sinkonly outputs S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 32 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 0.5 A, 32 sinkonly outputs S 24 V DC, 2 A, 8 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 2 A, 8 sinkonly out puts S 24 V DC, 2 A, 16 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 2 A, 16 sinkonly out puts S 24 V DC, 2 A, 32 sourceonly outputs S 24 V DC, 2 A, 32 sinkonly out puts S 115 V AC/DC, 4 A, 16 relay out puts S 24/110 V AC, 0.5 A, 8 outputs S 24/110 V AC, 0.5 A, 16 outputs S 24/110 V AC, 0.5 A, 32 outputs S 110/220 V AC, 1 A, 8 outputs S 110/220 V AC, 1 A, 16 outputs S 110/220 V AC, 1 A, 32 outputs S 220 V AC, 24 V DC, 2 A, 8 relay outputs S 220 V AC, 24 V DC, 2 A, 16 relay outputs S 220 V AC, 24 V DC, 2 A, 32 relay outputs S 220 V AC, 24 V DC, 5 A/3 A, 16 relay outputs S Simulation modules, 32 outputs
Order No.
PPX:505-7202
PPX:505-CP1434TF
PPX:505-4316-A PPX:505-4008-A PPX:505-4016-A PPX:505-4032-A PPX:505-4208-A PPX:505-4216-A PPX:505-4232-A PPX:505-4408-A PPX:505-4416-A PPX:505-4432-A PPX:505-4317 PPX:505-4318 PPX:505-4319 PPX:505-6010 PPX:505-4508 PPX:505-3508 PPX:505-4516 PPX:505-3516 PPX:505-4532 PPX:505-3532 PPX:505-4708 PPX:505-3708 PPX:505-4716 PPX:505-3716 PPX:505-4732 PPX:505-3732 PPX:505-5417 PPX:505-4608 PPX:505-4616 PPX:505-4632 PPX:505-4808 PPX:505-4816 PPX:505-4832 PPX:505-4908 PPX:505-4916-A PPX:505-4932 PPX:505-5518 PPX:505-6011
PPX:505-5184
PPX:505-6860
5/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
SIMATIC 505
Ordering data
Order No. Special modules (continued) Manual for counter module with 2 counters, English with 6 counters, English Basic module 2 (RS232C/423) interfaces, me mory 28 KB, transmission rate 11019200 bps Backup battery for basic module EEPROM for basic program PPX:505-6308 PPX:505-6408 PPX:505-8105-2 PPX:505-8123-1 Manual (supplied with module) 386/ATM module with CPU 30C286SX, RAM 4 MB, hard disk 120 MB, clock fre quency 8 or 16 MHz, MSDOS manual (English) and software Manual (supplied with module) Turbo plastic module 5 analog inputs 0 to +5/0 to +10V DC 4 analog outputs, -10 to +10 V DC 4 digital outputs, 15 to 24 V DC Turbo parison module 4 digital inputs/5 analog inputs 4 digital inputs/4 analog inputs Hot backup system 560T hot backup system with 560/565T hot backup card, upgrade kit (PPX:5602129A) and: S 2 560T CPU (PPX:560T1KM1101) S 2 560T CPU (PPX:560T1KM1102) S 2 560T CPU (PPX:560T4KM1101) S 2 560T CPU (PPX:560T4KM1102) S 2 565T CPU (PPX:565T1KM1101) S 2 565T CPU (PPX:565T1KM1102) S 2 565T CPU (PPX:565T4KM1101) S 2 565T CPU (PPX:565T4KM1102) Manuals S Hot backup installation instruc tions, English S TI505 redundant I/O, English
Order No.
PPX:505-6108-A PPX:505-6208-A
PPX:505-7012 PPX:505-7016
PPX:505-ATM-MANL-3 PPX:505-5100
PPX:505-5103
PPX:505-7003
PPX:560-65-8103-2 PPX:505-8125-2
Siemens ST 50 1998
5/7
SIMATIC 505
Ordering data
Order No. Spares for 525 to 555 (continued) Fuses S Set, 3 A/125 V, pack of 5, for 50545xx S Set, 3 A/250 V, pack of 5, for 50548xx S Set, 3 A/250 V, pack of 5, for 50546xx S Set, 3 A/250 V, pack of 5, for 5056660 Spares for TI560/565 S 560T digital CPU S 565T special function CPU S 560T/565T power supply mod ule, 110/220 V AC S 560T/565T power supply mod ule, 24 V DC S Remote channel controller (RCC) (FM) S Remote channel controller (RCC) (RS 485) S Hot backup card S Hot backup upgrade kit (2 modules + cable) S Memory expansion module 64 K words S Memory expansion module 256 K words S Distributor box for 565T hot backup, tri splitter S Fiber optic cable for 565 HBU
Order No.
PPX:2587705-8010 PPX:2587705-8011 PPX:2587705-8003 PPX:2587704-8001 PPX:2587705-8001 PPX:2587705-8009 PPX:2587681-8020 PPX:2587681-8022 PPX:2587681-8031 PPX:2587681-8012 on request PPX:2587681-8030 PPX:2587678-8005 PPX:2601094-8001 PPX:545-1111 PPX:2587704-8002
PPX:560-2820 PPX:565-2820 PPX:560-2122 PPX:560-2123 PPX:560-2126-B PPX:560-2127-B PPX:560-2128-A PPX:560-2129-A PPX:560-2130 PPX:560-2136 PPX:2587755-8001 PPX:2587693-8010
Order No. PPX:575-2103 PPX:575-8101-4 PPX:575-8104-1 PPX:575-6660 PPX:575-6663 PPX:575-2126 Accessories S Connecting cable with RS232 interface (for connecting pro gramming devices) S dummy plate 1" for 5752124 (9 slots) S dummy plate 0.2" for 5752124 (9 slots) or for 5752128 (14 slots) S dummy plate 0.4" for 5752124 (9 slots) or for 5752128 (14 slots) S dummy plate 0.6" for 5752130 (16 slots) S dummy plate 0.8" for 5752130 (16 slots) S Mounting rail for 5752124 (9 slots) S Mounting rail for 5752128 (14 slots) S Mounting rail for 5752130 (16 slots) S Ventilator set for 5752130, 115/230 V AC S J2 backplane bus connector for power supply, 1 slot for all de vices (optional) S Daisy chain bridging connector for 5752124 or for 5752128 S Spare I/O connector S Spare battery, 4 V, 5 Ah S Spare fuse for 5756660, 8 A
Order No.
PPX:VPU200-3605
PPX:2589739-8003 PPX:2589739-8004
PPX:2589739-8005
5/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
Standard Tools
STEP 5 programming software Application
Software
Fig. 7/2
STEP 5 is the time-tested pro gramming software for SI MATIC S5 programmable con trollers. With STEP 5 it is possible to create, test and document user programs for all SIMATIC S5 programmable controllers. STEP 5 is an attractive solu tion for all S5 users: S Ergonomic user interface according to the SAA stan dard; makes STEP 5 user friendly and easy to operate S Novell-based network capa bility; facilitates data mainte nance and archiving consid erably S Large range of functions; manages even complex tasks without great effort
STEP 5 is available in two variants: S STEP 5/ST basic package for programming devices and PCs; for programming, testing, documenting, installing and automatic documentation of S5 programs for the pro grammable controllers S5-90U, S5-95U/F, S5-100U, S5101-U, S5-115U/H/F,S5-135U, S5-150U and S5-155U/H.
S
STEP 5 runs under the operat ing systems S MS-DOS 5.0 or higher S Windows 3.x and S Windows 95 on S PG 730, PG 750, PG 770 S PG 720, PG 740, PG 760 or S AT-compatible PC. At least 4 megabytes of RAM are required.
STEP 5/ST for mini PLCs for PC; STEP 5/ST for mini PLCs is specially for programming the mini controllers S5-90U, S5-95-U/F and S5-100U. Only the following software packages are executable: GRAPH Mini, COM IP 266, COM GRAPH, COM Text, COM 95F, COM DB1, COM 521 BASIC. All other COM packages and optional packages can not be used. STEP 5/ST for mini controllers
S
Design
STEP 5/ST basic package for programming devices and PCs The scope of supply includes: STEP 5 programming soft ware (including KOMDOK) S STL editor/batch compiler S COM DB 1 parameterization software
S
The basic package is instal led on the programming devi ces PG 720, PG 740 and PG 760 as standard software. If it is required for a PC it is sup plied on CD and diskettes.
The scope of supply includes: STEP 5 programming soft ware for mini controllers; based on the STEP 5 pro gramming language.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/3
Software
Standard Tools
STEP 5 programming software (continued) Function Structured programming With STEP 5 it is possible to program clearly from simple AND/OR operations to com plex functions, e.g. switch off delays or arithmetic calcula tions. A STEP 5 program can be several thousand state ments long. To keep pro grams as clear as possible, STEP 5 features several con trol structures:
S
Blocks A linear sequence of com mands is subdivided into sections and each section packed into a block. There are different types of blocks for different technological subtasks of a program. The executable program consists of calls of blocks in other blocks. Nesting is pos sible to a depth of 32 levels.
Segments For fine structuring inside blocks subtasks can be pro grammed in individual seg ments. Segments can be co pied from one block to another. Comments A complete program, blocks, segments and indi vidual statements can be commented directly. This ensures that the program re mains understandable on every level of abstraction.
Methods of representation
STEP 5 can be programmed in three methods of represen tation: S Statement list (STL): The program consists of a sequence of mnemonic ab breviations of the com mands to be executed by the programmable controller. S Ladder diagram (LAD): Graphic representation of the automation task with cir cuit diagram symbols (American representation)
Control system flowchart (CSF): Graphical method of repre senting the automation task with symbols according to DIN 40700/DIN 40719
With all three methods of rep resentation, absolute or sym bolic designations for oper ands can be used.
In LAD and CSF, complex functions and function block calls can be entered using the function keys. They are dis played as graphic symbols on the screen. Programs that were created in STL cannot necessarily be displayed in LAD or CSF be cause STL has several fea tures of its own. However, pro grams in LAD or CSF can be translated to STL. LAD and SCF are largely mutually com patible.
STL
SCF
7/4
Siemens ST 50 1998
Standard Tools
STEP 5 programming software (continued) Function (continued) Blocks There are 5 types of block: Organization blocks (OB); for organizing the control program S Program blocks (PB); contain the control program, subdivided according to functional or technological criteria
S
Software
Sequence blocks (SB); for programming sequential control systems S Function blocks (FB); contain frequently recurring or especially complex parts of the program (e.g. signal ing and calculation func tions). Function blocks can be parameterized and have an extended operation set
S
Data blocks(DB) for storing data that is re quired to process the control program, e.g. actual values, limit values, texts
Types of operation
STEP 5 makes a distinction between three types of opera tion: S Basic operations; e.g. logic operations, stor age operations, loading and transferring, timer opera tions, counter operations, comparison operations, arithmetic operations, block operations. They can be executed in organization, program, sequence and function blocks. A whole range of easy-to-use additional functions make pro gram handling easy: S Storage of user-specific project settings
Except for addition (+F), subtraction (-F) and organi zational operations they can be executed in all three me thods of representation S Supplementary operations; complex functions, e.g. sub stitution statements, test functions, word logic, decre menting/incrementing and branching functions. This can only be executed in STL.
System operations; These access the operating system directly and must therefore only be used by experienced programmers. They can only be executed in STL.
Additional functions
Symbol editor; for creating and automati cally updating assignment lists for the symbolic pro gramming of blocks S Automatic generation and updating of cross-reference lists S Comparison of user pro grams between diskette, hard disk, PLC or EPROM
S S
Transfer of blocks to EPROM or EEPROM submodules for the programmable control lers S Rewiring of inputs, outputs, flags, timers and counters (i.e. renaming operands in the entire user program or individual blocks)
S
For commissioning and main tenance, STEP 5 provides a number of test and service functions; With the menu "documenta tion" it is possible to output the following documentation on a printer: S Complete programs or pro gram sections, if necessary with comments S Cross-reference lists for op erand symbols(I/Q/F/T/C/S) and/or individual operands (e.g. I 1.7)
Direct and program-depen dent signal state display, i.e. status of variables or blocks (program status)
S S
Control of outputs, flags etc. Detection of double assign ment of bit, byte and word addresses for I/Q/F/S
Program documentation
Program overview display, if necessary with call structure of all blocks of a complete program S Assignment plan for inputs, outputs, flags, timers and counters S Assignment lists with com ments (up to 40 characters per assignment)
S
In addition to standard output, user-friendly output of docu mentation functions (pre viously called KOMDOK) can be used. It permits, for exam ple, automation of printout using control statements or graphic preparation, sorting and evaluation of program data.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/5
Software
Standard Tools
STEP 5 programming software (continued) Function (continued) STEP 5 Version 7.0 STEP 5 Version 7.0 includes a whole range of improvements and innovations over the pre vious version. Real DOS application Version 7.0 is the first "real" DOS variant of STEP 5 and makes consistent use of the functions of this operating system: S Consistent implementation of the SAA standard S Use of DOS directory paths; the previous restriction to one directory per drive has been abolished S Use of all drive letters from A to Z Improved performance Version 7.0 includes further increases in performance: S Use of the entire RAM in cluding extended memory (XMS) S Reduction of the memory re quirements in the conven tional memory area S Lower package reloading times for improved strategy S Integration of the EPROM driver into the STEP 5/ST ba sic package; it no longer needs to be resident in the RAM Ergonomic user interface Operator ergonomics has been improved once again: S Shallower menu structures; by and large there are now only two menu levels S Standardization of the dialog field structure S New acceleration keys and hotkeys S Project settings in "index cards" S Access to interfaces from project settings S Direct fast callup of editors from the project settings, the block directory and ISTACK S Test functions quickly ac cessible through new menu items "test" and "PLC" S Online/offline switchover now in dialog boxes
Fig. 7/5 S Project settings (index cards)
Fig. 7/4
Dialog fieldstructure
Extended and standardized syntax for the block list, valid for all functions (editor, printer etc.)
New functions Numerous new functions have been integrated into the pro gram: S Switchover between various languages within STEP 5 S Call of a DOS shell from STEP 5 S Automatic loading of the last active optional package on restarting STEP 5 (if para meterized) S Retention of the project files last used in the "file" menu S History (repetition function) for input fields in dialog boxes or in program han dling
Extension of help and info functions in the menu and in the dialog boxes, fast ac cess by menu keys S Integration of COM pack ages into the "change" menu S New options for general project settings, e.g. com patibility monitoring between older and new STEP 5 ver sions
S
Extensive downward compati bility In the development of STEP 5/ST V7.0, the greatest pos sible compatibility with ver sions 3.x and 6.x has been re tained. If new options are used, e.g. DOS paths, incompatibility with older STEP 5 versions can arise because they do not know these functions. In this case a message appears in dicating abandonment of compatibility.
7/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
Standard Tools
STEP 5 basis packages (continued) Technical specifications
STEP 5/ST basic package for programmers and PCs Current version Operating system V 7.0 MSDOS V5.0 and higher Windows 3.x Windows 95 min. 4 Mbytes 13 Mbytes PG, PC S590U S595U/F S5100U S5101U S5115U/H/F S5135U S5150U S5155U/H STEP 5/ST for mini-controllers V 7.0 MSDOS V5.0 and higher Windows 3.x Windows 95 4 Mbytes 13 Mbytes PC S590U S595U S5100U
Software
Ordering data
STEP 5/ST-basic pacakge for PG and PC (V7.0) on the basis of MS-DOS with au thorization diskette, for program ming all PLCs with PCs, on 31/2" diskettes in German, English, French, Spanish, Italian. Single license Copy license STEP 5/ST for mini-controllers (V7.0) on the basis of MS-DOS with au thorization diskette for program ming mini PLCs, S5-90U, 95U and 100U, executable on PC, on 31/2" diskettes in German, English , French, Spanish, Italian Single license Copy license
Order No. PC-AG cable (734-1) Connecting cable between SIMA TIC S5 (15-pin) and PC (25-pin), 3.2m PG-AG cable (734-2) (included in the scope of supply of the programmer, 3.2m) connec ting cable between the program mer and SIMATIC S5, 5m 10 m 25 m Documentation for STEP 5/ST for PG/PC (V7.0) (also for STEP 5/ST basic pack age and STEP 5/ST for mini con trollers) German English French Spanish Italian
6ES5 998-0MA14 6ES5 998-0MA24 6ES5 998-0MA34 6ES5 998-0MA44 6ES5 998-0MA54
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/7
Software
TISOFT Application
Standard Tools
TISOFT is a complete soft ware package for program ming and documenting all SIMATIC programmable con trollers of the series 505. TISOFT allows the rapid and simple implementation of all automation tasks, as well as straightforward maintenance of the plant placed in opera tion.
TISOFT Programming
PG/PC
505
Fig. 7/6
Design
S S S S
Tools for programming, doc umenting, debugging, de veloping and maintaining programs Menudriven operation Extensive online auxiliary functions Programmable updating displays Sophisticated debugging aids
TISOFT has the same user in terface for all programmable controllers. Plant modifica tions and extensions can thus be implemented by the user with no additional training. TISOFT runs on: SIMATIC PG 720, PG 720C, PG 730, PG 730C, PG 740, PG 750, PG 760 and PG 770 programming devices S IBM PCs S IBMcompatible PCs
S
Additional requirements: Floppy disk drive (at least 360 Kbyte) and hard disk drive S Monochrome or color monitor S MSDOS S Connecting cable for RS 232 C modem (for on line mode only)
S
Ordering data
TISOFT for 505 Version 6.2 TISOFT upgrading to Version 6.2 TISOFT license V6.2 for 505 TISOFT V6.2 additional copy for 505 PLC
Order No. PPX:PC505-6262 PPX:PC505-UPG62 PPX:TSSL505-6251 PPX:TSSL505-6362 Manual for 505 TISOFT English German French Italian
Order No.
7/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
Standard Tools
APT (Application Productivity Tool) Application APT is an integrated control system design environment that uses computeraided software engineering (CASE) technology to provide an ob jectoriented design environ ment for the SIMATIC505 pro grammable controllers. APT also provides a link between the individual controllers and their logical representation in the data base of the SIMATIC PCS humanma chineinterface. The package runs on PCs or on the state oftheart Siemens program ming devices.
Fig. 7/7
Software
APT Programming
PG/PC
Functions
APT provides a natural means of mapping the physical pro cess into the control system. It encourages the partition into a hierarchical structure which is easier to understand and implement. APT uses a graphical ap proach to design. GRAFCET techniques are used for de veloping sequential logic. APT also has a graphical repre sentation for continuous con trol processes based on the SAMA1) standard. Develop ment of lowerlevel control ac tions are simplified by using a library of devices and contin uous function blocks that in clude internal interlocks and comprehensive auxiliary in formation.
Separate safestate sequen tial function charts (SFC) pro vide alternate control actions for emergency situations. The safestate SFCs have flexible returntonormal paths to match the process operating procedures. Extensive valida tion functions are included to quickly trap invalid and mis sing configurations. MAITT, a test language interpreter, is included for writing tests and validating control logic.
The principal features of APT are: S Supports sequential continu ous, safestate, parallel, batch control strategies and process partitioning S Integrates application de sign development, testing, documentation, and mainte nance S Windowing, splitscreens, pulldown help screens, em bedded algorithms, and fill intheblank forms S Sequential function chart (SFC) and continuous func tion chart (CFC) graphics based languages S State control and math text based languages S Multiple main and subordi nate safestate SFCs with priority levels S Libraries of standard control algorithms
Order No.
Ordering data
SIMATIC APT software Upgrade, with manual set (Version 1.7a) SIMATIC APT software Upgrade to V1.7a, with manual set SIMATIC APT software Version 1.7a , with APT manual set, single license and network card CP 1413, for linking with Industrial Ethernet, compatible with SIMATIC 505 and SIMATIC S5
Order No. PPX:APT-6201-T Manuals System overview for APT software, English User manual for APT software, German French Programming instructions for APT software, German French Manual set for APT software (Version 1.7a)
PPX:APT-8100
PPX:APT-6202-T
PPX:APT-8101D PPX:APT-8101F
PPX:APT-6204-T
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/9
Engineering Tools
GRAPH 5/II Application The S5 software package GRAPH 5/II is used for config uring, programming, testing and documenting sequence control systems with a stan dard method of representa tion. Graph 5/II contains all functions of the STEP 5 basic package (see page 7/3). A program package with stan dard function blocks is re quired for runnlng the GRAPH 5/II functions in the program mable controllers (see page 7/55). GRAPH 5/II can be used in the following programmable controllers: S S595U (as of 6ES5 0958M. .2); only with FB 72, FB 73, FB 74 and SB5 S S5100U; only with CPU 103 S S5115U; with CPU 941, CPU 942, CPU 943, CPU 944 and CPU 945
Software
Transition 4: Part inserted S1 T2 S2 T3 S3 T4 S4 T7 S8 T6 S7 T5 S6 T9 S11 T10 S12 Step 4: Auto enable Ver 1 Hand S1 Ver 2 Retract arm & ?1 & =A2.0 S5 T8 S10 S9 E 7,1 E 7,2 E 7,3 E 7,4 E 7,5 E 7,6 E 7,7 &
&
?1 Auto enable
&
=A1.0
T12
S5135U: with CPU 922, CPU 928 and CPU 928B S S5150U; no restrictions S S5155U; with CPU 946, CPU 947 and CPU 948 Synchronization with the standard function block (FB 70 - 73), which controls the chain (also supports si multaneous branches) S Diagnostic functions with criteria analysis (via Indus trial Ethernet for up to 4 pro grammable controllers), op erating mask on the screen as "HW tableau/PG operat ing panel" or as "Simple op erating panel", indication of fault signals S User interface and plausibil ity check when generating step chains S Stepoverlapping magnify ing glass: multiple control of the same outputs, similar
GRAPH 5/II is executable un der S5DOS/ST, S5DOS/MT (V.6x) on the following pro gramming devices: PG 710 Plus, PG 720, PG 720C, PG 740, PG 730, PG 730C, PG 740, PG 750, PG 760 and PG 770. links and locks are only con figured and saved once, stepindependent actions are realized (can also be included in chain diagnostic function) Search function: Operands can be found step and transitionoverlap ping Preset timer values for easier programming Minimum monitoring time for monitoring unpermissible system states Optimization of the runtime by shorter operating times of the blocks and immediate activation of the following step at completed transition
Functions
S S
Generating the programs in accordance with the stan dard IEC DIS 11313 Conversion of GRAPH 5 blocks to GRAPH 5/II and vice versa; change of GRAPH 5 blocks; Programming of the steps (S) and transitions (T) in STL, CSF or LAD Overview and detailed rep resentation or zoom Synchronization of system, process and programmable controller. There are 2 methods of synchronization: Synchronization with the au tomatically generated syn chronization SB (supports alternative branches);
S S
Ordering data
GRAPH 5/II software package (S5-DOS/ST, S5-DOS/MT) for configuring and programming sequence control systems, for the S595U to S5155U program mable controllers (for S595U only with restrictions) on 31/2" diskettes German, English, French Single license Copy license 1) Does not run under STEP 5/ST V7.0
Order No. Documentation for GRAPH 5/II V6.6 German English French Software package GRAPH 5/II V7.02)(MS-DOS, FlexOS)) 6ES5 884-1FA03 6ES5 884-1FA03-0KL1
Order No.
2) Adapted to the new architecture and improved user interface of STEP 5/ST V7.0
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/11
Engineering Tools
PRODAVE Application PRODAVE is a toolbox which allows process data traffic be tween the programmable con troller and the programming device/PC. PRODAVE builds up the process data traffic be tween the programmable con troller and the programming device/PC via the AS511 pro tocol or via the 3964R (AK512). PRODAVE runs under MSDOS or Windows. All cur rent compilers, such as MSC, Turbo C and Turbo Pascal can be used as programming lan guage. Further details about the pro tocol processing are not re quired. The PLC communication is processed by PRODAVE au tonomously in the back ground. PRODAVE DOS/WIN PRODAVE DOS/WIN commu nicates via the serial interface of the programming de vice/PC with the programming device interface at the CPU, i. e. no special communications processor is needed in the PLC for connection of the pro gramming device/PC. Either the COM 1 or COM2 interface can be used in the program ming device or PC. For con nection via the COM2 inter face of the programming device or COM1 and COM2 interface of the PC, an V.24/TTY converter must be used. The programming device multplexer PG-MUX can be used as an interface multi plexer for the connection of max. 7 PLCs to a serial inter face of the programming de vice/PC. Principle of operation Once loaded, the PRODAVE toolbox remains resident in memory. It can therefore ope rate in quasibackground whilst other applications such as statistical evaluations of The toolbox contains the following functions: Read PLC info (PLC type, CP type, version) S Read PLC status (RUN, STOP) S Byte conversion from a byte to 8 logical values and vice versa
S Siemens ST 50 1998
Software
PLC
PRODAVE
PRODAVE DOS 64R or WIN 64R communicate with the PLC via the serial inter face of the programming de vice and via the CP 521/ CP 523/CP 524 and CP 525 communications processors. Thus, the interface of the CPU remains free. PRODAVE NET PRODAVE NET communicates with the programmable con troller via SINEC H1/ PROFIBUS and runs on a pro gramming device/PC under MSDOS and Windows 3.11. PRODAVE DDE (for SIMATIC S5) PRODAVE DDE communi cates via the serial interface of the programming device with the programming device interface on the CPU (protocol AS 511). such process data run in the foreground. The individual tools can be called within the processing program. PRO DAVE allows not only the eva luation and monitoring of a Read data words from block (range from... to...) S Write data words into block (address range) S Read/write data words from/in blocks with simulta neous conversion of the data (e.g. KF, KG format)
S
It also communicates via the serial interface of the pro gramming device/PC with a point-to-point CP slotted into a programmable controller (e.g. CP 524, protocol RK 512). PRODAVE DDE includes a DDE interface with which standard Windows applica tions (e.g. Excel) can commu nicate with the control. PRODAVE for SIMATIC S7300/400 PRODAVE for SIMATIC S7300/400 runs un der MSDOS/Win dows 3.11/WIndows 95 and communicates with the control via the MPI interface (no operation with TK 858 and modem).
process, but also intervention in the process because a number of functions for wri ting data from the program ming device to the program mable controller are available.
S S S S S
Functions
Read input bytes from the PLC Write output byte to the PLC Format conversion of data (e.g. KH to integer) Bit memory bit test as status check Read bit memory byte or word from the PLC
7/15
Software
Engineering Tools
PRODAVE (continued) Functions (continued)
S S S S S
S S S
Write bit memory byte or word to the PLC Read counter statuses from the PLC Set counter statuses in the PLC Read timers from the PLC Time calls for the user pro gram delay, reset, sync, (e.g. for delay loops for reading data cyclically) Output error messages in plaintext Load the toolbox in the user memory Remove the toolbox from the user memory
Further functions of
PRODAVE DOS 511 and WIN 511: Common reading of data of different format (MIXREAD function) S Detection of all data blocks (DB and DX) in the PLC with the book function S Operation of PRODAVE with TK 858 and modem (not for PRODAVE for SIMATIC S7300/400)
S
Additional use of the pro gramming device interfaces COM 3 and COM 4 for the data traffic (also for PRODAVE WIN 511 Mini) S Fast processing of the data traffic without considerable additional memory space requirements
S
Scope of supply
For that, the receipt of the old software package must be presented, its serial number
must be stated and the origi nal diskette must be sent in with the rest of the labels.
Order No.
Ordering data
PRODAVE DOS 511 For data link via programming device interface of the PLC under MSDOS operating system, on 31/2" diskettes, operating in structions in German and English Single license Copy license PRODAVE WIN 511 For data link via programming device interface of the PLC under WINDOWS 3.11 operating sy stem, on 31/2" diskettes, opera ting instructions in German and English Single license Copy license PRODAVE WIN 511 Mini For data link via programming device interface of the PLC under Windows operating system, (only DB read/write and ask for PLC status), on 31/2" diskettes, operating in structions in German and English Single license Copy license PRODAVE DOS 64R For data link via CP 524/CP 525 (RK 512) or CP 521SI/CP 523 (3964R) under MSDOS operating system, on 31/2" diskettes, with operating instructions Single license Copy license German English French Spanish
PRODAVE WIN 64R For data link via e.g. CP 524/CP 525 (RK 512) or CP 521 SI/CP 523 (3964R) under Windows 3.11 operating system, on 31/2" diskettes, opera ting instructions in German and English Single license Copy license PRODAVE NET For data link with SIMATIC S5 via PROFIBUS/Industrial Ethernet under MSDOS and MSWINDOWS operating system, on 31/2" diskettes, manual in German and English Single license Copy license PRODAVE WIN DDE for SIMATIC S5 For data link via programming device interface of the PLC under Windows 3.11 (with DDE inter face), on 31/2" diskettes, opera ting instructions in German and English Single license Copy license 6ES5 886-2WS01 6ES5 886-2WS01-0KL1 6ES5 886-2MS01 6ES5 886-2MS01-0KL1 6ES5 897-2VD01 6ES5 897-2VD01-0KL1
7/16
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
COM 246, COM 247 Application The COM 246 and COM 247 parameter assignment soft ware enables parameter as signment, programming and control of the IP 246 and IP 247 positioning modules. COM 246 is required for the following modules: 6ES5 2464UA31, 6ES5 2464UB11. COM 247 is required for the following modules: 6ES5 2474UA31. Full functional capability can only be guaranteed with these combinations. See page 7/122 for standard function blocks for the relevant pro grammable controller. COM 246 und COM 247 sind ablauffhig unter MSDOS.
Programming device IP 246 IP 247
Software
Fig. 7/14 Connection and programming of the IP 246 and IP 247 positioning modules
Functions
The COM 246 and COM 247 parameter assignment soft ware enables operator prompted interactive dialog with the positioning modules.
There are userfriendly func tions available for this pur pose:
S
Representation of traverse programs in accordance with DIN 66 025 and in plaintext (you can switch at will between the two repre sentation types) S Help menus, extensive fault diagnostics
S Order No.
Ordering data
The parameter assignment soft ware COM 246 is part of the: Configuration package for IP 246I/A consisting of: Manual, standard FBs and para meter assignment software COM 246 German English French
Order No. The parameter assignment soft ware COM 247 is part of the: Configuring package for IP 247 consisting of: Manual, standard FBs and para meter assignment software COM 247 German English French
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/21
Software
COM 260 Application
Engineering Tools
The COM 260 software pack age provides userfriendly support for programming and startup of the IP 260 closed loop control module. All functions are executed using entries in interactive screen forms and function keys. COM 260 runs under MSDOS.
PG
Programming
COM 260
Ordering data
The parameter assignment soft ware COM 260 is part of the: Configuring package for IP 260 consisting of: Manual, standard FBs and para meter assignment software COM 260 German English French
Order No.
Order No.
COM 265 Application The COM 265 programming software is used to create the user program of the IP 265 highspeed sub control and to start up the module. Creation of the user program in FBD S parameter assignment S Offline simulation of the user program
S
The software runs under MS DOS on the PG 720, PG 740, PG 760 as well as under MS DOS on a PC with a proces sor from 80386. Online test function Compilation of the user program S Online loading of the user program via the CPU in the IP 265
S S
Functions
Reading/writing of the user program from/to EPROM or EEPROM S Management of program files
S
Ordering data
The parameter assignment soft ware COM 265 is part of the: Configuring package for IP 265 consisting of: Manual and programming soft ware COM 265, incl. decoder German English French
Order No.
7/22
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
COM 266 Application The COM 266 parameter as signment software is required for the IP 266 positioning module for direct program ming, parameter assignment and control from the program ming device. The COM 266 parameter as signment software allows userfriendly, interactive op eration with the IP 266 posi tioning module. It offers the following facilities, amongst others: S Input/output of machine data and traversing programs S Representation of traversing programs in accordance with DIN 66 025 and in plaintext. The user can change over between both methods of representation at will Ordering data
The parameter assignment soft ware COM 266 is part of the: Configuring package for IP 266 consisting of: Manual and para meter assignment software COM 266 German English French Order No.
Software
Programming
Programming device
COM PMC Application The COM PMC parameter as signment software is required for adapting the "PMC 527 standard software" to each automation task.
COM PMC
Printer DR 2XX
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/23
Software
Engineering Tools
COM PMC (continued) Principle of operation The COM PMC parameter as signment software supports the user in configuring the lo cal operator system, the mas ter operator system and the
Order No. COM PMC parameter assignment software (continued) on 51/4" diskettes Single license Copy license 6ES5 835-4SFJ1 6ES5 835-4SFJ1-0KL1 1 2 3 German English French
signalling functions. The pa rameters required for describ ing the system configuration are acquired via screen forms and stored in data blocks on
the diskette. The user data are checked for correctness on entry.
Ordering data
COM PMC parameter assignment software for parameterizing the "PMC stan dard software, S5DOS/ST, on 31/2" diskettes Single license Copy license German English French
Order No.
COM REG Application COM REG is required for structuring and parameteriz ing the following: The IP 252 closedloop con trol module in the S5115U, S5135U, S5150U and S5155U programmable controllers S The R64 controller struc ture" standard function block (software controllers, see page 7/65) for the CPU 922, CPU 928 and CPU 928B of the S5135U and S5155U programmable controllers
S
Programming
COM REG
Functions
Ordering data
COM REG parameter assignment software (S5DOS) for parameterizing the IP 252 closedloop control module and the R64 controller structure" standard function block on 31/2"and 51/4" diskettes,
Order No. Single license German English French Copy license German English French
6ES5 895-3SA12 6ES5 895-3SA22 6ES5 895-3SA32 6ES5 895-3SA12-0KL1 6ES5 895-3SA22-0KL1 6ES5 895-3SA32-0KL1
7/24
Siemens ST 50 1998
Software
Engineering Tools
SIEPID S5 (continued) Functions Recording and storing measu red values: SIEPID S5 can be used for re cording and storing measured values. Specification of controlled systems by the user It is possible for the user to specify models of controlled systems, and therefore carry out investigations. This function is very useful for theoretical preliminary in vestigations or for training purposes, without the need to work online on the pro cess.
Technical specifications
Class of controlled system System identification Initiation Systems with and without inherent regulation, setting time > 2.5 ms In the open/closed control loop; 100 ms scan cycle Step change of manip. variable (open control loop, controller in manual mode) Setpoint change (closed loop control controller in automatic mode) Optimum absolute value Simulation Offline simulation of controlled system and of closed control loop Storage of process and controller parameters All PG 7xx, CP 581 and ATPC MSDOS as of 3.0 Printer with parallel interface and IBM character set/Proprinter emulation
Controller design
Ordering data
SIEPID S5 software package (MSDOS) on 31/2" diskettes, with authorization diskette and manual Single license German English French
Order No. SIEPID S5 software package (continued) Copy license German English French 6ES5 834-3MA11 6ES5 834-3MA21 6ES5 834-3MA31
Order No.
COM PP Application The COM PP parameter as signment software is used for creating the parameter blocks which are required for driving the CP 544 and the second in terface on the CPU 928B. The COM PP software is user friendly with interactive opera tor prompting.
COM PP Programming
Ordering data
COM PP parameter assignment software for paramerizing the CP 544 and the second interface on the CPU 928 B, on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes German/English/French Single license Copy license
7/26
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
PMC PRO Application The PMC/LSB (process moni toring and control system for COROS LSB, see page 7/91) standard software supports sophisticated operator control and monitoring of processes as well as display of operat ing states with the COROS LSB process monitoring and control system. In the PMC system concept not only pure monitoring and control of process values and states are integrated, but also signalling and monitoring functions. To adapt the software to the particular automation task, PMC PRO parameter assign ment software is required.
Software
COROS LSB
Principle of operation
The PMC PRO parameter as signment software supports the user at:
S
Configuring of the commu nication between the pro grammable controllers S5115U, S5135U and S5155U and the COROS LSB humanmachineinter face
Order No.
Configuring ot the signalling functions and of the status processing of the objects; here, objects can also be newly defined in PMC PRO
PMC PRO checks all inputs for their reliability and plausi bility and generates an executable program out of the input parameters.
Here, Standard function blocks are read into the work file. This program can now be transferred online to the CPU. A large scale of online test functions are available for startup.
Ordering data
PMC PRO parameter assignmentsoftware assigns parameters to the "PMC/ LSB standard software, S5DOS/MT, with manual, on 31/2" disketten, Single license German English Copy license German English
Order No. PMC PRO parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the "PMC/ LSB standard software, Windows, with manual, on 31/2" diskettes,
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/27
Software
Engineering Tools
COM 115H, COM 155H, COM 95F, COM 115F COM 115H and COM 155H parameter assignment software The COM 115H and COM 155H software packages as sign parameters to the fault tolerant S5115H and S5155H programmable con trollers. They support the user in con figuring and fault diagnostics: Configuring the Hrelated data S Generating the configuration block from the configuration data
S
System diagnostics via the error data block and inter rupt register S Documentation of the Hre lated data via printer S General system data han dling
S
The COM 95F and COM 115F software packages assign pa rameters to the failsafe S595F and S5115F program mable controllers.
They support the user at: Configuring the inputs and outputs S assigning parameter to the operating system of the CPU in dialog with the program ming device
S
The user need not take into account the redundancy of the PLC and the connection diagrams of the various input and output modules during program development.
Ordering data
COM 115H parameter assignment software for programming the S5115H programmable controller; on 31/2"and 51/4" diskettes; German, English, French, Spanish, Italian Single license Copy license COM 155H parameter assignment software for programming the S5115H programmable controller; on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes; German, English, French Single license Copy license German English French Spanish Italian
Order No. COM 115F parameter assignment software for programming the S5115F programmable controller; on 31/2"and 51/4" diskettes German, English, French, Italian 6ES5 895-3STJ1 6ES5 895-3STJ1-0KL1 Single license Copy license COM 95F parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the S595F programmable controller with manual, on 31/2"and 51/4" diskettes; German, English, French, Italian Single license Copy license German English French Italian
Order No.
7/28
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
COM PROFIBUS Application COM PROFIBUS allows the connection of S distributed I/O devices ET 200U, ET 200M, ET 200B, ET200C, ET 200L, ET 200X,
S S S S S S S
COM PROFIBUS
Software
the DP/AS interface link, DP/PA link, the S595U/DP slave, S7200/300 as the slave and other field devices IM 308C, S595U/DP master and other DP master mod ules.
Fig. 7/21 Parameter assignment with COM PROFIBUS
Compared to COM ET 200 Windows (up to 12/96), COM PROFIBUS has been ex tended to include FMS config uring of the 5412 (A2) PC module (see page 3/89).
S
IM 308C; The set configuration of PROFIBUS DP is stored on a memory card. Burning of the memory card can be imple mented directly with the pro gramming device or a PC (with EPROM/EEPROM PG). The data are downloaded via the CP 5411, CP 5511, CP 5611 PC modules or the MPI.
S595U/DP master: The set configuration of PROFIBUSDP is transferred to the programmable con troller by downloading via the DP interface. FMS configuring CP 5412 (A2) PC module
COM PROFIBUS runs on the PG 720, PG 740 or PG 760 and ATcompatible PCs, under Windows 3.11 or Windows 95.
Principle of operation
The COM PROFIBUS parame ter assignment software is in stalled on the programming device/PC. It enables simple, userprompted generation of the address list and parame ters for the slave devices. The following must be defined: S DP address S Address area in which the I/O modules are to be ad dressed S Start addresses of the I/O modules S Slavespecific parameter as signments, for example, measuring range of an ana log input channel The following must also be defined: S Setting of the transmission rate S Setting of the failure re sponse
Memory card Example: IM 308C interface S5115U S5135U S5155U S595U/DP master
With an online connection be tween the programming de vice/PC and PROFIBUS/DP, the COM PROFIBUS
parameter assignment soft ware can be used to locate faults in the startup phase or during operation.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/29
Software
Engineering Tools
COM PROFIBUS (continued) Ordering data
COM PROFIBUS parameter assignment software for programming the IM 308C and other DP master modules, runs on PG 720, 740 and 760 or ATcompatible PCs, with Windows 3.1 or Windows 95, on 3 1/2" diskettes with manual for the distributed ET 200 I/O system, single license copy license German English French Spanish Italian Order No. Manual for the distributed ET 200 I/O system German English French Spanish Italian Order No.
6ES5 998-3ES12 6ES5 998-3ES22 6ES5 998-3ES32 6ES5 998-3ES42 6ES5 998-3ES52
COM ET 100 Application The COM ET 100 parameter assignment software makes the assignment of addresses (address lists) for the ET 100 U electronic terminator possible.
Programming device
Principle of operation
The COM ET 100 parameter assignment software is loaded onto the programming device. The address list for an ET 100 connected to an IM 308A can then be created with the use of prompts. The following have to be specified for each ET 100U:
Address area in which the input and output modules are to be addressed (I/O area and extended area, up to 210 Kbyte of addresses) S Types of the individual modules (e.g. digital input module) S Slots of the individual modules
S
The completed address list is loaded into the memory sub module of the IM 308 on the programming device. The programmed memory submo dule is then plugged into the IM 308A.
Order No.
Ordering data
COM ET 100 parameter assignment software for assigning the addresses for the ET 100U electronic terminator; German/English/French/ Italian/Spanish COM ET 100 (continued) on 31/2" diskettes Single license Copy license on 51/4"diskettes Single license Copy license
7/30
Siemens ST 50 1998
Software
Engineering Tools
COM 521 BASIC Application The COM 521 BASIC makes programming for the CP 521 BASIC communica tions processor possible. It supports: The terminal emulation at the programming device S A program backup on EPROM or diskette S A loading and reloading of the CP
S Programming device
Programming
Ordering data
COM 521 BASIC parameter assignment software for support in programming the CP 521 BASIC communications processor, on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes, (continued on the right)
Order No.
COM 525, COM 530, COM 5431 FMS/DP, COM 1430 TF, COM 1473 MAP Application The COM 525, COM 530, COM 5431 FMS/DP, COM 1430 TF, COM 1430 TCP and COM 1473 MAP parame ter assignment software is needed for programming and parameter input for the rele vant communications proces sors with a programming de vice.
S S S
COM... Programming
S S S
COM 525 for CP 524, CP 525 COM 530 for CP 530 (L1) COM 5431 FMS/DP for CP 5431 FMS/DP (PROFI BUS) COM 1430 TF for CP 1430 TF (Industrial Ethernet) COM 1430 TCP for CP 1430 TCP (Industrial Ethernet) COM 1473 MAP for CP 1473 MAP (MAP 3.0-Ethernet)
Functions
The programs offer operator prompting and interactive screen forms to facilitate the programming of specific func tions of the communications
processors. The programs also include extensive testing, diagnostics and documenta tion functions.
7/32
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
COM 525, COM 530, COM 5431 FMS/DP, COM 1430 TF, COM 1473 MAP (continued) Ordering data
COM 525 parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the CP 524 and CP 525; German, English, French; on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes Single license Copy license COM 530 parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the CP 530; Ger., English, French, Italian; on 31/2" diskettes Single license Copy license on 51/4" diskettes Single license Copy license German English French Spanish Italian COM 5431 FMS/DP parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the CP 5431 FMS/DP, with manual CP 5431 FMS/DP; on 31/2" diskettes, German English French Italian 6GK1 745-1AD00-0EA0 6GK1 745-1AD01-0EA0 6GK1 745-1AD02-0EA0 6GK1 745-1AD04-0EA0 6ES5 835-6SCJ1 6ES5 835-6SCJ1-0KL1 6ES5 895-6SC J1 6ES5 895-6SC J1 1 2 3 4 5 6ES5 895-4SAJ1 6ES5 895-4SAJ1-0KL1 Order No. CP 5431 FMS/DP manual German English French Italian COM 1430 TF parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the CP 1430 TF, with CP 1430 TF ma nual, on 31/2" diskettes, German English French Italian CP 1430 TF/COM 1430 TF manual German English French Italian Parameter assignment software COM 1430 TCP Configuration software for CP 1430 TCP, on 31/2" diskettes Manual CP 1430 TCP/COM 1430 TCP German English COM 1473 MAP parameter assignment software assigns parameters to the com munications processor, CP 1473 MAP, with manual CP 1473 MAP, on 31/2" diskettes, German English CP 1430 TF manual German English Order No.
Software
6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA0 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA1 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA2 6GK1 970-1TA43-0AA4 2XV9 450-1AU01
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/33
Software
Engineering Tools
SIMATIC ProTool and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite Application/ Programming SIMATIC ProTool and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite are modern confi guration tools for configuring SIMATIC text displays, opera tor panels, touch panels and HMI part of the SIMATIC C7-620 complete systems. The following can be configu red: S TD 17 S OP3, OP5, OP7, OP25, OP17, OP25, OP27 (avail able soon), OP35 and OP37 S TP27 and TP37 S C7-621, C7-623, C7-624 and C7-626 Whereas the SIMATIC ProTool is for configuring all devices, SIMATIC ProTool/Lite is a lowcost version for configuring the line oriented devices TD17, OP3 to OP17 and C7-621 to C7-624 with re strictions. Functionally, SIMATIC ProTool/ Lite is a subset of SIMATIC ProTool. The configuration philosophy is the same for both tools. The software can be installed in German, English, French, Italian or Spanish. If the STEP 7 configuration software for configuring SIMATIC S7/C7/M7 it is also installed on the configuration computer, SIMATIC ProTool and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite can be installed in such a way that they are integrated. HMI proj ects are managed with the SIMATIC manager within STEP 5 projects. ProTool and ProTool/Lite can access sym bol lists and communication parameters of STEP 7 directly. This eliminates expensive and multiple input of this data.
OP3, OP5, OP7, OP15, OP17, OP25, OP27, OP35, OP 37, TP 27, TP 37 (alternatives)
TD17
Features of SIMATIC ProTool and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite S Integrated configuration software for all devices S Short learning time for the configuration software be cause of use of the standard operating system Windows and an integrated Online help system S Simple and fast operation of the configuration software using the standard operat ing mechanisms of Windows and WYSIWYG display of text and graphics S Simple reusability of parts of configuration with simulta neous opening of several configurations (multiple doc ument interface) and interproject copying through the clipboard by drag-and-drop or copy-and-paste S Clear, easy to understand configuration by object-ori ented symbolic data man agement and cross-refer ence lists with direct data access by mouse click S Access to symbol lists and communication parameters of the control configuration with integrated installation under SIMATIC STEP 7
With graphic oriented opera tor panels/touch panels also: Use of the usual working en vironment for graphics cre ation by integration of graphic editors via the OLE interface or import of pixel graphic objects S Pixel graphic printer output of process diagrams S Support of Asian logo graphic languages
S
Current versions SIMATIC ProTool V4.0 Simatic ProTool/Lite V4.0 SIMATIC ProTool V4.0 and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite V4.0 are 32-bit applications for Windows 95 and Windows NT 4.0. For users of Windows 3.1/3.11, SIMATIC ProTool V2.5 and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite V2.5 are still available (func tional scope partly restricted; see also Catalog ST80.1 1997)
7/34
Siemens ST 50 1998
Engineering Tools
SIMATIC ProTool and SIMATIC ProTool/Lite (continued) Ordering data
Configuring software SIMATIC ProTool/Lite V4.01) for configuring TD17, OP3, OP5, OP7, OP15, OP17, C7-621, C7-623, C7-624; executable un der Windows 95 and Windows NT, multilingual program forms (can be installed in German, En glish, French, Italian or Spanish), on CD-ROM with configuring in structions in German English French Italian Spanish SIMATIC ProTool/Lite V2.5 Order No. Configuring software SIMATIC ProTool V4.01) for configuring TD17,OP3, OP5, OP7, OP15, OP17, OP25, OP27, OP35, OP37, TP27, TP37, C7-621, C7-623, C7-624, C7-626; executable under Win dows 95 and Windows NT, multi lingual program forms (can be in stalled in German, English, French, Italian or Spanish); on CD-ROM with configuring instructions in German English French Italian Spanish SIMATIC ProTool V2.5 Order No.
Software
6AV9 620-1BB07-1AA0 6AV9 620-1BB07-1AB0 6AV9 620-1BB07-1AC0 6AV9 620-1BB07-1AD0 6AV9 620-1BB07-1AE0 see Catalog ST 80.1 1997
6AV9 620-1AA07-1AA0 6AV9 620-1AA07-1AB0 6AV9 620-1AA07-1AC0 6AV9 620-1AA07-1AD0 6AV9 620-1AA07-1AE0 see Catalog ST 80.1 1997
1) The hardware required depends on the operating system platform (Windows 95 or Windows NT)
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/35
Software
Runtime Software
Introduction standard function blocks Application Standard function blocks are readymade software modules which can be linked into pro grams written by the user for the programmable controllers of the U range. They consist of selfcontained complex functional procedures which are often required by the user when programming. For instance, standard func tion blocks for mathematical and arithmetic functions, se quence control and closed loop control are available. The blocks are stored in the user memory of the programmable controller and can be called up by the user as required in his program. They can be called many times during pro gram execution and supplied with the required actual pa rameters. Complex functions can be in cluded very simply by the user in his programs through the use of standard function blocks. This makes program ming, testing and debugging of user programs very effi cient. The user can tap a vast amount of experience by us ing standard function blocks. The blocks are continuously updated and maintained.
SB PB FB, FX SB
PB
DB, DX
FB, FX
PB
PB FB, FX
OB PB FB, FX SB DB, DX Organization block Program block Function block Sequence block Data block
The user writes his programs for the S5 programmable con trollers of the U range in the STEP 5 programming lan guage. The programs are structured, i.e. broken down into selfcontained sections. The individual program sec tions are called "blocks".
The following types of blocks are used for different pur poses: Organization blocks (OB), for supervising the user program S Program blocks (PB), for structuring the program according to the technologi cal control task S Function blocks (FB, FX), for recurring complex functions
S
Sequence blocks (SB), for individual technological sequence controls S Data blocks (DB, DX), these are memory areas in which data for the user program can be stored
S
The blocks can be nested as required (Fig. 7/28), i.e. blocks from one level can call blocks in a lower level.
7/36
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Introduction standard function blocks (continued) Design (continued) Notes on programming with standard function blocks
Software
: JU : ADD : : : : : : : : : : BE
JU FB1 JU FB 1
ADD: 32 Block name Z12 Z11 . . to . . Z32 Z31 IW1 IW3 . . to . . QW1 QW3
FB1 IW1 IW3 IW5 IW7 Z12 Z11 Z22 Z21 ADD : 32 OV Z3=0 Z32 Z31 Q 0.0 Q 0.1 QW1 QW3
Fig. 7/29 Representation of standard function blocks by the programming device above: in statement list form (STL) below: in control system flowchart (CSF) form
A standard function block is designed in such a way that the programming device prompts the user when linking the block into his program. The internal programming of the function block is not im portant for this. The function block is called with a call statement (see Fig. 7/29). It is then displayed with its block name and its formal operands (block pa rameters). Formal operands are mnemonics which repre sent the type of function of in puts and outputs as well as the data required by the func tion block. Documentation A software handbook contain ing a comprehensive descrip tion of the function blocks is provided with each of the pro gram packages (on dis kettes).
An actual operand must be entered alongside each for mal operand when the corres ponding block is called up. The actual operand is chosen by the user according to the requirements of the control task at that particular point.
"A" type parameters (outputs or results) are shown on the right of the function symbol. Basic and supplementary op erations in function blocks can only be shown in the statement list. Parameters with "E, D, B, T or Z" types of parameters (inputs or preset data) are shown in the graphic design on the left of the function symbol.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/37
Software
Overview
Runtime Software
Program packages Installable in S5- 90U 95U 100U CPU 103 115U CPU 941 to 944
J J J J J J J J J J J J J J J
Basic functions Floatingpoint arithmetic Mathematical functions GRAPH 5 / II Closedloop control S5100U/115U closedloop control R64 controller structure Compact fuzzy control Modular PID and fuzzy control Standard software PMC PMC/LSB Message functions Message functions for standard CP Compact message func tions Signalling functions Data handling blocks Intelligent I/O modules CP 516 memory submodule Failsafe standard function blocks
J
J J
J J
J J J J J J J J J J J J J
J J
7/91
J J J J
J J
J J J J J
J J J J J
J J J J
J J J J
J J
Inter nal
J J J
Inter nal
J J
7/38
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions ADD:32 32bit binary adder The ADD:32 function block adds two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number (31 bit + sign). Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB Block length in words 108 108 108 108 108 108 100 100 100 69 69 Call length in words 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 Processing time in ms 1.8 2.1 2.8 2.8 2.6 <0.2 1.6 0.8 0.3 0.03 0.13
Software
FB 1 for 95U FB 1 for 100U FB 1 for 115U FB 1 for 135U FB 3 for 155U
The function block sets the following condition codes if appropriate: Overflow (result is cancelled), result is 0.
Number range: -2 147 483 648 to +2 147 483 647 (-231 to +231 -1).
FB 2 for 95U FB 2 for 100U FB 2 for 115U FB 2 for 135U FB 7 for 155U
The SUB:32 function block subtracts two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number (31 bit + sign). Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB
The function block sets the following condition codes, if appropriate: Overflow (result is cancelled), result is 0.
Number range: -2 147 483 648 to + 2 147 483 647 (-231 to +231 -1).
Block length in words 108 108 108 108 108 108 100 100 100 69 69
Processing time in ms 1.8 2.1 2.5 2.5 2.3 <0.2 1.6 0.74 0.4 0.03 0.13
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/39
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) MUL:32 32bit binary multiplier The MUL:32 function block multiplies two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number (63 bit + sign). Technical specifications FB 3 for 115U FB 3 for 135U FB 11 for 155U
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB Block length in words 399 399 Call length in words 11 11 Processing time in ms 8.3 to 31.4 3.2 to 5.4 4.0 to 8.2 4.0 to 8.2 3.5 to 5.6 0.01 to 0.035 11.6 4.32 0.5 0.11 0.7
The function block sets the following condition code, if appropriate: Result is 0.
Number range: Multiplicand -231 to +231 -1 Multiplier -231 to +231 -1 Product -263 to +263 -1.
Fig. 7/30 32BitDualmultiplizierer 399 11 399 11 399 11 209 11 302 302 302 197 197 11 11 11 11 11
FB 4 for 95U FB 4 for 100U FB 4 for 115U FB 4 for 135U FB 15 for 155U
The DIV:32 function block divides two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number (31 bit + sign).
The function block sets the following condition codes, if appropriatie: Overflow (result is candelled), quotient equals zero, remainder equals zero, error: division by zero.
Number range: -2 147 483 648 to + 2 147 483 647 (-231 to +231 -1).
Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 9451) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB Block length in words 395 395 395 395 395 395 203 242 242 242 203 203 Call length in words 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 Processing time in ms 2.1 to 25.8 2.4 to 4.2 5.9 to 6.8 5.9 to 6.8 4.2 to 4.7 1.7 to 2.2 0.015 to 0.12 1.2 to 37 0.9 to 13.3 1.2 0.2 0.2 to 2
7/40
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) RAD:16 16bit binary root extractor The RAD:16 function block extracts the sqare root of a fixedpoint binary number (15 bit + sign). The result is two fixedpoint binary num bers (8bit root, 16bit remainder). Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 9451) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB Block length in words 126 126 126 126 126 126 126 126 126 126 128 128 Call length in words 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 Processing time in ms 5.3 1.3 1.6 1.6 1.4 0.3 0.045 0.6 to 9.7 0.42 to 6.5 0.4 0.12 0.7
Software
The function block sets the following condition code, if appopriate: Radicand negative.
FB 5 for 95U FB 5 for 100U FB 5 for 115U FB 5 for 135U FB 18 for 155U
Number range: Radicand -32 768 to +32 767 Root 0 to +181 Remainder 0 to +361.
The RAD: GP function block extracts the square root of a floatingpoint number (expo nent: 7 bit + sign; mantissa: 23 bit + sign). The result is also a floatingpoint number (exponent: 7 bit + sign; man tisse: 23 bit + sign). The least significant bit of the mantissa is not rounded. Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
The function block sets the following condition code, if appropriate: Radicand negative.
Number range: Radicand "0.1469368 exp. -39 to "0.1701412 exp. +39 Root + 0.3833234 exp. -19 to + 0.1304382 exp. +20.
Processing time in ms 0.04 3.8 to 10.8 2.2 to 7.1 0.4 0.09 0.3 to 0.4
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/41
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) REG:SCHB Shift register (bit) The REG:SCHB (bit) function block implements a rightleft shift register of variable length. The shift register is lo cated in the bit memory area; the first and last bit memory byte must be specified. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9414) CPU 9424) CPU 9434) CPU 9444) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) With 8 bit 2) With 128 bit Block length in words 250 250 250 250 250 250 250 250 250 250 252 252 Call length in words 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 Processing time in ms 5.31) to 77.42) 2.31) to 28.82) 6.71) to 33.42) 6.71) to 33.42) 6.41) to 31.82) 0.51) to 2.52) 0.0451) to 0.282) 1.53) 1.93) 0.7 0.04 to 1.49 0.2 to 12
The shift register has inputs for right and left shifting and corresponding outputs for the carry.
FB 10 for 95U FB 10 for 100U FB 10 for 115U FB 10 for 135U FB 24 for 155U
The REG:SCHB function block requires a data block which must be called before REG:SCHB itself. Max. register length: 32 bit
FB 11 for 95U FB 11 for 100U FB 11 for 115U FB 11 for 135U FB 25 for 155U
The REG:SCHW (word) func tion block implements a right left shift register of variable length. The shift register is located in the data area; this data area and the number of data words needed must be specified. The shift register has inputs for right and left shifting and corresponding outputs for the carry.
Several "shift register" func tion blocks can be chained if bit memory words, input words, output words or peri pheral words are used for the inputs and outputs "ZER", "TEL", ZAR", and "ZAL". The "ZER" and "ZEL" inputs of the following function block must then be connected to the "ZAR" and "ZAL" outputs of the preceding block.
Conditions The data words DW0 and DW1 of the data block se lected are not available to the user; this means that, with a single data block, the maxi mum possible length of the shift register is 254 words. For K > 254 or K = 0, the function block is not pro cessed. The shift register can be ex tended by one data block with each subsequent call of the REG:SCHW function block. Continued on the next page.
7/42
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) REG:SCHW (continued) Shift register (word) Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9416) CPU 9426) CPU 9436) CPU 9446) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) With 64 SR words (1 word = 2 byte) 2) With 64 SL words Block length in words 125 Call length in words 10 Processing time in ms 20.11) to 31.42) 81.04) to 122.85) 27.01) to 37.02) 96.04) to 144.05) 31.01) to 44.02) 117.04) to 170.05) 31.01) to 44.02) 117.04) to 170.05) 30.01) to 43.02) 113.04) to 166.02) 1.51) to 2.32) 5.24) to 8.75) 0.0451) to 0.182) 0.5254) to 0.6755) 1.0 to 1003) 0.8 to 673) 0.4 0.361) to 0.432) 1.374) to 1.645) 0.4 5) With 254 SL words 6) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
Software
125
10
10 10 10 10 10
10 10 10 10
10
REG:FIFO Buffer
The REG:FIFO function block contains a FIFO (first in/first out) register of variable depth.
The FIFO is located in a data area; this data area and the length of the buffer must be specified. 16bit words can be read in and read out.
The function block has out puts for "Buffer full" and "Buffer empty".
FB 12 for 95U FB 12 for 100U FB 12 for 115U FB 12 for 135U FB 26 for 155U
95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9414) CPU 9424) CPU 9434) CPU 9444) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
Technical specifications
For S5 Block length in words 160 160 160 160 160 160 148 160 160 160 162 162 Call length in words 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 Processing time in ms 1.4 1.6 2.3 2.3 2.2 0.3 0.015 1.2 0.6 0.1 0.035 0.2
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/43
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) REG:LIFO Stack The REG:LIFO function block stores the information in a stack (LIFO = last in/first out). The depth of the stack is variable. The stack is located in a data area; this data area and the depth of the stack must be specified. 16bit words can be stored. The function block has out puts for "Stack full" and "Stack empty".
FB 13 for 95U FB 13 for 100U FB 13 for 115U FB 13 for 135U FB 27 for 155U Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
Block length in words 117 117 117 117 117 117 110 117 117 117 119 119
Processing time in ms 1.4 1.4 max. 2.4 max. 2.4 max. 2.3 max. 0.3 max 0.012 0.9 0.52 0.1 0.03 0.2
The function block "Code con verter BCD into binary" con verts a BCD number consis
ting of 8 decades plus sign into a fixedpoint binary num ber (31 + 1 bit).
FB 21 for 115U
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 183 183 183 183 Call length in words 7 7 7 7 Processing time in ms 3.3 3.3 2.5 0.9
The function block "Code con verter binary into BCD" con verts a fixedpoint binary number (31 + 1 bit) into a BCD Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
FB 23 for 115U
Block length in words 302 320 302 302 Call length in words 8 8 8 8 Processing time in ms 3.5 3.5 2.5 1.2
7/44
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) AE:464 Read in analog value from 6ES5 464 modules The function block "AE:464" is used to read in analog values from the 6ES5 4648M... ana log input modules. The function block takes into consideration the characteris tics of the various analog in put modules and produces at its output a standardized value between specified lower and upper limits for a given Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 1032) 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 395 395 418 418 418 418 384 384 384 386 386 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 9 9 11 11 11 11 11 Processing time in ms 5.8 3.5 4.5 4.5 3.9 2.7 3.6 1.9 0.6 0.095 0.4
Software
FB 30 for 95U FB 30 for 100U FB 30 for CPU 941 to 944 FB 13 for 135U FB 27 for 155U
nominal input signal. The user sets the limits. The function block for the S595U, S5100U and S5115U (CPU 941 to 944) produces the standardized value as a 16bit fixedpoint number, for the S5115U (CPU 945), S5135U and S5155U as a 32bit floating point number.
Modules to be used: 6ES5 4648MA11 6ES5 4648MA21 6ES5 4648MB11 6ES5 4648MC11 6ES5 4648MD11 6ES5 4648ME11 6ES5 4648MF11 6ES5 4648MF21.
The function block "AE:460" is used to read in analog values from the 6ES5 4604UA/7LA.. or 6ES5 4654UA/7LA.. analog input modules. The function block takes into consideration the characteris tics of the various analog in put modules and produces at its output a standardized value between specified lower and upper limits for a given Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
FB 30 for CPU 941 to 944 FB 250*) for CPU 945 FB 31 for 135U/155U
*) is integrated in the operating system of the CPU 945
nominal input signal. The user sets the limits. The function block for the S5115U (CPU 941 to 944) produces the standardized value as a 16bit fixedpoint number, for the S5115U (CPU 945), S5135U and S5155U as a 32bit floating point number.
Both cyclic and selective sampling are possible. Modules to be used: 6ES5 4604UA1. 6ES5 4604LA1. 6ES5 4654UA1. 6ES5 4657LA1.
Block length in words 315 315 315 315 300 300 300 305 305
Processing time in ms 4.9 4.9 4.6 2.8 3.5 1.6 0.6 0.095 0.4
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/45
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) AE:463 Read in analog value from 6ES5 4634U modules The function block "AE:463" is used to read in analog values from the 6ES5 4634UAVV or 6ES5 4634UBVV analog input modules. The function block takes into consideration the characteris tics of the various analog in put modules and produces at its output a standardized value between specified lower and upper limits for a given Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 235 235 235 235 219 219 219 221 221 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 11 11 11 11 11 Processing time in ms 4.2 4.2 4.0 2.7 3.0 1.6 0.6 0.08 0.5
FB 32 for CPU 941 to 944 FB 241*) for CPU 945 FB 32 for 135U/155U
*) is integrated in the operating system of the CPU 945
nominal input signal. The user sets the limits. The function block for the S5115U (CPU 941 to 944) produces the standardized value as a 16bit fixedpoint number, for the S5115U (CPU 945), S5135U and S5155U as a 32bit floating point number.
The function block "AE:466" is used to read in analog values from the 6ES5 4663LA1 V analog input modules. The function block takes into consideration the characteris tics of the various analog in put modules and produces at its output a standardized value between specified lower and upper limits for a given Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
FB 33 for CPU 941 to 944 FB 243*) for CPU 945 FB 33 for 135U/155U
*) is integrated in the operating system of the CPU 945
nominal input signal. The user sets the limits. The function block for the S5115U (CPU 941 to 944) produces the standardized value as a 16bit fixedpoint number, for the S5115U (CPU 945), S5135U and S5155U as a 32bit floating point number.
Block length in word 283 283 283 283 252 252 252 254 254
Processing time in ms 10.6 10.6 8.4 4.8 3.3 1.6 0.5 0.09 0.7
7/46
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) RLG:AA Output analog value The function block "Output analog value" is used to out put analog signals to the pro cess via analog output modules. The function block must be assigned values be tween a lower and an upper limit. Technical specifications FB 41 for 135U/155U
*) is integrated in the operating system For S5 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 101 101 101 105 105 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 9 12 12 12 12 12 Processing time in ms max. 6 max. 6 max. 6 max. 6 max. 6 2.9 2.4 0.2 0.053 0.27
Software
Modules to be used: 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES54707LC12.
When a cyclic user program is interrupted by a timecon trolled or process interrupt driven program, there is dan ger of the data stored in the "scratched bit memory area" (FW 200 to FW 254) being overwritten by the Technical specifications
interruptdriven program. The "RETTEN" function block is called at the beginning of the interrupt service routine to save the scratch bit memories in a data block.
The "LADEN" function block is called at the end of the inter rupt service routine to reload FW 200 to FW 254 with the scratch bit memories for the cyclic program.
For S5
115U with CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
93 105 105
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/47
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) SST:UHR Clock The "SST:UHR" function block sets and reads the system clock. The block is not pro grammable. Technical specifications
For S5 155U with CPU 946/947 Block length in words 53 Call length in words 2 Processing time in ms 0.1 to 0.4
It reserves the data words DW 0 to DW 11 in DB 55; the user must initialize these data words.
The function blocks copy a defined number of data words (0 to 255) between a source DB/DX and a destination DB/DX. With the CPU 941 to CPU 944 only the normal data area (DB) is permitted. Technical specifications
For S5 Block length in words FB44 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 216 216 216 216 247 168 168 168 233 233 FB 45 273 273 273 273 318 217 217 217 303 303
The FB 44 and FB 45 function blocks have the same func tion. They differ only in their type of parameter assign ment.
The parameters of the FB 44 are specified when they are called (direct parameter assignment) while the FB 45 receives its block parameters by the transfer of a pointer on a parameter field (indirect pa rameter assignment).
Processing time in ms FB 44 2.4 to 24.3 2.4 to 24.3 2.0 to 22.2 1.0 to 1.2 0.025 to 0.115 2.3 to 2.8 1.4 to 1.6 0.3 to 0.6 0.04 to 0.315 0.3 to 0.7 FB 45 2.6 to 24.7 2.6 to 24.7 2.4 to 22.5 0.9 to 1.5 0.035 to 0.125 3.0 to 3.3 1.7 to 2.0 0.4 to 0.7 0.09 to 0.34 0.3 to 0.8
7/48
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) PER:ET Read and write extended I/Os The function block "Read and write extended I/Os" transfers (depending on the type of pa rameter assignment) an I/O area via one of the interface modules specified to a CPU internal area or vice versa. Input bytes can thus be read from the extended I/Os and output bytes written to the extended I/Os. FB 196: Direct parameter assignment FB 197: Indirect parameter assign ment
S5115U S5135U with CPU 922 928.UA.. 128-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 10-2042 10-2042 0-235 -
Software
The following table contains all source and destination areas which can be addressed.
Areas
CPU 928 .UB.. 128-255 0-255 0-255 0-255 10-2042 10-2042 0-235 0-1023
S5155U
I/O area
P (byte no.) Q (byte no.) IM3 (byte no.) IM4 (byte no.) DB (DW no.) DX (DW no.) Bit memories (byte no.) SBit memories (byte no.)
Internal area
The "PER:ET" function block is used with one of the follow ing interface modules: IM 3003, IM 3005 (5CA11), IM 3005 (5LB11), IM 3013, IM 3015, IM 304, IM 305, IM 306, IM 307 and IM 308 Technical specifications
For S5 Block length in words FB 196 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 213 213 213 213 214 267 267 267 301 301 FB 197 272 272 272 272 282 322 322 322 369 369
Note: The I/O modules addressed with one block call must be addressed continuously. After each gap in the addresses, the PER:ET function block must be called again.
Processing time2) in ms FB 196 2.3 to 10.9 2.3 to 10.9 2.1 to 10.7 0.4 to 0.6 0.025 to 0.115 3.2 to 4.7 1.4 to 2.6 0.9 to 2.1 0.07 to 1.2 1.1 to 1.3 FB 197 2.1 to 10.7 2.1 to 10.7 1.9 to 10.5 0.7 to 0.9 0.035 to 0.125 3.9 to 5.4 1.8 to 3.0 1.0 to 2.2 0.09 to 1.4 1.3 to 1.5
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/49
Software
Runtime Software
Basic functions (continued) Summary Program package "Basic functions
Function block For S5 programmable controllers 95U ADD : 32 SUB : 32 MUL : 32 DIV : 32 RAD : 16 RAD : GP REG : SCHB REG : SCHW REG : FIFO REG : LIFO COD : B8 COD : 32 AE : 464 AE : 460 AE : 463 AE : 466 RLG : AA SON : WS SST : UHR Retten Laden DBCOPY PER : ET
1)
115U with CPU 941944 FB 3 FB 4 FB 5 FB 6 FB 10 FB 11 FB 12 FB 13 FB 2421) FB 2501) FB 2411) FB 2431) FB 2511) FB 38 FB 39 FB 44/45 FB 196/197
FB 1 FB 2 FB 3 FB 4 FB 5 FB 10 FB 11 FB 12 FB 13 FB 30 FB 2511)
These function blocks are integrated in the operating system of the CPU. Order No.
Ordering data
Program package Basic functions for S595U, S5100U with CPU 103, S5115U with CPU 9419442), CPU 945, S5135U /155U with CPU 922, 928, 928 B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, with manual in German, English, French, for MSDOS, S5DOS/MT operating system, on 31/2" diskettes ( 720 Kbyte) and on 51/4" diskettes ( 360 Kbyte) Single license Copy license
2)
7/50
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Floating-point arithmetic Application The standard function blocks for floatingpoint arithmetice nable the S5115U, S5100U (with CPU 103) and S595U to execute arithmetic operations with The following standard func tion blocks are available for floatingpoint arithmetic: FB 15: Fixedpoint to floatingpoint conversion S FB16: Floatingpoint to fixedpoint conversion S FB 17: Add two floating point numbers S FB 18: Subtract two floating point numbers
S S
Software
32bit floatingpoint num bers (exponent: 7 bit + sign bit, mantissa: 23 bit + sign bit)
Functions
FB 19: Multiply two floating point numbers S FB 20: Divide two floating point numbers S FB 21: Compare two floatingpoint numbers
S
Number range for fixedpoint numbers: 2 147 483 648 to + 2 147 483 647 (231 to +231 1). Number range for floating point numbers: 1 469 368 exp.38 to 1 701 412 exp. + 39.
These function blocks set the following bit memories for futher processing: S Overflow S Result is 0 S Error
Technical specifications
Block number Block name Block length in words 72 95 266 267 176 223 112 Processing time in ms with S595U 0.41 - 4.67 0.54 - 5.63 1.29 - 2.62 1.14 - 1.38 3.63 - 3.97 0.56 - 9.3 0.67 - 1.01 S5100U CPU 103 0.9 - 1.3 1.1 - 1.8 1.4 - 1.9 1.77 - 2.3 2.7 - 4.3 1.8 - 4.0 1.0 - 1.5 S5115U CPU 941 0.85 - 2 1.6 - 2.3 2.1 - 2.5 2.1 - 2.5 2.5 - 4.8 1.6 - 4.2 1.5 - 1.8 Nesting depth CPU 942 0.85 - 2 1.6 - 2.3 2.1 - 2.5 2.1 - 2.5 2.5 - 4.8 1.6 - 4.2 1.5 - 1.8 CPU 943 0.78 - 1.4 1.2 - 1.9 1.6 2.25 1.8 - 2.3 2.2 - 4.6 1.1 - 3.5 1.0 - 1.4 CPU 944 0.04 - 0.23 0.14 - 0.5 0.13 - 0.56 0.13 - 0.56 1.3 - 4.4 0.5 - 2 0.1 - 0.15 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 FB 242, MUL: 16 FW 200 to FW 203 FW 200 to FW 203 FW 200 to FW 212 FW 200 to FW 212 FW 200 to FW 220 FW 200 to FW 214 FW 200 to FW 207 Blocks called Bit memories reserved
FB 15 FB 16 FB 17 FB 18 FB 19 FB 20 FB 21
Ordering data
Program package Floating-point arithmetic for S595U, S5100U with CPU 103, S5115U with CPU 941944 with manual in German, English, French, for MSDOS, S5DOS/MT operating system, on 3 1/2" diskettes ( 720 Kbyte) and on 5 1/4" diskettes ( 360 Kbyte) Single license Copy license
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/51
Software
Runtime Software
Mathematical functions Application The following standard func tion blocks are avaiIable for executing oftenused mathe matical functions: S Trigonometric functions; sine, cosine, tangent, cotangent Standard function blocks for mathematical functions are handled in the same way as equivalent STEP 5 statements. When the block is called,
S
Arc functions; arc sine, arc cosine, arc tangent, arc cotangent S Logarithmic functions; natural logarithm, common logarithm, logarithm to any base
S S
Exponential functions; exponent to base e, exponent to base 10, exponent to any base. The function blocks are available for S5135U and S5155U.
S
Principle of operation
the contents of accumulator 1 are changed in accor dance with the function exe cuted (without altering the contents of the other accu mulators or the base address register BR), or
the contents of accumula tors 1 and 2 are combined in accordance with the function executed, with the contents of accumulator 3 being pushed into accumulator 2 and the contents of accumu lator 4 into accumulator 3 (like a STEP 5 arithmetical function). The contents of the BR register remain un changed.
All standard function blocks for mathematical functions process 32bit floatingpoint numbers.
The "SINUS" function block calculates the sine of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The value must lie within the range 0 (KG = + 0000000 + 00) to 2p (KG = + 6283185 + 01).
The "COSINUS" function block calculates the cosine of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The value must lie within the range 9 (KG = + 0000000 + 00) to 2p (KG = + 6283185 + 01).
The "TANGENS" function block calculates the tangent of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number. The value must lie within the range 0 (KG = + 0000000 + 00) to 2p (KG = + 6283185 + 01).
If the input value is p/2 (KG = + 1570796 + 01) or 3p/2 (KG + 4712389 + 01), the result is infinite and the function block reports an error.
The "COTANG" function block calculates the cotangent of a 24/32bit floatingpoint num ber. The value must lie within the range (KG = + 2938734 - 34 to KG = + 6283184 + 01).
If the input value is 0p (KG = 3141593 + 01) or 2p (KG = 6283185 + 01), the result is infinite and the function block reports an error.
The "ARCSIN" function block calculates the arcsine of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The value must lie within the range - 1 (KG = - 1000000 + 01) to + 1 (KG = + 1000000 + 01).
7/52
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Mathematical functions (continued) ARCCOS arccos (x) FB 106 for 115U/135U/155U ARCTAN arctan (x) FB 107 for 115U/135U/155U The "ARCCOS" function block calculates the arccos of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number. The value must lie within the range - 1 (KG = - 1000000 + 01) to + 1 (KG = + 1000000 + 01).
Software
The "ARCTAN" function block calculates the arctan of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
With a value of less than KG = - 5773456 + 07 the re sult output is - p/2, with a value greater than KG = + 1209486 + 07 the result is + p/2. With a value of less than KG = - 5773456 + 07 the result output is , with a value greater than KG = + 1209486 + 07 the result is 0.
ARCOT arcot (x) FB 108 for 115U/135U/155U LN X ln (x) FB 109 for 115U/135U/155U LG X lg (x) FB 110 for 115U/135U/155U B LOG X logb (x) FB 111 for 115U/135U/155U E^X ex FB 112 for 115U/135U/155U ZEHN^X 10x FB 113 for 115U/135U/155U
The "ARCCOT" function block calculates the arccot of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The "LN X" function block cal culates the natural log of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
With a value of less than or equal to 0, accumulator 1 remains unchanged and the function block reports an error.
The "LG X" function block calculates the common log of a 24/32bit floatingpoint num ber.
With a value of less than or equal to 0, accumulator 1 re mains unchanged and the function block reports an error.
The "B LOG X" function block calculates the log to any base. Base b is expected in accumulator 1, the value x in
accumulator 2, both as 24/32bit floatingpoint num bers. Both values must be greater than 0, and the base cannot have the value 1.
The "E^X function block cal culates the exponential value to the base e of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The value must lie within the range KG = - 8802962 + 02 to KG = + 8802966 + 02, otherwise an overflow condi tion is produced.
The "ZEHN^X" function block calculates the exponential value to the base 10 of a 24/32bit floatingpoint number.
The value must lie within the range KG = - 3823079 + 02 to KG - 3823079 + 02, otherwise an overflow condition is produced. the exponent a1 in accumula tor 1, both as 24/32bit float ingpoint numbers. The base value must be positive. The result is represented in accu mulator 1 as a 24/32bit float ingpoint number. If the result produces an over flow, the contents of accumu lators 1 and 2 remain un changed and the function block reports an error.
The "A2^A1" function block calculates the exponential value to any base. Base a2 is expected in accumulator 2,
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/53
Software
Runtime Software
Mathematical functions (continued) Technical specifications
Block number b 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 Block name SINUS COSINUS TANGENS COTANG ARCSIN ARCCOS ARCTAN ARCCOT LN X LG X B LOG X E^X ZEHN^X A2^A1 Block length in words CPU 922, 928 242 238 318 321 218 253 268 269 222 222 274 253 260 418 CPU 945 192 188 268 271 184 219 241 246 187 191 227 217 224 364 CPU 946/ 947, 948 211 207 287 290 203 238 260 265 206 210 254 236 243 391 Processing time in ms with CPU 922 3.8 3.8 4.0 4.0 3.5 3.7 4.2 4.3 4.3 4.3 7.6 4.5 4.6 7.4 CPU 928 2.4 2.4 2.5 2.5 2.2 2.3 2.6 2.7 2.9 2.9 5.1 3.0 3.1 4.9 CPU 928B 1.3 1.4 1.4 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.4 1.4 1.5 1.5 1.9 1.5 1.5 1.9 CPU 945 0.039 0.038 0.043 0.041 0.035 0.040 0.044 0.046 0.042 0.044 0.079 0.046 0.048 0.077 CPU 946/947 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.35 0.35 0.45 0.45 0.5 0.5 0.95 0.5 0.5 0.5 CPU 948 0.15 0.14 0.16 0.15 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.17 0.17 0.17 0.31 0.18 0.19 0.31
Ordering data
Program package Mathematical functions for S5115U with CPU 945, S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, with manual in German, English, French, for MSDOS, S5DOS/MT operating systems, on 3 1/2" diskettes (720 Kbyte) and on 5 1/4" diskettes (360 Kbyte) Single license Copy license
Order No.
7/54
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II Application GRAPH 5/II is an easytouse software system for planning and design, programming, documenting and testing se quencers. It consists of the GRAPH 5/II system program for the programming device and the GRAPH 5/II package of standard function blocks (see page 7/10). Compared with the GRAPH 5 package, the GRAPH 5/II package offers additional diagnostic functions, synchro nization and optimized pro cessing times. The sequence blocks gener ated with an older version of GRAPH 5 can be matched to the new function blocks with the GRAPH 5/II option package.
Auxiliary functions PB x FB 74 Main sequencer FB 70 or FB 72 or FB 73
Software
Transition + action
DB x
ST57-2048
DB y
: User block : Standard function block : DBs are generated by the GRAPH5 system program : Data traffic : Block calls Fig. 7/31 Calling structure
Processing times
Structure linear sequencer For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941 CPU 942 CPU 943 CPU 944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 FB 70 23 13 11 10.1 1.2 0.49 16.0 1.0 0.59 1.65 FB 73 5.9 13 7 6 4 1.0 0.43 10.4 0.7 0.5 1.2 FB 73/74 8.5 19 10 9 5.5 1.15 0.47 13.9 0.85 0.57 1.5 2 simultaneous sequencers FB 72/74 14 29 15 13 11.8 1.45 0.51 21.6 1.3 0.74 2.2 4 simultaneous sequencers FB 72/74 22.5 47 22 19 19.6 2.1 0.59 32.6 1.85 1.0 3.1 8 simultaneous sequencers FB 72/74 41 71 36 33 35.1 3.3 0.74 54.6 3.2 1.52 5.1
1) Processing times for sequencers with 25 steps, 3 assignments per step, 3 scans per transition, switching per cycle (in ms).
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/55
Software
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) GPH:HKET Main sequencer The "GPH:HKET" function block controls the main se quencer of a sequence con trol system. It controls the conveniently programmable operating modes (e.g. man Technical specifications
For S5 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944, CPU 945 135U /155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 Block length in words 1100 1100 1097 1085 1085 1085 1095 1095 Call length in words 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 Depending on the volume of the sequence control system, see table on page 7/55 Processing time
ual, automatic) and calls the secondary sequencers. A maximum of 255 sequenc ers can be called; a single se quencer can contain 127 steps.
A maximum of eight columns (simultaneous or alternative branches) can be pro grammed for each sequencer; one initial step can be se lected for each column.
The "GPH:UKET" function block controls the secondary sequencer of a sequence control system. Secondary sequencers are called in the main sequencer steps. Technical specifications
STEP 5 blocks for S5 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
The operating modes of the main sequencer are for warded automatically to the secondary sequencer. All other functions are the same as in FB 70.
Block length in words 1104 1104 1101 1089 1089 1089 1099 1099
Processing time
Depending on the volume of the sequence control system, see table on page 7/55
7/56
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) GPH:SIM1 Highspeed simultaneous sequencer FB 72 for 95U to 155U The "GPH:SIM1" function block enables somewhat less convenient but highspeed processing of alternative and simultaneous sequencers. Number of sequencers and steps as for FB 70. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 Block length in words 731 731 731 731 731 731 731 731 731 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 Depending on the volume of the se quence control system, see table on page 7/55 Processing time
Software
The "GPH:LIN1" function block enables somewhat less convenient but highspeed processing of linear sequenc ers. Number of sequencers and steps as for FB 70. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 Block length in words 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 Depending on the volume of the sequence control system, see table on page 7/55 Processing time
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/57
Software
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) GPH:ZFK1 Auxiliary functions The "GPH:ZFK1" function block implements auxiliary functions for FB 72 and FB 73, e.g. step selection and syn chronization. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 Block length in words 370 370 370 370 369 369 369 369 369 Call length in words 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 Depending on the volume of the sequence control system, see table on page 7/55 Processing time
The "PG COPY" function block provides the program ming device with a diagnostic message from the diagnostic buffer for display purposes.
OB 1/ PB a
DBx FB 69 FB<G5:DIA G> Operator control and monitoring section Restart section FB 67 FB<PG:COPY> DBy+1 DB<DIAG> Data puffer
FB 68 FB<COPY>
7/58
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) COPY Write diagnostic messages The "COPY" function block enters the diagnostic mes sages in the diagnostic buffer.
Software
FB 68 for 100U to 155U G5 DIAG Diagnostics The "DIAG" function block organizes and monitors the GRAPH 5/II diagnostics. It calls function blocks FB 67 and FB 68. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 118 120 103 103 103 112 112 107 109 92 92 92 101 101 1800 1667 1520 1520 1520 1530 1530 Block length in words FB 67 118 FB 68 107 FB 69 1800
Diagnostic functions
The diagnostic functions mon itor all GRAPH 5/II sequenc ers and transfer the se quencer status information to a programming device or an operator control and monitor ing device. The "GPH:REAK" function block saves and reactivates waiting times and monitoring timers Technical specifications
For S5 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
Services: Detection of errors in se quencers and preparation of firstup signals S Updating of status data of the sequencers monitored
S
Selection and display of se quencer operating modes S Recording of diagnostic in formation in a data buffer
S
Block length in words 1144 1144 1109 1098 1098 1098 1098 1108
Processing time
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/59
Software
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) Sequence blocks Execution blocks SBTIPP These blocks are needed for executing GRAPH 5 sequenc ers in the programmable con troller. A special SBTIPP is al located to each GRAPH 5/II function block:
FB SBTIPP FB 70 SB0 FB 72 SB2 FB 73 SB3
The associated SBTIPP is called in each transition of sequence block SBx, and executes the operating modes initialized in the corre sponding function block. Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 941944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
When a sequencer is gener ated with the GRAPH 5/II sys tem program, the SBTIPP call is automatically entered in the user sequence block SBx.
(Ordering data for the GRAPH 5/II system program for pro grammers: see page 7/10)
Block length in words SB0 385 385 385 385 385 385 385 385 SB2 3333 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 SB3 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75
For each sequencer of a se quence control system there is one sequence block SBx, which contains the structure, step enabling or transition conditions and actions.
The user generates sequence blocks SBx using the GRAPH 5/II system program.
7/60
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
GRAPH 5/II (continued) Sequence blocks (cont.) Synchronization block SB5 Linear sequencers with alter native branches can be syn chronized with the system. The GRAPH 5/II option package generates a block for the sequencer with the conditions of synchronization. With the synchronization conditions, the synchroniza tion block SB 5 sets the step which corresponds to the system status. The SB 5 synchronization block can be run on the following programmable controllers: S S595U S S5100U with CPU 103 S S5115U with CPU 941944, 945 S S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928 B, 948 S S5155U with CPU 946/947 It has a block length of 318 words.
Fig. 7/33 Call structure for synchronization
Software
OB 1/PB a
DB x User DB
SB 5
One DBx work data block is available for each sequencer in sequence control system, and is allocated automatically to the associated SBx se quence block. The DBx work data block maintains the cur rent status of the sequencer.
The error messages for all se quencers in a programmable controller are stored in the DBy diagnostic data block. The GRAPH 5 system pro gram diagnostic function can thus be used to trace group errors over the inidvidual se quencers all the way to the detail level of the faulty se quencer.
S
The DBx and DBy blocks are generated with the GRAPH 5/II system program.
Summary
The GRAPH 5/II program package contains the follow ing blocks:
Order No.
Function blocks FB 67 to FB 75
Sequence blocks SB 0, SB 2, SB 3, SB 5
Ordering data
GRAPH 5/II program package for S595U, S5100U with CPU 103, S5115U with CPU 941944, 945, S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947 MSDOS, S5DOS/MT operating systems, on 31/2I diskettes (1.44 Mbyte) and on 51/4I diskettes (1.2 Mbyte) with manual in German, English, French Single license Copy license
Order No. GRAPH 5/II programming software Documentation for GRAPH 5/II program package, V 6.6 German Englisch French See page 7/11
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/61
Runtime Software
PMC/LS-B standard software Application The PMC (Process Monitoring and Control System) standard software enables convenient monitoring and control of loop controllers as well as process visualization. Besides opera tor control and monitoring of process values and states, si gnalling and monitoring func tions are also included in the system concept. Up to four operator control and monitoring channels can be configured with the PMC/ LSB standard software. PMC for COROS LSB has the following characteristics: S Communication between SIMATIC S5 and COROS LS B can easily be imple mented S Powerful data processing capability S Flexible S Coordination of all commu nication jobs between CO ROS LSB and SIMATIC S5 S Standardized control loop representation for COROS LSB including monitoring functions Besides the standard commu nication blocks KOMOS sup plied with all COROS LSB devices, the following system communication expansions are available: S Signalling functions S Status, standard displays and control loops The functions are pro grammed with the PMC PRO configuring and test software (see page 7/27). PMC/LS-B: Signalling functions The "PMC/LSB: Signalling functions" program package enables easy configuring of messages. With COROS LSB, these messages are output via the message ar chive on the screen (message display) or on a printer (message sequence log).
Software
Local station
O+M communication
Connection to S5 (incl. in scope of supply)
PMC PRO
Signalling functions
Acquisition and prepro cessing of up to 10,000 messages, timeofday stamp Display, acknowledging and archiving of messages
Parameteri zing and te sting of com munication jobs, signal ling functions and status processing
Status
Process monitoring
Display, archiving and acknowledging of status data
Objects
Standard displays
Message displays and mes sages can be selected and acknowledged in COROS LSB. Events registered by the CPU of the programmable controller can be output via a maximum of 4 communica tions channels.
COROS LSB via backplane bus (VPB) COROS LSB via Industrial Ethernet (IWB, OPB) CP 524/5 (event recorder) CP 526/7/8 (message display CP 581 (in connection with the PMC 581 software)
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/91
Software
Runtime Software
PMC/LS-B standard software (continued) PMC/LS-B: Signalling functions (continued) The "PMC/LSB: Signalling functions" program package contains standard function blocks which can be parame terized with the PMC PRO pa rameter assignment and test software. PMC PRO genera tes an executable program which can be transferred to the programmable controller and also analyzed in the test mode. In the programmable control ler, the "PMC/LSB: Signalling functions" blocks monitor up to 625 input, output, bit memory or data words bit by bit for signal change. The data to be monitored may be distributed in the program mable controller. Up to 10,000 messages can thus be configured in the pro grammable controller. Each message contains the following: S Data and time of day S Message number S Message state: incoming, outgoing, acknowledged S Optionally one process value (message parameter) The message number is used to assign a message text to a message in the human machineinterface. PMC/LS-B: Status, Standard displays and objects The "PMC/LSB: Status, standard displays and ob jects" software package offers standardized control loop rep resentation for COROS LSB including the corresponding monitoring functions. Exam ples of data transfers to/from the PMC control loops and the data structures of the control loops are supplied together with the software package. The following are PMC control loops: S R64 controller structure: continuousaction controller, stepaction controller, measuring points S SIPART DR compact con troller: continuousaction controller, stepaction con troller S IP 260 redundant closed loop control module: contin uous action controller, step action controller S Measuredvalue window S IP 261 redundant propor tioning module Hardware requirements S5115U with CPU 941, 942, 943, 944, 945 S S5135U/155U with CPU 928, 928B, 948 S S5155U with CPU 946/947
S
Main memory requirements The blocks (OB, PB, FB) con tained in the "PMC/LSB: Signalling functions" program package require a total of approx. 8 to 12 Kbyte of memory space (depending on the CPU used). The number and the length of the DBs depend on the num ber of message words and message parameters.
The following I/O terminals can be used: S COROS LSB via backplane bus (VPB) S COROS LSB via Industrial Ethernet (IWB, OPB) S CP 524/5252 (event recorder) S CP 526/527/528 (message display) S CP 581 (in connection with the PMC 581 software) Besides the "PMC/LSB: Signalling functions" program package, the following soft ware components are re quired for the configuration of a signalling system: S PMC PRO parameter assignment and test soft ware for parameterizing and testing of signalling func tions S Corresponding software for the communications partner, e.g COROS LSB: BIPRO Industrial Ethernet: COM 143TF, COM 525, COM B+B, PMC 581 Individual control module: Motors Valves Switching function S Any analog values with limit monitoring S Any binary states S Modular control: Continuousaction controller, stepaction controller
S
Standard displays The standard display driver blocks for the representation of PMC control loops in COROS LSB offer the following: S Complete layout in ergo nomic colours conforming to standards S Clear and logic operation S Connection to S5 standard blocks S Value standardizations The standard display driver blocks can be used for the following: S Generation of a standard ized display, such as group display or loop display
Status processing Status processing consists of standard function blocks in the programmable controller. The status information is taken from the PMC control loop data blocks and is moni tored for the occurrence of irregular statuses. The following statuses are irregular: S Upper alarm limit violated S Lower alarm limit violated S Upper warning limit violated S Lower warning limit violated S Control system fault For certain situations (e.g. runningup of a process), sta tus processing can be sup pressed generally or specifi cally for certain control loops.
7/92
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
PMC/LS-B standard software (continued) PMC/LSB; Status, Standard displays and objects (ctd.) Hardware requirements The following programmable controllers can be used: S S5115U with CPU 941, 942, 943, 944, 945 S5135U/155U with CPU 928, 928B, 948 S S5155U with CPU 946/947
S
Software
The following I/O terminals can be used: S COROS LSB via backplane bus (VPB) S COROS LSB via Industrial Ethernet (IWB, OPB) S CP 581 (in connection with the PMC 581 software)
Software requirements Besides the "PMC/LSB: Sta tus, standard displays and objects" program package, the following software compo nents are required: S PMC PRO parameter assignment and test soft ware for parameterizing and testing of status processing
S
Corresponding software for the communications partner, e.g. COROS LSB: BIPRO and PMC 581
Main memory requirements The blocks (OB, PB, FB) con tained in the "PMC/LSB: Sta tus, standard displays and objects" program package require a total memory space of approx. 1 Kbyte. The number and the length of the DBs depend on the num ber of control loops to be monitored.
Ordering data
PMC/LS-B standard software signalling function program package for S5115U with CPU 941944, 945 S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, for S5DOS/MT operating system on 3 1/2I diskettes (1.44 Mbyte), with manual in German and English Single license Copy license PMC/LS-B standard software Status, standard displays and objects program package for S5115U with CPU 941944, 945 S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, for S5DOS/MT operating system on 3 1/2I diskettes (1.44 Mbyte), with manual in German and English Single license Copy license
Order No. PMC 581 driver software PMC driver for CP 581 and stan dard function block for commu nication with 5115U, S5135U with CPU 928/928B, S5155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, BPU 948 on 3 1/2I diskettes (1.44 Mbyte), With manual in German and English Single license Copy license PMC PRO parameter assignment software COM 525 COM B+B, COROS LS-B
Order No.
6ES5 886-2MR01 6ES5 886-2MR01-0KL1 see page 7/27 see page 7/32 see Catalog ST 80.1
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/93
Software
Runtime Software
Signalling functions Application The processes involved in process and power engineer ing can only be reliably con trolled and monitored if a constant check is kept on op erations at a central point. All important events, such as checkback, auxiliary and fault signals and messages, must be monitored and brought to the attention of the operators both visually and audibly. A set of standard function blocks with the designation "Signalling functions" is avail able for this purpose. MLD:TG Clock generator FB 50 for 95U to 155U The "Clock generator" function block produces flashing fre quencies for the lamp outputs of the annunciator blocks. The positivegoing edges of the 0.63 Hz, 1.25 Hz, 2.5 Hz and 5 Hz frequencies are synchronized. The FR parameter provides these frequencies in bits 4 to 7 of the specified byte (fre quency byte). Bit assignment of the FR frequency byte Bit 0: Signal 0 Bit 1: Signal 0 Bit 2: Signal 0 Bit 3: Signal 0 Bit 4: F4 flicker frequency 5 Hz Bit 5: F3 fast flashing light 2.5 Hz (1/2F4) Bit 6: F2 flashing light 1.25 Hz (1/4F4) Bit 7: F1 slow flashing light 0.63 Hz (1/8F4) Technical specifications
For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB. Block length in words 23 20 44 20 20 20 23 22 22 22 19 19 Call length in words 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Processing time in ms 0.4 0.5 0.8 0.8 0.7 <0.1 0.005 0.4 0.2 0.05 0.01 0.1
A distinction is made between firstup and newvalue mes sages (DIN 19 235). In the case of the former, the mes sage (in a group of mes sages), whose status was the first in the group to change af ter the last acknowledgement was made, is highlighted. All messages occuring after this firstup message are referred to as newvalue messages.
The signalling and acknowl edgement states can be indi cated by a steady light or flashing light with various frequencies. A number of individual mes sages can be combined and displayed as a group message.
Conditions For the S595U, S5100U (with CPU 103), S5115U, S5135U: The above frequencies re sult if called in OB 13, pro vided the cycle time is < 1 00 ms. For cycle times > 100 ms, FB 50 must be called from OB 13 only on each 2nd, 5th or 10th pass; the frequen cies are then changed ac cordingly. FB 50 must not be called more than once in a single cycle.
For the S5155U: The above frequencies re sult if called in OB 13, pro vided the cycle time is < 100 ms. For cycle times > 100 ms, FB 50 must be called from OB 14, OB 15 or OB 16; the frequencies are then changed accordingly. FB 50 must not be called more than once in a single cycle.
7/98
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Signalling functions (continued) MLD:EZW MLD:EZWK Firstup signal with single frequency flashing light (word mode) FB 51 for 95U to 155U FB 57 for 95U to 155U The MLD:EZW and MLD:EZWK function blocks indicate changes in signal status (either with a steady light or flashing light), de pending on acknowledgement signals. The sensor signals are processed in word mode either on the opencircuit or closedcircuit principle. Technical specifications
Max. number of signal signals words Block length in words FB 51 368 368 368 368 368 368 326 368 368 368 323 323 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 4.4 to 137 5.3 to 162 6.8 to 212 6.8 to 212 6.5 to 207 0.30 to 1.8 0.40 to 0.925 4 to 60 4 to 55 0.2 to 7.7 0.07 to 1.575 0.2 to 10 Call length in words Processing time in ms Block length in words FB 57 378 386 386 386 386 386 339 392 392 392 336 336 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 4.4 to 137 5.30 to 162 6.8 to 212 6.8 to 212 6.5 to 207 0.3 to 11.8 0.04 to 0.9 4 to 60 4 to 55 0.2 to 7.7 0.07 to 1.575 0.2 to 10 Call length in words Processing time in ms
Software
The function block imple ments the indication of a first up signal and the output of an audible signal, Firstup sig nals. newvalue signals and the audible signal are all ack nowledged separately.
In the case of the MLD:EZW function block (FB 51), the signals are routed to outputs. In the case of the MLD:EZWK function block (FB 57), the signals can be routed either to outputs or to bit memories.
FB For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
FB 51/FB 57 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 40 40 256 256 256 256 256 256 256 256 256 256 640 640
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/99
Software
Runtime Software
Signalling functions (continued) MLD:EDW MLD:EDWK Firstup signal with double frequency flashing light (word mode) FB 52 for 95U to 155U FB 58 for 95U to 155U The MLD:EDW and MLD:EDWK function blocks indicate changes in signal status with a flashing light whose frequency depends on acknowledgement signals. The sensor signals are pro cessed in word mode either on the opencircuit or closed circuit principle. Technical specifications
Max. number of signal signals words FB For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 FB 52/FB 58 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 256 256 256 256 256 256 256 Block length in words FB 52 449 454 454 454 454 454 401 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 4.8 to 177 8.1 to 223 1.2 to 266 10.2 to 266 9.8 to 261 0.5 to 14.1 0.045 to 1.145 4 to 88 4 to 63 0.2 to 9.4 0.11 to 2.856 0.2 to 15 Call length in words Processing time in ms Block length in words FB 58 463 469 469 469 469 469 417 21 21 21 21 21 21 21 4.8 to 177 8.1 to 223 10.2 to 266 10.2 to 266 9.8 to 261 0.5 to 14.1 0.045 to 1.145 4 to 88 4 to 63 0.2 to 9.4 0.11 to 2.856 0.2 to 15 Call length in words Processing time in ms
The function block imple ments the indication of a first up signal and the output of an audible signal. Firstup sig nals, newvalue signals and the audible signal are all ack nowledged separately.
In the case of the MLD:EDW function block (FB 52), the signals are routed to outputs. In the case of the MLD:EDWK function block (FB 58), the signals can be routed either to outputs or to flags.
16 16 16 40 40
20 20 20 20 20
21 21 21 21 21
7/100
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Signalling functions (continued) MLD:EZ MLD:EZK Firstup signal with single frequency flashing light (bit mode) FB 55 for 95U to 155U FB 59 for 95U to 155U The MLD:EZ and MLD:EZK function blocks indicate changes in signal status (ei ther with a steady light or flashing light), depending on acknowledgement signals. The sensor signals are pro cessed on the opencircuit or closed circuit principle. Processing is carried out in bit mode. Technical specifications
Max. number of signal words Function block For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 FB 55/ FB 59 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 Block length in words FB 55 Call length in words Processing time in ms Block length in words FB 59 Call length in words Processing time in ms
Software
The function block imple ments the indication of a first up signal and the output of an audible signal. Firstup sig nals, newvalue signals and the audible signal are ack nowledged separately.
In the case of the MLD:EZ function block (FB 55), the signals are routed to outputs. In the case of the MLD:EZK function block (FB 59), the signals can be routed either to outputs or bit memories.
21 21 21 21 21 21 21
3.9 to 100.0 5.1 to 100.8 5.8 to 120 5.8 to 120 5.7 to 115 0.2 to 7.5 0.035 to 0.955 6 to 175 4 to 86 0.2 to 7 0.09 to 2.585 0.2 to 12
22 22 22 22 22 22 22
3.9 to 100.0 5.1 to 100.8 5.8 to 120 5.8 to 120 5.7 to 115 0.2 to 7.5 0.035 to 0.955 6 to 158 4 to 85 0.2 to 6.7 0.08 to 2.38 0.2 to 12
30 30 30 64 64
22 22 22 21 21
22 22 22 22 22
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/101
Software
Runtime Software
Signalling functions (continued) MLD:ED MLD:EDK Firstup signal with double frequency flashing light (bit mode) FB 56 for 95U to 155U FB 60 for 95U to 155U The MLD:ED and MLD:EDK function blocks indicate changes in signal status with a flashing light whose fre quency depends on acknowl edgement signals. The sensor signals are processed on the opencircuit or closed circuit principle. Processing is carried out in bit mode. Technical specifications
Max. number of signal words Function block For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 FB 56/ FB 60 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 Block length in words FB 56 Call length in words Processing time in ms Block length in words FB 60 Call length in words Processing time in ms
The function block imple ments the indication of a first up signal and the output of an audible signal. Firstup sig nals, newvalue signals and the audible signal are ack nowledged separately.
In the case of the MLD:ED function block (FB 56), the signals are routed to outputs. In the case of the MLD:EDK function block (FB 60), the signals can be routed either to outputs or bit memories.
23 23 23 23 23 23 23
4.3 to 102.0 5.7 to 101.2 6.9 to 122 6.9 to 122 6.5 to 116 0.3 to 8.3 0.04 to 1.06
24 24 24 24 24 24 24
4.3 to 102.0 5.7 to 101.2 6.9 to 122 6.9 to 122 6.5 to 116 0.3 to 8.3 0.04 to 1.06
30 30 30 64 64
22 22 22 23 23
24 24 24 24 24
7/102
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Signalling functions (continued) MLD:SAMW MLD:SAM Group signal (word mode) Group signal (bit mode) The MLD:SAMW function block combines individual signals to form a group sig nal. The smallest group con sists of one sensor word (16 signals or messages). The "Group signal (word mode)" function block works together with the MLD:EZW (FB 51), MLD:EDW (FB 52), MLD:EZWK (FB 57) and MLD:EDWK (FB 58) function blocks. It uses the data block edited by the signalling func tion blocks. Technical specifications
Max. number of signal words Block length in words Call length in words Processing time in ms Block length in words Call length in words Processing time in ms
Software
The "Group signal (bit mode)" function block works together with the MLD:EZ (FB 55), MLD:ED (FB 56), MLD:EZK (FB 59) and MLD:EDK (FB 60) function blocks. It uses the data block edited by the signalling function blocks.
Each new signal is indicated by highfrequency flashing light and an audible signal. After acknowledgement of the signalling function blocks, the group signal and the audible singal can be acknowledged separately if the signal is still present, the flashing light changes to a steady light, otherwise it darkens.
Function block For S5 95U 100U with CPU 103 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945
FB 53/ FB 54 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
FB 53
FB 54
12 12 12 12 12 12 12
2.2 to 22.0 2.5 to 27.6 2.9 to 31.2 2.9 to 31.2 2.8 to 30.5 0.1 to 1.9 0.02 to 0.19
11 11 11 11 11 11 11
2.0 to 15.0 2.2 to 59.6 2.9 to 31.2 2.9 to 31.2 2.8 to 30.5 0.1 to 1.90 0.015 to 0.465 2 to 8 1 to16 0.1 to 3.6 0.03 to 1.11 0.2 to 2
135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
16 16 16 40 40
12 12 12 12 12
11 11 11 11 11
Ordering data
Signalling functions program package for S595U S5100U with CPU 103, S5115U with CPU 941944, CPU 945 S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, CPU 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, for S5DOS/MT operating system on 3 1/2I diskettes (720 Kbyte) and on 5 1/4I diskettes (360 Kbyte) Single license Copy license
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/103
Software
Runtime Software
Data handling blocks Application
Central processor
FB "SEND"
Communications processor
Communications processor
Central processor
FB "RECEIVE"
Data
Link
Data
Data traffic between a central processor and S Communications processors (CPs) S Intelligent I/O modules IP 246, IP 247 and IP 252 S CP 516 submodule memory is carried out with the aid of standard function blocks, called "data handling blocks". For example, see Fig. 7/76. In the case of the S5115U, the data handling blocks are fully integrated in the operat ing system.
The functions for the CPU 922, 928, 928B and CPU 948 of the S5135U are stored in the operating system, the parameters, however, are passed via loadable standard function blocks. The data handling blocks can handle the central processor data traffic with all commu nications processors inter faced to the programmable controller, e.g. with two CPs 525 or one CP 528. The structure of the data handling blocks depends on the type of the central processor used, but not on the communica tions processors. SENDDirect can be used, for example, to send a data area specified by the user program in the central processor to the module.
Standard function blocks for "multiprocessor communica tion" are integrated in the op erating systems of the CPU 922, 928, 928B and CPU 948 for data transfer between CPUs over the page frames of the C coordinator Note: The relevant standard function blocks are required for initial ization and control of the intel ligent I/Os. These standard function blocks call the data handling blocks as required.
SEND Send
The SEND standard function block controls data transmis sion from the central proces sor to an I/O module memory (dualport RAM). The two possible operating modes are SENDAll and SENDDirect. Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948
The SENDAll function, on the other hand, sends only data requested by the module, and determines which data are to be transmitted by the central processor.
7/104
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Data handling blocks (continued) RECEIVE Receive The RECEIVE standard func tion block transfers data from the I/O module memory (dual port RAM) to the central pro cessor. Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 36 36 36 36 Processing time See table below
Software
Like the SEND function block, the RECEIVE function block has two operating modes: RECEIVEDirect and RECEIVEAll.
Processing times for data transmission using the SEND and RECEIVE data handling blocks:
For S5 Processing time in ms for transmission of 16 byte 115U with CPU 941 to 944, CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 9211) CPU 9221) M prozessor2)3) CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 1 128 byte 7.5 256 byte 15 512 byte 30
60 6 6 6 6 6
65 7 7 7 7 7
70 8 8 7 7 7
93 10 10 9 9 9
1) The S processor data handling blocks differ from the others be cause of queue processing (see ACTIVE and UP ACTIV function blocks). Four to five ACTIVE calls are necessary for data transfer, depending on the amount of data involved. When these calls are not implementedin one cycle, the user program cycle time must be taken into account when estimating the total data transfer time.
2) The specified times contain the processing times for the function blocks, including the data transfer time and a waiting period of 5 ms for the module response (a maxi mum of 2 waiting periods of up to 5 ms each may occur).
3) The times given are approximate values for one R processor trans ferring data with the data handling blocks. When four R processors are used in parallel, it can take up to 11 ms, for example, to transfer 256 bytes. In multiprocessor oper ation, the properties of the CPs/IPs must be taken into account.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/105
Software
Runtime Software
Data handling blocks (continued) FETCH The FETCH standard function block signals the module that it has to make certain specific data available in the memory (dualport RAM). Technical specifications FB 122 for 155U
*) integrated in the operating system For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 36 36 36 36 Processing time See table on page 7/105
The central processor then queries these data with the RECEIVEAll function.
CONTROL
The CONTROL standard func tion block queries the module for status information at any point in the user program. The request might be for the num ber of the task which the module is currently proces sing, Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948
or for the information whether a certain task is currently exe cuting or whether that task is free of errors, or whether it has been finished due to a specific error.
RESET
The RESET function block can be used to reset individual communications relationships to their initial status. Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 921 CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 76 21 21 21 21 Processing time See table on page 7/105
7/106
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Data handling blocks (continued) SYNCHRON Synchronize The SYNCHRON function block synchronizes the inter face between the central pro cessor and the modules (CP, IP, magnetic bubble memory) during system startup. Technical specifications FB 125 for 155U
*) integrated in the operating system For S5 135U/155U with CPU 921 CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 119 21 21 21 21 Processing time See table on page 7/105
Software
SEND-A Send
The SENDA is a special ver sion of the SEND function block. The SENDAll function call is shorter, thus making parameter assignment more lucid. Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 24 24 24 24 Processing time See table on page 7/105
REC-A Receive
RECA is a special version of the RECEIVE function block. The RECEIVEAll function call is shorter, thus making pa rameter assignment more lu cid. Technical specifications
For S5 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 Block length in words 24 24 24 24 Processing time see table on page 7/105
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/107
Software
Runtime Software
Data handling blocks (continued) Summary The "Data Data handling blocks blocks program package contains the following function blocks:
For S5
S5135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 FB 120 FB 121 FB 122 FB 123 FB 124 FB 125 FB 126 FB 127
SEND RECEIVE FETCH CONTROL RESET SYNCHRON ACTIVE UP ACTIV SENDA RECA
*) With the S5115U the function blocks are contained in the operating system of the central controller module.
Ordering data
Data handling blocks program package for S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, 948 Single license Copy license
Order No.
7/108
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 240 Application For the operation of the intelli gent I/O modules (see Sec tions 2 and 4), programs are required in the programmable controller to control the func tions of the intelligent I/O modules, to acquire and pro cess the data and to evaluate the signals and interrupts coming from the modules. These programs are available in the form of standard func tion blocks, which are briefly described below. A complete description of the function blocks is contained in the pro gramming instructions which are supplied together with the modules. STRU.POS Initialization of function block for positioning mode The configuring FB first checks the input parameters and the length of the data block to be used for data in terchange with the IP 240. It then transfers the general module data (machine read able product designation of the module, FW and HW ver sions) from the IP to the data The following standard func tion blocks are available for the IP 240: Positioning FB 167 "STRU.POS" for initialization S FB 168 "STEU.POS" for control
S
Software
Position decoding S FB 169 "STRU.WEG" for initialization S FB 170 "STEU.WEG" for control
Speed measurement for forewarding to the IP 252 closedloop control module S FB 173 "STRU.252" for initialization (for S5115U only)
block, verifying its own com patibility with the firmware version as it does so. It then enters any errors detected during the startup test in the data block. Finally, the config uring data (parameters for FB 167) and the following data areas are transferred from the DB to the IP:
Zero offset Final value for the rotary axis Distance values for the switching and signalling ranges S Position numbers and posi tion values for positions 1 to 254.
S S S
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 1159 1159 1159 1159 1007 1152 1152 1152 1059 1059 Call length in words 14 14 14 14 15 15 15 15 16 16 Processing time in ms 34 to 410 34 to 410 34 to 410 14 to 170 11.6 to 135 23 to 320 18 to 264 13 to 161 11.6 to 135 10 to 130
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/109
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 240 (continued) STEU.POS Control function block for positioning mode FB 168 for 115U, 135U, 155U The control function block first checks to make sure that the channel has been configured for "positioning" mode. Then, depending on the parameters with which the FR was initia lized, specific data areas are forwarded from the data block to the IP or read out from the IP and updated in the data block. The following functions are possible:
S S S S S S S
Read actual value, final value and status bits Write control bits and position number Write position data for position 0 Read interrupt request bytes Write new position values for positions 1 to 254 Write new zero offset Write new distance values for positions 1 to 254
Parameter assignment errors and data errors are flagged in the PAFE byte and described in detail in words DW 8 to 10 and DW 13. When an error is detected, the selected func tion is not executed. The control FB is normally in voked in the cyclic program. Before it is called, IP 240 must be initialized with the configuring function block FB 167 (STRU.POS, initalize positioning mode).
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 830 830 830 830 801 833 833 833 795 795 Call length in words 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Processing time in ms 6.0 to 7.4 6.0 to 7.4 6.0 to 7.4 1.9 to 2.8 1.1 to 2.0 4.3 to 6.2 2.5 to 4 2.1 to 3.0 0.8 to 2.4 0.9 to 2.1
The "Initialize position de coder" function block sup plies the IP 240 (position de coding mode) with the initial and final setpoint values of the tracks for both channels and the assignments of process Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
interrupts and digital outputs to the tracks. The data is forwarded in a data block. The user must ini tialize this DB before calling the function block.
Block length in words 1098 1098 1098 1098 971 1654 1654 1654 993 992
7/110
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 240 (continued) STEU.WEG Control position decoder The following functions can be executed with the "Control position decoder" function block in "Position decoding" mode:
S S S S S
Software
Read actual values and status bits Read track identification bits Read, delete or modify start and end values of a track Write zero offset Read interrupt request bytes
The function block is normally called in the cyclic program. Before it is called, the IP 240 must be initialized with FB 169 (STRU.WEG, initialize position decoder).
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 975 975 975 975 918 1539 1539 1539 980 980 Call length in words 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Processing time in ms 6 to 54 6 to 54 6 to 54 2 to 17 0.8 to 17 6.6 to 68 3.5 to 45 1.7 to 4.0 0.8 to 15.9 2.1 to 17
The "Initialize counter" func tion block transfers parameter data from the CPU to the IP 240. These data include the setpoint count and information Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
on the use of digital output, process interrupt and gate control. The function block re ports any parameter errors from the IP 240 to the CPU.
Block length in words 814 814 814 814 739 1248 1248 1248 740 740
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/111
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 240 (continued) STEU.DOS Control counter FB 172 for 115U, 135U, 155U The "Control counter" function block can execute the follow ing functions in "Counting" mode:
S
Issue commands to the IP 240, such as start, stop, initialize Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
Before it is called, the IP 240 must be initialized with FB 171 (STRU.DOC, initialize position decoder).
Block length in words 680 680 680 680 641 1110 1110 1110 696 696
Processing time in ms 6 to 11 6 to 11 6 to 11 1.6 to 2.2 0.9 to 1.2 6 to 10 3.5 to 6.0 1.9 to 2.2 0.8 to 1.2 1.6 to 2.2
The "Initialize speed measure ment" function block reserves the IP 240 for "IP 252 expan sion" mode only. This mode is possible only on the S5115U. Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
The user must initialize a data block with the data to be for warded before calling the function block.
The FB is normally called in organization block OB 20 on a cold restart and in organiza tion block OB 22 on a warm restart.
Ordering data
The standard function blocks for IP 240 are part of the: Configuring package for IP 240 consisting of: Manual and standard FBs for me tering, position acquisition and positioning German English French Italian
Order No.
Order No.
7/112
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 242A PER:ZSTK Counter module controller (for page addressing) FB 178 for 115U, 135U, 155U The IP 242 A counter module normally uses page addres sing. The FB 178 function block supports the following functions: Counter initialization Issue of commands to the counter module, e.g. start, stop, initialize S Interrupt processing
S S
Software
The function block can be called both from a restart or ganization block (for cold re starts) and from a cyclic or in terruptdriven program. Different functions are ena bled according to the calling point, e.g. initialization is ena bled if it is called in the cold restart OB, interrupt acknow ledgement is enabled if called in the interrupt OB and all other functions are enabled if called in the cyclic program.
Counter data (initialization va lues, counter settings, actual counter readings, etc.) are stored in a data block for pro cessing by the CPU or for transfer to the counter module.
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 135U/155U with CPU 9222) CPU 9283) CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 1359 1359 1359 1359 1281 1281 1281 1203 1203 Call length in words 11 11 11 11 11 11 11 12 12 Processing time in ms 4.8 to 60.2 4.8 to 60.2 4.7 to 59.6 0.8 to 10.7 3.6 to 48 2 to 26 1.6 to 19.9 0.23 to 2.65 12 to 6.4
The IP 242A counter module can be used for linear addres sing in the S5115U and S5155U programmable con trollers. This addressing Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) 155U with CPU 946/947 CPU 948 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
technique uses a special address space in the PLC. As with page addressing, data exchange between the CPU and the IP 242 A can only
take place via the function block. Interrupt handling func tionality is restricted if the IP 242 A is used with linear addressing.
Processing time in ms 4.8 to 60.2 4.8 to 60.2 4.7 to 59.6 0.8 to 10.7 1.2 to 6.4 0.23 to 2.65
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/115
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 242A (continued) PER:BS Write to counter module (for page addressing) PER:BL Read from counter module (for page addressing) PER:IN Acknowledge counter module interrupt (for page addressing) FB 180 for 115U, 135U, 155U The IP 242 A counter module is capable of executing com mand lists as a result of inter rupt events. This attribute helps to offload the CPU and enhances the response time of the total system. Certain function blocks have been de veloped to further accelerate data exchange between the CPU and the IP 242 A. These blocks are "read from module", "write to module" and "acknowledge interrupt". The FBs are used in conjunc tion with FB 178. Module to be used: 6ES52421AA3.
7/116
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 242B ZYK:242B Counter module controller The following functions can be executed with the "Counter module controller" function block:
S S
Software
To initialize the counter mod ule, the function block FB 183 is normally called in the restart organization blocks OB 20, 21 and 22. Control of the counter module (i.e. starting of counter or reading of actual values) is then carried out in the cyclic program (organization block OB 1). Counter data (initialization val ues, counter settings, actual counter readings, etc.) are stored in a data block for pro cessing by the CPU or for transfer to the counter mod ule. Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 9222) CPU 9283) CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB..
The IP 242 B counter module is capable of executing com mand lists as a result of inter rupt events. This attribute helps to offload the CPU and enhances the response time of the total system. In contrast to the IP 242 A, the IP 242 B also offers arithmetic functions in connection with load, transfer and comparison operations. Certain control words tailored to the module functions have been developed to further ac celerate data exchange be tween the CPU and the IP 242 B, besides the use of the command list.
Amongst others, these are the following: S Process command list S Write constant register S Prepare loading S Read sequence of mea sured values The commands are used in conjunction with FB 183. The module is capable of storing the calculation results (or the counter contents) in measured value sequences on the IP 242 B with a total of 100 x 2 DW. A second data block is re quired to read these mea sured value sequences. Module to be used: 6ES52421AA4.
Block length in words 1111 1111 1111 1111 1002 1293 1293 1293 1246 1246
Processing time in ms 9.9 to 41 9.9 to 41 8.5 to 37.78 1.6 to 7.1 0.42 to 3.36 1.0 to 46.4 4.6 to 25 3.6 to 20.1 0.74 to 3.69 1.7 to 6.7
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/117
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 242B (continued) INT:242B Process interrupt The FB 184 function block is used to process interrupts and process alarms. The great advantage is that the access times for the spe cial functions "Write register", "Read register" and "Ac knowledge interrupt" are opti mized. To evaluate the process alarms or interrupts, the FB 184 is called in an orga nization block of the interrupt driven program (OB 2 to OB 9, depending on the pro grammable controller). The FB 184 may only be used in conjunction with FB 183. The interrupt source can be acquired from parameter IIR. Further functions are:
S
Transfer new parameter as signment data to the module (write data). The counter registers and the global reg isters can thus be trans ferred from the data block to the module. Read data from the counter module. All counter content registers, the counter status registers and all result regis ters are read by the module.
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length in words 375 375 375 375 311 394 394 394 370 370 Call length in words 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 11 11 Processing time in ms 3.5 to 12.2 3.5 to 12.2 2.4 to 11.3 < 0.5 to 2.5 0.04 to 2.07 1.8 to 17 0.9 to 4.7 < 0.5 to 3.4 0.05 to 2.00 < 0.5 to 2.3
Standard function block FB 185 (ZA:242B) quickly reads the counter module IP 242B (page addressing).
The function block FB 185 matches the functions of FB 183 when called with BEF = ZA in a cyclic, timecontrolled program
You can additionally invoke the FB 185, which has shorter running times. This function block can S read the counter state regis ter S read the counter value regis ter S read the results register
Technical specifications
for S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length, in words 346 346 346 346 303 352 352 352 367 367 Call length in words 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 6 Processing time in ms 2.0 to 5.9 2.0 to 5.2 1.8 to 6.7 0.4 to 1.3 0.03 to 0.6 1.8 to 6.2 < 0.5 to 2.9 0.05 to 0.25 < 0.4 to 1,2
7/118
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 242B (continued) Ordering data
The standard function blocks for IP 242A and IP 242B are part of the: Configuration package for IP 242A/B consisting of Manual and standard FBs German English French Italian Order No. Order No.
Software
Function blocks for IP 243-3 PER:ANL Read analog module The function block "read ana log module" accepts the se lected analog value (if the analog module IP 243 is pres ent) and passes on the value Technical specifications
for S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES5 94.7UB.. Block length, words 165 165 165 165 222 180 180 180 222 222 Call length, words 13 13 13 13 14 14 14 14 14 14 Execution time in ms 4.4 to 5.9 4.9 to 5.9 4.1 to 5.5 0.3 to 1.7 0.175 to 0.185 1.8 to 2.1 1.1 to 1.2 1.0 to 1.1 0.48 to 0.49 0.69 to 0.74
either as a bit pattern as it is received from the module or as a 16-bit fixed-point num ber scaled to the appropriate nominal values.
Moreover, the function block can be used to read the digi tal inputs and comparator out puts.
The function block "write ana log module" transfers the ei ther specified bit pattern or a
16-bit fixed-point number scaled to the nominal value to the IP 243-3 analog module.
The function block can be used to control digital outputs (the module must be equipped with a memory for digital output).
Execution time in ms 3.2 to 3.5 3.2 to 3.5 2.6 to 2.8 0.1 to 1.66 0.05 to 0.06 1.4 to 1.7 0.7 to 1 0.2 to 0.3 0.06 to 0.07 0.6 to 0.64
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/119
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 243-3 (continued) Ordering data
The Standard function blocks for IP 243-3 for: S5-115 with CPU 941-944, CPU 945, S5-135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, 948, S5-155U with CPU 946/947 for operating system MS-DOS, S5-DOS/MT on 31/2" diskettes or 51/4" diskettes incl. example program German, English, French Order No. 6ES5 848-7MA01 Order No.
7/120
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 244 PER:TREG Control temperature controller The "Control temperature con troller" function block trans fers the control parameters and setpoint values to the module and reads error mes sages, actual values and ma nipulated variables, extreme Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 9222) CPU 9283) CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES594.7UB.. 2) As of Order No.: 6ES59223UA11 3) As of Order No.: 6ES59283UA12 Order No. Block length in words 1746 1746 1746 1746 1788 1504 1504 1504 1637 1637 Call length in words 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 Processing time in ms 6.9 to 74.4 6.9 to 74.4 6.5 to 72.8 0.8 to 5.9 0.185 to 3.72 5.7 to 8.8 4.4 to 6.2 1.6 to 12.6 0.36 to 3.39 0.8 to 1.7
Software
values or the selfoptimizing parameters. The data is stored in three data blocks. The function block can assign parameters to the entire mod ule or one controller.
The diskette also contains a test program to facilitate installation, with comments in the appropriate language. Module to be used: 6ES5 2443AA22 and 6ES5 2443AB31
Ordering data
The standard function blocks for IP 244 are part of the: Configuring package for IP 244 consisting of: Manual and standard FBs German English French Italian
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/121
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 246 and 247 Application The "Control and monitor po sitioning module" and" Initia lize positioning module" The "Control and monitor po sitioning module" function block performs the following functions: S Starts a job (modes BA 1 ... BA 19) on the IP 246 or IP 247 (modes BA 1 ... BA 17) from an application pro gram. Cyclically reads an actual position value, follow ing error or residual path from the IP 246 or IP 247. These values are output in binary or BCD code, ac cording to the setting of the BCD parameter function blocks are compa tible with both the IP 246 and the IP 247.
S
Continually reads the mode setting, current M function, feedback signals and mod ule error from the initialized interface. These are pro vided as output parameters from the function block or in the axisspecific data block
DB 164 is divided into two areas. Data words DW 1 to DW 7 are set aside for indirect initialization of the function block. Data words DW 8 to DW 15 comprise the fixed working area of FB 164. Work areas may not be changed. Jobspecific parameters are additionally required for some modes of operation. Before a mode is enabled, these must be stored in the appropriate data block as byte, word and double word parameters. The free area of DB 164 can be used for this purpose.
FB 164 works in conjunction with DB 164. The data block must first be initialized by the user, up to and including data word DW 15. There are no special provisions to be made for the data words.
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 9222) CPU 9283) CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES594.7UB.. 2) As of Order No.: 6ES59223UA11 3) As of Order No.: 6ES59283UA12 Block length in words 1012 1012 1012 1012 627 618 618 618 682 682 Call length in words 20 20 20 20 19 19 19 19 19 19 Processing time in ms 5.6 to 11.8 5.6 to 11.8 4.3 to 10.4 0.6 to 5.3 0.1 to 0.8 3.0 to 11.8 0.5 to 6.0 1.2 to 3.9 0.6 to 1.2 1.0 to 4.4
The "Initialize positioning module" function block hand les the transfer of data bet ween the application program and the IP 246 or IP 247. Each valid job number leads to data transfer between the mo dule and the PLC.
Data transfer PLC ! IP 246/IP 247 Data awaiting transfer are stored in a data block (source DB) which you must first create. The data block is con figured directly using the FB 165 block parameters or indirectly in the axisspecific data block.
Data transfer from IP 246/IP 247 ! PLC Data to be read from the IP 246 or IP 247 are stored in a data block (target DR) in the controllers memory (target DB). The user can configure this data block directly using the FB 165 block parameters or indirectly in the axisspe cific data block.
7/122
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 246 and 247 (continued) Positioning module PER:PDAT FB 165 (continued) With the aid of FB 165 and the PLC interface, the user can S Read, delete and transfer machine data and traversing programs on the IP 246 or IP 247 S Read the SYSID from the IP 246 or IP 247 and transfer it to the IP 246 or IP 247
S
Software
Request an overview of ma chine data or traversing pro grams on the IP 246 or IP 247 and simultaneously read actual values (actual position value, residual path)
DW 47, inclusive, for its work ing area. The user can specify an axis specific data block through the DBNR parameter. This data block requires a "job block" of 15 data words in length for every axis.
FB 165 works in conjunction with the DB 165 data block. It requires data words DW 3 to
Technical specifications
For S5 115U with CPU 9411) CPU 9421) CPU 9431) CPU 9441) CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 9222) CPU 9283) CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947 1) As of Order No.: 6ES594.7UB.. 2) As of Order No.: 6ES59223UA11 3) As of Order No.: 6ES59283UA12 Block length in words 706 706 706 706 640 573 573 573 569 569 Call length in words 13 13 13 13 Processing time in ms 5.4 to 11.8 5.4 to 11.8 5.1 to 9.3 3.2 to 8.3
13 13 13 13
The FB 164 and FR 165 func tion blocks can be initialized directly or indirectly. In the case of direct initialization, the jobspecific data and parame ters are provided as input pa rameters to the FB. With indi rect initialization, the axisspecific data block is configured from the data block which was valid before
the call. The function block supplies the remainder of the parameters from the axisspe cific DB. The "SEND", "RECEIVE", "FETCH" and "SYNCHRON" data handling blocks are re quired for communication be tween the positioning module and the CPU (see page 7/97) and are called by FB 164 or FB 165.
The "SYNCHRON" block must be called once (by the user) in the restart organization blocks. The COM 246 or COM 247 system program (see page 7/21) for the appropriate pro gramming device is required for comfortable installation and programming of the posi tioning module.
Ordering data
The standard function blocks for IP 246/247 are part of the: Configuring package for IP 246I/A consisting of: Manual, standard FBs and para meter asgmt software COM 246 German English French
Order No. The standard function blocks for IP 246/247 are also part of the: Configuring package for IP 247 consisting of: Manual, standard FBs and para meter assignment software COM 247 German English French
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/123
Runtime Software
Function blocks for IP 262 Application The software package for the IP 262 closedloop control module for the S590U, 95U, and 100U programmable controllers comprises the fol lowing blocks: S DB 11 to DB 17 default data blocks containing comments and used to describe and read back structure switches and parameters stored in the IP 262 S FB 61 and FB 62 function blocks for the simplified ex change of all types of data between the IP 262 and the CPU of the S5100U, S590U or S595U. Function block FB 60 for simpler data exchange of certain data between the IP 262 in the ET 200U and a S5 master CPU (example pro gram). Usually setpoints, controller parameters etc. are trans ferred from a CPU to the IP 262. In the other direction, actual values and limit val ues reached are made avail able to the CPU by the IP 262 for monitoring, for ex ample S Sample programs for data exchange between the IP 262 and the CPU of the S5100U, S590U or S595U
S
Software
FB 61 fr 90U, 95U, 100U FB 62 fr 90U, 95U, 100U FB 60 for 95U, 115U, 135U, 155U
A function block and sample programs for data exchange over the SINEC L1 LAN. S Sample displays for the OP 396 operator panel
S
All the blocks are provided on a diskette containing the vari ous program files and have comments in English, German and Italian. Programming instructions are contained in the IP 262 manual.
Ordering data
The standard function blocks for IP 262 are part of the: Configuring package for IP 262 consisting of: Manual and standard FBs German English French Italian
Order No.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/127
Software
Runtime Software
Function blocks for CP 516 memory submodule Application Data transfer between the CPU and the CP 516 is car ried out with the function block FB 199. The handling blocks (see page 7/104) must also be provided in the CPU. DB 255 is permanently assi gned as work area to FB 199. Transfer of a data block from the CPU to the CP 516 or vice versa S Deletion of a sector or a data block within a sector on the CP 5161)
S
Functions
Transfer of the list of data blocks of a sector to a data block1) S Transfer of the memory card data (type, capacity) to the CPU1)
S
Technical specifications
For S5 Name Block length in words Call length in words Transfer time CP/CPU or CPU/CP in s Approx. 1s for 1 kbyte at 100 ms scan time
115U with CPU 941 CPU 942 CPU 943 CPU 944 CPU 945 135U/155U with CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 155U with CPU 946/947
EXT115U EXT115U EXT115U EXT115U EXT945U EXT135R EXT135R EXT135R EXT155U EXT155U
959 959 959 959 988 1168 1168 1168 1168 1168
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
Ordering data
Standard function blocks for the CP 516 memory submodule for S5115U with CPU 941944, 945, S5135U/155U with CPU 922, 928, 928B, 948, S5155U with CPU 946/947, with CP 516 manual, for MSDOS, S5DOS/MT operating system on 3 1/2" diskettes (720 Kbyte), on 5 1/4" diskettes (360 Kbyte), Single license Copy license with manual in German English French 1) Not for S5115U
Order No.
7/128
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs Application S5-95F Only the following function blocks can be used in the S595F: S Prototypetested standard function blocks
S
Software
Prototypetested standard function blocks have been tested by various test insti tutes and, like the S595F, possess a certificate. They enable implementation of fre quently required functions without extra overhead. Nonprototypetested stan dard function blocks are re jected by the S595F.
S5-115F Only standard function blocks tested and approved by the German Technical Inspector ate (TV) can be used for the S5115F programmable con troller. A check is made at system startup to ensure that only such standard FBs are used. The software package with the standard FBs for the S5115F contains blocks for the following tasks: S Calculations with 32 bit fixedpoint numbers Processing of messages Control of sequencers Safe pointtopoint link between two S5115Fs Each standard FB for the S5115F has been prototype tested by the Bavarian Techni cal Inspectorate (TV). The result of this test is recorded in a certificate supplied to gether with the software.
S S S
The test divides the blocks into the following groups: S Standard function blocks that can perform safetyre lated tasks (failsafe stan dard FBs) S Standard FBs that cannot in fluence other blocks of the control program (reaction free standard FBs) At the individual acceptance test of your control program, the safety test of the standard FBs is restricted to the follow ing: S Library number check
S S
Usage to the intended pur pose check Block parameter assignment check
The standard function block Fuel engineering" contains typical functions for fuel engineering. Design
Function block Initialization FB 10 Fuel preselec tion FB 11
The function blocks can be called as often as desired allowing several burners to be operated with one S595F or S5115F.
The blocks are designed for continuous and intermittent operation. They have been TV prototypetested.
Explanations S Call in OB 21/22 S Reset data in DB S Switching of operating mode oil/ gas S Generation of control enable S Indication of operating mode via LEDs S Scanning of safety sequence S Output of fault signals as firstup signal S Interface to text display S Start of preventilation time S Valve control and monitor S Display of operating mode S Control of ignition valve depend ing on fuel, networked control lers, preventilation S Manual/automatic ignition S Indication of operating mode
Function block Solenoid valve oil FB 15 Solenoid valve gas FB16 Networked con trollers FB 17
Explanations S Control of the oil solenoid valves S S S S S Control of the gas solenoid valves Seal check Indication of operating states External controller check Ignition position networked controller ON depending on fuel, closedloop control enable, openloop control en able, limit switch g motor in the Control of the actuating OPEN/CLOSED position Output of the first fault signal of 16 possible signals Acknowledgment of fault signals one after the other Lamp test
S Firstup signal FB 18 S S S
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/129
Software
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs (continued) Standard function block package Emergency off for 95F Emergency off circuits of category 0 to 2 in accordance with DIN EN 60204 Part 1 can be safely controlled with the standard function block pack age Emergency off". The blocks have been prototype tested by the German Trade Association Institute for Safety at Work. Handling emergency off with onboard I/O Up to 16 emergency off se quences and 8 shutdown de vices can be implemented. Handling emergency off with external I/O Up to 56 emergency off se quences and 28 shutdown devices can be implemented.
Design
Function block S Startup initia tion FB 21 FB 22 S Start block for OB 1 FB 40 Explanations Initialization of the data used at startup S Management of a shutdown device S Monitoring of the start condition for the sequence S Restart disable after initiation S Actuator readback S Acknowledgment of an initiation S Can be called eight times Initialization of data used at startup Function block S Start block for OB 3 FB 41 Explanations S Simultaneous management of 16 emergency off sequences and 8 shutdown devices S Fast shutdown after initiation S Programmable assignment of differ ent sequences to one shutdown q device
S Startup initia tion FB 21 FB 22 S Start block for OB 1 (1 FB per DI and DQ module) FB 42, FB 44, FB 46, FB 48, FB 50, FB 52 FB 54, FB 56
S Management of a shutdown device S Monitoring of the start condition for the sequence S Restart disable after initiation S Actuator readback S Acknowledgment of an initiation S Can be called four times
S Start block for OB 3 (1 FB per DI and DQ module) FB 43, FB 45, FB 47, FB 49, FB 51, FB 53, FB 55 55, FB 57
S Simultaneous management of 8 emergency off sequences and 4 shutdown devices S Fast shutdown after initiation S Programmable assignment of differ ent sequences to one shutdown device
The standard function block package Extended functions" contains function blocks for processing special functions.
The diskette contains one file with functions for the S595F and one file with functions for the S5115F. The following functions can be used for the S595F:
S S S
Addition of two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign) S New value Subtraction of two fixedpoint binary signal numbers (31 bit + sign) FB 153 Multiplication of two fixedpoint Sequencer binary numbers (31 bit + sign) FB 170 Division of two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign)
Explanations The signals are differentiated between firstup signal and new value. The first signal is output. Every change y signal g g is output p as a new value. Sequential control S Linear processing g S Branched p processing S Alternative branchings p The FB 170 function block operates in conjunction with up to 255 sequence blocks (SB 1 to SB 255) and one work ing data block (DB). One single step of a sequential control is programmed in a step block. The function block requires the working data block for storing the current statuses of the sequencer such as operating mode" and current step".
OB 13 call for 8 edgesynchronous blink frequencies. The OB 13 call interval determines the blink fre quency. Called in the cyclical program section. The blink frequencies are generated via a timer.
7/130
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs (continued) Standard function block package Extended functions (continued) for 115F The following functions can be used for the S5115F:
S S S
Software
Design
Function block Arithmetic functions1) S ADD:32 32 bit binary adder FB 1 Explanations FB 1 (block name ADD:32) adds two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is a fixedpoint binary number (31 bit + sign) and lies within the interval -230 ... + 230 . The function block sets the following identifier for further processing: S Overflow of the number range S Result of the addition is zero FB 2 (block name SUB:32) subtracts two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number (31 bit + sign) and lies within the interval -230 to 230. The function block sets the following identifier for further processing: S Overflow of the number range S Result of the subtraction is zero FB 3 (block name MUL:32) multiplies two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is a fixedpoint binary number (63 bit + sign) and lies within the interval -262 to +262. The function block sets the following identifier for further processing: S Overflow of the number range S Result of the multiplication is zero FB 4 (block name DIV:32) divides two fixedpoint binary numbers (31 bit + sign). The result is also a fixedpoint binary number. (31 bit + sign) with remainder (31 bit + sign). The function block sets the following identifier for further processing: S Overflow S Error from division by zero S Quotient equals zero S Remainder equals zero Continuous monitoring of the process is frequently required for rationalized and safe control in process engineering and power engineering. All signifi cant checkback signals, indicator signals and fault signals must be cap tured and indicated via LEDs or audible signals. The following blocks are available for this purpose: FB 50 (block name TAKT1) generates eight edgesynchronous blink fre quencies. The block is called in OB 13. The blink frequencies are defined by the OB 13 call interval. FB 51 generates eight edgesynchronous blink frequencies. The block is called in the cyclic program section. The blink frequencies are generated via timer T in the cyclic control program. The basic frequency f1 is defined via the programmable time value. FB 52 monitors an encoder word (16 signals) S for signal level 0" (quiescent current monitor) or S for signal level 1" (load current monitor). The signals are differentiated according to firstup signal and new value. Indications depends on the acknowledgment signals. The monitor responds with a signal if S one bit of the encoder word and S the bit of the specification parameter have the same signal state. The modified signal states of the encoder word are indicated. Firstup indicator The first indication of a signal change is output as the firstup signal. The firstup signal is indicated by setting output bits.
Signalling functions
S TAKT1 Clock generator via OB 13 call FB 50 S TAKT2 Clock generator via timer FB 51 S MLD:ERST Firstup signal FB 52
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/131
Software
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs (continued) Standard function block package p g Extended functions ( (continued) i d) for 115F Design
Function block Signalling functions (continued) S MLD:NEUW Firstup signal FB 53 Explanations FB 53 (block name MLD:NEUW) monitors an encoder word (16 signals) S for signal level 0" (quiescent current monitor) or S for signal level 1" (load current monitor). The monitor responds with a signal if S one bit of the encoder word and S the bit of the specification parameter have the same signal state. Modified signal states of the encoder word EINW are indicated with S Flashing light S Steady light S Horn Indication depends on acknowledgment signals. New value indication The first indication of a signal change is output as the firstup signal. The firstup signal is indicated by setting output bits. Many technical process sequences can be subdivided into individual steps that must be processed chronologically one after the other. Control tasks of this type can be implemented very easily and clearly using step sequence controls. The essential advantages of step sequence controls are: S Easy and timesaving programming S Control program easy to modify S Fast location of errors The smallest unit of a step sequence control is the sequence step or step. Each step is programmed in its own step block. Each step block consists of a statement section and a scan section. S In the statement section, you define actions to be executed in the step (for example, switching of actuators, starting of timers, etc.) S In the scan section, you program the step enabling condition for the next step (for example, by scanning limit switches or waiting times). Several steps executed one after the other constitute a step sequence. As well as linear (unbranched) step sequences, in which the order of the steps is constant, you can also program branched step sequences. Branched step sequences are divided into several parallel program paths. The paths to be followed depend on the status of the step enabling condi tion. In addition, there are various operating modes available for controlling the step sequence, for example, automatic mode, singlestep mode, sequence STOP etc. as well as a fault monitor. Management of the step sequence with its various operating modes and management of the fault monitor independent of the process and can thus be organized by FB 70. Only the step blocks of the step sequence are processdependent and must be programmed by you. Use of GRAPH 5 software is not possible. The step blocks must be programmed in STEP 5. Function block FB 70 ABL:MAST manages step sequence controls for ma chines or processes. Function block FB 70 operates in conjunction with up to 255 step blocks (SB 1 ... SB 255) and one working data block (DB). In the step blocks, you program the individual steps of the step sequence control. FB 70 requires the working data block for storing the current states of the step sequence, such as operating mode and current step.
7/132
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs (continued) Standard function block package p g Extended functions ( (continued) i d) Design
Function block Safetyrelated pointtopoint connection between two S5115Fs via CP 5232) Explanations The pointtopoint connection permits safetyrelated data exchange be tween two S5115Fs via CP 523. Up to 124 net data words can be ex changed. One CP 523 is required in each programmable controller. Both CP 523s are linked via a connecting cable up to 10 m in length. The failsafe pointtopoint connection has been prototype tested by the Bavarian Technical Inspectorate TV and is approved for plants with processes of S Requirement class 6 in accordance with DIN V 19250 S TV safety class 2. Both unidirectional and bidirectional data exchange are possible via point topoint connection. Data blocks function as send and receive mailboxes for the safetyrelated data. Organization of data exchange is handled by three standard function blocks. FB 100 is called in the startup OB. It transfers to the CP 523 all the data required to parameterize the CP 523 for safetyrelated data exchange.
Software
S ANLA523 Startup data to CP 523 FB 100 Safetyrelated pointtopoint connection between two S5115Fs via CP 5232) S SEND523 Send data to CP 523 FB 101
FB 101 is processed in the cyclic program (OB 1). It organizes sending of frame data to the connected CP 523. FB 101 starts data transfer by reading the net data from the send data block and calculating data for frame secu rity. Send and security data are then transferred to the CP 523 in several data records. In the case of errorfree transfer, the frame data are transferred automatically by the connected CP 523 to the second CP 523. If FB 101 detects a parameter assignment error or a send error, it signals this error in the PAFE" byte. You must evaluate the PAFE" byte and branch to an error routine in the event of a send error. Function block FB 102 is processed in the cyclic program (OB 1). It handles receiving of the frame data from the connected CP 523. FB 102 reads the frame data in several data records from the CP 523 and checks the received frame for errors using the security information. Only when the frame has been received without errors does FB 102 transfer the net data to the receive data block. If FB 102 detects an error when checking the security information or if the programmed monitoring time runs out, FB 102 deletes the contents of the receive data block.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/133
Software
Runtime Software
Failsafe standard FBs (continued) Ordering data
Standard function block package Fuel engineering for S5-95F, S5115F, incl. German manual, on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes, Single license Copy license Standard function block package Emergency off for S5-95F, incl. German manual, on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes, Single license Copy license Order No. Standard function block package Extended functions for S5-95F, S5115F, consisting of: Arithmetic functions, signalling functions, step sequence control and safetyrelated pointtopoint connection, incl. German manual, on 31/2" and 51/4" diskettes, Single license Copy license Order No.
7/134
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Special driver software Application
Software
CP 524 CP 525-2
Fig. 7/89 Special driver software on the CP 524/CP 5252 (driver software on minidiskette, routines are located into EPROM on the CP 524 and into RAM or EPROM on the CP 525) are required for interfacing host systems such as computers or subsystems such as scales or bar code readers.
The everincreasing extent of the tasks performed by pro grammable controllers and the hierarchical structure of installations in the process in dustry often make it neces sary to connect SIMATIC S5 systems to host computers and subsystems. These in clude scanners, barcode readers, automatic labelling machines and identification systems. The CP 524 and CP 5252 communications processors support connection to stan dard Siemens devices, e.g. computers, CRT units and printers. For this purpose the CP 524 communications pro cessor has one interface and the CP 5252 two interfaces. Special drivers for CP 524 and CP 5252 communica tions processors are available for connection to computers and subsystems of other manufacturers. The special drivers enable asynchronous transmission via: S The 20 mA currentloop in terface (TTY, over a distance of up to 1 km/1.6 miles) S RS 232C interface (V24/V.28, up to 16 m/52.48 ft) Special driver software (continued) Open drivers (continued) "Open drivers"can be used to send and receive data of any structure (all printable ASCII characters and all other cha racters from 00H to FFH). The
RS 422/RS 485 interface (voltage differential trans mission, only with CPU 524, up to 1200 m/3936 ft). The user can choose from the following: S Character frame; ASCII or fulltransparent transmission, number of start bits, number of data bits, parity bit S Procedure; Opening character, end character, acknowledge ment character, block check character S Message format; Specifications pertaining to the type and amount of data, etc.
S
Honeywell, IBM and MODI CON as well as for the sub systems manufactured by Da talogic (scanners and barcode readers), SAAB SCA NIA Automation (Premid mi crowave reader system), Phil ips (weighing equipment), Leuze (barcode readers) and Sick Opto electronic (barcode readers and other systems). Thanks to their modularity, new special drivers can be easily created on demand. If required, translations can be made of existing operating instructions for the special drivers. An additional range of "open drivers" is also available which the user can tailor to his own requirements. Many manufacturers of sub systems have integrated the Siemens RK 512 standard or 3964 (R) procedure in their systems. This enables these systems to be interfaced via the driver software contained in the COM 525 package. If only the 3964 (R) procedure has been implemented, a special driver (6ES5 8972AB. 1) is required for the CPU 524/CP 5252 communications processors.
These technical capabilities enable optimum adaptation to the interface of the host sys tem. The special drivers are deliv ered on diskette (51/4" and 31/2") and are supplied with a manual. Driver routines have been de veloped for many common process computers and sub systems such as the process computers and control sys tems manufactured by AEG, Allen Bradley, ASEA, Data General, FISHER CONTROL,
message structure is kept open so that the S5 user can send complete messages to the CP with all control charac ters intact ( including start or
end characters), and likewise receive complete messages. The structure of outgoing messages can vary from inco ming ones.
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/135
Software
Runtime Software
Special driver software (continued) Open drivers (continued) Because of the wide variety of possible configurations, a tho rough knowledge is required of the interface to be connec ted. There is a choice of several "open drivers" with different technical specifications for a variety of configurations. Sending: All data types are allowed as source data. If the source type "DB" is used, messages can be sent from any data block. The maximum mes sage length is 2048 byte. Receiving: A message can begin with any character. The CP reco gnizes the end of the data
S
string being received from the end parameter. When the CP recognizes the end parame ter, the complete message is passed to the CPU. The data are entered with the aid of FB RECEIVEALL. The data block for all received messages must have been created beforehand.
The S5D004 "open driver" has the greatest choice of config urations. The S5D004 "open driver" is configured through a direct SEND job from a STEP 5 pro gram. The following can be parameterized: S Baud rate from 50 to 19,200 bauds (with fullduplex and TTY up to 9,600 bauds) S Character frame S Receiving data block, data word and CPU number
S S
S S
Message end parameter: 1 or 2 end codes, timer, fixed length (combination of end codes or timer with fi xed partblock length possi ble) Fullduplex mode Halfduplex mode optional XON/XOFF protocol for sending and receiving, optional STX holdoff interval, optional echo optional BREAK evaluation in ANZW Wordwise or bytewise transmission Character delay time: 4 to 65,535 ms in 1 ms raster
Technical specifications No block check character; No software handshake (ac knowledgement), no hardware handshake (auxiliary signals); CP 524: 20 mA (current loop), V.24, RS 422, RS 485 CP 525: 20 mA (current loop), V.24; Maximum sending length from DB: 4096 byte, unlimited receiving length through blocking, maximum block length: 1024 byte Buffering for heavy message traffic
The S5D002 open driver sup ports the V.24 auxiliary signal (hardware handshake) of the CP 524 as required. The S5D002 "open driver" is configured through a direct SEND job from a STEP 5 program. The following can be parame terized: S Baud rate from 50 to 19,200 baud (with fullduplex and 20 mA (current loop) up to 9,600 baud S Character frame S Receiving data block, data word and CPU number
Message end parameter: 1 or 2 end codes, timer S Fullduplex mode S Halfduplex mode Optional XON/XOFF protocol for sending (monitoring time 6 s) and STX holdoff inter val, optional echo S Character delay time: 100 to 25,500 ms in 101 ms raster.
S
Note The S5D002 driver is suitable only for use in the CP 524.
Technical specifications No block check character; no software handshake (acknowledgement), programmable hardware handshake (RTSCTS handshake; DTR, STEP 5compatible PS3, DCD, DSR, RI and PM1 can be evaluated from STEP 5); CP 524: 20 mA (current loop), V.24 with auxiliary signals, RS 422; maximum sending length from DB: 4096 byte, maximum receiving length: 508 byte
Order No.
Ordering data
Program Open driver S5D004 for CP 524/CP 525-2 (programmed with PG) Single license Copy license with description in German English French 1) To be used with CP 525 only
Order No. Program Open driver S5D002 for CP 524 (programmed with PG) 6ES5 897-2DC J 1 6ES5 897-2DC J 1-0KL1 1 2 3 Single license Copy license with description in German English
7/136
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Special driver software (continued) Technical specifications and ordering data for special driver programs
Device Details Master/slave relationship: S5 is Master Protocol Lan gua ge G G License Order No.
Software
S Does not support control signals of the V.24 interface S Only for use with CP 524 S Processes the V.24 RTS control signals S Enables data transmission via modem module e.g. LABK03frequency telegraphy unit (AEG) S Only for use with CP 524 S Processes the V.24 RTS and DCD control signals S Enables data transmission via modems (e.g. UEB4) or GD from AEG S Does not support control signals of the V.24 interface S Connection unit from the Geazent 8006 system with Partyline pro cedure to SIMATIC S5 S Does not support control signals of the V.24 interface S Does not support control signals of the V.24 interface S Max. transceiving length 128 byte S Does not support control signals of the V.24 interface
SEAB1
Master
SEAB1
G Slave SEAB1
AEG Logistat CP80 A200A500 AEG Geazent 8006 system AEG MARK IV Turbine control ABB (ASEA) Robot control
Slave
SEAB1
G G
Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license
6ES5 897-2UB11 6ES5 897-2UB11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2ND11 6ES5 897-2ND11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2XA11 6ES5 897-2XA11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2KD11 6ES5 897-2KD11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2MA11 6ES5 897-2MA11-0KL1
Slave
AEG Partyline
G G
ADLP10
ABB (BBC) Procontrol P station auto mation system ABB (ASEA) Master Piece 200/1 Master Piece 800
Slave S The DSCA 114 interface board is required on the ABB side S V.24 control signals not supported S Note: ABB offers further modules which can also be used for communication with SIMATIC: e.g. via Modbus protocol with DSCA 180B interface e.g. via Siemens RK 512 protocol with DSCA 180F interface For details, please contact ABB S For PLC 2, communication controller 1771 KGM is required
Master
G, E F
G Slave
Allen Bradley PLC 2 ATRON Memory submodule DEC Micro VAX, PDP 11
S Writing to the submodule, max. 252 byte S Reading from the sub module, max 255 byte S RK 512 drivers are available for SIMATIC S5 sister controllers
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/137
Software
Runtime Software
Special driver software (continued) Technical specifications and ordering data for special driver programs (continued)
Device Details Master/ slave relation ship: S5 is Protocol Lan gua ge License Order No.
S The Siemens RK 512 protocol is imple mented in various Datalogic devices. A special driver is then not required. For details, please contact Datalogic S Communications software in acc. with DIN 19244 and IEC TC 57, format class FT 1.2, with customerspecific adjust ments S Communications software in acc. with DIN 19 244 and IEC TC 57, format class FT 1.2, with customerspecific adjust ments S This driver enables various printers to be interfaced for process status listing with CP 524/525 (as standard, only PT 88/89 and DR 210/21 1/ 230/231 printers with ECM module can be connected) S Not suitable for E&N ClU 858! Master In acc with DIN 19244 and IEC TC 57 In acc. with DIN 19244 and IEC TC 57 LAUF
Printer
G,E
ENRAF NONIUS Microlect System Fisher Controls PROVOX Process control system Hewlett Packard HP 1000A, Type A600, A700, A900 Hewlett Packard HP 9000, Process computer Honeywell (Modbus)
S Communication is possible via Modbus protocol if function codes which are not supported by the Fisher PROVOX system are not used S RK 512 drivers are available for SIMATIC S5 sister controllers For details, please contact HP
Slave
G,E, F
Please consult HP
G S A Generik gateway TDC 200 or TDC 3000, for example, can be used as inter face to the bus Master Modbus protocol, RTU mes sage frame format Modbus protocol, RTU mes sage frame format RK 512 or procedure 3964 (R)
G,E, F
Honeywell (Modbus)
S A Generik gateway TDC 200 or TDC 3000, for example, can be used as inter face to the bus
Slave
G,E, F
S Toolbox, "PRODAVE DOS 64R" for PG/ PC (AT and ATcompatible) under MS DOS operating system
G,E, F,S
G E F S
1 2 3 4
7/138
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Special driver programs (continued) Technical specifications and ordering data for special driver programs (continued)
Device Details Master/ slave relation ship: S5 is Protocol Lan gua ge License Order No.
Software
IEEE 488
S Interfacing to the bus is possible via "ICS 4835 Serial EE1E 488 Controller" S Controller can be obtained from: Meilhaus Electronic GmbH 82178 Puchheim Federal Republic of Germany Phone ++498980 70 81 Simliar to RK 512 and procedure 3964 S e.g. BLC 10 S Siemens RK 512 is implemented in vari ous devices from Leuze (a special driver is then not required) For details, please contact Leuze S The J478 standalone modem, for exam ple, can be used as interface module to the bus Slave Modbus protocol, RTU mes sage frame format Modbus protocol, RTU mes sage frame format
IBM S1 computer
Modicon (AEG)
G,E, F
Modicon (AEG)
S The J478 standalone modem, for exam ple, can be used as interface module to the bus S Modbus for TELEPERM AS 215 process control system S AS 215 is master
Master
G,E, F
Modicon (AEG)
Master
MTU MCS 4
Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license
6ES5 897-2LD11 6ES5 897-2LD11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2DC J1 6ES5 897-2DC J1-0KL1 6ES5 897-2NB J1 6ES5 897-2NB J1-0KL1 6ES5 897-2MB J1 6ES5 897-2MB J1-0KL1
Open driver
S If the CP 524 is used, RS 485 operation is possible with the RS 422/485 module S Suitable only for CP 524 with V.24 module Support the V24 accompanying signals S This driver enables connection to "sim ple" RS 485 master/slave networks S The driver acts as master S Possible parameters: end/start character, BCC type, character delay time, XON/ XOFF protocol S PR 159X family PR 1600 family Master Master
No protocol
G,E, F,S
Open driver
No protocol
G,E
Open driver
No protocol
G,E
Open driver (Operation procedure) Philips Weighing systems Philips Closedloop controllers
LAUF
Philips EW protocol
G,E
Master
G,E
G E F S
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/139
Software
Runtime Software
Special driver programs (continued) Technical specifications and ordering data for special driver programs (continued)
Device Details Master/ slave relation ship: S5 is Master S Suitable for microwave ID systems with 20 decimal places, e.g. PC 301 /00;/02;/42 central processing units and PC 3001, PC 3002, PC 3003 data storage units or PC 3040/00/01 compact communications units S Suitable for microwave ID systems with 8 Kbyte data storage units, e.g. PC 3010/52 CPUs and 2K/8 Kbyte data storage units PC 3004, PC 3005 Master S Suitable for barcode readers, decoders, terminals, etc. S Interfacing via SIDN interface unit S Terminals 3805, 3821, ES 005, ES 01 5, ES 021, ES 1 01 B Master 38xx G Protocol Lan gua ge License Order No.
Rotork PA 14 protocol
G G
SAAB Automation (Philips) Premid Identsystem Staefa WSE1 Bus SICK Optoeletronic Siemens Alarm systems Siemens 38 Terminals Siemens SIROTEC RCM Siemens SICOMP M Siemens TELEPERM FM 100 Siemens 3964 (R)
G Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license Single license Copy license 6ES5 897-2SA11 6ES5 897-2SA11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2GE11 6ES5 897-2GE11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2CC11 6ES5 897-2CC11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2DA J1 6ES5 897-2DA J1-0KL1 6ES5 897-2VB11 6ES5 897-2VB11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2HC11 6ES5 897-2HC11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2LB11 6ES5 897-2LB11-0KL1 6ES5 897-2AB J1 6ES5 897-2AB J1-0KL1
G G,E
LSV 2 S SEBM S FM 100 field multiplexer S 3964(R) procedure with programmable character frames, control characters and times. With/ without S5 header S Computer link 512; nonstandard feature: times, character frames and control charac ters are programmable. RK 512 always has S5 header S Toolbox "PRODAVE DOS 64R" for PG/PC (AT and ATcompatible) under MSDOS operating system 3964 (R)
G G G G,E
Siemens RK 512
RK 512
G,E
Siemens PG 7xx
G,E F,S
Tandem Computer
G E F S
1 2 3 4
7/140
Siemens ST 50 1998
Runtime Software
Special driver programs for CP 544B Hard- and software requirements The special drivers are execu table on the CP 544B (6ES5 544-3UB11). A RAM or Flash EPROM memory submodule (..or ..) must be plugged into the CP 544B as the memory. The two serial interfaces of the CP 544B can be operated independently of each other with different standard proto cols and special drivers with the interface modules RS 232C (V.24)/TTY/RS 422/485. For loading and parameteri zing special drivers, the para meter assignment software COM PP Version 3.0 and hig her is required.
Software
Technical specifications
Allen Bradley Data Highway General notes Data transmission is performed with the full duplex (DF 1) protocol for the data highway asynchronous link from Allan Bradley. All Allen Bradley modules on which the full duplex protocol can be parameterized on the asynchronous link interface can be used as the communication modules. Coupling with the 2nd CPU interface of Allen Bradley CPUs is also possible if the full duplex protocol can be set . The procedure is operated on an RS 232C, V.24 20 mA (TTY) or RS 422 (fourwire full duplex) interface. Technical specifications S Allen Bradley Data Highway full duplex (DF1) protocol S Interfaces: 20 mA (TTY), RS 232C (V.24), RS 422/485 (four-wire) S No embedded responses S Transmission rate of 300 baud to 76800 baud; TTY up to 9600 baud; RS 232 (V.24) up to 19200 baud S Character frame S Receive mailbox DB and data word S Timeout for acknowledgment character 30 ms to 10 s S Number of repetitions on NAK 0 to 5 S Number of ENQ requests 0 to 5 S Duplicate message transmission detection: ON or OFF S Acknowledgment of the CP immediately after receipt or only after transfer to the PLC Settable parameters Extended open driver General notes Transmission is performed asynchronously, half or full duplex and is run on an RS 232C (V.24), 20 mA (TTY) or RS 422/485 interface. The RS 485 interface of the CP 544B can use the RS 232C (V.24) interface with a modem for multipoint connections. Moreover, RS 232C (V.24) signaling and control lines can be used if the special driver is used. S Transmission rate 300 baud to 76800 baud; TTY up to 9600 baud, RS 232C (V.24) up to 19200 baud S Character frame S Mode, i.e. end criterion for receive S CP functions as master of a masterslave link S With/without RS 485 operation for twowire connections S With/without RS 232C (V.24) accompanying signals S Handling of transmission errors at beginning of message frame S Break evaluation S Character timeout in millisecond timebase S Block assembly (continuous receiving) S BREAK output Data flow control with XON/XOFF or BUSY is not supported by this driver
Settable parameters
Siemens ST 50 1998
7/141
Software
Runtime Software
Special driver programs for CP 544B (continued) Technical specifications (continued)
MODBUS master Technical specifications S MODBUS protocol with RTU format S Master-slave link: SIMATIC S5 is master S Implemented function codes: 01, 02, 03, 04, 05, 06, 07, 08, 11, 12, 15, 16 S No RS 232C (V.24) control and signal lines S CRC polynomial X16 + x15 + x2 + 1 S Interfaces: 20 mA (TTY), RS 232C (V.24), RS 422/485 (two-wire or four-wire) S Receive mailbox DB and data word are spe cified on transmission S Character timeout 3.5 characters (baudratedependent) S Broadcast message possible S Transmission rate of 300 baud to 76800 baud; TTY up to 9600 baud (RS 232C) V.24 up to 19200 baud S Character frame S With/without RS 485 operation for two-wire connections S With/without modem operation (ignore scratch character) S Response timeout 100 ms to 25.5 s in 100 ms timebase S Factor for character timeout 1-9 MODBUS slave General notes The communications software consists of a special driver and two function blocks. Data transmission is performed according to the master-slave principle. The master takes the initiative in transmission, the CP 544B func tions as a slave and only transmits to the ma ster on request. Message frame exchange from slave to slave is not possible. S MODBUS protocol with RTU format S Master-slave link: SIMATIC S5 is the slave S Implemented function codes: 01, 02, 03, 04, 05, 06, 08, 15, 16 S CRC polynomial X16 + x15 + x2 + 1 S Interfaces: 20 mA (TTY), RS 232C (V.24), RS 422/485 (two-wire or four-wire) S Communications FBs (FB 180 for start-up, FB 181 for cyclic operation with data handling blocks) S MODBUS data address is converted to S5 data areas. Processable data areas: DB or DX, flags, out puts, timers, counters, (extended) I/Os, (ex tended) system addresses S Character timeout 3.5 characters (baudratedependent) S Transmission rate of 300 baud to 76800 baud; TTY up to 9600 baud RS 232C (V.24) up to 19200 baud S Character frame S Slave address of the CP S With/without RS 485 operation for two-wire connections S With/without modem operation (ignore scratch character) S Factor for character timeout 1-9 S Number of the working DB (for FB proces sing) S Release of the memory areas that can be written by the master and the readable (ex tended) I/Os
Technical specifications
Settable parameters
Settable parameters
Ordering data
Allen Bradley Data Highway German Single license Copy license Extended open driver with operation of the RS 232C (V.24) accompanying signals or two-wire operation for RS 485, German Single license Copy license
Order No. MODBUS master RTU message frame format German, English, French Single license Copy license MODBUS slave RTU message frame format German, English, French Single license Copy license German English French
Order No.
7/142
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
11/2
Modules Power con. at 9V
No.of data bits3)
IM: PLC: Price Slot number 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Qty. S mA 4 8 16 4 4 4 8 8 8 8 4 4 8 4 4 8 8 4 8 8 16 644) 644) 644) 644) 644) 644) 324) 324) 325) 324) 324) 324) 324) 4 32 4 4 8 4 each total Up to 6 additional modules can be connected to the S5-90U using the IM 90 interface module. mA 16 34 50 5 16 16 32 32 32 6 15 15 14 15 14 35 25 14 30 20 60 70 100 70 70 70 70 70 100 100 170 170 170 170 20 70 10 35 30 25
Item S5-90U (integral power supply) IM 90 interface module Digital input 4 x 24 V DC module 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 24 V DC 4 x 24 V/60 V DC 4 x 115 V UC 4 x 230 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 8 x 115 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 8 x 5/24 V DC Digital output 4 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 4 x 24 V DC; 2.0 A 8 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A 4 x 24/60 V DC; 0.5 A 4 x 115/230V AC;1.0 A 8 x 24 V DC; 1 A 8 x 115/230V AC;0.5A 4 x relay output 8 x relay output 8 x 5/24 V DC; 0.1 A Dig. I/O module 16 in., 16 out., 24V DC Analog input 4 x 50 mV module 4 x f. therm.( 50 mV) 4 x 1 V 4 x 10 V 4 x 20 mA 4 x +4 to 20 mA 2 x 500 mV/Pt 100 2 x f. Pt100m. w. linear. 4 x 0 to +10 V Analog output 2 x 10 V module 2 x 20 mA 2 x +4 to 20 mA 2 x +1 to 5 V Counter 500 Hz module 500 kHz Timer module Comparator module Simulator module Diagnostics module
Order No. 6ES5 0908MA01 6ES5 0908ME11 6ES5 4208MA11 6ES5 4218MA12 6ES5 4228MA11 6ES5 4308MB11 6ES5 4308MC11 6ES5 4308MD11 6ES5 4318MA11 6ES5 4318MC11 6ES5 4318MD11 6ES5 4338MA11 6ES5 4408MA12 6ES5 4408MA22 6ES5 4418MA11 6ES5 4508MB11 6ES5 4508MD11 6ES5 4518MA11 6ES5 4518MD11 6ES5 4528MR11 6ES5 4518MR12 6ES5 4538MA11 6ES5 4828MA13 6ES5 4648MA11 6ES5 4648MA21 6ES5 4648MB11 6ES5 4648MC11 6ES5 4648MD11 6ES5 4648ME11 6ES5 4648MF11 6ES5 4648MF21 6ES5 4668MC11 6ES5 4708MA12 6ES5 4708MB12 6ES5 4708MC12 6ES5 4708MD12 6ES5 3858MA11 6ES5 3858MB11 6ES5 3808MA11 6ES5 4618MA11 6ES5 7888MA11 6ES5 3308MA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
Closedloop IP 262; K controller control module IP 262; S controller IP 263 positioning module IP 264 electronic cam controller IP 265 high speed sub control IP 266 positioning module IP 267 stepper motor controller Communica CP 521 SI tions CP 521 BASIC processor CP 24336)
6ES5 2628MA12 6ES5 2628MB12 6ES5 2638MA13 6ES5 2648MA12 6ES5 2658MA01 6ES5 2668MA11 6ES5 2678MA11 6ES5 5218MA21 6ES5 5218MB11 6GK1 2433SA00
Bus unit (screw connection) Bus unit (screw connection, enhanced EMC level) Bus unit (crimp connection) enhanced EMC level) 1 4 4 4)16 bits for each active channel 5)8 bits for each active channel 6)max. 1 module Total current I 300 mA
6ES5 7008MA22
IM 315 interface module IM 316 interface module IM 316F interf. mod. (enh. EMC level)
1)Max. configuration: 2 tiers 2)Max. configuration: 4 tiers (1 IM 316 per tier) 3)Max. permissible number (S): 480 data bits, 256 of which from analog modules
Accessories Qty. each Front connector total 40pin; screw 20pin; screw Front connector 40pin, crimp6) 40pin, without crimp cont.6) 40pin, screw6) SubDconnector 9pin, plug 9pin, socket 15pin, plug Simulator Other see Sections 2 and 4 6ES5 4908MB11 6ES5 4908MB21 6ES5 4908MA13 6ES5 4908MA03 6ES5 4908FB11 6ES5 7502AA11 6ES5 7502AB11 6ES5 7502AA21 6ES5 7888MK11 Price Item Order No. Qty. Price each
Item
Order No.
Memory submodul EPROM, 8 Kbyte EEPROM, 2 Kbyte EEPROM, 4 Kbyte Backup battery Wall mounting DIN rail 483 mm/18.84 in for 19" cabinets 530 mm/20.67 in for 600m/23.4 in cab. 830 mm/32.37 in for 900m/35.1 in cab. Length: 2000 mm/78 in 712 connecting cable Length: 0.5 m/ 1.6 ft 2.5 m/ 8.2 ft 5.0 m/16.4 ft 10.0 m/32.8 ft
6ES5 3758LA11 6ES5 3758LC11 6ES5 3758LC21 6ES5 9800MB11 6ES5 9818MB11 6ES5 7108MA11 6ES5 7108MA21 6ES5 7108MA31 6ES5 7108MA41 6ES5 7128FA00 6ES5 7128BC50 6ES5 7128BF00 6ES5 7128CB00
Sum
+ =
Total price
Configuring
11/3
11/4
Slot number Price each total
B B
Configuring
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Qty. mA S mA
Item S5-95U S5-95U with SINEC L2 interface S5-95U with second serial interface S5-95U with PROFIBUS DP slave inter. S5-95U with PROFIBUS DP master int. S5-100U CPU 100 CPU 102 CPU 103 PS 935 power supply module 7) Digital input 4 x 24 V DC module 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 24 V DC 4 x 24 V/60 V DC 4 x 115 V UC 4 x 230 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 8 x 115 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 8 x 5/24 V DC Digital output 4 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 4 x 24 V DC; 2.0 A 8 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A 4 x 24/60 V DC; 0.5 A 4 x 115/230V AC; 1.0 A 8 x 24 V DC; 1 A 8 x 115/230V AC;0.5 A 4 x relay output 8 x relay output 8 x 5/24 V DC; 0.1 A Dig. I/O module 16 in.,16 out.,24 V DC Analog input 4 x 50 mV module 4 x f. therm.( 50 mV) 4 x 1 V 4 x 10 V 4 x 20 mA 4 x + 4 to 20 mA 2 x 500 mV/Pt 100 2 x f. Pt100 w. linear. 4 x 0 to +10 V Analog output 2 x 10 V module 2 x 20 mA 2 x +4 to 20 mA 2 x +1 to 5 V Ex dig. in. mod. 4 x NAMUR Ex dig. out. mod. 4 x 7 V DC; 2 mA Ex analog in. 4 x thermoelement Ex analog in. mod. 2 x +4 to 20 mA Ex analog in. mod. 2 x Pt 100 Ex analog out. mod. 2 x +4 to 20 mA Counter 500 Hz module 500 kHz Timer module Comparator module 16 34 50 5 16 16 32 32 32 6 15 15 14 15 14 35 25 14 30 20 60 70 100 70 70 70 70 70 100 100 170 170 170 170 50 55 270 320 270 350 20 70 10 35 8 4 8 16 4 4 4 8 8 8 8 4 4 8 4 4 8 8 4 8 8 16 645) 645) 645) 645) 645) 645) 325) 325) 326) 325) 325) 325) 325) 4 4 32 32 32 32 4 32 4 4
Order No. 6ES5 0958MA03 6ES5 0958MA02 6ES5 0958MC01 6ES5 0958MD01 6ES5 0958ME01 6ES5 1008MA02 6ES5 1028MA02 6ES5 1038MA03 6ES5 9358ME11 6ES5 4208MA11 6ES5 4218MA12 6ES5 4228MA11 6ES5 4308MB11 6ES5 4308MC11 6ES5 4308MD11 6ES5 4318MA11 6ES5 4318MC11 6ES5 4318MD11 6ES5 4338MA11 6ES5 4408MA12 6ES5 4408MA22 6ES5 4418MA11 6ES5 4508MB11 6ES5 4508MD11 6ES5 4518MA11 6ES5 4518MD11 6ES5 4528MR11 6ES5 4518MR12 6ES5 4538MA11 6ES5 4828MA13 6ES5 4648MA11 6ES5 4648MA21 6ES5 4648MB11 6ES5 4648MC11 6ES5 4648MD11 6ES5 4648ME11 6ES5 4648MF11 6ES5 4648MF21 6ES5 4668MC11 6ES5 4708MA12 6ES5 4708MB12 6ES5 4708MC12 6ES5 4708MD12 6ES5 4378EA12 6ES5 4578EA12 6ES5 4678EA11 6ES5 4678EE11 6ES5 4678EF11 6ES5 4778EC11 6ES5 3858MA11 6ES5 3858MB11 6ES5 3808MA11 6ES5 4618MA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
Simulator module Diagnostics module Closed-loop IP 262; K controller control module IP 262; S controller IP 263 positioning module IP 264 electronic cam controller IP 265 high speed sub control IP 266 positioning module IP 267 stepper motor controller Communica CP 521 SI tions CP 521 BASIC processor CP 24339)
6ES5 7888MA11 6ES5 3308MA11 6ES5 2628MA12 6ES5 2628MB12 6ES5 2638MA13 6ES5 2648MA12 6ES5 2658MA01 6ES5 2668MA11 6ES5 2678MA11 6ES5 5218MA21 6ES5 5218MB11 6GK1 2433SA00
8 4 64 64 64 64 64 64 32 64 64 16
Bus unit (screw connection) Bus unit (screw connection)8) Bus unit (crimp connection)8) Ex bus unit Interrupt bus unit (screw connection)1) Interrupt bus unit (crimp connection)1) 1 4 2) 2) 2) 2) 4 Total current without PS 935 I 1 A with PS 935 I 2.5 A
1) 1) 1)
6ES5 7008MA11 6ES5 7008FA11 6ES5 7008MA22 6ES5 7008EA11 6ES5 7008MB11 6ES5 7008MB21
1) 1) IM 315 interface module 6ES5 3158MA11 2) 2) IM 316 interface module 6ES5 3168MA12 2) 2) IM 316 interface mod. (enh. EMC level) 6ES5 3168FA12 1) For S5100U with CPU 103 only; operates as normal bus unit in all other cases 2) Max. configuration: 2 tiers 4) Maximum permissible number (S): S595U: 704 data bits, max. 512 of which from analog modules S5100U with CPU 100: 256 data bits, max. 128 of which from analog modules CPU 102: 480 data bits, max. 256 of which from analog modules CPU 103: 704 data bits, max. 512 of which from analog modules
5) 16 bit for each active channel 6) 8 bit for each active channel 7)Not with CPU 100 8) Enhanced EMC level Item total
9)S595U: 2 CPs can be connected CPU 100: 1 CP can be connected CPU 102, CPU 103: 2 CPs can be connected CPU 103 without additional I/O modules: 3 CPs can be connected Order No. 6ES5 4908MB11 6ES5 4908MB21 6ES5 4908MA13 6ES5 4908MA03 6ES5 4908FB11 6ES5 7502AA11 6ES5 7502AB11 6ES5 7502AA21 6ES5 9308MD11 6ES5 9318MD11 6EW1 3801AB 6EW1 3804AB01 Qty. Price each Front connector 40pin, screw 20pin, screw Front connector 40pin, crimp cont.8) 40pin, without cr. cont8) 40pin, screw8) Sub D connector 9pin, plug 9pin, socket 15pin, plug Power supply module 24 V AC/DC, 1 A (S5100U only) 24 V AC/DC, 2 A 24 V AC/DC, 4 A 24 V AC/DC, 10 A Other see Sections 2 and 4
Item
Order No.
Memory submodule
Backup battery DIN rail 483 mm/18.84 in for 19 in cabinets 530 mm/20.67in for 600mm/23.4in cap. 830 mm/32.37in for 900mm/35.1in cap. Length: 2000 mm/78 in Ex partition 712 connecting cable Length: 0.5 m/1.6 ft 2.5 m/8.2 ft 5.0 m/16.4 ft 10.0 m/32.8 ft Sum
EPROM, 8 Kbyte EPROM, 16 Kbyte EPROM, 32 Kbyte EEPROM, 2 Kbyte EEPROM, 4 Kbyte EEPROM, 8 Kbyte EEPROM, 16 Kbyte
6ES5 3751LA15 6ES5 3751LA21 6ES5 3751LA41 6ES5 3750LC11 6ES5 3750LC21 6ES5 3750LC31 6ES5 3750LC41 6ES5 9800MA11 6ES5 7108MA11 6ES5 7108MA21 6ES5 7108MA31 6ES5 7108MA41 6ES5 4978EA11 6ES5 7128FA00 6ES5 7128BC50 6ES5 7128BF00 6ES5 7128CB00
Sum
+
Total price
Configuring
11/5
Configuring
Both subunits have on board I/Os. Actuators and sensors are connected to the sub units by means of special front connectors for the F model. As the output voltage of the failsafe outputs (both on board and external) is switched off for about 5 ms for internal testing, only ac tuators for which sufficient backup can be provided can be used.
The memory submodules in both subunits must be iden tical and contain the same user program. Safety opera tion is only possible with EPROM submodules. For test purposes the pro gram can also be loaded into the internal RAM.
Nonsafetyrelated I/Os are connected in a singlechan nel configuration. The I/O modules used are only pro totypetested modules of the S5100U.
Safetyrelated modules can also be used in a single channel configuration. The input and output function is then, however, not failsafe.
The modules are addressed according to slot. Special addressing rules apply.
Safetyrelated I/Os are con nected in a twochannel configuration. For every slot in subunit A there is an equivalent slot in subunit B (e.g. slot 0 and slot 1, slot 14 and slot 15). S Only safety-related modules may be used. S Each subunit must contain the same set of safetyre lated modules. Correspond ing modules must be plugged into equivalent slots.
S
Only the address in subunit A need be specified in the user program. The operating system of the S595F han dles the addressing of the equivalent slots in subunit B. S Safetyrelated sensors are always wired in parallel to both of the equivalent safe tyrelated digital input mod ules. S Nonsafetyrelated sensors are always present in dupli cate. Each sensor is wired to one of the subunits.
S S
Actuators are driven by both of the equivalent safetyre lated digital output modules. Since the output voltage of the failsafe outputs is switched off for approxi mately 5 ms (see above), sufficient backup should be provided for the actuators.
A failsafe PLC must be con figured and programmed before it can be started up. During configuring, safetyre lated parameters and the hardware configuration are defined. The processoriented functions of the system are programmed.
S
When the S595F is started for the first time, all the F pa rameters are automatically determined or preset values transferred. The S595F thus starts without being config ured by the user.
The configuring data can be modified by means of the COM 95 F parameter assignment software. During operation, the S595F acts as being a singlechan nel S595U. The programming device is only connected to one sub unit. All functions carried out on a programming device are au tomatically carried out on both subunits. The S595F is programmed in the same way as the S595U, i.e. by means of the STEP 5 programming lan guage in its various meth ods of representation.
Only one user program is created for both subunits. S Only the controller function is set in the user program. S During startup, COM 95F additionally assists the user in error diagnostics and documentation.
S
11/6
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
DI 2ch. DI 2ch.
Subunit A
DI 2ch. DI 2ch.
Sensor
Subunit B DI Subunit A DI Subunit B 24 V I/O type B; binary input, safety oriented, singlechan nel and failsafe sensor, no line monitoring I/O type C; binary input, safety oriented, twochannel sensor, no line monitoring I/O type D; binary input, safety related singlechannel and failsafe sensor, with line monitoring (e.g. for presses) I/O type E; binary input, safety related, twochannel sensor, with line monitoring (presses) I/O type F (095-8FB01 onwards); binary input, safety-re lated, sensor two-channel with line moni toring 2 x FDI 2 x FDI 6ES5 431-8FA11 On board I/Os
DI 2ch. DI 2ch.
Sensor
Subunit A
DI 2ch. DI 2ch.
Sensor
I/O type G.2 binary input, safety-re lated, 2 sen sors exclu sive OR
4 x FDI or 4 x FDI
Sensor I/O type G.3; binary input, safety-re lated, sensor exclusive OR 1 x DI 1 x DI 1 x DI 1 x DI 1 x DI 1 x DI 1 x FDI 1 x DI 1 x DI/DA 2 x FDI or 2 x FDI 6ES5 421-8MA12 6ES5 430-8MB11 6ES5 430-8MC11 6ES5 431-8MA11 6ES5 431-8MC11 6ES5 431-8MD11 6ES5 431-8FA11 6ES5 433-8MA11 6ES5 482-8MA13 6ES5 431-8FA11 Onboard I/Os
Subunit A
Sensor
Sensor 2
1 x DO 2 x FDI 1 x DO 2 x FDI
DO Subunit A or B DI Subunit A DI Subunit B DO Subunit A or B DI Subunit A DI Subunit B DA Sensor 1a Subunit A DA DI Subunit B DI Sensor 1 Sensor
DI 2ch. DA 2ch.
Subunit A
DA 2ch. DI 2ch.
Subunit B 1 x DO 2 x FDI 1 x DO 2 x FDI On board I/Os 6ES5 431-8FA11 On board I/Os On board I/Os
DI 1ch. DI 1ch.
Subunit A
DI 1ch. DI 1ch.
Subunit 2
6ES5 421-8MA12 6ES5 430-8MB11 6ES5 430-8MC12 6ES5 431-8MA11 6ES5 431-8MC11 6ES5 431-8MD11 6ES5 431-8FA11 6ES5 433-8MA11 6ES5 482-8MA13 6ES5 450-8FA11 6ES5 450-8FA12 6ES5 441-8MA11 6ES5 450-8MB11 6ES5 450-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MA11 6ES5 451-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MR12 6ES5 452-8MR11 6ES5 453-8MA11 6ES5 482-8MA13
2 x DA 2 x FDI or 2 x DA 2 x FDI
Subunit A
Sensor 1b
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/7
Configuring
DI 1ch. DI 2ch.
Subunit A
DI 2ch. DI 1ch.
Sensor
Actua tor
DQ Subunit B (source output) I/O type H2; binary input, safety-re lated, faulttolerant 2 sensors 4 x FDI 6ES5 431-8FA11 DQ Subunit A DQ Subunit B Sensor I/O type H3; binary input, safety-re lated, faulttolerant 3 sensors 4 x FDI 6ES5 431-8FA11 AI Subunit A and B UI Sensor I/O type P; binary input, not safety-re lated 1 x AI 1 x AI 1 x AI 1 x AI 1 x AI 1 x FAI 6ES5 464-8MA21 6ES5 464-8MB11 6ES5 464-8MC11 6ES5 464-8MD11 6ES5 464-8ME11 6ES5 464-8MG11 0V 0V 24V I/O type N; binary output, safety-re lated, actua tor fail-safe 2 x FDQ
Subunit B
DI 1ch. DI 2ch.
6ES5 450-8FA12
Sensor
Sensor
Subunit A
DI 2ch. DI 1ch.
Sensor
Subunit B
Sensor I/O type J; binary output not safety-re lated 1 x FDQ 1 x FDQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DQ 1 x DI/DQ 2 x FDQ 2 x FDQ 2 x FDQ 6ES5 450-8FA11 6ES5 450-8FA12 6ES5 441-8MA11 6ES5 450-8MB11 6ES5 450-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MA11 6ES5 451-8MD11 6ES5 451-8MR12 6ES5 452-8MR11 6ES5 453-8MA11 6ES5 482-8MA13 6ES5 450-8FA11 6ES5 450-8FA12 On-board I/Os I/O type R4.2; analog input, safety-related 2 x AI 6ES5 464-8MG11
DQ Subunit A or B Actuator
DQ Subunit A Stellglied
3 x AI
6ES5 464-8MG11
DQ Subunit B
24 V
I/O type L; 2 x FDQ binary output, 2 x FDQ safety-re lated, cou 2 x FDQ pling relay, diverse
3 x AI
6ES5 464-8MG11
Actua tor 0V
11/8
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
AI AI Subunit A AI AI Subunit B
Sensor 1 Sensor 2
AI Subunit A AI Sensor 1
AI AI AI Subunit A AI AI AI Subunit B
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/9
Configuring
11/10
PLC Modules Subunit A Slot number
B
Price
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 Qty.
6ES5 4318FA11
6ES5 4218MA12 6ES5 4308MB11 6ES5 4308MC11 6ES5 4318MA11 6ES5 4318MC11 6ES5 4318MD11 6ES5 4338MA11 6ES5 4508FA11
6ES5 4418MA11 6ES5 4508MB11 6ES5 4508MD11 6ES5 4518MA11 6ES5 4518MD11 6ES5 4528MR11 6ES5 4538MA11 6ES5 4518MR12 6ES5 4828MA13
6ES5 4648MG11
Safetyoriented 8 x 24 V DC digital input module Digital input 8 x 24 V DC module 5) 4 x 24 to 60 V DC 4 x 115 V AC 8 x 24 V DC 8 x 115 V AC 8 x 230 V UC 8 x 5/24 V DC Safetyoriented 4 x 24 V DC digital output module Digital output 8 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 5) 4 x 24to 60 V DC;0.5 A 4 x 115to230V AC;1A 8 x 24 V DC; 1 A 8 x 115/230VDC; 0.5A 4 x relay output 8 x 5/24 V DC; 0.1 A Relay output 8 x 30 V DC/230 V AC Dig. I/O 16 in., 16 out., module5) 24 V DC Safety 4 x 4 to 20 mA related analog input Analog input 4 x 50 mV module 5) 4 x 1 V 4 x 10 V 4 x 20 mA 4 x + 4 to 20 mA Analog output 3 x 10 V module 5) 3 x 20 mA 3 x + 4 to 20 mA 2 x 1 to 5 V Counter module 385B5) 500 kHz Timer module 2 x 0.3 to 300 s Comparator module 2 x 0.5 to 20 mA/ 0.5 to 10 V Simulation module (DI or DO)
6ES5 4648MA21 6ES5 4648MB11 6ES5 4648MC11 6ES5 4648MD11 6ES5 4648ME11 6ES5 4708MA12 6ES5 4708MB12 6ES5 4708MC12 6ES5 4708MD12 6ES5 3858MB11 6ES5 3808MA11 6ES5 4618MA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
6ES5 7888MA11
Closed-loop control module IP 262 Closed-loop control module IP 2625); step controller Positioning module IP 263 El. cam controller IP 264 Positioning module IP 266 2) Stepper motor controller IP 267 Communications processor CP 521 SI Communic. processor CP 521 BASIC Communications processor CP 2433 20 20 20 150 140 140 200
2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2)
20 20
64 64
Siemens ST 50 1998 4 4 Total current I 1 A Qty. each total Front connector 40pin; screw6) Front connector 40pin; crimp7) (increas. EMC prot.) 40pin, w/o crimp cont.7) 40pin, screw7) Sub D connector 9pin, plug 712 connecting cable Length: 0.5 m/1.7 ft 2.5 m/8.3 ft 5.0 m/16.5 ft 10.0 m/32.8 ft 6ES5 4908MB11 6ES5 4908MA13 6ES5 4908MA03 6ES5 4908FB11 6ES5 7502AA11 6ES5 7128AF00 6ES5 7128BC50 6ES5 7128BF00 6ES5 712-8CB00 Price Item Order No. Qty. Price each total Sum Sum
6ES5 2638MA13 6ES5 2648MA11 6ES5 2668MA11 6ES5 2678MA11 6ES5 5218MA21 6ES5 5218MB12 6GK1 2433SA00
Bus unit (screw connection) Bus unit (crimp connection)7) Bus unit (screw connection)7)
1) 2) 3) 4) 5)
Maximum configuration: 2 tiers Maximum configuration: 4 tiers (one IM 316F per tier) Maximum permissible number (S): 352 data bits, max. 256 of which from analog modules (per tier) 16 bit for each active channel Reduced electromagnetic compatibility according to IEC 801
Accessories
Item
Order No.
Memory submodule
Backup battery DIN rail 483 mm/18.84 in for 19 in cabinets 530mm/20.67in for 600mm/23.4in cab. 830mm/32.37in for 900mm/35.1in cab. Length: 2000 mm/78 in Fiber optic cable 1 m/3.3 ft 2 m/6.6 ft 5 m/16.5 ft 10 m/32.8 ft
6ES5 3751LA15 6ES5 3751LA21 6ES5 3751LA41 6ES5 9800MA11 6ES5 7108MA11 6ES5 7108MA21 6ES5 7108MA31 6ES5 7108MA41 6ES5 7221BB00 6ES5 7221BC00 6ES5 7221BF00 6ES5 7221CB00
+ =
Total price
Configuring
11/11
Configuring
Dimensions S5-90U
Dimensions in mm/in
91.5/3.6 91/3.5
81/3.1
135/5.2 149/5.8
approx. 40/1.5
97/3.7
5.3/0.2
81/3.1
135/5.2
12/0.4
S5-100U
Dimensions in mm/in
127/4.9
45.4/ 1.7
91.5/3.5
91.5/3.5
11/12
Siemens ST 50 1998
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/14
Slot No.
PS
B B
General accessories (No., see below) Ad t casing Adapter i required i d (D) Fan subassembly required (D) Price each total
B
D D 5 5 5 5 D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 7 7 5
Module type CPU CPU 941, CPU 942 CPU 943, CPU 944 with 1/2 interfaces CPU 945 Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC module d l 16 x 24...48 V UC 16 x 48...60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5...15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module d l 16 x 24...60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48...115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5...24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs; 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs; 16 outputs 0.5 A output t t 24 V DC: 16 inputs; 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs; 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs; 24 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module d l 4 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module d l 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA Power output module (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Intelligent g IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. I/O IP 241 for counting and pos. dec. modules d l IP 242A for counting6) IP 242B for counting IP 243 for analog value processing IP 244 for temperature control
5 5 6 4
Order No. 6ES5 94.7UB11 6ES5 94.7UB.1 6ES5 9457UA.3 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4534LA12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31
A 0.16 0.2/0,45 0.55/1,251) 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.82) 1.02), 3) 1.1 1.1 0,6 0.4
Siemens ST 50 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.05 0.6 0.8 0.52) 0.752) 1.52) 0.55 0.13 1.0 1.0 0,7 0.01/14) 0.05/24)
D 7 IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control5) 6ES5 2604UA11 D 7 IP 261 for proportioning5) 6ES5 2614UA11 D 7 IP 281 for counting 6ES5 2814U.12 D 7 IP 288 for positioning 6ES5 2884UA11 D 7 WF 705 for position decoding 6FM1 7053AA00 D 7 WF 706 for contr. pos., 3channel 6FM1 7063AA20 D 7 WF 706 for contr. pos., 6channel 6FM1 7063AB20 D 7 WF 707 for cam controller module 6FM1 7073AA10 D 3 CPU 523 for pointtopoint link 6ES5 5233UA11 3 CPU 530 for SINEC L1, block type 6ES5 5307LA12 D 3 CPU 530 for SINEC L1, compact 6ES5 5303LA12 D CP 2430 (I/OBetrieb) fr ASInterface 6GK1 2430SA10 IM 305 interface module 6ES5 3057L.11 7 IM 306 interface module 6ES5 3067LA11 Total current for central controller 1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the respective sensor matching module for each channel used.4)Power consumption/current supply to the EU5)Not in conjunction with CPU 945
Total current of the central controller and central expansion units (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HB.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Short fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
6ES5 4974U...
+ =
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/15
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/16
Slot No.
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 IM Qty.
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) F subassembly Fan b bl required i d (D)
D D
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
Module type CPU CPU 941, CPU 942 CPU 943, CPU 944 with 1/2 interfaces CPU 945 Digital g 32 x 24 V DC p input 32 x 24 V DC 16 x 24...48 V UC module 16 x 48...60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5...15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A p output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24...60 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48...115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 32 x 5...24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ p / 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output p 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A module 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs p input 8/16 inputs 4 inputs module 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output p 8 outputs, 10 V 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA module Power output module 5) (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Intelligent g IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. / I/O IP 241 for counting and pos. dec. 5) modules IP 242A for counting 5), 6) IP 242B for counting 5) IP 243 fr analog value processing IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/O for contr. pos., incremental IP 246 I/O for contr. pos., absolute IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control5) IP 261 for proportioning5) IP 281 for counting
3 3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 4 5 5 6 5 5 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 3/7 7 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 94.7UB11 6ES5 94.7UB.1 6ES5 9457UA.3 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12
Current cons. at 5V Sum A A 0.16 0.2/0.45 0.55/1.251) 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.82) 1.02), 3) 1.1 1.1 0,4 0.4 1.32) 1.32) 0.8 2.3 0.05 0.6
Siemens ST 50 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 7 7 3 3 7 7 7 7 3 3 7 7 3 3 7 7 D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 D D D D D 3 7 7
6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063AA20 6FM1 7063AB20 6FM1 7073AA10 6FM1 7213AA20 6FM1 7233.A.0 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA13 6ES5 5443UA11 6AV1 2420AB.0 6ES5 5263LA22
6AV4 0120AA100AB0
6ES5 5307LA12 6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 5431AA00 6GK1 1430AA01 6GK1 1430AB01 6GK1 1473MA00 6ES5 5163UA11 1.8 0.5 0.810) 1.5 0.01/110) 0.05/210) 1 0.5 0.6 0.7 1.5 1.0
0.52) 0.752) 1.52) 0.55 1.02) 1.32) 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 1.5 2.3 1.8 1.0 1.0 0,7 0.45 2.5 4.5 4.2 0.8
WF 705 for position decoding 4) WF 706 for contr. pos., 3channel 4) WF 706 for contr. pos., 6channel 4) WF 707 cam controller module 4) WF 721 for contr. positioning 4) WF 723 for contr. positioning 4) Commu CP 523 for pointtopoint link nications CP 524 for pointtopoint link process CP 544 for pointtopoint link p CP 527 for HMI sors CP 526/527 for HMI, exp. module CP 528 for HMI, digital or analog CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact CP 2430 (I/O, Kachelbetr.) f. ASInterf. CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP1430 TF for Industrial Ethernet CP 1430 TF for Industrial Etnernet CP 1473 MAP 10) Special p CP 516 applica pp CP 581, SIMATIC PC, modular - Basic module tions - Mass storage module 6) - Slot module (max. 2) 7) IM 304 interface module IM 305 interface module IM 306 interface module IM 307 interface module IM 308 interface module 4) IM 308C interface module only y for CPU 942H S5115H IM 304, int. module, CC int., 2nd CC IM 324R, int. mod., CC int., 1st CC Total current for central controller
6ES55811ED13 6ES5 5813LA11 6ES5 5810RA12 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3057L.11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3083UA12 6ES5 3083UC11 6ES5 9427UH11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3243UR11
1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the respective sensor matching module for each channel used.4)Not for S5115H5)Not in conjunction with CPU 945.6)The mass storage module can only be plugged in directly on the right next to the basic module7) Slot modules can be plugged in directly on the right next to the basic, mass storage or slot module. 8) Without pluggedin AT modules9) For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 10) Not for S5115F
Total current of the central controller and central expansion units (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs) 1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HB.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Short fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
6ES5 4974U...
+ =
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/17
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/18
Slot No.
PS
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Fan subassembly required (D) Cross modules required
3 3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 D D 5 5 5 5 D 5 4 6 6
Order No. 6ES5 94.7UB11 6ES5 94.7UB.1 6ES5 9457UA3 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.2 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09
Current cons. at 5V A 0.16 0.2/0.45 0.55/1.251) 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25
Module type CPU 941, CPU 942 CPU CPU 943, CPU 944 with 1/2 interfaces CPU 945 32 x 24 V DC Digital g input 32 x 24 V DC module 16 x 24...48 V UC 16 x 48...60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 16 x 5...15 V DC 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A Digital g output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24...60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48...115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5...24 V DC; 0.1 AV 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 24 V DC: 16 Inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A Digital g input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A 8 inputs Analog g input 8/16 inputs module 4 inputs 8/16 inputs 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA Analog output t t 8 outputs, 10 V module 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA Power output module (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A)
6ES5 4707LB12
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 3 D 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 3 7 7 7 4
Siemens ST 50 1998
7
IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. IP 241 for counting and pos. dec. IP 242A for counting 5) IP 242B for counting IP 243 fr Analogwertverarbeitung IP 244 for temperature control IP 260 for high speed cl.loop control IP 261 for proportioning 5) IP 281 for counting IP 288 for positioning WF 705 for position decoding WF 706 for contr. pos., 3channel WF 706 for contr. pos., 6channel WF 707 cam controller module CP 523 for pointtopoint link CP 530 for SINEC L1, block type CP 2430 (I/OBetrieb) fr ASInterface IM 305 interface module IM 306 interface module Total current for central controller
6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12 6ES5 2884UA11 6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063AA20 6FM1 7063AB20 6FM1 7073AA10 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5307LA12 6GK1 2430SA10 6ES5 3057L.11 6ES5 3067LA11
0.8 2) 1.0 2), 3) 1.1 1.1 0.6 0.4 0.05 0.6 0.8 0.5 2) 0.75 2) 1.5 2) 0.55 0.13 1.0 0.7 0.01/1 4) 0.05/2 4)
1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the respective sensor matching module for each channel used4)Power consumption/current supply to the EU5)Not in conjunction with CPU 945
Total current of the central controller and central expansion units (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU
+
CC
3/6
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907...1 6ES5 4974U...
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
+ =
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/19
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/20
Slot No.
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM Qty.
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) F subassembly b bl required i d (D) Fan A 0.16 0.2/0.45 0.2/0.45
0.5/1.251)
5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5)
D D
D D
5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5) 5)
D D
Module type CPU CPU 941, CPU 942 CPU 943, CPU 944 with 1/2 interfaces CPU 945 Digital g 32 x 24 V DC p 32 x 24 V DC input 16 x 24 ... 48 V UC module 16 x 48 ... 60 V DC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5 ... 15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A p 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 16 x 24 V DC ... 60 V; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 ... 115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115 V ... 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5 ... 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ p / 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output p 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A module 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs p 8/16 inputs input 4 inputs module 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 ... 20 mA 8 outputs, 10 V output p 8 outputs, 1 ... 5 V; 4 ... 20 mA mod. Power ouput module5),6) (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Intelli IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. g IP 241 for counting and pos. dec.5) gent IP 242A for counting5), 6) I/O / modules IP 242B for counting5) IP 243 for analog value processing IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., incremental IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., absolute IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control IP 261 for proportioning IP 281 for counting WF 705 for position decoding5) WF 706 for contr. pos. 3channel5)
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 3 3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 4 5 5 5 5 5 7 7 7 7 4 7 7 7 7 3/7 7 7 7 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 94.7UB11 6ES5 94.7UB.1 6ES5 9457UA.3 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464U. .1 6ES5 2464U.1 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 281 4U.12 6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063AA20 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.12 0,05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.82) 1.02),3) 1.1 1.1 0.6 0.4 1.32) 1.32) 0.82) 2.3 0.05 0.6 0.53) 0.753)
Siemens ST 50 1998
6FM1 7063AB20 6FM1 7073AA10 6FM1 7213AA20 6FM1 7233.A.0 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA15 6ES5 5443U.11 6AV1 2420AB.0
D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 3 3 7 7 7 3 3
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D 7 3 3 7 7 7 D D D D D 7 7 7 7 3 7 7
WF 706 for contr. pos. 6channel5) WF 707 for cam controller module5) WF 721 for contr. positioning5) WF 723 for contr. positioning5) Commu CP 523 for pointtopoint link nications CP 524 for pointtopoint link CP 544 for pointtopoint link proces p CP 527 for HMI sors CP 528 for HMI digital or analog CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact CP 2430 (I/O, page operation) f. AS interf. CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP 1430 TF for Ind. Ethernet CP 1430 FT for Ind. Ethernet CP 1473 MAP for Ind. Ethernet5) Special CP 516 applica pp IM 304 interface module IM 305 interface module tions IM 306 interface module IM 307 interface module IM 308 interface module IM 308C interface module Anschaltung only for CPU 942H IM 308C Anschaltung IM 308C S5115H IM 304 int. module, CC int., 2nd CC IM 324R int. mod., CC int., 1st CC Total current for central controller
6ES5 5307LA12 6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 5431AA00 6GK1 1430AA01 6GK1 1430AB01 6GK1 1473MA00 6ES5 5163UA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3057L.11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3083UA12 6ES5 3083UC11 6ES5 9427UH11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3243UR11
6AV40120AA100AB0
1,53) 0.55 1.03) 1.33) 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 1.5 1.8 1.0 1.0 0.7 0,45 2.5 4.5 0.45 0.8 1.5 0.01/14) 0.05/24) 1 0.5 0.6 0.7 1.5 1.0
1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the respective sensor matching module for each channel used4)Power consumption/current supply to EU5)Nor for S5115H 6)Not in conjunction with CPU 9457) For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 8) Not for S5115F
Total current for the central controller and central expansion units (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37 ...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907 ...1 6ES5 4974U ...
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Frontconnector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
Sum
+
Total price of expansion units
=
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/21
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/22
Slot No.
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM Qty.
General accessories (No., ( , see below) ) Adapter casing required (D) Fan subassembly required (D) A 0.16 0.2/0.45
0.55/1.251)
D D
3 3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 4 5 5 5
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 3/7 7 7 7 7
Module type CPU CPU 941, CPU 942 CPU 943, CPU 944 with 1/2 interfaces CPU 945 Digital 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 24 V DC input 16 x 24 ... 48 V UC module 16 x 48 ... 60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5 ... 15 V DC Digital 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 16 x 24 V DC ... 60 V; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 ... 115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115 V ... 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5 ... 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A Digital 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A module 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog 8 inputs 8/16 inputs input 4 inputs module 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 ... 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module d l 8 outputs, 1 ... 5 V; 4 ... 20 mA Power output module5) (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Intelli IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. gent g IP 241 for counting and pos. dec.5) I/O IP 242A for counting5), 6) modules d l IP 242B for counting5) IP 243 for analog value processing IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., incremental IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., absolute IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control 6) IP 261 for proportioning 6) IP 281 for counting WF 705 for position decoding5)
5 5 7 7 7 7 4
Order No. 6ES5 94.7UB11 6ES5 94.7UB.1 6ES5 9457UA.3 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464U ..1 6ES5 2464U ..1 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 281 4U.12 6FM1 7053AA00 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.8 2) 1.0 2),3) 1.1 1.1 0.6 0.4 1.3 2) 1.3 2) 0.8 2) 2.3 0.05 0.6 0.5 2)
Siemens ST 50 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 7 D 7 3 3 3 7 7 7 7 7 3 3 7 7 7 7 3 3
6FM1 7063AA20 6FM1 7063AB20 6FM1 7073AA10 6FM1 7213AA20 6FM1 7233.A.0 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA13 6ES5 5443U.11 6AV1 2420AB.0 6ES5 5263LA22
WF 706 for contr. pos., 3channel5) WF 706 for contr. pos., 6channel5) WF 707 for cam controller module5) WF 721 for contr. positioning5) WF 723 for contr. positioning5) CP 523 for pointtopoint link CP 524 for pointtopoint link CP 544 for pointtopoint link CP 527 for HMI CP526/527 for HMI, exp. module CP 528 for HMI, digital or analog7) CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact CP 2430 (I/O, page operation) f. AS interf. CP 5431 FMS 2.5 4.5 4.2 0.8
6AV40120AA100AB0
0.75 2) 1.5 2) 0.55 1.0 2) 1.32) 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 1.5 2.3 1.8 1.0 1.0 0.7 0.45
6GK1 1430AA01
6GK1 1430AB01
6GK1 1473MA00
6ES5 5163UA11
CP 516 CP 581, SIMATIC PC, modular -Basic module -Mass storage module8) -Slot module (max. 2)9) IM 304 interface module IM 305 interface module IM 306 interface module IM 307 interface module IM 308 interface module5) IM 308C interface module
D D D 7 7 7 7
6ES5 5811ED13 6ES5 5813LA11 6ES5 5810RA12 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3057L .11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3083UA12 6ES5 3083UC11 0.7 1.5 1.0
+
3rd EU
+
CC
3 CPU 942H 6ES5 9427UH11 D 7 IM 304 int. module, CC int. 2nd CC 6ES5 3043UB11 D 7 IM 324R int. module, CC int. 1st CC 6ES5 3243UR11 Total current for central controller 1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the resprective sensor matching module for each channel used4)Power consumption/current supply EU5)Not for S5115H6)Not in conjunction with CPU 9457)Available soon for S5115H8)Mass storage module can only be plugged in directly to the right of the basic module9)Slot modules can be plugged in directly to the right of the basic, mass storage or slot module 10)Without pluggedin AT modules11)For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 12) Not for S5115F + Total current of the central controller and central expansion units 1st EU 2nd EU (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB217NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC without fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37 ...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907 ...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front conector 490 crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
+ =
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/23
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/24
Slot No.
0 1 2 3 4 5 IM Qty.
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.01/1 0.05/21)
Order No. 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC module d l 16 x 24 ... 48 V UC 16 x 48 ... 60 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module d l 16 x 24 V ... 60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 ... 115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115 V ... 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5 ... 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V UC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0,5 A I/O 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module d l 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module
6ES5 4657LA13
8 outputs, 10 V; 0 ... 20 mA 6ES5 4707LA12 5 8 outputs, 10 V 6ES5 4707LB12 5 8 outputs, 1 ... 5 V; 4 ... 20 mA 6ES5 4707LC12 5 Power output module2) (max. 1.25 A) 6ES5 7767LA13 IM 305 interface module 6ES5 3057L.11 7 IM 306 interface module 6ES5 3067LA11 Total current (carried over, where applicable, to the configuring sheets of a central contoller or of a distributed expansion unit) 1)Power consumption/current supply to EU 2)Not for S5115H
Siemens ST 50 1998
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Price each total
Order Nr. 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 0.15 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0,01/1 0.05/21)
A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC d l module 16 x 24 to 48 V UC 16 x 48 to 60 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module d l 16 x 24 V DC to 60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 to 115 V DC; 1 A 16 x 115 to 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 to 230 V AC; 1 A 32 x 5 to 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A I/O 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module d l 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 ouputs 1.5 A Analog 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module
6ES5 4657LA13
5 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 to 20 mA 6ES5 4707LA12 5 8 outputs, 10 V 6ES5 4707LB12 5 8 outputs, 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA 6ES5 4707LC12 5 Power output modules2) (max. 1,25 A) 6ES5 7767LA13 IM 305 interface module 6ES5 3057L .11 7 IM 306 interface module 6ES5 3067LA11 Total current (carried over, where applicable, to the configuring sheets of a central controller or a distributed expansion unit) 1)Power consumption/current supply to EU 2)Not for S5115H
Accessories
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/25
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/26
Slot No.
PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM Qty.
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) F subassembly b bl required i d (D) Fan A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.13
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC module 16 x 24 ... 48 V UC 16 x 48 ... 60 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5 ... 15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 ... 60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 ... 115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5 ... 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A I/O 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module 4 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 ... 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V 12) mod mod. 8 outputs, 1 ... 5 V; 4 ... 20 mA Power output module2) (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Commu CP 523 pointtopoint link nication sproces sor
Order No. 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 5233UA11
Siemens ST 50 1998
7 D D D D 7 7 7
Siemens ST 50 1998
IM 306 interface module (always req.) IM 314 interface module IM 317 interface module IM 318 interface module2) 313 monitoring module2) Total current for expansion unit
6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3143UA11 6ES5 3173UA11 6ES5 3183UA11 6ES5 3133AA12
Total current for expansion unit and central expansion units connected to ER 701-2 (carried over from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB217NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC without fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907 ...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
Sum
+
Total price of central expansion units connected to ER 7012
=
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/27
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/28
Slot No.
PS 0 Sum A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM Qty.
Component list
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) F subassembly b bl required i d (D) Fan Cross modules required
D D
D D D D D D D
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 4 5 5 5 5 5 7 7 7 7 4
D D
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC p input 32 x 24 V DC module 16 x 24...48 V UC 16 x 48...60 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5...15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A p output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24...60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48...115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5...24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ p / 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output p 24 V DC: 16 inptus, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs input p 8/16 inputs module 4 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output p 8 outputs, 10 V module 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA Power output module 5) (max. 1.25 A) (max. 2.5 A) Intelli IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. gent g IP 241 for counting and pos. dec.5) I/O / IP 242A for counting5), 6) modules IP 242B for counting5) IP 243 for analog value processing IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., incremental7) IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., absolute7) IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control7) IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control6) IP 261 for proportioning6) IP 281 for counting WF 705 for position decoding5),8) WF 706 for contr. pos., 3channel5),8) WF 706 for contr. pos., 6channel5),8) WF 707 for cam controller module5),8) WF 721 for contr. positioning5),8) WF 723 for contr. positioning5),8)
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D 7 7 7 7 3/7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA13 6ES5 4707LB13 6ES5 4707LC13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 7767LA13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464UB31 6ES5 2464UA11 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12 6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063AA20 6FM1 7063AB20 6FM1 7073AA10 6FM1 7213AA20 6FM1 7233.A.0
Current cons. at 5V A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.09 0.09 0.82) 1.0 2), 3) 1.1 1.1 0.6 0.4 1.32) 1.32) 0.82) 2.3 0.05 0.6 0.52) 0.752) 1.52) 0.55 1.02) 1.32)
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 2.3 1.5 1.8 1.0 1.0 0.33 0,7 0.45 2.5 4.5 4.2 0.8
D D D D D 7 7 7 7 7
CP 523 for pointtopoint link CP 524 for pointtopoint link7) CP 544 for pointtopoint link CP 526 for HMI, expansion module7) CP 527 for HMI7) CP 528 for HMI analog7) CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype7) CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact7) CP 5430 TF for PROFIBUS7) CP 2430 (I/O, page operation) f. AS interf. CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP 1430 TF for Ind. Ethernet CP 1430 TF for Ind. Ethernet CP 1473 MAP for Ind. Ethernet10) CP 516
6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA13 6ES5 5443U.11 6ES5 5263LA22 6AV1 2420AB.0
6ES5 5307LA12 6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 5430AA01 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 5431AA00 6GK1 1430AA00 6GK1 1430AB01 6GK1 1473MA00 6ES5 5163UA11
6AV4 0120AA100AB0
IM 306 interface module IM 307 interface module IM 314 interface module IM 317 interface module IM 318 interface module5) 313 monitoring module5) Total current for expansion unit
6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3143UA11 6ES5 3173UA11 6ES5 3183UA11 6ES5 3133AA12
1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Allowance must also be made for the respective sensor matching module for each channel used4)Power consumption/current supply EU5)Not for S5115H6)Not in connection with CPU 945 7)Only for interface module IM 314 or IM 317 8)Only for interface module IM 3149) For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 10) Not for S5115F
Total current for expansion unit and central expansion units (carried over from configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU
+
CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
6ES5 4974U...
Sum
+
Total price of central expansion units connected to ER 7013 Total price
Configuring
S5115U
11/29
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Addressing intelligent I/Os and CPs at S5-115U Addressing intelligent I/Os and CPs When configuring, attention must be paid to the address assignment of all modules used. The intelligent I/O modules and communica tions processors can be ad dressed in different address areas and therefore require different ad dress widths. Addressing also depends on the CPU. For ex ample, these modules can only be addressed in the page area or P area in the case of the CPU 942H and only in the P area when using the CPU 942F.
CPU 945
Module
CPU 942H
Address area Page 1 2 2 4 1 1 2/4/83) 1 42) 42) 42) 42) 1/43) 1/2/4/83) P 16 8 1) 8 32 2 2 8 8 32 8
2) 2)
Address area Q 16 8 8 32 8 8 32 8
1) 1)
IP 240 IP 241 IP 242A IP 242B IP 243 IP 2444) IP 246 I/A IP 247 IP 252 IP 260 IP 261 IP 281 WF 705, WF 706, WF 707 WF 721, WF 723A/B/C CP 523 CP 524 CP 544 CP 527, CP 528, CP 530 CP 5430 TF CP 5431 FMS CP 143 FMS CP 1473 MAP CP 516 CP 581
IM 3 32
IM 4 32
P 16 8 8 32 2 2 8 8
1) 1)
Table 1: Address widths required (in byte) for the individual address areas of intelligent I/O modules and communications processors, depending on the CPU used.
1) 2) 3) 4)
Addressing in absolute area with a width of 1 Kbyte Not for CPU 941 Parameterselectable Address width in absolute area: 32 byte
11/30
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Design, I/O types for S5-115H Design In the basic configuration a faulttolerant S5115H program mable controller consists of two subunits each comprising S A CR 7000LB, CR 7002, CR 7002F or CR 7003 sub rack, S A CPU 942H central proces sing unit with memory sub module S A PS 951 power supply module with battery backup. The two subunits are intercon nected via IM 304 and IM 324R interface modules (in adapter casings) and the 721 connecting cable (max. 100 m/330 ft). Both subunits must have the same memory configuration. There are three possible I/O configurations, depending on the degree of availability re quired of the I/O area: S Singlesided configuration S Switched configuration S 2-fold redundant configura tion
S5115U/H/F
I/O types
I/O Type 1 2 3 8 9 10 13 14 15 18 19 20 24 25 Designation Digital input (DI) Digital output (DQ) Analog input (AI) Analog output (AQ) CP/IP Configuration singlesided switched redundant singlesided switched redundant singlesided switched redundant singlesided switched redundant singlesided switched Addresses required including read inputs (RDI) without locating inputs/outputs DI 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte (RDI) DQ AI AQ
Example 10 redundant DIs without error locating (I/O type 3) 5 redundant DIs with error locating (I/O type 3) 8 redundant DQs with error locating (I/O type 10)
1 byte for DIs 1 bit for LDIs 1 bit LDQs 1 byte for DQs 1 bit for LDIs 1 bit for LDQs 8 bits for RDIs
5 DIs per subunit 1 LDIs per subunit 1 LDQ per subunit 8 DQs per subunit 1 LDI per subunit 1 LDQ per subunit 8 RDI (subunit A, B or switched)
Table 3: Examples of addresses and inputs/outputs required for the redundant I/O configuration Legend DI, DQ = Digital input/output or binary input/output AI, AQ = Analog input/output LDI, LDQ = Locating input/output RDI = Readback input
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/31
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Design, I/O types for S5-115H (continued) I/O types (continued) In order to distinguish between the different configurations of the I/O modules including the CPs and IPs, they have been divided into I/O types. Each configuration has its own re sponse mode:
S S
Singlesided configuration with types 1, 8, 13, 18 and 24 The I/O module is perma nently assigned to one of the two subunits. When the corresponding subunit is op erating, the module is active. Information that has been readin is also avail able in the other subunit irre spective of whether it is op erating as the master or standby unit. The I/O address used may not be used in the second subunit.
Switched configuration with types 2, 9, 14, 19 and 25 Only the master unit ad dresses the I/O module. In formation that has been readin is automatically passed to the standby unit, so that if required the latter can continue the process without interruption. Redundant configuration with types 3, 10, 15 and 20 The I/O modules are all pro vided in duplicate. They occupy the same I/O ad dresses in each subunit. In errorfree operation, both I/O modules are active in each case.
Table 2 shows the addresses required for the various I/O modules in singlesided, switched and redundant con figurations. Since the locating inputs and outputs are as signed in groups, no more than 1 byte for the LDIs and 1 byte for the LDQs is normally required per subunit. Table 3 shows some examples of address requirements. It also shows the necessary wir ing. If an input/output byte is occupied by some redundant DI or DQ addresses, it can no longer be used for nonredun dant inputs and outputs.
The redundant I/O configura tion (I/O types 3, 10, 15 and 20) is described on page 11/33.
11/32
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Redundant I/O configuration for S5-115H I/O types for redundant configuration I/O type 3 (redundant digital inputs)
S
S5115U/H/F
I/O type 3 without fault loca tion. If no locating inputs/outputs (LDI, LDQ) have been parameterized, the S5115H continues to operate in the case of a dicrepancy with the value of the master. It is possible that this value is incorrect. If this case cannot be tolerated, the redundant digital inputs (DI) must be operated with fault location. I/O type 3 with fault location. In this case, locating inputs/ outputs (LDI, LDQ) are used in addition to the re dundant digital inputs (DI). As well as recognizing the fault, the operating system can also locate and deacti vate the faulty DI module. The S5115H then continues to operate with the faultfree module only.
DI
Subunit A Sensor
DI
Subunit B
Fig. 11/1 Redundant digital input without fault location L-D Q L-DI
Subunit A
DI
Sensor Subunit B
The LDQ and LDI modules are assigned in groups to the redundant DI modules. A group consists of all the DIs connected to the same sensor supply
DI L-D Q L-DI Fig. 11/2 Redundant digital input with fault location
I/O type 10 is designed for fault recognition with re stricted or complete fault location (depending on the version) for the intermittent outputs. An output is intermit tent if it changes its signal status at least once per hour. Since the RDI readback digi tal inputs are permanently as signed to the redundant digi tal outputs (DQ), just as many RDIs are required as redun dant DQs.
DI
Subunit A
DI
Subunit B
DI
Subunit A or B
Fig. 11/3 Redundant intermittent digital output with restricted fault location
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/33
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
I/O type 10 (redundant, intermittent digtal outputs) (continued) Redundant I/O configuration for S5-115H (continued) I/O type 10 with restricted fault location. If no locating inputs/outputs (LDI, LDQ) are parameter ized, it is only possible to rec ognize and locate "permanent 0 faults" (DQ cannot be switched to "1"). If such a case cannot be tolerated, i. e. it must also be possible to handle "permanent 1 faults", the redundant digital outputs must be operated with fault location. S I/O type 10 with fault loca tion. In this case, locating inputs/ outputs (LDI, LDQ) must be provided in addition to the re dundant digital outputs (DQ) and the readback digital in puts (RDI). The operating system can thus recognize and locate not only "perma nent 0 faults", but can also deactivate the faulty DQ mod ules in the case of "perma nent 1 faults". Together with the LDQs it switches off the load supply of the DQ mod ule briefly and checks the readback signals at the RDIs. The S5115H then con tinues to operate with the faultfree module until the faulty module is repaired.
S L-D Q L-DI M
DQ
Subunit A
R-DI DQ
Subunit B
P L-DI L-D Q Fig. 11/4 Redundant, intermittent digital output with fault location M
Decoupling
The outputs of the redundant digital output modules for 24 V DC connected in parallel must be decoupled with diodes. The same applies to locating outputs.
This I/O type provides fault recognition with restricted fault location in the case of re dundant analog inputs (AI). During fault location, the oper ating system accesses fault information of AI modules via a standard function block. Fault information includes range violation, overrange and wire break. The operating system also reports unac ceptable deviations in input values.
AI
Subunit A
AI
Subunit B
11/34
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Redundant I/O configuration for S5-115H (continued) I/O types for redundant configuration (continued) I/O type 20 (redundant analog outputs) This I/O type does not receive any operating system support in the recognition and locating of faults. The user must pro gram these himself. The out put values are output to both subunits in parallel. Each subunit scans the inputs assigned to it. The user speci fies a "discrepancy time" (10 ms to 320 s) for each digi tal input. This is the maximum permissible time deviation be tween the signals at two re dundant inputs. The operating system monitors this discrep ancy time. If the permis In the case of redundant digi tal outputs, the operating sys tem checks whether an error has occured. If required, the operating system signals the error (entry in error data block). In order to ensure nonstop operation, the operating sys tem must not only detect but also locate faults so that the faulty module can be deacti vated. In the case of digital outputs, faults are recognized and lo cated using auxiliary signals. For redundant digital inputs and outputs fault detection is possible with or without fault locating. For redundant analog inputs and outputs fault detection without fault locating is pos sible. Address assignment The redundant digital input and output modules can only be operated in the process image area (addresses 0 to 127) and the analog input and output modules in the P area (addresses 128 to 255). For nonstop systems, input and output modules with fault locating functions must be used. sible time is exceeded, the operating system locates and reports the error (entry in er ror data block). In the case of analog input modules, the user specifies the maximum permissible value by which the input signals may deviate. This "discrepancy window" is monitored by the ANEI func tion block. The block is sup plied on diskette together with the COM 115H parameteriza tion software.
S5115U/H/F
Redundant inputs
Redundant outputs
For redundant analog outputs there is no error detection. If required, this can be pro grammed by the user (e.g. with readback analog inputs).
In the case of analog outputs, the operating system does not support fault recognition. If necessary, the user can program fault detection and loating himself. Readback inputs, locating inputs and outputs For fault detection of redun dant DQs, readback inputs (RDIs) are necessary; fault location requires locating in puts and outputs (LDI, LDQ).
Readback inputs are perma nently assigned to their re dundant outputs (1 readback input per output pair). Read back inputs can be allocated to subunit A, subunit B or a switched expansion unit. Lo cating inputs and outputs can be grouped for several inputs or outputs, e. g. together in one LDI byte and one LDQ byte per subunit. As a general rule, a maximum of 1 byte per subunit for LDIs and 1 byte per subunit for LDQs is required.
The auxiliary signals LDI, LDQ and RDI required for fault recognition and locating can be operated in the entire P area.
Non-stop operation
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/35
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/36
Slot No.
PS Sum A
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Fan subassembly required (D) Cross modules required
3 3 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6
D D
32 x 24 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 16 x 24...48 V UC 16 x 48...60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 16 x 5...15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module d l 16 x 24...60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48...115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5...24 V DC; 0.1 AV 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output t t 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module d l 1) 4 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V 1) module d l 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA IP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. Intellig gent I/O IP 243 fr Analogwertverarbeitung modules IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., incremental IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., absolute IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control IP 261 for proportioning IP 281 for counting
D D D D D D D D D D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 6 4 5 5 5 7 4 7 7 7 7 3/7 7 7 7
6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 281 4U.12
Current cons. at 5V A 0.7 0.7 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.82) 0.6 0.4 1.32) 1.32) 0.82) 2.3 0.05 0.6
Siemens ST 50 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D D D D 3 3 3/7 7 7 3 3 3 7 3 3 7
Commu nica tions ti proces proces sors 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 1.5 1.8 1.0 1.0 0.33 0.45 2.5 4.5 0.8
CP 523 for pointtopoint link CP 524 for pointtopoint link CP 544 for pointtopoint link CP 527 for HMI CP 528 for HMI, digital or analog CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact CP 5430 TF for PROFIBUS CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP 1431 TF for Ind. Ethernet CP 1431 FT for Ind. Ethernet CP 516
D 7
6AV40120AA100AB0
6ES5 5307LA12 6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 5430AA01 6GK1 5431AA00 6GK1 1430AA01 6GK1 1430AB01 6ES5 5163UA11 1.5 0.01/14) 0.05/24) 1 1.5 1.0
IM 304 IM 305 IM 306 IM 307 IM 304, CC int., 1st CC IM 324R, CC int., 2nd CC Total current for central controller
6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3057L.11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3243UR11
Total current of the central controller and central expansion units (carried forward from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU
+
CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
6ES5 4974U...
Sum
+
Total price of expansion units
=
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/37
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/38
Module Current cons. at 5V Cross modules required
Sum A 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 D D 5 5 5 D D D D D D D 7 3/7 7 7 7 4 7 4 6 6 6
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) F subassembly b bl required i d (D) Fan A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.08 0.01 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.175 0.07 0.035 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.8 2) 0,6 0.4 1.3 2) 1.3 2) 0.8 2.3
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC module 16 x 24 ... 48 V UC 16 x 48 ... 60 V UC 8 x 24 V DC 16 x 115 V UC 16 x 115 V UC 8 x 115 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 16 x 230 V UC 8 x 230 V UC 32 x 5 ... 15 V DC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 ... 60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 48 ... 115 V AC; 1 A 16 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 1 A 8 x 115 ... 230 V AC; 2 A 32 x 5 ... 24 V DC; 0.1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 250 V AC relay contacts 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output 24 V DC; 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC; 8 inputs, 8 ouptuts 2.5 A 24 V DC: 24 inputs, 16 outputs 1.5 A Analog g 8 inputs input 8/16 inputs module 4 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 ... 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module 8 outputs, 1 ... 5 V; 4 ... 20 mA IntelliIP 240 for counting, pos. dec. and pos. gent I/O IP 243 for analog value processing modules IP 244 for temperature control IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., incremental IP 246 I/A for contr. pos., absolute IP 247 for contr. pos. IP 252 for closedloop control
Order No. 6ES5 4207LA11 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4317LA11 6ES5 4327LA11 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LA11 6ES5 4357LB11 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LA11 6ES5 4367LB11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4417LA12 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4537LA11 6ES5 4547LA12 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4557LA11 6ES5 4567LA11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4577LA11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4587LC11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4857LA11 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4657LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D 3 D D D D D D D 3 D 3 3 3 7 3 7 7 D 7 3/7 D 3/7 3 7 7
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.05 0.6 0.13 1.5 >0.91) 2.3 1.5 1.8 1.0 1.0 0.7 0.45 2.5 4.5 2.64) 0.8
7 D 7
6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 281 4U.12 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA13 6ES5 5443U.11 6ES5 5263LA22 6AV1 2420AB.0
IP 260 for highspeed cl.loop control IP 261 for proportioning IP 281 for counting CP 523 for pointtopoint link CP 524 for pointtopoint link CP 544 for pointtopoint link CP 526 forHMI expansion module CP 527 for HMI CP 528 for HMI, digital or analog CP 530 for SINEC L1, blocktype CP 530 for SINEC L1, compact CP 2430 (page operation) for AS interface CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP 1430 TF for Ind. Ethernet CP 1430 for Ind. Ethernet CP 1473 MAP for Ind. Ethernet5) CP 516
6AV40120AA100AB0
6ES5 5307LA12 6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 5431AA00 6GK1 1430T.0. 6GK1 1431AU00 6GK1 1473MA00 6ES5 5163UA11
IM 306 interface module IM 314R interface module Total current for expansion unit
1)Depending on the interface module2)Without sensor supply3)Power consumption/current supply to EU 4)For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 5) Not for S5115F
Total current for expansion unit and central expansion units connected to ER 701-3 (carried over from the configuration sheets for the central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU 3rd EU
+
CC
up to 3A: 6ES5 9517LB21/7NB21; up to 7 A (PLC without fan) or up to 15 A (PLC with fan): 6ES5 9517LD21/7ND51/7ND41
6ES5 4910L.11 6ES5 9810HA.1 6ES5 37 ...... 6XX3 068/6XX3 081 6ES5 4907 ...1
Accessories 1Adapter casing 2Long fan subassembly 24 V DC or 230 V AC 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
Sum
+
Total price of expansion units
=
Total price
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/39
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Design, I/O types for S5-115F Design In the basic configuration, an S5115F programmable con troller consists of 2 subunits each comprising 1 CR 7002F or CR 7000LB subrack, S CPU 942F with memory submodule, S PS 951 power supply mod ule with battery backup, S IM 306 interface module (for address setting).
S
The two subunits are intercon nected via IM 304 and IM 324 interface modules and the 721 connecting cable (max. 10m/33 ft) Both subunits must have the same memory con figuration. Safety operation is only possible with EPROM and EEPROM submodules. The supply voltage is 24 V DC. A transceiver connected to the CPU for interfacing with SINEC L1 or a programming device must have a separate power supply. The relays must meet the reg ulations relating to the techni cal equipment of the plant in question. Sensors: Proof against persistent faults, single-twochannel Sensors are proof against persistent faults if according to their type of construction and certification they cannot initiate a dangerous state of the plant following a default. If sensors are proof against per sistent faults, they can be connected in a singlechannel configuration. Otherwise, two sensors must be used, each of them send ing signals to one subunit. In both cases, the operating system compensates for any small deviations between the switching instance of the two sensors. Sensors: Controllable/ non-controllable A sensor is noncontrollable, if it cannot be powered individu ally via a binary output. Conse quently, in the case of I/O type 3, the (test) signal must be routed via a relay module or a transistor module1).
I/O type (analog) safetyrelated no yes yes no yes yes Type 13 14 15 16 18
Each of the two subunits has 6 or 4 slots for I/O modules. If the number of slots is not sufficient, expansion units with ER 701 subracks can be used. These expansion units with ER 701 subracks can be connected either in central ized configurations using the IM 306 interface module or in distributed configurations us ing the IM 304 and IM 314 in terface module (see Section 3).
I/O types
All input and output modules specified in Section 3 may be used. The interconnections between modules and the type of connection of the signal leads determine the "I/O type". The table below contains the 11 different I/O types and the address space required. For block diagrams see pages 11/43 up to 11/46. The main terms used in the dia grams are explained below: Interrupt evaluation A 4347 digital input module for interrupt evaluation can be plugged into each subunit. In terrupt signals always require a twochannel configuration. They can be regarded as be ing safetyoriented if the fal ling edge triggers an inter rupt. Direct and indirect driving of actuators Binary outputs can drive an actuator either directly or indi rectly, i.e. via relays. Some actuators cannot be driven directly as their technical specifications do not allow this (see data sheet).
Intermittent signals Signals at safetyoriented in puts and outputs are re garded as intermittent if the status changes frequently in response to process events within the second error occur rence period (permissible period of time: e.g. 24 hours): S Binary signals changing to the other output state; S Analog signals changing from the nonsafetyrelated range to the safetyrelated limit value range. Safety-oriented analog output modules These analog output modules can only be implemented if the sensors and actuators are connected as in the following example: An analog output signal is read back by a safety analog input on the ac tuator. In the case of an error, a reset binary output provides an additional shutdown facility for the module. Non-safety-related I/O types These types can only be used for input and output modules which cannot cause a danger ous condition in the case of a defect.
I/O type (digital) Type 1 2 3 8 9 10 Designation Binary input (DI) Binary output (DQ)
11/40
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Characteristics of inputs and outputs, address assignment, scan time for S5-115F Characteristics of inputs and outputs Twochannel and safetyre lated configurations require that some of the inputs and outputs have special charac teristics. Binary inputs At the beginning of each cycle, both subunits generate a process input image. If the operating system detects any deviations when comparing individual input signals, it will repeatedly read these inputs for a certain period of time (discrepancy time). However, if the input signals still deviate at the end of the permitted discrepancy time, a fault re sponse is triggered. The discrepancy time can be configured by the user with the support of the COM 115F parameterization software. If this time is not sufficient for some sensors, it is also pos sible to assign them a spe cific discrepancy time. Nonintermittent (changing) sig nals at binary inputs (type 3) are deactivated and checked once within the selectable test cycle time by means of a test output. This test function need not to be taken into consider ation when developing the user program. Address assignment The addresses of the input and output modules plugged into a subrack can be set on the IM 306 interface module based in the same rack. An exception to this is the ad dress of the 4634 analog in put module and 4534 digital output module, which are set by means of a coding switch ing on the module itself. The module can therefore only be used in the CR 7000LB, CR 7002F and ER 7013 sub racks. Digital modules Word addresses (16 bits) are set for digital modules. The following addresses are per missible S Input modules: 0 to 126 S Output modules: 0 to 124. Binary outputs The operating system checks nonintermittent binary out puts (type 10) once every test cycle. If an output is "1" at that moment, it will be switched to "0" for a short instant (and vice versa) until the associated readback input has responded. When check ing with the "1" signal, the ac tuator is at 0 current since the outputs are checked one after another. This test function need not to be taken into account in the user program. Analog inputs The user can specify in the COM 115F parameterization software how the S5115F PLCs are to respond to de viating analog signals in two channel systems. The deviation tolerances can be entered ei ther absolutely or relative to the average measured value. The operating system unifies the signal values of the two sub units by generating minimum, maximum or average values. Nonintermittent analog inputs (types 14 and 15) are checked by the operating system once within a test cycle via a test analog output. No provisions need be made for this test function in the user program. Analog inputs must be read exclusively by the standard function block FB 250 ANEI. This block is integrated in the operating system and permits safety functions such as range monitoring and wire break detection. Analog outputs The safetyrelated configura tion of analog outputs is not possible. Signal groups All safetyrelated inputs and outputs can be combined to form signal groups using the COM 115F parameterization software. Any fault in one module will then result in pas sivation of all modules in a signal group. Passivated out put modules must be deener gized by the user within a specified second fault occur rence period. The formation of signal groups provides a cer tain degree of independence between function groups, which enhances the availabil ity of the system.
S5115U/H/F
Analog modules Addresses from 128 onwards are available for analog mod ules. A maximum of 64 word addresses can be assigned. This results in the following maximum number of modules: S Eight 4607 analog input modules with 8 word ad dresses S Sixteen 4634 analog input modules with 4 word ad dresses S Eight 4707 analog output modules with 8 word ad dresses. If individual coding has not been preset on the 4607 ana log input module, the same addresses may be used by an output module. The ad dresses used by the 4607 and 4634 analog output va lues must not overlap.
Two-channel input and output modules For twochannel input and output modules, correspond ing modules of the two sub units must be assigned the same addresses. Additional inputs and outputs for testing and readback are assigned to any vacant ad dresses with the COM 115 parameterization software. In the case of analog input types 14 and 15, it is sufficient for inputs with the same mea suring range to have identical analog output values. Single-channel non safetyrelated input and output modules Modules may be distributed over any unassigned slots in the two subunits. However, each address must only be assigned once per system.
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/41
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Characteristics of inputs and outputs, address assignment, scan time for S5-115F (continued) Scan time The scan time of a program is defined by the following S Runtime of the user pro gram S Runtime of the operating system In order to determine the run time of the user program, the execution times of all the statements of the blocks acti vated in a scan must be sum mated. On the average, the execution of 1000 statements is 15 ms. The runtime of the operating system is approx. 60 ms to 250 ms per scan style (ave rage 80 ms). The maximum runtime of the operating sy stem is determined from the following factors S 55 to 80 ms for operating system functions S 5 to 10 ms for additional selftests S 12 to 140 ms for checking I/O modules S 0 to 30 ms for processing discrepancy times Generally, the last two time factors very rarely occur. The additional selftest is not car ried out while checking I/O modules. The scan time can also be ex tended by: S Timecontrolled organization blocks S Interruptdriven organization blocks S The SINEC L1 LAN
11/42
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Block diagrams and module combinations for S5-115F Block diagrams and module combinations
S5115U/H/F
Permissible module combinations 1 x DI or 1 x DI/DQ or 1 x DI or 1 x DI 2 x DI or 2 x DI or 2 x DI 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 482-7LA11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 436-7LC11 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 436-7LC11
DI Subunit A DI Subunit B
DQ
Sensor 1
2 x DI or 2 x DI or 2 x DI
Sensor 2 I/O type 3; binary input; safetyrelated; singlechannel sensor; sensor can be controlled 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI 6ES5 451-7LA11 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 436-7LC11 6ES5 451-7LA11 6ES5 434-7LA12 6ES5 451-7LA11 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 436-7LC11
DQ
I/O type 3; binary input; safetyrelated; twochannel sensor; sensor can be controlled
Sensor 1
Sensor 2 I/O type 3; binary input; safetyrelated; singlechannel sensor; sensor cannot be controlled 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DQ 2 x DI 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 2 x DI 6ES5 458-7LA111) 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 430-7LA11 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 434-7LA11 6ES5 458-7LA111) 6ES5 434-7LA11 6ES5 458-7LA111) 6ES5 430-7LA12 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 430-7LA12
Subunit A or B DI Subunit B
Sensor
DI Subunit A
DQ
Subunit A
DQ
Sensor 1 Sensor 2
I/O type 3; binary input; safetyrelated; twochannel sensor; sensor cannot be controlled
Subunit B DI Subunit B
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/43
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Block diagrams and module combinations for S5-115F (continued) Block diagrams and module combinations (continued)
Block diagram
Permissible module combiantion 1 x DQ or 1 x DQ or 1 x DQ or 1 x DQ or 1 x DQ or 1 x DI/DQ or 1 x DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ or 2 x DI/DQ or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ or 2 x DI/DQ or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 2 x DI/DQ 2 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ or 2 x DI/DQ or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 2 x DI or 2 x DQ 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ or 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ 2 x DI or 1 x DI/DQ 1 x DI/DQ 2 x DI
6ES5 451-7LA11 6ES5 454-7LA11 6ES5 454-7LB11 6ES5 458-7LA111) 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 482-7LA11 6ES5 456-7LB11
DQ Subunit A or B Actuator
DQ
I/O type 9 with intermittent mode, otherwise I/O type 10; binary output; safetyrelated; driven directly Actuator
6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF31 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 436-7LC11 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF31 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 436-7LC11 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF31 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 456-7LB11 6ES5 436-7LC11 6ES5 458-7LB11 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 482-7LF11 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 435-7LC11 6ES5 482-7LF31 6ES5 482-7LF21 6ES5 436-7LC11
Subunit B
DQ
Actuator
I/O type 9 with intermittent mode; otherwise I/O type 10; binary output; safetyrelated; driven indirectly; coupling relay not tested
Subunit B
DQ
Actuator
I/O type 9 with intermittent mode, otherwise I/O type 10; binary output safetyrelated; driven indirectly; coupling relay tested
Subunit B
11/44
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Block diagrams and module combinations for S5-115F (continued) Block diagrams and module combinations (continued)
S5115U/H/F
Characteristics I/O type 14; analog input; safetyrelated; current sensor; singlechannel sensor
Subunit B I Sensor
DQ and AQ must be connected to the same subunit. The current and voltage ranges of the AQs, AIs and sensors must be identical.
DQ
Subunit A or B
AQ
Subunit A or B
AI Subunit A I
DQ
I/O type 15; analog input; safetyrelated; current sensor; twochannel sensor
2 x AI 1 x DQ 1 x AQ
The current and voltage ranges of the AQs, AIs and sensors must be identical.
Sensor 1
Subunit B
AQ
Subunit A or B
DQ
I Sensor 2
Subunit A AI Subunit B
AI Subunit A AI Subunit B
I Sensor
I/O type 16; analog input; safetyrelated; intermittent mode; current sensor; singlechannel sensor I/O type 16; analog input; safetyrelated; intermittent mode; current or voltage sensor; twochannel sensor
2 x AI
6ES5 463-4U.12
AI Subunit A AI Subunit B
UI Sensor 1 UI Sensor 2
2 x AI
6ES5 463-4U.12
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/45
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Block diagrams and module combinations for S5-115F (continued) Block diagrams and module combinations (continued)
Characteristics I/O type 14; analog input; safetyrelated; voltage sensor; singlechannel sensor
Subunit B U
DQ
DQ and AQ must be connected to the same subunit. The current and voltage ranges of the AQs, AIs and sensors must be identical.
Sensor
Subunit A or B
AQ
Subunit A or B
AI Subunit A U
DQ
I/O type 15; analog input; safetyrelated; voltage sensor; twochannel sensor
2 x AI 1 x DQ 1 x AQ
The current and voltage ranges of the AQs, AIs and sensors must be identical.
Sensor 1
Subunit B
AQ
Subunit A or B
DQ
U Sensor 2
Subunit A AI Subunit B
AI Subunit A AI Subunit B
U Sensor
I/O type 16; analog input; safetyrelated; intermittent mode; voltage sensor; singlechannel sensor
2 x AI
6ES5 463-4U.12
AI Subunit A and B
UI Sensor
1 x AI or 1 x AI
1 x AQ
6ES5 470-7L.12
11/46
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
Program blocks for S5-115F Program blocks Configuration data blocks The data required for execu ting the safetyspecific func tions are stored in the confi guration data blocks. These blocks take up extremely little user memory space. For ge nerating the configuration data blocks the COM 115F parameterization software must first be loaded into the programming device. The programming device will then prompt the user when ente ring the necessary data, i. e. the configuration of the sy stem. The parameterization software is subdivided into the following groups: S Operating system parame ters S Communications data S Signal input and output data For setting the operating sys tem parameters, the user re quires certain data, such as monitoring times, test cycle time or time tolerances for Logic program counter Each block (except data blocks) must begin with the following sequence of state ments to enable the operating system to monitor the correct functional sequence of the blocks: input signal deviations be tween subunits. For cummunications via the SINEC L1 LAN, the user must specify, for example, the source and destination mail boxes. The mailboxes can be assigned to the flag area or data blocks. Standard modules are used for signal input and output. The wiring for input and out put modules used depends on the characteristics re quired (pages 11/43 up to 11/46). The COM 115F para meterization software, for ex ample, requires the following data: S Data block number under which the data is to be stored S Maximum discrepancy time between binary inputs S Location (address) of check outputs and readback inputs Signal group number for group passivation S Tolerance range for two channel analog input mod ules
S
S5115U/H/F
The data block numbers are predefined S DB 1: System configuration data block S DB 2: Error/fault data block for subunit A S DB 3: Error/fault data block for subunit B The numbers of the other con figuration data blocks can be defined by the user. Editing of the configuration data, e.g. correcting, chang ing or copying, is simple. The configuration data can also be printed out for documentation purposes.
L L + T
FW 0 KF+1 F FW 0
The logic program counter (LPLZ) enables the operating system to perform a number OB1 Cyclic program execution S OB2 Interrruptdriven program execution S OB13 Timecontrolled program execution
S
of monitoring functions. The counter must be activated at least every 128 statements. The logic program counter is assigned bit memory word 0. The user can use bit memo ries only from word 2 on wards. OB21 Startup characteristics for manual powerup S OB22 Startup characteristics for automatic powerup S OB251 Processing of PID control algorithm
S
Organization blocks
The following organization blocks are integrated in the operating system of the S5115F failsafe program mable controller:
The function blocks listed in the table below are imple mented in the operating sys tem of the S5115F and there fore do not take up any user memory space. The safety specific function blocks are explained below:
Function block FB 250 ANEI The FB 250 ANEI processes the analog values entered and converts them into scaled val ues. This function block also detects errors and issues er ror messages. A range moni tor can be used for detecting wire breaks. The function block executes all functions in connection with the evaluation of twochannel, safetyrelated analog value sensors. For ex ample, FB 250 ANEI gener ates from the slightly differing analog values of both sub units a single value, which both subunits can process.
Function block FB 253 MBXT The FB 253 MBXT permits the implementaiton of a twochan nel and thus faulttolerant SINEC L1 LAN. If a fault occurs on the main channel, the FB 253 copies the data in the mailbox of a second chan nel into the mailbox of the main channel.
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/47
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Program blocks, standard function blocks for the S5-115F Program blocks Integrated function blocks (continued) Function block FB 254 SYNC FB 254 SYNC synchronizes the two subunits irrespective of the times mentioned under "Principle of operation" (page 3/18). Program loca tions and time intervals for the synchronization of various functions can thus be defined. These are, for example: Updating of timers Calling of time process and interrupt service routines (organization blocks) S Updating the mailboxes of the SINEC L1 LAN S Data transfer to the pro gramming device
S S
Designation Code converter Code converter Multiplier Divider Readin analog value Output analog value Block transfer CP 523 Transfer mailbox Synchronization COD: B4 COD: 16 MUL: 16 DIV: 16 ANEI ANAU AGF:BLUE MBXT SYNC FB 240 FB 241 FB 242 FB 243 FB 250 FB 251 FB 252 FB 253 FB 254
Function Conversion of a 4decade BCDcoded number into a 16bit fixedpoint binary number Conversion of a 16bit fixedpoint binary num ber into a 6decade BCDcoded number Multiplication of two 16bit fixed point binary numbers Division of two 16bit fixedpoint binary numbers Readingin analog values via analog input modules Output of analog values via analog output modules Transfer of data to CP 523 Transferring the contents of the redundant SINEC L1 mailbox to the main mailbox Synchronization of the two subunits
Processing time1) 0.8 ms 1.3 ms 1.1 ms 2.6 ms 4.0 ms 6.0 ms 2 to 20 ms 2.0 ms 2.0 ms
1) Approximate average values; greatly dependent on parameters. Function blocks integrated in the operating system of the S5115F
Only the following FBs can be used for the S5115F pro grammable controller: S Prototypetested standard function blocks S Function blocks created by the user (tested during sys tem acceptance)
No other standard function blocks may be used. A check is made for such standard function blocks on system startup. The standard function blocks prototypetested by the Tech nical Inspectorate for Bavaria may be used, on the CPU 942F only, as follows:
Function blocks for arithme tic functions, signalling func tions and sequencer on CPU 942F from Order No. 6ES5 9427UF12 onwards S Function blocks for interfac ing on CPU 942F from Order No. 6ES5 942-7UF13 onwards S Standard function blocks for fuel engineering
S
11/48
Siemens ST 50 1998
Module
D D D D
Module type CPU 942F Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input p 8 x 24 V DC (interrupt module) 8 x 115 V UC module 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A p output 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A module 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ p / 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output p 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A module Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA p output 8 outputs, 10 V 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA module CP 523 for pointtopoint link IM 304 interface module for dist. conf. IM 306 interface module for cent. conf. IM304 interface mod. for CC int., 1st CC IM324 interface mod. for CC int., 2nd CC Total current for central controller
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5/7 4 5 5 5 3 7 7 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 9427UF13 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4517LA 11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4547LA11 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3243UA12
Current consumption at 5V Sum A A 0.8 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.01 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.035 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.13 1.5 0.05/21) 1.5 1.0
Total current for central controller and central expansion units (carried over from configuring sheets for central EUs) 1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951 power supply module (up to 7 A)
Accessories 1Adapter casing 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Frontstecker 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 7Other
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/49
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/50
Slot No.
PS CPU 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 IM Qty.
Component p list
D D D D
Module type CPU 942F Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input p 8 x 24 V DC (interrupt module) 8 x 115 V UC module 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A p output 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A module 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ p / 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output p 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A module Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA p output 8 outputs, 10 V 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA module CP 523 for pointtopoint link IM 304 interface module for dist. conf. IM 306 interface module for centr. conf. IM304 interface mod. for CC int., 1st CC IM324 interface mod. for CC int., 2nd CC Total current for central controller
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5/7 4 5 5 5 3 7 7 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 9427UF13 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4347LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4517LA11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4547LA11 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3243UA12
Current consumption at 5V Sum A A 0.8 0.005 0.07 0.005 0.005 0.1 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.035 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.25 0,25 0.13 1.5 0.05/21) 1.5 1.0
Total current for central controller and central expansion units (carried over from configuring sheets for central EUs) 1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951 power supply module (up to 7 A)
Accessories 1Adapter casing 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 4Front connector K, crimp/screw connection 5Front connector 490, crimp/screw/springtype connection 7Other
Sum
+
Total price of expansion units
=
Total price
Siemens ST 50 1998
General list (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Cross modules required
Siemens ST 50 1998
Module
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 8 x 115 V UC module d l 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A module d l 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 1 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output t t 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A Analog input, 8 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module d l 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA IM 306 interface module Total current for expansion unit
5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5/7 5 5 5 7
Bestell-Nr. 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4547LA11 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 3067LA11
Current consumption at 5V Sum A A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.035 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.15 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.05/21)
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/51
S5115U/H/F
Configuring
11/52
Slot Nr.
PS 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 IM Qty.
Component p list
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Cross modules required
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 8 x 115 V UC module d l 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A module d l 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output t t 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A Analog input, 8 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module d l 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA IM 306 interface module2) IM 314 interface module Total current for expansion unit
D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5/7 5 5 5 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4517LA.1 6ES5 4547LA11 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3143UA11
Current consumption at 5V Sum A A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.01 0.05 0.05 0.035 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.15 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.05/21) 1.0
1)Power consumption/current supply to EU 2)The ER 7012 can also be expanded centrally in the case of the S5115F; however, this means that no power supply can be installed in ER 7012
Total current expansion unit and central expansion units connected to the ER 701-2 (carried over from the configuring sheets for central EUs)
+
1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951 power supply module (up to 7 A)
Siemens ST 50 1998
General accessories (No., see below) Adapter casing required (D) Cross modules required
Module type Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 8 x 115 V UC module d l 8 x 230 V UC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A module d l 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 24 V DC; 2 A 8 x 115...230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 30 V AC relay contacts 8 x 30 V DC/250 V AC relay contacts Digital g 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A input/ 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A output t t 24 V DC: 16 inputs, 16 outputs 0.5 A module 24 V DC: 8 inputs, 8 outputs 2.5 A Analog g 8 inputs inputs 4 inputs2) Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0...20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V module d l 8 outputs, 1...5 V; 4...20 mA CP 523 for pointtopoint link IM 306 interface module3) IM 314 interface module Total current for central controller
D D 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5/7 6 5 5 5 3 7 7
Order No. 6ES5 4307LA12 6ES5 4357LC11 6ES5 4367LC11 6ES5 4517LA11 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4547LA11 6ES5 4547LB11 6ES5 4567LB11 6ES5 4587LA11 6ES5 4587LB11 6ES5 4827LA11 6ES5 4827LF11 6ES5 4827LF21 6ES5 4827LF31 6ES5 4607LA13 6ES5 4634U.12 6ES5 4707LA12 6ES5 4707LB12 6ES5 4707LC12 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 3067LA11 6ES5 3143UA11
Current consumption at 5V Sum A A 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.01 0.12 0.05 0.05 0.035 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.15 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.13 0.05/21) 1.0
1)Power consumption/current supply to EU2) In a centralized configuration of the ER 7013 with IM 306 the analog input module can be used only in the 1st/2nd expansion unit and only with connection cable 7050AF00 (0.5 m/1.64 ft)3)The ER 7013 can also be expanded centrally in the case of the S5115F; however, this means that no power supply unit can be installed in the ER 7013
+
1st EU 2nd EU
+
3rd EU
+
CC
Total current for expansion unit ER 701-3 and central expansion units connected to the ER 701-3 (carried over from the configuration sheet for central EUs)
PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951F power supply module (up to 7 A) PS 951 power supply module (up to 7 A)
Accessories 1Adapter casing 3RAM, EEPROM, EPROM memory submodule 5Front connector 490, crimp/srew/springtype connection 6Front connector 497, crimp/screw connection 7Other
6ES5 4974U...
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
11/53
Configuring
S5115U/H/F
Dimensions S5-115U/ S5-115H S5-115F (subunit)
302.6 mm/11.80 in
171.5 mm/6.69 in
The central controller with the CR 700-0 subrack and the expansion unit with the ER 701-0 subrack are both 353 mm/13.77 in. wide.
11/54
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/56
Slot No.
B
135U/155U central controller for S5-135U and S5-155U and ZG 135U central controller for S5-135U
Module
Qty.
B
Component list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D
1)
1)
1)
D D D
D D D D D
Order No. 6ES5 1883UA.. 6ES5 9223UA11 6ES5 9283UA12 6ES5 9283UB12 6ES5 9483UA.1 6ES5 9233UA11 6ES5 9233UC11 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
2.2 3.0 5.0 3.6 0.5 1.1 0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.09
1)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1)
1)
ZG 135U/155U central controller for S5-135U and S5-155U and ZG 135U central controller for S5-135U
D
1) 1) 1)
D D D D D D D D D D D D
1)
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA13 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31
D D D D
Module type Subrack CPUs CPU 922 CPU 928 CPU 928B CPU 948 923A coordinator 923C coordinator Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC modules d l 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115/230 V AC 8 x 115/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules d l 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V DC/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110 V DC/250 V AC; 5A ralay contact Digital 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) modules d l 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs; 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs; 10 V modules d l 8 outputs; 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Intelli IP 240 counter and pos. decoder mod. gent I/O IP 241 digital pos. decoder mod. modules d l IP 242A counter module IP 242B counter module Analogbaugruppe IP 243 Intelli IP 244 temperature control module gent I/O modules IP 246I positioning module IP 246A positioning module IP 247 positioning module 0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.8 1.0 7) 1.1 1.1 0.4 0.4 1.3 1.3 0.8 d8) d8) D d8)
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1)
Siemens ST 50 1998
D
d5)
6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12 6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063A.20 6FM1 7073AA10 6FM1 72.3A.00 6FM1 7233.A00 6ES5 5233UA11 6ES5 5243UA13 6ES5 5443U.11 6ES5 5263LA22 6AV1 2420AB.0
6AV4 0120AA100AB0
Special p modules
Interface module
IP 252 closedloop control module IP 260 closedloop control module IP 261 proportioning module2) IP 281 counter module WF 705 position decoding module WF 706 positioning module WF 707 cam controller module WF 721/WF 723 A pos. module WF 723 B/C positioning module CP 523 CP 524 CP 544/CP 544B CP 526 9) (exp.) CP 527 9) CP 528 9) CP 530 CP 2430 (I/O mode) for AS interface CP 24307) (page operation) for AS interf CP 1430 TF for ind. Ethernet CP 1430 TCP for ind. Ethernet CP 1473 MAP for ind. Ethernet CP 5431 FMS/DP for ind. Ethernet CP 581 integrated PC: basic module Mass storage module Slot module CP 516 memory submodule from CC to EU IM 3003 IM 3005LB IM 3005C IM 3013 IM 3015 IM 304 IM 307 IM 308 IM 308C
D D D D D D D D D D
5) 5) 5) 5)
6ES5 5303LA12 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 2430SA10 6GK1 1430T.0. 2XV9 4501AU00 6GK1 1473MA00 6GK1 5431AA01 6ES5 5811ED13 6ES5 5813LA11 6ES5 5810RA11 6ES5 5163UA11 6ES5 3003AB11 6ES5 3005LB11 6ES5 3005CA11 6ES5 3013AB13 6ES5 3015CA12 6ES5 3043UB11 6ES5 3073UA11 6ES5 3083UA12 6ES5 3083UC11 5) 6) 7) 8) Depending on version, 1 or 2 slots See Catalog ST 80.1 for detailed description of slot assignment Only slots 19-67 available for page operation in ZG (CC) 135K For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A
2.3 0.1 0.05 0.6 0.5 0.75/1.5 0.25 1.0/1.3 1.3 0.13 1.5 0.9 2.3 1.5 1.8 1.0 0.7 0.7 3 3 2.68) 0.45 1.8 0.5 4) 0.8 4) 0.8 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.8 0.8 1.2 1.0 0.5 0.7 Total current for central controller
1) 2) 3) 4)
No interrupt lines, thus functionality severely restricted Cannot be used with CPU 948. With IR transmission Depends on components used
Accessories:
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Total price
11/57
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/58
Slot No.
B
Component p list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1)
D D
Order No. 6ES5 1883UA.. 6ES5 9483UR.2 6ES5 9483UR51 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11 3.6 3.6 0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.09
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D d 8) D D D D
Module type Subrack CPU CPU 948R CPU 948RL Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC module 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC1) 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115 V/230 V AC 8 x 115 V/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A module 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V DC/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110 DC/250 V AC; 5 A relay contact Digital g 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) modules 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V modules 8 ouptuts, 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Intelli IP240 counter and pos. dec. module1) gent IP 241 digital pos. decoder module1) I/O IP 242A counter module1) modules IP 242B counter module1) Analog module IP 2431) Positioning module IP 246I IP 246A IP 247 positioning module IP 252 closedloop control module IP 260 closedloop control module IP 281 counter module1) 0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.8 1.07) 1.1 1.1 0.6 1.3 1.3 0.8 2.3 0.1 0.6
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2474UA.1 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2814U.12
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.13 1.5 0.9 1.8 1.0 0,.7 0.,7 0.45 3 3 2.65) 1.8 0.52) 0.82) 0.8 0.6 0.6 0.8 0.8 1.2 1.0 0.5 0.7 1.2 1.0 Total current for central controller Total price
CP 523 CP 524 CP 544/CP 544B CP 5283) CP 530 CP 2430 (I/O mode) for AS interface CP 24304) (page operation) for AS interf. CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS CP 1430 TF for ind. Ethernet CP 1430 TCP for ind. Ethernet CP 1473 MAP for ind. Ethernet Special p CP 581 integrated PC: basic module tasks Mass storage module Slot module CP 516 memory submodule Interface from CC to EU IM 3005LB modules IM 3005C IM 3033/IM 3013 IM 3015 IM 304 IM 307 IM 308 IM 308C from CC to CC IM 304 IM 324R 1) No interrupt processing possible
6AV4 0120AA100AB0
D 6ES5 5303LA12 D 6GK1 2432SA10 D 6GK1 2432SA10 D 6GK1 5431AA01 D 6GK1 1430T.0. D 2XV9 4501AU00 D 6GK1 1473MA00 D 6ES5 5811ED13 1-3 6ES5 5813LA11 1-3 6ES5 5810RA12 6ES5 5163UA11 D 6ES5 3005LB11 D 6ES5 3005CA11 D 6ES5 30.3AB1. D 6ES5 3015CA12 D 6ES5 3043UB11 D D 6ES5 3073UA11 D 6ES5 3083UA12 D 6ES5 3083UC11 D 6ES5 3043UB11 D 6ES5 3243UR11 3) See Catalog ST 80.1 for detailed description of slot assignment
Accessories:
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/59
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/60
Slot No.
B
Component p list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
Order No. 6ES5 1883UA.. 6ES5 9557NC11 6ES5 9483UR.2 6ES5 9483UR51 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11
D
3.6 3.6 0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.09
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
Module designation Subrack Power supply1) CPU CPU 948R CPU 948RL Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC2) 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115 V/230 V AC 8 x 115 V/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x relay contact 60 V/0.5 A 16 x relay contact 110 DC/250 V DC; 5 A Digital g 16/24 inputs. 24 V DC input 8/16 outputs. 24 V DC; 0.5 A output Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs. 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs. 10 V 8 outputs. 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Intelli Counter and pos. dec. module IP2402) gent I/O Digital position decoder module IP 2412) module Counter module IP 242A2) Counter module IP 242B2) Analog module IP 2432) Positioning module IP 246I IP 246A Positioning module IP 247 Closed-loop control module IP 252 Closed-loop control module IP 260 Counter module IP 2812) 0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.8 1.03) 1.1 1.1 0.6 1.3 1.3 0.8 2.3 0.1 0.6
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA13 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA13 6ES5 4704UB13 6ES5 4704UC13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2814U.12
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.13 1.5 0.9 1.8 1.0 1.8 0.53) 0.83) 0.8 1.2 0.5 0.7 1.2 1.0 Total current for central controller Total price
6AV4 0120AA100AB0
CP 523 CP 524 CP 544/CP 544B CP 528 4) CP 530 Special Integrated PC CP 581: tasks Basic assembly Mass storage module Slot module Memory module CP 516 Inter from CC to EU IM 304 faces IM 308 IM 308C from CC to CC IM 304 IM 324R 1) ) Part of scope p of supply pp y
1-3 6ES5 5813LA11 1-3 6ES5 5810RA12 6ES5 5163UA11 D 6ES5 3043UB11 D 6ES5 3083UA12 D 6ES5 3083UC11 D 6ES5 3043UB11 D 6ES5 3243UR11 3) on components used ) Depends p p
4 4) For
Accessories:
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/61
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/62
Slot number
B
Components p list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1)
Order No. 6ES5 1833UA.. 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11 0,08 0,10 0,09 0,2 0,08 0,10 0,10 0,08 0,08 0,12 0,12 0,10 0,10 0,10 0,10 0,12 0,08 0,12 0,09
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1)
1)
Module type Subrack Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC modules 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115/230 V AC 8 x 115/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110V DC/AC 250 V; 5A relay contact Digital g 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) modules 4 inupts (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V modules 8 outputs, 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Intelli IP240 counter and pos. dec. mod.2) gent I/O IP 241 digital pos. decoder module modules IP 243 analog module IP 260 cl loop control module IP 261 proportioning module4)6) IP 281 counter module Position decoder module WF 705 6) Positioning module WF 7062)6) Cam conditionerWF 7072)6)
d 5)
1)
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA13 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA13 6ES5 4704UB13 6ES5 4704UC13 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12 6FM1 7053AA00 6FM1 7063A.20 6FM1 7073AA10
0,15 0,2 0,2 0,15 0,7 0,25 0,25 0,25 0,8 1,0 3) 0,6 0,1 0,05 0,6 0,5 0,75/1,5 0,25
Siemens ST 50 1998
D D D D D D D D D D
Siemens ST 50 1998 4) Not applicable in connection with CPU 948. 5) Depending on version 1 or 2 slots. 6) Not released for CPU 948R/RL. 0.6 0.6 0.7 1.0 0.3 0.2 0.2 1.0 0.4 Total current for CC
from EU to CC/EU IM 3003 6ES5 3003AB11 IM 3005C 6ES5 3005CA11 IM 310 6ES5 3103AB11 IM 317 6ES5 3173UA11 IM 3183 6ES5 3183UA11 IM 312 6ES5 3123AB12 IM 312 6ES5 3123AB32 IM 314 6ES5 3143UA11 313 monitoring module 6ES5 3133AA12 1) .No interrupt lines, thus functionality severely restricted. 2) No interrupt processing possible. 3) Depending on components used.
Accessories:
S5135U, S5155U/H
Configuring
11/63
Total price
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/64
Slot number
B
Components p list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
Module type Subrack Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC modules 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115/230 V AC 8 x 115/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V DC/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110V DC/250V AC; 5A relay contact Digital g 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules 0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.09
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1)
Order No. 6ES5 1843UA.. 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11
8 inputs 4 inputs (50 Hz) 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 to 20 mA 8 outputs, 10 V 8 outputs, 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA IP240 counter and pos. dec. mod.2)
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6ES5 2401AA21
0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.8 0.6 3) 0.6 0.1 0.05 0.6
6ES5 2411AA12
Analog module IP 243 IP 260 cl. loop control module IP 261 proportioning module 4) IP 281 counter module 2)
Siemens ST 50 1998
Interface module
D D D
from EU to CC/EU IM 312 IM 312 313 monitoring module Total current for CC
1) 2) 3) 4)
No interrupt lines, thus functionality severely restricted. Only via IM 3005/IM 3125 interface module, since there is no power supply in the EU 184. Depending on components used. Not applicable in connection with CPU 948.
Accessories:
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Total price
11/65
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/66
Slot number
B
Component p list 2 1
B
3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107115123131139147155163
D D D
D D D D D
Order No. 6ES5 1853UA.. 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.09
1)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 2) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 2)
1) 1)
1)
D
1) 1) 1) 2)
1)
1)
1)
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1) 1)
1)
Module type Subrack Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC modules d l 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115/230 V AC 8 x 115/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules d l 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V DC/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110 V DC/250 V AC; 5A relay contact Digital 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) modules d l 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs; 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs; 10 V modules d l 8 outputs; 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Intelli IP 240 counter and pos. dec. module gent IP 241 digital pos. dec. module I/O IP 242A counter module modules IP 242B counter module IP 243 analog module IP 244 temperature control module IP 246I positioning module IP 246A positioning module IP 247 positioning module IP 252 closed-loop control module IP 260 closed-loop control module IP 261 proportioning module 7) IP 281 counter module IP 288 positioning module WF 705 position decoding module 3)
D D D D
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6ES5 2401AA21 6ES5 2411AA12 6ES5 2421AA32 6ES5 2421AA41 6ES5 2431AA13 6ES5 2443AB31 6ES5 2464UA31 6ES5 2464UB11 6ES5 2474UA31 6ES5 2523AA13 6ES5 2604UA11 6ES5 2614UA11 6ES5 2814U.12 6ES5 2884UA11 6FM1 7053AA00
0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0,8 1,0 6) 1,1 1,1 0,6 0,4 1,3 1,3 0,8 2,3 0,1 0.05 0.6 0.8 0.5
Siemens ST 50 1998
Siemens ST 50 1998 0.75/1.5 0.25 1.0/1.3 1.4 0.13 1.5 0.9 2.3 1.5 1.8 1.0 0.7 0.7 0.45 3 3 2.611) 1.8 0.5 6) 0.8 6) 0.8 0.6 0.6 0.6 1.0 1.0 0.3 0.5 0.7 1.0 0.4 Total current for central controller Total price
D d8) WF 706 positioning module 3)5) 6FM1 7063A.20 D WF 707 cam controller module 3) 6FM1 7073AA10 D WF 721/WF 723A positioning module 3) 6FM1 72.3AA00 D WF 723 B/C positioning module 3) 6FM1 7233.A00 Commu CP 523 D 6ES5 5233UA11 nica D CP 524 6ES5 5243UA13 ti tions D CP 544/CP 544B 6ES5 5443U.11 proces proces D CP 526 (Exp.) 9) 6ES5 5263LA22 sors D CP 527 9) 6AV1 2420AB.0 6AV4 0120AA100AB0 D CP 528 9) D CP 530 6ES5 5303LA12 D CP 2430 (I/O mode) for AS interface 6GK1 2430SA10 D CP 243010) (page operation) for AS int. 6GK1 2430SA10 D CP 5431 FMS/DP for PROFIBUS 6GK1 5431AA01 D CP 1430 TF for ind. Ethernet 6GK1 1430T.0. D CP 1430 TCP for ind. Ethernet 2XV9 4501AU00 D CP 1473 MAP for ind. Ethernet 6GK1 1473MA00 Special p CP 581 integrated PC: basic module 6ES5 5811ED13 modules Mass storage module 13 6ES5 5813LA11 13 Slot module 6ES5 5810RA12 CP 516 memory submodule 6ES5 5163UA11 Interface from CC to EU D IM 3003 6ES5 3003AB11 module D IM 3005C 6ES5 3005CA11 D IM 310 6ES5 3103AB11 D IM 314 6ES5 3143UA11 D D IM 317 6ES5 3173UA11 D IM 3183 6ES5 3183UA11 D IM 308 6ES5 3083UA12 D IM 308C 12) 6ES5 3083UC11 D for progr. contr. S5155H IM 314R 6ES5 314UR11 D 313 monitoring module 6ES5 3133AA12 1) No interrupt lines, thus functionally severely restricted. 2) When IM 307/IM 317 interface modules are used, the IP 244 temperature control module may not be used. 3) Not with S5155H. 5) No interrupt processing possible. 6) Depending on components used. 7) Cannot be used with CPU 948. 8) 1 or 2 slots depending on the variant. 9) For more information on slot assignment please refer to Catalog ST 80.1. 10) Only slots 19-67 available for page operation in ZG (CC) 135K 11) For power supply of a transceiver max. 4.2 A 12) Operation in EU 185U only in combination with S5-155H
Accessories:
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/67
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
11/68
Slot No.
B
Component p list 2 1
B
3
D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D D
Order No. 6ES5 1873UA.. 6ES5 4204UA14 6ES5 4304UA14 6ES5 4314UA12 6ES5 4324UA12 6ES5 4344UA12 6ES5 4354UA12 6ES5 4364UA12 6ES5 4364UB12 6ES5 4414UA14 6ES5 4514UA14 6ES5 4534UA12 6ES5 4544UA14 6ES5 4554UA12 6ES5 4564UA12 6ES5 4564UB12 6ES5 4574UA12 6ES5 4584UA12 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4584UC11 6ES5 4824UA11
19 35 51 67 83 99 115 131 147 163
0.08 0.10 0.09 0.2 0.08 0.10 0.10 0.08 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.10 0.12 0.08 0.12 0.12 0.09
D D D D D D D D D D D D
Module type Subrack Digital g 32 x 24 V DC input 32 x 24 V DC modules 16 x 24/48/60 V DC 32 x 24 V DC 32 x 5/15 V DC 16 x 24/48/60 V AC 16 x 115/230 V AC 8 x 115/230 V AC Digital g 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A output 32 x 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24 V DC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V AC; 2 A 16 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 8 x 115/230 V AC; 2 A 16 x 24/48/60 V DC; 0.5 A 16 x 60 V DC/0.5 A relay contact 16 x 110V DC/250V AC; 5A relay contact 16 x relay contact 110V DC/250V DC;5A Digital g 16/24 inputs, 24 V DC I/O 8/16 outputs, 24 V DC; 0.5 A modules Analog g 8 inputs input 4 inputs (50 Hz) modules 4 inputs (60 Hz) 8/16 inputs 8/16 inputs Analog g 8 outputs, 10 V; 0 to 20 mA output 8 outputs, 10 V modules 8 outputs, 1 to 5 V; 4 to 20 mA Comm. CP 2430 for AS interface proc. Interface from EU to CC/EU IM 312 modules IM 312 313 monitoring module 0.15 0.2 0.2 0.15 0.7 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.7 0.2 0.2 0.4 Total current for expansion unit
6ES5 4604UA13 6ES5 4634UA12 6ES5 4634UB12 6ES5 4654UA12 6ES5 4663LA11 6ES5 4704UA12 6ES5 4704UB12 6ES5 4704UC12 6GK1 2430SA10
Siemens ST 50 1998
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Accessories:
Total price
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/69
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite Design The fault-tolerant program mable controllers S5-155H and S5-155H Lite are avail able in two versions. One basic version consists of two separate subunits each with S One central controller CC 135U/155U with integrated power supply chassis and S One central controller CPU 948R/RL The other basic version con sists of S A central controller CC 155H divided into two halves and S One central controller mod ule CPU 948R/RL and one power supply module for each half. I/O types In order to distinguish the dif ferent configurations available for the I/O modules, they are divided into I/O types. The 4 different configurations are matched by 4 different modes of operation:
S
The two subunits are con nected via the IM 304 and IM 324R interface modules and the 721 connecting cable (max. 100m/328 ft). Each sub unit/half requires the same amount of memory.
I/O modules are available in 4 different configurations de pending on the level of availa bility required for the I/O area: S Singlesided configuration S Switched configuration S Doubleredundancyconfigu ration S Tripleredundancy configu ration
The I/O module is only ad dressed by the master unit. Information read in is auto matically passed to the standby unit so that it can take over operation smoothly if required.
S
1 or 3 sensors can be used per tripleredundant input. The maximum possible avail ability is achieved when using 3 sensors, since the faulty sensor can be localized and deactivated. The table on the next page shows an overview of the I/O types for the addresses re quired. The table on the next page contains a number of exam ples. It also describes the amount of wiring required. If an input/output byte is par tially reserved with redundant DI or DQ addresses, it can no longer be used for nonredun dant inputs and outputs.
The I/O module is perma nently assigned to one of the two subunits. The module re mains active for as long as the corresponding subunit is in operation. Information read in is also available in the other subunit irrespective of whether it is operating as a master or standby unit. The peripheral address used may not be used in the second subunit.
S
Each I/O module is available in duplicate. The I/O modules occupy the same I/O ad dresses in both subunits. Both modules are active in normal, faultfree operation.
S
The I/O modules are available in triplicate. Two inputs re serve the same I/O address in both subunits. The third input can either be of the single sided or switched type.
11/70
Siemens ST 50 1998
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (continued) I/O types (continued)
Configuring
I/O
Required addresses including readback digital inputs (RDI), without locating inputs/outputs Device Digital input (DI) Design Singlesided Switched Double redundancy Triple redundancy Singlesided Switched Double redundancy Double redundancy Non intermittent Singlesided Switched Double redundancy Triple redundancy Singlesided Switched Double redundancy Double redundancy4) Singlesided Switched DI 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte1) 2 byte2) 1 byte1) (RDI) 2 byte (RDI) 1 byte 1 byte 1 byte1) 1 byte2) DQ AI AQ
Type 1 2 3 4 8 9 10 11
13 14 15 16 18 19 20 21 24 25
1 word 1 word 1 word1) 2 word2) 1 word 1 word 1 word1) 1 bit3) Addressing according to module 1 word (RAI) 1 word1)
CP/IP
Example 10 x 2 redundant DIs without fault location (type 3) 5 x 2 redundant DIs with fault location (type 3) 8 x 2 redundant DIs with fault location (type 10)
1 byte DI 1 byte LDI 1 byte LDQ 1 byte DQ 1 bit LDI 1 bit LDQ 1 byte RDI 2 byte DI 1 byte DQ 1 bit LDI 1 bit LDQ 2 byte RDI
5 DIs per subunit 1 LDI per subunit 1 LDQ per subunit 8 DQs per subunit 1 LDI per subunit 1 LDQ per subunit 8 RDI (assigned to subunit A, B or switched) 24 DI 8 DQ per subunit 1 LDI per subunit 1 LDQ per subunit 8 RDQ per subunit 8 RDI (assigned A, B or switched)
Examples of required addresses and inputs/outputs in the case of redundant I/O configuration Legend: DI, DQ = Digital input/output AI, AQ = Analog input/output LDI, LDQ = Localization input/output RDI = Readback digital input
1) 2) 3) 4)
Address identical in subunit A and subunit B. As 1); the 2nd address is required for the 3rd channel (either in subunit A, subunit B or switched EU, as required). As 1); 1 byte DQ for 8 AQ channels. With fault localization.
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/71
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (continued) Redundant inputs Each subunit scans the inputs assigned to it. The user speci fies a "discrepancy time" (20 ms to 320 s) for each digi tal input. This is the maximum permissible time deviation be tween the signals at 2 redun dant inputs. The operating system monitors this discrep ancy time. If the permissible time is exceeded, the operat ing system locates and re ports the fault (entry in fault data block). In the case of redundant digi tal outputs, the operating sys tem checks by reading back the outputs, whether a fault has occurred. If required, the operating system signals the fault (entry in fault data block). In order to ensure nonstop operation, the operating system must not only detect but also locate faults so that the faulty module can be deactivated. Double-redundancy configuration In the case of doubleredun dancy configuration, faults are recognized and located in the case of digital outputs using auxiliary signals. Additional, external wiring is required for this purpose. The following 2 possibilities exist for doubleredundancy digital inputs and outputs: S Fault recognition without fault locating S Fault recognition with fault locating Only the fault recognition without locating alternative is possible for doubleredun dancy analog inputs. If fault locating is required, the user must install a tripleredun dancy configuration. Addressing The redundant digital input and output modules can only be operated in the process image area (addresses 0 to 127), and the analog input and output modules in the P area (addresses 128 to 254) and in the Q area (addresses 0 to 254). In the case of analog input modules, the user specifies the maximum permissible value by which the input sig nals may deviate. This "dis crepancy window" is moni tored by ANEI function blocks. The function block is supplied on diskette together with the COM 155H parame terization software. Suitable modules The redundant operation of digital input modules with an input voltage of 115/230V AC (6ES5 435-4UA1. and 6ES5 436-4U...) is not allowed.
Redundant outputs
Fault detection is not available for redundant analog outputs. If required it can be pro grammed by the user (with readback analog inputs).
Decoupling In redundant 441, 451 and 454 digital output modules for 24 V DC, the outputs con nected in parallel must be de coupled by means of diodes. The same applies to the locat ing outputs. The user can determine the number of DI or DQ per group (recommended: 1 module per group). In the case of redun dant AQ with fault location (type 21), one readback AI (RAI) and one LDQ is re quired per output (recom mended: relay module 6ES5 4584...). Triple-redundancy configuration Fault recognition is automati cally accompanied by fault location in the case of triple redundancy inputs. In con trast to the doubleredun dancy configuration, auxiliary signals are not required.
Analog outputs with (type 21) or without (type 20) fault loca tion can be implemented. A function block is available for fault location (included in the COM 155H scope of deliv ery). Readback inputs, locating inputs and outputs For fault detection of redun dant DQ, readback inputs (RDI) are necessary; fault location requires locating in puts and outputs (LDI, LDQ). Readback inputs are perma nently assigned to their re dundant outputs (1 readback input per output pair). Read back inputs can be allocated to subunit A, subunit B or a switched expansion unit. Locating inputs and outputs can be grouped for several inputs or outputs.
Double-redundancy configuration The auxiliary signals LDI, LDQ and RDI required for fault recognition and locating can be operated in the entire P area; RDI can also be op erated in the Q area.
Triple-redundancy configuration The third input can be oper ated in the complete P and Q area.
11/72
Siemens ST 50 1998
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (continued) I/O types for redundant configuration I/O type 3 (double-redundancy digital inputs) I/O type 3 without fault loca tion: If locating inputs/outputs (LDI, LDQ) are not parame terized, the S5155H contin ues working in the case of a discrepancy with a value that may be the wrong one. If such a case cannot be tolerated, the redundant digital inputs (DI) must be operated with fault location or implemented with triple redundancy (type 4).
DI
Subunit A Sensor
Configuring
DI
Subunit B
I/O type 3 with fault location: In this case, locating inputs/ outputs (LDI, LDQ) are used in addition to the redundant digital inputs (DI). The operat ing system can thus not only recognize faults, but it can also locate and deactivate the faulty DI module. The S5155H then only continues working with the faultfree module. The LDQ and LDI are as signed by groups to the re dundant digital inputs. A group comprises all DI, which are connected to the same sensor supply.
L-DQ L-DI
Subunit A
DI
Sensor Subunit B
DI L-DQ L-DI Fig. 11/7 Doubleredundancy digital input with fault location
I/O type 4 (triple-redundancy digital inputs) The operating system per forms a cyclic scan to compare whether the signal status of the 3 inputs is identi cal. If different signal statuses are found to exist after expiry of the discrepancy time, a fault is signalled. A valid sig nal status is one derived from the 2outof3 decision result.
Subunit A
DI Subunit A, B or switched DI
Subunit A
DI
DI
DI
Singlechannel sensor
DI
Redundant sensor
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/73
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (contined) I/O types for redundant configuration I/O type 10 (double-redundancy digital outputs) I/O type 10 is designed for fault recognition with re stricted or complete fault location (depending on ver sion) for intermittent outputs. An output is intermittent if it changes its signal status at least once per hour. Since the RDI readback digital inputs are permanently assigned to the redundant digital outputs (DQ), just as many RDIs are required as redundant DQs. I/O type 10 with restricted fault location If locating inputs/outputs (LDQ, LDI) are not parame terized, it is only possible to recognize and locate "perma nent 0 faults" (DQ cannot be switched to "1"). If such a case cannot be tolerated, i.e. it must also be possible to handle "permanent 1 fault", the redundant digital outputs must be operated with fault location. I/O type 10 with fault location In this case, location inputs/ outputs (LDI, LDQ) must be provided in addition to the re dundant digital outputs (DQ) and the readback digital input (RDI). The operating system can thus recognize and locate not only "permanent 0 faults" but it can also deactivate the faulty DQ modules in case of "permanent 1 faults".
Subunit A
DI
Subunit B
DI
Subunit A or B
DI
Fig. 11/9 Double-redundancy intermittent digital output with restricted fault location
L-DQ L-DI
L-
L+
L+
DQ
Subunit A
R-DI
DQ
Subunit B L+
L-DI L-DQ
L-
11/74
Siemens ST 50 1998
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (continued) I/O types for redundant configuration I/O type 11 (double-redundancy nonintermittent digital outputs) I/O type 11 is capable of fault recognition and location in volving non-intermittent out puts. Three RDis are required per redundant DQ. An RDI is assigned to each subunit. The third RDI ist either assigned to a subunit or is in switched configuration. I/O type 15 (double-redundancy analog inputs) This I/O type provides fault recognition with restricted fault location in the case of re dundant analog inputs (AI). During fault location, the oper ating system accesses fault information of AI modules via a standard function block. Fault information includes range violation, overrange and wire break. The operating system can recognize, locate and deacti vate "permanent 0 faults" and "permanent 1 faults. The circuit is stuctured as for I/O type 10. Two DIs must be provided for each DQ pair.
Configuring
Twochannel
Subunit A
AI
Subunit B
AI
Subunit B
AI
AI
Twochannel
Subunit A
AI
R=500 W Subunit B
AI
Subunit B
AI
AI
I/O type 16 (triple-redundancy analog inputs) This I/O type provides fault recognition with fault location for redundant analog inputs (AI). In order to recognize faults, the 3 analog values are checked for discrepancy. If a singlesided locatable fault occurs (QVZ acknowledgment delay, wire break), the module is deactivated. If the operat ing system locates a discrep ancy fault, the operating sys tem waits until the discrepancy time has elapsed and then deactivates the module the analog value of which deviates most from the other two values.
Three-channel
Subunit A
AI Subunit A, B or switched AI
Subunit B
AI Subunit A, B or switched AI
Subunit B
AI
Threechannel
Subunit A
AI Subunit A, B or switched AI
R=500 W Subunit B
AI
AI
Subunit B
AI
AI
Siemens ST 50 1998
11/75
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Design S5-155H and S5-155H Lite (continued) Design (contined) I/O types for redundant configuration I/O type 20 (redundant analog outputs) This I/O type does not receive any operating system support in the recognition and locating of faults. They must be pro grammed by the user. The output values are output to both subunits in parallel. I/O type 21 The analog output is available under the same address in both subunits. One AI and one L-DQ (e.g. DQ 458) are also necessary. Only one side is active. It is checked whether the passive AQ chan nel is intact by changing over the active side.
Subunit A
Analog actuator
Subunit B
AQ AI
Subunit A, B or switched
R-AE
Current output
Subunit A
Analog actuator
AQ AI
50 W
Subunit A, B or switched
R-AI
11/76
Siemens ST 50 1998
S5135U, S5155U/H
Technical specifications and dimensions Technical specifications
Insulation group Degree of protection Ambient temperature Transport and storage temperature Humidity rating Altitude rating Mechanical stress C in acc. with VDE 0110 (line side), Part 13 Group 2 (for 48 V, 24 V and 5 V inputs/outputs) IP 20 for power supply modules or modules with screw terminals, otherwise IP 00 0 to +55 _C (air inlet temperature, below) -40 to +70 _C F in acc. with DIN 40040 ( 15% to 95%, no condensation) S in acc. with DIN 40040 (860 to 1060hPa; 660 to 1060 hPa for transport and storage) Installation in stationary equipment, free from vibration; Installation on ships and in vehicles, provided that special installation rules are observed, but not on the engine assembly see page 4/134 approx. ZG 135U/155: ZG 135U: EG 183U, EG 185U: EG 184U: EG 187U: 14 kg (30.8 Ib) 16 kg (35.2 Ib) 14 kg (30.8 Ib) 13 kg (28.6 Ib) 11 kg (24.2 Ib)
Configuring
440/17.16
266/10.37 432/16.85
465/18.14 482/18.8
440
178
420
266
465 482
Siemens ST 50 1998
11,5
11/77
220
53.4
32
310/12.09
178
Configuring
S5135U, S5155U/H
Technical specifications and dimensions (continued)
11/78
Siemens ST 50 1998
11.5/0.45 220/8.58